REJ09B0426-0100 16 H8S/2604 Group Hardware Manual Renesas 16-Bit Single-Chip Microcomputer H8S Family/H8S/2600 Series H8S/2604 H8S/2603 Rev.1.00 Revision Date: Jan. 24, 2008 HD64F2604 HD6432604 HD6432603 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page ii of xxxvi Notes regarding these materials 1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in this document. 2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples. 3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations. 4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed through our website. (http://www.renesas.com ) 5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information included in this document. 6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application. Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the information in this document or Renesas products. 7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above. 8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below: (1) artificial life support devices or systems (2) surgical implantations (3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.) (4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all damages arising out of such applications. 9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges. 10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system manufactured by you. 11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment. 12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written approval from Renesas. 13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page iii of xxxvi General Precautions on Handling of Product 1. Treatment of NC Pins Note: Do not connect anything to the NC pins. The NC (not connected) pins are either not connected to any of the internal circuitry or are used as test pins or to reduce noise. If something is connected to the NC pins, the operation of the LSI is not guaranteed. 2. Treatment of Unused Input Pins Note: Fix all unused input pins to high or low level. Generally, the input pins of CMOS products are high-impedance input pins. If unused pins are in their open states, intermediate levels are induced by noise in the vicinity, a passthrough current flows internally, and a malfunction may occur. 3. Processing before Initialization Note: When power is first supplied, the product's state is undefined. The states of internal circuits are undefined until full power is supplied throughout the chip and a low level is input on the reset pin. During the period where the states are undefined, the register settings and the output state of each pin are also undefined. Design your system so that it does not malfunction because of processing while it is in this undefined state. For those products which have a reset function, reset the LSI immediately after the power supply has been turned on. 4. Prohibition of Access to Undefined or Reserved Addresses Note: Access to undefined or reserved addresses is prohibited. The undefined or reserved addresses may be used to expand functions, or test registers may have been be allocated to these addresses. Do not access these registers; the system's operation is not guaranteed if they are accessed. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page iv of xxxvi Configuration of This Manual This manual comprises the following items: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. General Precautions on Handling of Product Configuration of This Manual Preface Contents Overview Description of Functional Modules • CPU and System-Control Modules • On-Chip Peripheral Modules The configuration of the functional description of each module differs according to the module. However, the generic style includes the following items: i) Feature ii) Input/Output Pin iii) Register Description iv) Operation v) Usage Note When designing an application system that includes this LSI, take notes into account. Each section includes notes in relation to the descriptions given, and usage notes are given, as required, as the final part of each section. 7. List of Registers 8. Electrical Characteristics 9. Appendix 10. Main Revisions and Additions in this Edition (only for revised versions) The list of revisions is a summary of points that have been revised or added to earlier versions. This does not include all of the revised contents. For details, see the actual locations in this manual. 11. Index Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page v of xxxvi Preface The H8S/2604 Group single-chip microcomputer is made up of the high-speed H8S/2600 CPU as its core, and the peripheral functions required configuring a system. The H8S/2600 CPU has an instruction set that is compatible with the H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs. Target Users: This manual was written for users who will be using the H8S/2604 Group in the design of application systems. Target users are expected to understand the fundamentals of electrical circuits, logical circuits, and microcomputers. Objective: This manual was written to explain the hardware functions and electrical characteristics of the H8S/2604 Group to the target users. Refer to the H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual for a detailed description of the instruction set. Notes on reading this manual: • In order to understand the overall functions of the chip Read the manual according to the contents. This manual can be roughly categorized into parts on the CPU, system control functions, peripheral functions, and electrical characteristics. • In order to understand the details of the CPU's functions Read the H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual. • In order to understand the details of a register when its name is known Read the index that is the final part of the manual to find the page number of the entry on the register. The addresses, bits, and initial values of the registers are summarized in section 21, List of Registers. Examples: Register name: The following notation is used for cases when the same or a similar function, e.g. 16-bit timer pulse unit or serial communication, is implemented on more than one channel: XXX_N (XXX is the register name and N is the channel number) Bit order: The MSB is on the left and the LSB is on the right. Related Manuals: The latest versions of all related manuals are available from our web site. Please ensure you have the latest versions of all documents you require. http://www.renesas.com/ Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page vi of xxxvi H8S/2604 Group manuals: Document Title Document No. H8S/2604 Group Hardware Manual This manual H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual REJ09B0139 User's manuals for development tools: Document Title Document No. H8S, H8/300 Series C/C++ Compiler, Assembler, Optimizing Linkage Editor User's Manual REJ10B0058 Microcomputer Development Environment System H8S, H8/300 Series Simulator/Debugger User's Manual ADE-702-037 H8S, H8/300 Series High-performance Embedded Workshop 3 Tutorial REJ10B0024 H8S, H8/300 Series High-performance Embedded Workshop 3 User's Manual REJ10B0026 All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page vii of xxxvi Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page viii of xxxvi Contents Section 1 Overview................................................................................................1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 Overview................................................................................................................................ 1 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................................... 2 Pin Assignment ...................................................................................................................... 3 Pin Functions ......................................................................................................................... 4 Section 2 CPU......................................................................................................11 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 Features................................................................................................................................ 11 2.1.1 Differences between H8S/2600 CPU and H8S/2000 CPU ..................................... 12 2.1.2 Differences from H8/300 CPU ............................................................................... 13 2.1.3 Differences from H8/300H CPU............................................................................. 13 CPU Operating Modes......................................................................................................... 14 2.2.1 Normal Mode.......................................................................................................... 14 2.2.2 Advanced Mode...................................................................................................... 15 Address Space...................................................................................................................... 18 Registers............................................................................................................................... 19 2.4.1 General Registers.................................................................................................... 20 2.4.2 Program Counter (PC) ............................................................................................ 21 2.4.3 Extended Control Register (EXR) .......................................................................... 21 2.4.4 Condition-Code Register (CCR)............................................................................. 22 2.4.5 Multiply-Accumulate Register (MAC)................................................................... 23 2.4.6 Initial Values of CPU Registers .............................................................................. 23 Data Formats........................................................................................................................ 24 2.5.1 General Register Data Formats ............................................................................... 24 2.5.2 Memory Data Formats ............................................................................................ 26 Instruction Set ...................................................................................................................... 27 2.6.1 Table of Instructions Classified by Function .......................................................... 28 2.6.2 Basic Instruction Formats ....................................................................................... 37 Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation........................................................ 38 2.7.1 Register DirectRn ............................................................................................... 39 2.7.2 Register Indirect@ERn ....................................................................................... 39 2.7.3 Register Indirect with Displacement@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:32, ERn)................. 39 2.7.4 Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement@ERn+ or @-ERn..... 40 2.7.5 Absolute Address@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32....................................... 40 2.7.6 Immediate#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32.................................................................... 41 2.7.7 Program-Counter Relative@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)....................................... 41 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page ix of xxxvi 2.8 2.9 2.7.8 Memory Indirect@@aa:8 ................................................................................... 41 2.7.9 Effective Address Calculation ................................................................................ 42 Processing States.................................................................................................................. 45 Usage Note........................................................................................................................... 46 2.9.1 Notes on Using the Bit Operation Instruction......................................................... 46 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes ....................................................................... 47 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 Operating Mode Selection ................................................................................................... 47 Register Descriptions........................................................................................................... 47 3.2.1 Mode Control Register (MDCR) ............................................................................ 48 3.2.2 System Control Register (SYSCR)......................................................................... 49 Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode ............................................................................... 50 Address Map ........................................................................................................................ 51 Section 4 Exception Handling ............................................................................. 53 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 Exception Handling Types and Priority............................................................................... 53 Exception Sources and Exception Vector Table .................................................................. 53 Reset .................................................................................................................................... 55 4.3.1 Reset Exception Handling ...................................................................................... 55 4.3.2 Interrupts after Reset............................................................................................... 57 4.3.3 State of On-Chip Peripheral Modules after Reset Release ..................................... 58 Traces................................................................................................................................... 58 Interrupts.............................................................................................................................. 59 Trap Instruction.................................................................................................................... 60 Stack Status after Exception Handling................................................................................. 61 Usage Note........................................................................................................................... 62 Section 5 Interrupt Controller.............................................................................. 63 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 Features................................................................................................................................ 63 Input/Output Pins................................................................................................................. 65 Register Descriptions........................................................................................................... 65 5.3.1 Interrupt Priority Registers A to M (IPRA to IPRM) ............................................. 66 5.3.2 IRQ Enable Register (IER) ..................................................................................... 67 5.3.3 IRQ Sense Control Registers H and L (ISCRH, ISCRL)........................................ 68 5.3.4 IRQ Status Register (ISR)....................................................................................... 70 Interrupt Sources.................................................................................................................. 71 5.4.1 External Interrupts .................................................................................................. 71 5.4.2 Internal Interrupts ................................................................................................... 72 Interrupt Exception Handling Vector Table......................................................................... 72 Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt Operation ................................................................ 76 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page x of xxxvi 5.7 5.6.1 Interrupt Control Mode 0 ........................................................................................ 76 5.6.2 Interrupt Control Mode 2 ........................................................................................ 78 5.6.3 Interrupt Exception Handling Sequence ................................................................. 80 5.6.4 Interrupt Response Times ....................................................................................... 82 5.6.5 DTC Activation by Interrupt................................................................................... 83 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................... 83 5.7.1 Conflict between Interrupt Generation and Disabling ............................................ 83 5.7.2 Instructions that Disable Interrupts ......................................................................... 84 5.7.3 When Interrupts Are Disabled ................................................................................ 84 5.7.4 Interrupts during Execution of EEPMOV Instruction............................................. 85 5.7.5 IRQ Interrupt .......................................................................................................... 85 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) .................................................................87 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 Features................................................................................................................................ 87 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................... 88 6.2.1 Break Address Register A (BARA) ........................................................................ 88 6.2.2 Break Address Register B (BARB) ........................................................................ 89 6.2.3 Break Control Register A (BCRA) ......................................................................... 89 6.2.4 Break Control Register B (BCRB).......................................................................... 90 Operation ............................................................................................................................. 90 6.3.1 PC Break Interrupt Due to Instruction Fetch .......................................................... 90 6.3.2 PC Break Interrupt Due to Data Access.................................................................. 91 6.3.3 PC Break Operation at Consecutive Data Transfer................................................. 91 6.3.4 Operation in Transitions to Power-Down Modes ................................................... 91 6.3.5 When Instruction Execution Is Delayed by One State............................................ 92 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................... 93 6.4.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ..................................................................................... 93 6.4.2 PC Break Interrupts ................................................................................................ 93 6.4.3 CMFA and CMFB .................................................................................................. 93 6.4.4 PC Break Interrupt when DTC Is Bus Master ........................................................ 93 6.4.5 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Address Following BSR, JSR, JMP, TRAPA, RTE, or RTS Instruction............................................... 93 6.4.6 I Bit Set by LDC, ANDC, ORC, or XORC Instruction .......................................... 93 6.4.7 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Address Following Bcc Instruction............. 94 6.4.8 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Branch Destination Address of Bcc Instruction...................................................................................... 94 Section 7 Bus Controller......................................................................................95 7.1 Basic Timing........................................................................................................................ 95 7.1.1 On-Chip Memory Access Timing (ROM, RAM) ................................................... 95 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xi of xxxvi 7.2 7.1.2 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Timing........................................................... 96 7.1.3 On-Chip SSU Module and Realtime Input Port Data Register Access Timing ...... 97 Bus Arbitration .................................................................................................................... 98 7.2.1 Order of Priority of the Bus Masters....................................................................... 98 7.2.2 Bus Transfer Timing............................................................................................... 98 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC).......................................................... 99 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 Features................................................................................................................................ 99 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 101 8.2.1 DTC Mode Register A (MRA) ............................................................................. 102 8.2.2 DTC Mode Register B (MRB).............................................................................. 103 8.2.3 DTC Source Address Register (SAR)................................................................... 103 8.2.4 DTC Destination Address Register (DAR)........................................................... 103 8.2.5 DTC Transfer Count Register A (CRA) ............................................................... 103 8.2.6 DTC Transfer Count Register B (CRB)................................................................ 104 8.2.7 DTC Enable Registers (DTCER).......................................................................... 104 8.2.8 DTC Vector Register (DTVECR)......................................................................... 105 Activation Sources............................................................................................................. 106 Location of Register Information and DTC Vector Table ................................................. 107 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 110 8.5.1 Normal Mode........................................................................................................ 111 8.5.2 Repeat Mode......................................................................................................... 112 8.5.3 Block Transfer Mode ............................................................................................ 113 8.5.4 Chain Transfer ...................................................................................................... 115 8.5.5 Interrupts............................................................................................................... 116 8.5.6 Operation Timing.................................................................................................. 116 8.5.7 Number of DTC Execution States ........................................................................ 117 Procedures for Using DTC................................................................................................. 119 8.6.1 Activation by Interrupt.......................................................................................... 119 8.6.2 Activation by Software ......................................................................................... 119 Examples of Use of the DTC ............................................................................................. 120 8.7.1 Normal Mode........................................................................................................ 120 8.7.2 Chain Transfer ...................................................................................................... 121 8.7.3 Software Activation .............................................................................................. 122 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 123 8.8.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ................................................................................... 123 8.8.2 On-Chip RAM ...................................................................................................... 123 8.8.3 DTCE Bit Setting.................................................................................................. 123 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xii of xxxvi Section 9 I/O Ports .............................................................................................125 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 9.7 9.8 Port 1.................................................................................................................................. 129 9.1.1 Port 1 Data Direction Register (P1DDR).............................................................. 129 9.1.2 Port 1 Data Register (P1DR)................................................................................. 130 9.1.3 Port 1 Register (PORT1)....................................................................................... 130 9.1.4 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 131 Port 3.................................................................................................................................. 134 9.2.1 Port 3 Data Direction Register (P3DDR).............................................................. 134 9.2.2 Port 3 Data Register (P3DR)................................................................................. 135 9.2.3 Port 3 Register (PORT3)....................................................................................... 135 9.2.4 Port 3 Open-Drain Control Register (P3ODR) ..................................................... 136 9.2.5 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 136 Port 4.................................................................................................................................. 138 9.3.1 Port 4 Register (PORT4)....................................................................................... 138 Port 7.................................................................................................................................. 139 9.4.1 Port 7 Data Direction Register (P7DDR).............................................................. 139 9.4.2 Port 7 Data Register (P7DR)................................................................................. 140 9.4.3 Port 7 Register (PORT7)....................................................................................... 140 9.4.4 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 141 Port 9.................................................................................................................................. 143 9.5.1 Port 9 Register (PORT9)....................................................................................... 143 Port A................................................................................................................................. 144 9.6.1 Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) ............................................................ 144 9.6.2 Port A Data Register (PADR)............................................................................... 145 9.6.3 Port A Register (PORTA)..................................................................................... 145 9.6.4 Port A Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PAPCR) ................................................. 146 9.6.5 Port A Open-Drain Control Register (PAODR) ................................................... 146 9.6.6 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 147 Port B ................................................................................................................................. 148 9.7.1 Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) ............................................................ 148 9.7.2 Port B Data Register (PBDR) ............................................................................... 149 9.7.3 Port B Register (PORTB) ..................................................................................... 149 9.7.4 Port B Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PBPCR) ................................................. 150 9.7.5 Port B Open-Drain Control Register (PBODR).................................................... 150 9.7.6 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 151 Port C ................................................................................................................................. 153 9.8.1 Port C Data Direction Register (PCDDR) ............................................................ 153 9.8.2 Port C Data Register (PCDR) ............................................................................... 154 9.8.3 Port C Register (PORTC) ..................................................................................... 154 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xiii of xxxvi 9.8.4 Port C Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PCPCR) ................................................. 155 9.8.5 Port C Open-Drain Control Register (PCODR).................................................... 155 9.8.6 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 156 9.9 Port D................................................................................................................................. 159 9.9.1 Port D Data Direction Register (PDDDR)............................................................ 159 9.9.2 Port D Data Register (PDDR)............................................................................... 160 9.9.3 Port D Register (PORTD)..................................................................................... 160 9.9.4 Port D Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PDPCR) ................................................. 161 9.9.5 Port D RealTime Input Data Register (PDRTIDR) .............................................. 161 9.10 Port F ................................................................................................................................. 162 9.10.1 Port F Data Direction Register (PFDDR) ............................................................. 162 9.10.2 Port F Data Register (PFDR) ................................................................................ 163 9.10.3 Port F Register (PORTF) ...................................................................................... 163 9.10.4 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................ 164 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) ....................................................... 167 10.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 167 10.2 Input/Output Pins............................................................................................................... 171 10.3 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 172 10.3.1 Timer Control Register (TCR).............................................................................. 174 10.3.2 Timer Mode Register (TMDR)............................................................................. 179 10.3.3 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR)...................................................................... 181 10.3.4 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER)............................................................... 198 10.3.5 Timer Status Register (TSR)................................................................................. 200 10.3.6 Timer Counter (TCNT)......................................................................................... 203 10.3.7 Timer General Register (TGR) ............................................................................. 203 10.3.8 Timer Start Register (TSTR) ................................................................................ 203 10.3.9 Timer Synchro Register (TSYR) .......................................................................... 204 10.4 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 205 10.4.1 Basic Functions..................................................................................................... 205 10.4.2 Synchronous Operation......................................................................................... 210 10.4.3 Buffer Operation................................................................................................... 212 10.4.4 Cascaded Operation .............................................................................................. 217 10.4.5 PWM Modes......................................................................................................... 219 10.4.6 Phase Counting Mode........................................................................................... 225 10.5 Interrupt Sources................................................................................................................ 233 10.6 DTC Activation.................................................................................................................. 235 10.7 A/D Converter Activation.................................................................................................. 235 10.8 Operation Timing............................................................................................................... 236 10.8.1 Input/Output Timing............................................................................................. 236 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xiv of xxxvi 10.8.2 Interrupt Signal Timing......................................................................................... 239 10.9 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 243 10.9.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ................................................................................... 243 10.9.2 Input Clock Restrictions ....................................................................................... 243 10.9.3 Caution on Period Setting ..................................................................................... 244 10.9.4 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear Operations .......................................... 244 10.9.5 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Operations ................................... 245 10.9.6 Conflict between TGR Write and Compare Match............................................... 246 10.9.7 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match .............................. 247 10.9.8 Conflict between TGR Read and Input Capture ................................................... 248 10.9.9 Conflict between TGR Write and Input Capture .................................................. 249 10.9.10 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture.................................. 250 10.9.11 Conflict between Overflow/Underflow and Counter Clearing ............................. 251 10.9.12 Conflict between TCNT Write and Overflow/Underflow .................................... 252 10.9.13 Multiplexing of I/O Pins ....................................................................................... 252 10.9.14 Interrupts in Module Stop Mode........................................................................... 252 Section 11 8-Bit Timers .....................................................................................253 11.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 253 11.2 Input/Output Pins ............................................................................................................... 255 11.3 Register Descriptions ......................................................................................................... 255 11.3.1 Timer Counters (TCNT) ....................................................................................... 256 11.3.2 Time Constant Registers A (TCORA) .................................................................. 256 11.3.3 Time Constant Registers B (TCORB) .................................................................. 257 11.3.4 Timer Control Registers (TCR) ............................................................................ 257 11.3.5 Timer Control/Status Registers (TCSR) ............................................................... 259 11.4 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 264 11.4.1 Pulse Output.......................................................................................................... 264 11.5 Operation Timing............................................................................................................... 265 11.5.1 TCNT Incrementation Timing .............................................................................. 265 11.5.2 Timing of CMFA and CMFB Setting When a Compare-Match Occurs............... 266 11.5.3 Timing of Timer Output When a Compare-Match Occurs ................................... 266 11.5.4 Timing of Compare-Match Clear When a Compare-Match Occurs ..................... 267 11.5.5 TCNT External Reset Timing............................................................................... 267 11.5.6 Timing of Overflow Flag (OVF) Setting .............................................................. 268 11.6 Operation with Cascaded Connection................................................................................ 269 11.6.1 16-Bit Count Mode ............................................................................................... 269 11.6.2 Compare-Match Count Mode ............................................................................... 269 11.7 Interrupt Sources................................................................................................................ 270 11.7.1 Interrupt Sources and DTC Activation ................................................................. 270 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xv of xxxvi 11.7.2 A/D Converter Activation..................................................................................... 270 11.8 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 271 11.8.1 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear ............................................................. 271 11.8.2 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment...................................................... 272 11.8.3 Conflict between TCOR Write and Compare-Match............................................ 273 11.8.4 Conflict between Compare-Matches A and B ...................................................... 273 11.8.5 Switching of Internal Clocks and TCNT Operation ............................................. 274 11.8.6 Conflict between Interrupts and Module Stop Mode............................................ 275 11.8.7 Notes on Cascaded Connection ............................................................................ 275 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG)............................................ 277 12.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 277 12.2 Input/Output Pins............................................................................................................... 279 12.3 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 279 12.3.1 Next Data Enable Registers H, L (NDERH, NDERL) ......................................... 280 12.3.2 Output Data Registers H, L (PODRH, PODRL)................................................... 281 12.3.3 Next Data Registers H, L (NDRH, NDRL) .......................................................... 282 12.3.4 PPG Output Control Register (PCR) .................................................................... 284 12.3.5 PPG Output Mode Register (PMR) ...................................................................... 285 12.4 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 286 12.4.1 Overview .............................................................................................................. 286 12.4.2 Output Timing ...................................................................................................... 287 12.4.3 Sample Setup Procedure for Normal Pulse Output............................................... 288 12.4.4 Example of Normal Pulse Output (Example of Five-Phase Pulse Output)........... 289 12.4.5 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output............................................................................. 290 12.4.6 Sample Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping Pulse Output............................... 292 12.4.7 Example of Non-Overlapping Pulse Output (Example of Four-Phase Complementary Non-Overlapping Output) .................. 293 12.4.8 Inverted Pulse Output ........................................................................................... 295 12.4.9 Pulse Output Triggered by Input Capture ............................................................. 296 12.5 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 297 12.5.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ................................................................................... 297 12.5.2 Operation of Pulse Output Pins............................................................................. 297 Section 13 Watchdog Timer.............................................................................. 299 13.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 299 13.2 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 300 13.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT)......................................................................................... 300 13.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)................................................................. 301 13.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR)............................................................. 303 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xvi of xxxvi 13.3 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 304 13.3.1 Watchdog Timer Mode Operation ........................................................................ 304 13.3.2 Interval Timer Mode............................................................................................. 304 13.4 Interrupts............................................................................................................................ 305 13.5 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 305 13.5.1 Notes on Register Access...................................................................................... 305 13.5.2 Conflict between Timer Counter (TCNT) Write and Increment........................... 306 13.5.3 Changing Value of CKS2 to CKS0....................................................................... 307 13.5.4 Switching between Watchdog Timer Mode and Interval Timer Mode................. 307 13.5.5 Internal Reset in Watchdog Timer Mode.............................................................. 307 13.5.6 OVF Flag Clearing in Interval Timer Mode ......................................................... 307 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) ............................................309 14.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 309 14.2 Input/Output Pins ............................................................................................................... 311 14.3 Register Descriptions ......................................................................................................... 311 14.3.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR) ............................................................................... 312 14.3.2 Receive Data Register (RDR) ............................................................................... 312 14.3.3 Transmit Data Register (TDR).............................................................................. 312 14.3.4 Transmit Shift Register (TSR) .............................................................................. 312 14.3.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR) ................................................................................ 313 14.3.6 Serial Control Register (SCR) .............................................................................. 317 14.3.7 Serial Status Register (SSR) ................................................................................. 320 14.3.8 Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR)..................................................................... 326 14.3.9 Bit Rate Register (BRR) ....................................................................................... 327 14.4 Operation in Asynchronous Mode ..................................................................................... 334 14.4.1 Data Transfer Format............................................................................................ 334 14.4.2 Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Asynchronous Mode ............................................................................................. 336 14.4.3 Clock..................................................................................................................... 337 14.4.4 SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode) .............................................................. 338 14.4.5 Data Transmission (Asynchronous Mode)............................................................ 339 14.4.6 Serial Data Reception (Asynchronous Mode)....................................................... 341 14.5 Multiprocessor Communication Function.......................................................................... 345 14.5.1 Multiprocessor Serial Data Transmission ............................................................. 346 14.5.2 Multiprocessor Serial Data Reception .................................................................. 347 14.6 Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode ......................................................................... 351 14.6.1 Clock..................................................................................................................... 351 14.6.2 SCI Initialization (Clocked Synchronous Mode) .................................................. 352 14.6.3 Serial Data Transmission (Clocked Synchronous Mode) ..................................... 353 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xvii of xxxvi 14.6.4 Serial Data Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode) .......................................... 356 14.6.5 Simultaneous Serial Data Transmission and Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode) .............................................................................. 358 14.7 Operation in Smart Card Interface ..................................................................................... 360 14.7.1 Pin Connection Example ...................................................................................... 360 14.7.2 Data Format (Except for Block Transfer Mode)................................................... 361 14.7.3 Block Transfer Mode ............................................................................................ 363 14.7.4 Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Smart Card Interface Mode................................................................................... 363 14.7.5 Initialization.......................................................................................................... 364 14.7.6 Data Transmission (Except for Block Transfer Mode)......................................... 365 14.7.7 Serial Data Reception (Except for Block Transfer Mode).................................... 368 14.7.8 Clock Output Control............................................................................................ 370 14.8 Interrupt Sources................................................................................................................ 372 14.8.1 Interrupts in Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode ............................... 372 14.8.2 Interrupts in Smart Card Interface Mode .............................................................. 373 14.9 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 375 14.9.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ................................................................................... 375 14.9.2 Break Detection and Processing ........................................................................... 375 14.9.3 Mark State and Break Detection ........................................................................... 375 14.9.4 Receive Error Flags and Transmit Operations (Clocked Synchronous Mode Only) ..................................................................... 375 14.9.5 Restrictions on Using DTC................................................................................... 376 14.9.6 SCI Operations during Mode Transitions ............................................................. 376 14.9.7 Notes when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin ................................................ 380 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) ............................ 383 15.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 383 15.2 Input/Output Pins............................................................................................................... 385 15.3 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 385 15.3.1 SS Control Register H (SSCRH) .......................................................................... 386 15.3.2 SS Control Register L (SSCRL) ........................................................................... 388 15.3.3 SS Mode Register (SSMR) ................................................................................... 389 15.3.4 SS Enable Register (SSER) .................................................................................. 390 15.3.5 SS Status Register (SSSR).................................................................................... 391 15.3.6 SS Transmit Data Register 3 to 0 (SSTDR3 to SSTDR0) .................................... 393 15.3.7 SS Receive Data Register 3 to 0 (SSRDR3 to SSRDR0) ..................................... 394 15.3.8 SS Shift Register (SSTRSR)................................................................................. 394 15.4 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 395 15.4.1 Transfer Clock ...................................................................................................... 395 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xviii of xxxvi 15.4.2 Relationship of Clock Phase, Polarity, and Data .................................................. 395 15.4.3 Relationship between Data I/O Pins and the Shift Register.................................. 396 15.4.4 Data Transmission and Data Reception ................................................................ 397 15.4.5 SCS Pin Control and Conflict Error...................................................................... 406 15.5 Interrupt Requests .............................................................................................................. 407 15.6 Usage Note......................................................................................................................... 408 15.6.1 Setting of Module Stop Mode............................................................................... 408 Section 16 A/D Converter..................................................................................409 16.1 Features.............................................................................................................................. 409 16.2 Input/Output Pins ............................................................................................................... 411 16.3 Register Description........................................................................................................... 412 16.3.1 A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) .............................................. 412 16.3.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ................................................................ 413 16.3.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) ............................................................................. 415 16.4 Operation ........................................................................................................................... 416 16.4.1 Single Mode.......................................................................................................... 416 16.4.2 Scan Mode ............................................................................................................ 416 16.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time .......................................................... 417 16.4.4 External Trigger Input Timing.............................................................................. 419 16.5 Interrupt Source ................................................................................................................. 419 16.6 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions .............................................................................. 420 16.7 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 422 16.7.1 Module Stop Mode Setting ................................................................................... 422 16.7.2 Permissible Signal Source Impedance .................................................................. 422 16.7.3 Influences on Absolute Accuracy ......................................................................... 423 16.7.4 Range of Analog Power Supply and Other Pin Settings....................................... 423 16.7.5 Notes on Board Design ......................................................................................... 424 16.7.6 Notes on Noise Countermeasures ......................................................................... 424 Section 17 RAM ................................................................................................427 Section 18 ROM ................................................................................................429 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 18.5 Features.............................................................................................................................. 429 Mode Transitions ............................................................................................................... 430 Block Configuration........................................................................................................... 434 Input/Output Pins ............................................................................................................... 435 Register Descriptions ......................................................................................................... 435 18.5.1 Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1)...................................................... 435 18.5.2 Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2)...................................................... 437 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xix of xxxvi 18.6 18.7 18.8 18.9 18.10 18.11 18.12 18.5.3 Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1) ............................................................................ 437 18.5.4 Erase Block Register 2 (EBR2) ............................................................................ 438 18.5.5 RAM Emulation Register (RAMER).................................................................... 438 On-Board Programming Modes......................................................................................... 439 18.6.1 Boot Mode ............................................................................................................ 440 18.6.2 Programming/Erasing in User Program Mode...................................................... 442 Flash Memory Emulation in RAM .................................................................................... 444 Flash Memory Programming/Erasing................................................................................ 446 18.8.1 Program/Program-Verify ...................................................................................... 446 18.8.2 Erase/Erase-Verify................................................................................................ 448 18.8.3 Interrupt Handling when Programming/Erasing Flash Memory........................... 448 Program/Erase Protection .................................................................................................. 450 18.9.1 Hardware Protection ............................................................................................. 450 18.9.2 Software Protection .............................................................................................. 450 18.9.3 Error Protection .................................................................................................... 450 Programmer Mode ............................................................................................................. 451 Power-Down States for Flash Memory.............................................................................. 451 Note on Switching from F-ZTAT Version to Masked ROM Version ............................... 452 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator..................................................................... 453 19.1 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 454 19.1.1 System Clock Control Register (SCKCR) ............................................................ 454 19.1.2 Low-Power Control Register (LPWRCR) ............................................................ 455 19.2 Oscillator............................................................................................................................ 456 19.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Resonator............................................................................ 456 19.2.2 External Clock Input............................................................................................. 457 19.3 PLL Circuit ........................................................................................................................ 459 19.4 Medium-Speed Clock Divider ........................................................................................... 459 19.5 Bus Master Clock Selection Circuit................................................................................... 459 19.6 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 460 19.6.1 Note on Crystal Resonator.................................................................................... 460 19.6.2 Note on Board Design........................................................................................... 460 Section 20 Power-Down Modes........................................................................ 463 20.1 Register Descriptions......................................................................................................... 466 20.1.1 Standby Control Register (SBYCR) ..................................................................... 466 20.1.2 Module Stop Control Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC) ................... 468 20.2 Medium-Speed Mode ........................................................................................................ 469 20.3 Sleep Mode ........................................................................................................................ 470 20.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode...................................................................................... 470 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xx of xxxvi 20.4 20.5 20.6 20.7 20.8 20.3.2 Clearing Sleep Mode ............................................................................................ 470 Software Standby Mode..................................................................................................... 471 20.4.1 Transition to Software Standby Mode .................................................................. 471 20.4.2 Clearing Software Standby Mode ......................................................................... 471 20.4.3 Setting Oscillation Stabilization Time after Clearing Software Standby Mode........................................................................................ 472 20.4.4 Software Standby Mode Application Example..................................................... 473 Hardware Standby Mode ................................................................................................... 474 20.5.1 Transition to Hardware Standby Mode ................................................................. 474 20.5.2 Clearing Hardware Standby Mode........................................................................ 474 20.5.3 Hardware Standby Mode Timings ........................................................................ 474 Module Stop Mode ............................................................................................................ 475 φ Clock Output Disabling Function ................................................................................... 476 Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................... 477 20.8.1 I/O Port Status....................................................................................................... 477 20.8.2 Current Consumption during Oscillation Stabilization Wait Period..................... 477 20.8.3 DTC Module Stop................................................................................................. 477 20.8.4 On-Chip Peripheral Module Interrupt................................................................... 477 20.8.5 Writing to MSTPCR ............................................................................................. 477 Section 21 List of Registers ...............................................................................479 21.1 Register Addresses (Address Order).................................................................................. 480 21.2 Register Bits....................................................................................................................... 488 21.3 Register States in Each Operating Mode ........................................................................... 498 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics .................................................................507 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................................................................. 507 22.2 DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................. 508 22.3 AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................. 510 22.3.1 Clock Timing ........................................................................................................ 511 22.3.2 Control Signal Timing .......................................................................................... 512 22.3.3 Timing of On-Chip Peripheral Modules ............................................................... 514 22.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics......................................................................................... 523 22.5 Flash Memory Characteristics ........................................................................................... 524 Appendix A. B. C. .........................................................................................................527 I/O Port States in Each Pin State........................................................................................ 527 Product Code Lineup ......................................................................................................... 528 Package Dimensions .......................................................................................................... 529 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxi of xxxvi Index ......................................................................................................... 531 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxii of xxxvi Figures Section 1 Overview Figure 1.1 Block Diagram .............................................................................................................. 2 Figure 1.2 Pin Assignment ............................................................................................................. 3 Section 2 CPU Figure 2.1 Exception Vector Table (Normal Mode)..................................................................... 15 Figure 2.2 Stack Structure in Normal Mode ................................................................................. 15 Figure 2.3 Exception Vector Table (Advanced Mode)................................................................. 16 Figure 2.4 Stack Structure in Advanced Mode ............................................................................. 17 Figure 2.5 Memory Map............................................................................................................... 18 Figure 2.6 CPU Registers ............................................................................................................. 19 Figure 2.7 Usage of General Registers ......................................................................................... 20 Figure 2.8 Stack............................................................................................................................ 21 Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (1).............................................................................. 24 Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (2).............................................................................. 25 Figure 2.10 Memory Data Formats............................................................................................... 26 Figure 2.11 Instruction Formats (Examples) ................................................................................ 38 Figure 2.12 Branch Address Specification in Memory Indirect Mode ......................................... 42 Figure 2.13 State Transitions ........................................................................................................ 46 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Figure 3.1 Address Map ............................................................................................................... 51 Section 4 Exception Handling Figure 4.1 Reset Sequence (Advanced Mode with On-Chip ROM Enabled)............................... 56 Figure 4.2 Reset Sequence (Advanced Mode with On-chip ROM Disabled: Not Available in this LSI) .............. 57 Figure 4.3 Stack Status after Exception Handling ........................................................................ 61 Figure 4.4 Operation when SP Value Is Odd................................................................................ 62 Section 5 Figure 5.1 Figure 5.2 Figure 5.3 Figure 5.4 Figure 5.5 Figure 5.6 Interrupt Controller Block Diagram of Interrupt Controller........................................................................ 64 Block Diagram of Interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 ................................................................ 71 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Interrupt Control Mode 0..... 77 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Control Mode 2..................... 79 Interrupt Exception Handling ...................................................................................... 81 Conflict between Interrupt Generation and Disabling................................................. 84 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxiii of xxxvi Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of PC Break Controller ...................................................................... 88 Figure 6.2 Operation in Power-Down Mode Transitions ............................................................. 92 Section 7 Figure 7.1 Figure 7.2 Figure 7.3 Bus Controller On-Chip Memory Access Cycle.................................................................................. 95 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Cycle.................................................................. 96 On-Chip SSU Module Access Cycle........................................................................... 97 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Figure 8.1 Block Diagram of DTC ............................................................................................. 100 Figure 8.2 Block Diagram of DTC Activation Source Control .................................................. 106 Figure 8.3 Location of DTC Register Information in Address Space......................................... 107 Figure 8.4 Flowchart of DTC Operation .................................................................................... 110 Figure 8.5 Memory Mapping in Normal Mode .......................................................................... 111 Figure 8.6 Memory Mapping in Repeat Mode ........................................................................... 112 Figure 8.7 Memory Mapping in Block Transfer Mode .............................................................. 114 Figure 8.8 Chain Transfer Operation.......................................................................................... 115 Figure 8.9 DTC Operation Timing (Example in Normal Mode or Repeat Mode) ..................... 116 Figure 8.10 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Block Transfer Mode, with Block Size of 2) ..................................... 117 Figure 8.11 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Chain Transfer) ............................................ 117 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Figure 10.1 Block Diagram of TPU............................................................................................ 170 Figure 10.2 Example of Counter Operation Setting Procedure .................................................. 205 Figure 10.3 Free-Running Counter Operation ............................................................................ 206 Figure 10.4 Periodic Counter Operation..................................................................................... 207 Figure 10.5 Example of Setting Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match.............. 207 Figure 10.6 Example of 0 Output/1 Output Operation ............................................................... 208 Figure 10.7 Example of Toggle Output Operation ..................................................................... 208 Figure 10.8 Example of Input Capture Operation Setting Procedure ......................................... 209 Figure 10.9 Example of Input Capture Operation ...................................................................... 210 Figure 10.10 Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure ........................................ 211 Figure 10.11 Example of Synchronous Operation...................................................................... 212 Figure 10.12 Compare Match Buffer Operation......................................................................... 213 Figure 10.13 Input Capture Buffer Operation............................................................................. 213 Figure 10.14 Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure................................................... 214 Figure 10.15 Example of Buffer Operation (1) .......................................................................... 215 Figure 10.16 Example of Buffer Operation (2) .......................................................................... 216 Figure 10.17 Cascaded Operation Setting Procedure ................................................................. 217 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxiv of xxxvi Figure 10.18 Figure 10.19 Figure 10.20 Figure 10.21 Figure 10.22 Figure 10.23 Figure 10.24 Figure 10.25 Figure 10.26 Figure 10.27 Figure 10.28 Figure 10.29 Figure 10.30 Figure 10.31 Figure 10.32 Figure 10.33 Figure 10.34 Figure 10.35 Figure 10.36 Figure 10.37 Figure 10.38 Figure 10.39 Figure 10.40 Figure 10.41 Figure 10.42 Figure 10.43 Figure 10.44 Figure 10.45 Figure 10.46 Figure 10.47 Figure 10.48 Figure 10.49 Figure 10.50 Figure 10.51 Figure 10.52 Figure 10.53 Section 11 Figure 11.1 Figure 11.2 Figure 11.3 Example of Cascaded Operation (1)...................................................................... 218 Example of Cascaded Operation (2)...................................................................... 218 Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure .......................................................... 221 Example of PWM Mode Operation (1) ................................................................. 222 Example of PWM Mode Operation (2) ................................................................. 223 Example of PWM Mode Operation (3) ................................................................. 224 Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure........................................... 226 Example of Phase Counting Mode 1 Operation .................................................... 226 Example of Phase Counting Mode 2 Operation .................................................... 227 Example of Phase Counting Mode 3 Operation .................................................... 229 Example of Phase Counting Mode 4 Operation .................................................... 230 Phase Counting Mode Application Example......................................................... 232 Count Timing in Internal Clock Operation............................................................ 236 Count Timing in External Clock Operation........................................................... 236 Output Compare Output Timing ........................................................................... 237 Input Capture Input Signal Timing........................................................................ 237 Counter Clear Timing (Compare Match) .............................................................. 238 Counter Clear Timing (Input Capture) .................................................................. 238 Buffer Operation Timing (Compare Match).......................................................... 239 Buffer Operation Timing (Input Capture) ............................................................. 239 TGI Interrupt Timing (Compare Match) ............................................................... 240 TGI Interrupt Timing (Input Capture) ................................................................... 240 TCIV Interrupt Setting Timing.............................................................................. 241 TCIU Interrupt Setting Timing.............................................................................. 241 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by CPU .............................................................. 242 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by DTC Activation ............................................ 242 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode ................ 243 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear Operations ........................................... 244 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Operations .................................... 245 Conflict between TGR Write and Compare Match ............................................... 246 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match............................... 247 Conflict between TGR Read and Input Capture.................................................... 248 Conflict between TGR Write and Input Capture................................................... 249 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture .................................. 250 Conflict between Overflow and Counter Clearing ................................................ 251 Conflict between TCNT Write and Overflow ....................................................... 252 8-Bit Timers Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer Module................................................................... 254 Example of Pulse Output......................................................................................... 264 Count Timing for Internal Clock Input.................................................................... 265 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxv of xxxvi Figure 11.4 Count Timing for External Clock Input .................................................................. 265 Figure 11.5 Timing of CMF Setting ........................................................................................... 266 Figure 11.6 Timing of Timer Output .......................................................................................... 266 Figure 11.7 Timing of Compare-Match Clear ............................................................................ 267 Figure 11.8 Timing of Clearing by External Reset Input ........................................................... 267 Figure 11.9 Timing of OVF Setting............................................................................................ 268 Figure 11.10 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear.............................................................. 271 Figure 11.11 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment ...................................................... 272 Figure 11.12 Conflict between TCOR Write and Compare-Match ............................................ 273 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Figure 12.1 Block Diagram of PPG............................................................................................ 278 Figure 12.2 PPG Output Operation ............................................................................................ 286 Figure 12.3 Timing of Transfer and Output of NDR Contents (Example) ................................. 287 Figure 12.4 Setup Procedure for Normal Pulse Output (Example) ............................................ 288 Figure 12.5 Normal Pulse Output Example (Five-Phase Pulse Output) ..................................... 289 Figure 12.6 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output ............................................................................... 290 Figure 12.7 Non-Overlapping Operation and NDR Write Timing ............................................. 291 Figure 12.8 Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping Pulse Output (Example)............................. 292 Figure 12.9 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output Example (Four-Phase Complementary)................ 293 Figure 12.10 Inverted Pulse Output (Example) .......................................................................... 295 Figure 12.11 Pulse Output Triggered by Input Capture (Example)............................................ 296 Section 13 Figure 13.1 Figure 13.2 Figure 13.3 Figure 13.4 Watchdog Timer Block Diagram of WDT .......................................................................................... 300 Example of WDT0 Watchdog Timer Operation ..................................................... 304 Writing to TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR (Example for WDT0) .............................. 306 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment ........................................................ 306 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Figure 14.1 Block Diagram of SCI............................................................................................. 310 Figure 14.2 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, Two Stop Bits) .................................................. 334 Figure 14.3 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode ........................................ 336 Figure 14.4 Relationship between Output Clock and Transfer Data Phase (Asynchronous Mode) ............................................................................................. 337 Figure 14.5 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart ....................................................................... 338 Figure 14.6 Example of Operation in Transmission in Asynchronous Mode (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit) .................................................... 339 Figure 14.7 Sample Serial Transmission Flowchart ................................................................... 340 Figure 14.8 Example of SCI Operation in Reception (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit) .................................................... 341 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxvi of xxxvi Figure 14.9 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (1) .......................................................... 343 Figure 14.9 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (2) .......................................................... 344 Figure 14.10 Example of Communication Using Multiprocessor Format (Transmission of Data H'AA to Receiving Station A) .......................................... 346 Figure 14.11 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Transmission Flowchart ........................................ 347 Figure 14.12 Example of SCI Operation in Reception (Example with 8-Bit Data, Multiprocessor Bit, One Stop Bit).............................. 348 Figure 14.13 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (1)........................................ 349 Figure 14.13 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (2)........................................ 350 Figure 14.14 Data Format in Synchronous Communication (For LSB-First) ............................ 351 Figure 14.15 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart ..................................................................... 352 Figure 14.16 Sample SCI Transmission Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode .................. 354 Figure 14.17 Sample Serial Transmission Flowchart ................................................................. 355 Figure 14.18 Example of SCI Operation in Reception ............................................................... 356 Figure 14.19 Sample Serial Reception Flowchart ...................................................................... 357 Figure 14.20 Sample Flowchart of Simultaneous Serial Transmit and Receive Operations ...... 359 Figure 14.21 Schematic Diagram of Smart Card Interface Pin Connections.............................. 360 Figure 14.22 Normal Smart Card Interface Data Format ........................................................... 361 Figure 14.23 Direct Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 0) ...................................................... 362 Figure 14.24 Inverse Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 1)..................................................... 362 Figure 14.25 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode (Using Clock of 372 Times the Transfer Rate) ..................................................... 364 Figure 14.26 Retransfer Operation in SCI Transmit Mode......................................................... 366 Figure 14.27 TEND Flag Generation Timing in Transmission Operation.................................. 366 Figure 14.28 Example of Transmission Processing Flow........................................................... 367 Figure 14.29 Retransfer Operation in SCI Receive Mode .......................................................... 368 Figure 14.30 Example of Reception Processing Flow................................................................ 369 Figure 14.31 Timing for Fixing Clock Output Level.................................................................. 370 Figure 14.32 Clock Halt and Restart Procedure ......................................................................... 371 Figure 14.33 Sample Transmission using DTC in Clocked Synchronous Mode........................ 376 Figure 14.34 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Transmission............................... 377 Figure 14.35 Pin States during Transmission in Asynchronous Mode (Internal Clock)............. 377 Figure 14.36 Pin States during Transmission in Clocked Synchronous Mode (Internal Clock)...................................................................................................... 378 Figure 14.37 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Reception .................................... 379 Figure 14.38 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin........................................... 380 Figure 14.39 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin (Example of Preventing Low-Level Output)......................................................... 381 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxvii of xxxvi Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Figure 15.1 Block Diagram of SSU............................................................................................ 384 Figure 15.2 Relationship of Clock Phase, Polarity, and Data..................................................... 395 Figure 15.3 Relationship between Data I/O Pins and the Shift Register .................................... 396 Figure 15.4 Example of SSU Initialization................................................................................. 397 Figure 15.5 Example of Transmission Operation ....................................................................... 399 Figure 15.6 Example of Data Transmission Flowchart .............................................................. 400 Figure 15.7 Example of Reception Operation ............................................................................ 402 Figure 15.8 Example of Data Reception Flowchart.................................................................... 403 Figure 15.9 Example of Simultaneous Transmission/Reception Flowchart ............................... 405 Figure 15.10 Conflict Error Detection Timing (Before Transfer Start)...................................... 406 Figure 15.11 Conflict Error Detection Timing (After Transfer End) ......................................... 407 Section 16 Figure 16.1 Figure 16.2 Figure 16.3 Figure 16.4 Figure 16.5 Figure 16.6 Figure 16.7 Figure 16.8 A/D Converter Block Diagram of A/D Converter ........................................................................... 410 A/D Conversion Timing.......................................................................................... 417 External Trigger Input Timing ................................................................................ 419 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions ................................................................... 421 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions ................................................................... 421 Example of Analog Input Circuit ............................................................................ 423 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit........................................................... 425 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit ....................................................................... 425 Section 18 ROM Figure 18.1 Block Diagram of Flash Memory........................................................................... 430 Figure 18.2 Flash Memory State Transitions.............................................................................. 431 Figure 18.3 Boot Mode............................................................................................................... 432 Figure 18.4 User Program Mode ................................................................................................ 433 Figure 18.5 Flash Memory Block Configuration........................................................................ 434 Figure 18.6 Programming/Erasing Flowchart Example in User Program Mode ........................ 443 Figure 18.7 Flowchart for Flash Memory Emulation in RAM ................................................... 444 Figure 18.8 Example of RAM Overlap Operation...................................................................... 445 Figure 18.9 Program/Program-Verify Flowchart ....................................................................... 447 Figure 18.10 Erase/Erase-Verify Flowchart ............................................................................... 449 Section 19 Figure 19.1 Figure 19.2 Figure 19.3 Figure 19.4 Figure 19.5 Clock Pulse Generator Block Diagram of Clock Pulse Generator ............................................................... 453 Connection of Crystal Resonator (Example)........................................................... 456 Crystal Resonator Equivalent Circuit...................................................................... 456 External Clock Input (Examples) ............................................................................ 457 External Clock Input Timing................................................................................... 458 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxviii of xxxvi Figure 19.6 Note on Board Design of Oscillator Circuit ............................................................ 460 Figure 19.7 External Circuitry Recommended for PLL Circuit.................................................. 461 Section 20 Figure 20.1 Figure 20.2 Figure 20.3 Figure 20.4 Figure 20.5 Power-Down Modes Mode Transition Diagram ....................................................................................... 464 Medium-Speed Mode Transition and Clearance Timing ........................................ 470 Software Standby Mode Application Example ....................................................... 473 Timing of Transition to Hardware Standby Mode .................................................. 474 Timing of Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode ............................................... 475 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Figure 22.1 Output Load Circuit................................................................................................. 510 Figure 22.2 System Clock Timing .............................................................................................. 511 Figure 22.3 Oscillation Settling Timing ..................................................................................... 512 Figure 22.4 Reset Input Timing.................................................................................................. 513 Figure 22.5 Interrupt Input Timing............................................................................................. 513 Figure 22.6 I/O Port Input/Output Timing.................................................................................. 517 Figure 22.7 Realtime Input Port Data Input Timing................................................................... 517 Figure 22.8 TPU Input/Output Timing ....................................................................................... 517 Figure 22.9 TPU Clock Input Timing......................................................................................... 518 Figure 22.10 SCK Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 518 Figure 22.11 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clocked Synchronous Mode)...................................... 518 Figure 22.12 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing...................................................... 518 Figure 22.13 PPG Output Timing............................................................................................... 519 Figure 22.14 8-Bit Timer Output Timing ................................................................................... 519 Figure 22.15 8-Bit Timer Clock Input Timing ........................................................................... 519 Figure 22.16 8-Bit Timer Reset Input Timing ............................................................................ 520 Figure 22.17 SSU Timing (Master, CPHS = 1) .......................................................................... 520 Figure 22.18 SSU Timing (Master, CPHS = 0) .......................................................................... 521 Figure 22.19 SSU Timing (Slave, CPHS = 1) ............................................................................ 521 Figure 22.20 SSU Timing (Slave, CPHS = 0) ............................................................................ 522 Appendix Figure C.1 Dimensions ............................................................................................................... 529 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxix of xxxvi Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxx of xxxvi Tables Section 2 CPU Table 2.1 Instruction Classification ........................................................................................ 27 Table 2.2 Operation Notation ................................................................................................. 28 Table 2.3 Data Transfer Instructions....................................................................................... 29 Table 2.4 Arithmetic Operations Instructions (1) ................................................................... 30 Table 2.4 Arithmetic Operations Instructions (2) ................................................................... 31 Table 2.5 Logic Operations Instructions................................................................................. 32 Table 2.6 Shift Instructions..................................................................................................... 32 Table 2.7 Bit Manipulation Instructions (1)............................................................................ 33 Table 2.7 Bit Manipulation Instructions (2)............................................................................ 34 Table 2.8 Branch Instructions ................................................................................................. 35 Table 2.9 System Control Instructions.................................................................................... 36 Table 2.10 Block Data Transfer Instructions ............................................................................ 37 Table 2.11 Addressing Modes .................................................................................................. 39 Table 2.12 Absolute Address Access Ranges ........................................................................... 40 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Table 3.1 MCU Operating Mode Selection ............................................................................ 47 Section 4 Exception Handling Table 4.1 Exception Types and Priority.................................................................................. 53 Table 4.2 Exception Handling Vector Table........................................................................... 54 Table 4.3 Statuses of CCR and EXR after Trace Exception Handling ................................... 58 Table 4.4 Statuses of CCR and EXR after Trap Instruction Exception Handling................... 60 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Table 5.1 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................... 65 Table 5.2 Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Interrupt Priorities................................. 73 Table 5.3 Interrupt Control Modes ......................................................................................... 76 Table 5.4 Interrupt Response Times ....................................................................................... 82 Table 5.5 Number of States in Interrupt Handling Routine Execution Status ........................ 83 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Table 8.1 Interrupt Sources, DTC Vector Addresses, and Corresponding DTCEs............... 108 Table 8.2 Register Information in Normal Mode.................................................................. 111 Table 8.3 Register Information in Repeat Mode................................................................... 112 Table 8.4 Register Information in Block Transfer Mode...................................................... 113 Table 8.5 DTC Execution Status........................................................................................... 118 Table 8.6 Number of States Required for Each Execution Status......................................... 118 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxi of xxxvi Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.1 Port Functions....................................................................................................... 126 Table 9.2 P17 Pin Function................................................................................................... 131 Table 9.3 P16 Pin Function................................................................................................... 131 Table 9.4 P15 Pin Function................................................................................................... 132 Table 9.5 P14 Pin Function................................................................................................... 132 Table 9.6 P13 Pin Function................................................................................................... 132 Table 9.7 P12 Pin Function................................................................................................... 133 Table 9.8 P11 Pin Function................................................................................................... 133 Table 9.9 P10 Pin Function................................................................................................... 133 Table 9.10 P37 Pin Function................................................................................................... 136 Table 9.11 P36 Pin Function................................................................................................... 136 Table 9.12 P35 Pin Function................................................................................................... 137 Table 9.13 P34 Pin Function................................................................................................... 137 Table 9.14 P33 Pin Function................................................................................................... 137 Table 9.15 P32 Pin Function................................................................................................... 137 Table 9.16 P31 Pin Function................................................................................................... 138 Table 9.17 P30 Pin Function................................................................................................... 138 Table 9.18 P77 Pin Function................................................................................................... 141 Table 9.19 P76 Pin Function................................................................................................... 141 Table 9.20 P75 Pin Function................................................................................................... 141 Table 9.21 P74 Pin Function................................................................................................... 141 Table 9.22 P73 Pin Function................................................................................................... 141 Table 9.23 P72 Pin Function................................................................................................... 142 Table 9.24 P71 Pin Function................................................................................................... 142 Table 9.25 P70 Pin Function................................................................................................... 142 Table 9.26 PA3 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 147 Table 9.27 PA2 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 147 Table 9.28 PA1 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 147 Table 9.29 PA0 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 147 Table 9.30 PB7 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 151 Table 9.31 PB6 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 151 Table 9.32 PB5 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 151 Table 9.33 PB4 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 152 Table 9.34 PB3 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 152 Table 9.35 PB2 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 152 Table 9.36 PB1 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 152 Table 9.37 PB0 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 153 Table 9.38 PC7 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 156 Table 9.39 PC6 Pin Function.................................................................................................. 156 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxii of xxxvi Table 9.40 Table 9.41 Table 9.42 Table 9.43 Table 9.44 Table 9.45 Table 9.46 Table 9.47 Table 9.48 Table 9.49 Table 9.50 Table 9.51 Table 9.52 Table 9.53 PC5 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 156 PC4 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 157 PC3 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 157 PC2 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 157 PC1 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 158 PC0 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 158 PF7 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 164 PF6 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 164 PF5 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 164 PF4 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 164 PF3 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 164 PF2 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 165 PF1 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 165 PF0 Pin Function .................................................................................................. 165 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.1 TPU Functions ...................................................................................................... 168 Table 10.2 TPU Pins............................................................................................................... 171 Table 10.3 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (Channels 0 and 3) ................................................................. 175 Table 10.4 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (Channels 1, 2, 4, and 5) ........................................................ 175 Table 10.5 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 0) .............................................................................. 176 Table 10.6 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 1) .............................................................................. 176 Table 10.7 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 2) .............................................................................. 177 Table 10.8 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 3) .............................................................................. 177 Table 10.9 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 4) .............................................................................. 178 Table 10.10 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 5) .......................................................................... 178 Table 10.11 MD3 to MD0 .................................................................................................... 180 Table 10.12 TIORH_0 (Channel 0) ...................................................................................... 182 Table 10.13 TIORL_0 (Channel 0)....................................................................................... 183 Table 10.14 TIOR_1 (Channel 1) ......................................................................................... 184 Table 10.15 TIOR_2 (Channel 2) ......................................................................................... 185 Table 10.16 TIORH_3 (Channel 3) ...................................................................................... 186 Table 10.17 TIORL_3 (Channel 3)....................................................................................... 187 Table 10.18 TIOR_4 (Channel 4) ......................................................................................... 188 Table 10.19 TIOR_5 (Channel 5) ......................................................................................... 189 Table 10.20 TIORH_0 (Channel 0) ...................................................................................... 190 Table 10.21 TIORL_0 (Channel 0)....................................................................................... 191 Table 10.22 TIOR_1 (Channel 1) ......................................................................................... 192 Table 10.23 TIOR_2 (Channel 2) ......................................................................................... 193 Table 10.24 TIORH_3 (Channel 3) ...................................................................................... 194 Table 10.25 TIORL_3 (Channel 3)....................................................................................... 195 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxiii of xxxvi Table 10.26 Table 10.27 Table 10.28 Table 10.29 Table 10.30 Table 10.31 Table 10.32 Table 10.33 Table 10.34 Table 10.35 Table 10.36 TIOR_4 (Channel 4) ......................................................................................... 196 TIOR_5 (Channel 5) ......................................................................................... 197 Register Combinations in Buffer Operation ..................................................... 213 Cascaded Combinations.................................................................................... 217 PWM Output Registers and Output Pins .......................................................... 220 Phase Counting Mode Clock Input Pins ........................................................... 225 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 1.................................. 227 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 2.................................. 228 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 3.................................. 229 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 4.................................. 230 TPU Interrupts .................................................................................................. 234 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 255 Table 11.1 Table 11.2 8-Bit Timer Interrupt Sources............................................................................... 270 Table 11.3 Timer Output Priorities......................................................................................... 273 Table 11.4 Switching of Internal Clock and TCNT Operation ............................................... 274 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Table 12.1 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 279 Section 13 Watchdog Timer Table 13.1 WDT Interrupt Source .......................................................................................... 305 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.1 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 311 Table 14.2 The Relationships between The N Setting in BRR and Bit Rate B ...................... 327 Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (1) ........................... 328 Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (2) ........................... 329 Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (3) ........................... 330 Table 14.4 Maximum Bit Rate for Each Frequency (Asynchronous Mode) .......................... 330 Table 14.5 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode) ................ 331 Table 14.6 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Clocked Synchronous Mode)..................... 332 Table 14.7 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Clocked Synchronous Mode) .... 332 Table 14.8 Examples of Bit Rate for Various BRR Settings (Smart Card Interface Mode) (When n = 0 and S = 372)...................................... 333 Table 14.9 Maximum Bit Rate at Various Frequencies (Smart Card Interface Mode) (When S = 372)..................................................... 333 Table 14.10 Serial Transfer Formats (Asynchronous Mode)................................................ 335 Table 14.11 SSR Status Flags and Receive Data Handling .................................................. 342 Table 14.12 SCI Interrupt Sources........................................................................................ 373 Table 14.13 SCI Interrupt Sources........................................................................................ 374 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxiv of xxxvi Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Table 15.1 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 385 Table 15.2 Interrupt Souses .................................................................................................... 408 Section 16 A/D Converter Table 16.1 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 411 Table 16.2 Analog Input Channels and Corresponding ADDR Registers .............................. 412 Table 16.3 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode)................................................................... 418 Table 16.4 A/D Conversion Time (Scan Mode) ..................................................................... 418 Table 16.5 A/D Converter Interrupt Source............................................................................ 419 Table 16.6 Analog Pin Specifications..................................................................................... 425 Section 18 ROM Table 18.1 Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode .................................. 431 Table 18.2 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................. 435 Table 18.3 Setting On-Board Programming Modes ............................................................... 439 Table 18.4 Boot Mode Operation ........................................................................................... 441 Table 18.5 System Clock Frequencies for which Automatic Adjustment of LSI Bit Rate is Possible................................................................. 441 Table 18.6 Flash Memory Operating States............................................................................ 451 Table 18.7 Registers Present in F-ZTAT Version but Absent in Masked ROM Version ....... 452 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Table19.1 Damping Resistance Value ................................................................................... 456 Table19.2 Crystal Resonator Characteristics ......................................................................... 457 Table19.3 External Clock Input Conditions........................................................................... 458 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Table 20.1 Low Power Consumption Mode Transition Conditions ....................................... 464 Table 20.2 LSI Internal States in Each Mode ......................................................................... 465 Table 20.3 Oscillation Stabilization Time Settings................................................................. 472 Table 20.4 φ Pin State in Each Processing State..................................................................... 476 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ................................................................................. 507 Table 22.2 DC Characteristics ................................................................................................ 508 Table 22.3 Permissible Output Currents ................................................................................. 510 Table 22.4 Clock Timing ........................................................................................................ 511 Table 22.5 Control Signal Timing .......................................................................................... 512 Table 22.6 Timing of On-Chip Peripheral Modules ............................................................... 514 Table 22.7 Timing of SSU ...................................................................................................... 516 Table 22.8 A/D Conversion Characteristics............................................................................ 523 Table 22.9 Flash Memory Characteristics .............................................................................. 524 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxv of xxxvi Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page xxxvi of xxxvi Section 1 Overview Section 1 Overview 1.1 Overview • High-speed H8S/2600 central processing unit with an internal 16-bit architecture Upward-compatible with H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs on an object level Sixteen 16-bit general registers 69 basic instructions • Various peripheral functions PC break controller Data transfer controller 16-bit timer-pulse unit (TPU) 8-bit timer (TMR) Programmable pulse generator (PPG) Watchdog timer Asynchronous or clocked synchronous serial communication interface (SCI) Synchronous serial communication unit (SSU) 10-bit A/D converter Clock pulse generator • On-chip memory ROM Model ROM RAM Remarks F-ZTAT Version HD64F2604 128 kbytes 8 kbytes Masked ROM Version HD6432604 128 kbytes 8 kbytes HD6432603 64 kbytes 8 kbytes • General I/O ports I/O pins: 59 Input-only pins: 17 • Supports various power-down states • Compact package Package Code Body Size Pin Pitch 100-pin QFP FP-100M/FP-100MV 14.0 × 14.0 mm 0.5 mm Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 1 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Block Diagram PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 VCL VCC VCC VCC VSS VSS VSS 1.2 Port A Port B Port C RAM PB7/TIOCB5 PB6/TIOCA5 PB5/TIOCB4 PB4/TIOCA4 PB3/TIOCD3 PB2/TIOCC3 PB1/TIOCB3 PB0/TIOCA3 PC7/SCS1 PC6/SSCK1 PC5/SSI1 PC4/SSO1 PC3/SCS0 PC2/SSCK0 PC1/SSI0 PC0/SSO0 Port 3 ROM (Masked ROM, flash memory) PA3/SCK2 PA2/RxD2 PA1/TxD2 PA0 P37 P36 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P34/RxD1 P33/TxD1 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P31/RxD0 P30/TxD0 Port 9 PC break controller (2 channels) Port F PF7/φ PF6 PF5 PF4 PF3/ADTRG/IRQ3 PF2 PF1/BUzz PF0/IRQ2 DTC Peripheral data bus Interrupt controller Bus controller H8S/2600 CPU Peripheral address bus NMI Internal data bus P L L Internal address bus MD2 MD1 MD0 EXTAL XTAL PLLVCL PLLCAP PLLVSS STBY RES FWE/NC* Clock pulse generator Port D P97/AN15 P96/AN14 P95/AN13 P94/AN12 P93/AN11 P92/AN10 P91/AN9 P90/AN8 WDT × 1 channel TMR × 4 channels SCI × 3 channels SSU × 2 channels Port 7 TPU P77 P76 P75/TMO3 P74/TMO2 P73/TMO1 P72/TMO0 P71/TMCI23/TMRI23 P70/TMCIO1/TMRIO1 PPG A/D converter P47 / AN7 P46 / AN6 P45 / AN5 P44 / AN4 P43 / AN3 P42 / AN2 P41 / AN1 P40 / AN0 Vref AVCC AVSS Port 4 P17/PO15/TIOCB2/TCLKD P16/PO14/TIOCA2/IRQ1 P15/PO13/TIOCB1/TCLKC P14/PO12/TIOCA1/IRQ0 P13/PO11/TIOCD0/TCLKB P12/PO10/TIOCC0/TCLKA P11/PO9/TIOCB0 P10/PO8/TIOCA0 Port 1 Note: * The FWE pin is provided only in the flash memory version. The NC pin is provided only in the masked ROM version. Figure 1.1 Block Diagram Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 2 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview PF0/IRQ2 PF1 PF2 PF3/ADTRG/IRQ3 PF4 PF5 PF6 PF7/φ PLLCAP FWE/NC* PLLVSS VSS EXTAL XTAL VCC NMI STBY VCL RES VSS MD2 MD1 MD0 P30/TxD0 P31/RxD0 Pin Assignment P97/AN15 P96/AN14 P95/AN13 P94/AN12 P93/AN11 P92/AN10 P91/AN9 P90/AN8 AVSS Vref AVCC P47/AN7 P46/AN6 P45/AN5 P44/AN4 P43/AN3 P42/AN2 P41/AN1 P40/AN0 P10/PO8/TIOCA0 P11/PO9/TIOCB0 P12/PO10/TIOCC0/TCLKA P13/PO11/TIOCD0/TCLKB P14/PO12/TIOCA1/IRQ0 P15/PO13/TIOCB1/TCLKC 75747372717069686766656463626160595857565554535251 76 50 77 49 78 48 79 47 80 46 81 45 82 44 83 43 84 42 85 41 H8S/2604 Group 86 40 PRQP0100KB-A 87 39 88 38 FP-100M/FP-100MV 89 37 (Top view) 90 36 91 35 92 34 93 33 94 32 95 31 96 30 97 29 98 28 99 27 100 26 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516171819202122232425 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P33/TxD1 P34/RxD1 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P36 P37 PA3/SCK2 PA2/RxD2 PA1/TxD2 PA0 PB7/TIOCB5 PB6/TIOCA5 PB5/TIOCB4 PB4/TIOCA4 PB3/TIOCD3 PB2/TIOCC3 VSS PB1/TIOCB3 VCC PB0/TIOCA3 PC7/SCS1 PC6/SSCK1 PC5/SSI1 PC4/SSO1 PC3/SCS0 P16/PO14/TIOCA2/IRQ1 VCC P17/PO15/TIOCB2/TCLKD VSS NC NC P70/TMCI01/TMRI01 P71/TMCI23/TMRI23 P72/TMO0 P73/TMO1 P74/TMO2 P75/TMO3 P76 P77 PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PC0/SSO0 PC1/SSI0 PC2/SSCK0 1.3 Note: * The FWE pin is provided only in the flash memory version. The NC pin is provided only in the masked ROM version. Figure 1.2 Pin Assignment Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 3 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview 1.4 Pin Functions Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function Power Supply VCC 2 32 61 Input Power supply pins. Connect all these pins to the system power supply. VSS 4 34 56 64 Input Ground pins. Connect all these pins to the system power supply (0 V). VCL 58 Output External capacitance pin for internal power-down power supply. Connect this pin to VSS via a 0.1µF capacitor (placed close to the pins). PLLVSS 65 Input On-chip PLL oscillator ground pin. PLLCAP 67 Output External capacitance pin for an on-chip PLL oscillator. XTAL 62 Input For connection to a crystal resonator. For examples of crystal resonator connection and external clock input, see section 19, Clock Pulse Generator. EXTAL 63 Input For connection to a crystal resonator (An external clock can be supplied from the EXTAL pin). For examples of crystal resonator connection and external clock input, see section 19, Clock Pulse Generator. φ 68 Output Supplies the system clock to external devices. Operating mode control MD2 MD1 MD0 55 54 53 Input Set the operating mode. Inputs at these pins should not be changed during operation. System control RES 57 Input Reset input pin. When this pin is low, the chip is reset. STBY 59 Input When this pin is low, a transition is made to hardware standby mode. FWE 66 Input Pin for use by flash memory. This pin is only used in the flash memory version. Clock Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 4 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function Interrupts NMI 60 Input Nonmaskable interrupt pin. If this pin is not used, it should be fixed high. IRQ5 IRQ4 IRQ3 IRQ2 IRQ1 IRQ0 47 50 72 75 1 99 Input These pins request a maskable interrupt. 97 98 100 3 Input These pins input an external clock. TIOCA0 TIOCB0 TIOCC0 TIOCD0 95 96 97 98 Input/ Output TGRA_0 to TGRD_0 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. TIOCA1 TIOCB1 99 100 Input/ Output TGRA_1 to TGRB_1 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. TIOCA2 TIOCB2 1 3 Input/ Output TGRA_2 to TGRB_2 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. TIOCA3 TIOCB3 TIOCC3 TIOCD3 31 33 35 36 Input/ Output TGRA_3 to TGRD_3 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. TIOCA4 TIOCB4 37 38 Input/ Output TGRA_4 to TGRB_4 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. TIOCA5 TIOCB5 39 40 Input/ Output TGRA_5 to TGRB_5 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pins. PO15 PO14 PO13 PO12 PO11 PO10 PO9 PO8 3 1 100 99 98 97 96 95 Output Pulse output pins. 16-bit timer- TCLKA pulse unit TCLKB TCLKC TCLKD Programmable pulse generator (PPG) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 5 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function 8-bit timer (TMR) TMO3 TMO2 TMO1 TMO0 12 11 10 9 Output Compare-match output pins. TMCI23 TMCI01 8 7 Input Input pins of external clocks input to the counter. 8-bit timer (TMR) TMRI23 TMRI01 8 7 Input Counter reset input pins. Serial communication Interface (SCI)/ smart card interface TxD2 TxD1 TxD0 42 49 52 Output Data output pins. RxD2 RxD1 RxD0 43 48 51 Input Data input pins. SCK2 SCK1 SCK0 44 47 50 Input/ Output Clock input/output pins. SSO1 SSO0 27 23 Input/ Output Data input/output pins. SSI1 SSI0 28 24 Input/ Output Data input/output pins. SSCK1 SSCK0 29 25 Input/ Output Clock input/output pins. SCS1 SCS0 30 26 Input/ Output Chip select input/output pins. Synchronous serial communication unit (SSU) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 6 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function A/D converter AN15 AN14 AN13 AN12 AN11 AN10 AN9 AN8 AN7 AN6 AN5 AN4 AN3 AN2 AN1 AN0 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 Input Analog input pins. ADTRG 72 Input Pin for input of an external trigger to start A/D conversion. AVCC 86 Input Power supply pin for the A/D converter. When the A/D converter is not used, connect this pin to the system power supply (+5 V). AVSS 84 Input The ground pin for the A/D converter. Connect this pin to the system power supply (0 V). Vref 85 Input The reference voltage input pin for the A/D converter. When the A/D converter is not used, connect this pin to the system power supply (+5 V). P17 P16 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 3 1 100 99 98 97 96 95 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. I/O ports Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 7 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function I/O ports P37 P36 P35 P34 P33 P32 P31 P30 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. P47 P46 P45 P44 P43 P42 P41 P40 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 Input Eight input pins. P77 P76 P75 P74 P73 P72 P71 P70 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. P97 P96 P95 P94 P93 P92 P91 P90 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 Input Eight input pins. PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0 44 43 42 41 Input/ Output Four input/output pins. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 8 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin NO. I/O Function I/O ports PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PB2 PB1 PB0 40 39 38 37 36 35 33 31 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. PC7 PC6 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. PF7 PF6 PF5 PF4 PF3 PF2 PF1 PF0 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 Input/ Output Eight input/output pins. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 9 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 1 Overview Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 10 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Section 2 CPU The H8S/2600 CPU is a high-speed central processing unit with an internal 32-bit architecture that is upward-compatible with the H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs. The H8S/2600 CPU has sixteen 16-bit general registers, can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space, and is ideal for realtime control. This section describes the H8S/2600 CPU. The usable modes and address spaces differ depending on the product. For details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating Modes. 2.1 Features • Upward-compatible with H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs Can execute H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs object programs • General-register architecture Sixteen 16-bit general registers also usable as sixteen 8-bit registers or eight 32-bit registers • Sixty-nine basic instructions 8/16/32-bit arithmetic and logic instructions Multiply and divide instructions Powerful bit-manipulation instructions Multiply-and-accumulate instruction • Eight addressing modes Register direct [Rn] Register indirect [@ERn] Register indirect with displacement [@(d:16,ERn) or @(d:32,ERn)] Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement [@ERn+ or @–ERn] Absolute address [@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32] Immediate [#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32] Program-counter relative [@(d:8,PC) or @(d:16,PC)] Memory indirect [@@aa:8] • 16-Mbyte address space Program: 16 Mbytes Data: 16 Mbytes • High-speed operation All frequently-used instructions execute in one or two states 8/16/32-bit register-register add/subtract: 1 state 8 × 8-bit register-register multiply: 3 states Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 11 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 16 ÷ 8-bit register-register divide: 16 × 16-bit register-register multiply: 32 ÷ 16-bit register-register divide: • Two CPU operating modes Normal mode* 12 states 4 states 20 states Advanced mode • Power-down state Transition to power-down state by the SLEEP instruction CPU clock speed selection Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI. 2.1.1 Differences between H8S/2600 CPU and H8S/2000 CPU The differences between the H8S/2600 CPU and the H8S/2000 CPU are shown below. • Register configuration The MAC register is supported by the H8S/2600 CPU only. • Basic instructions The four instructions MAC, CLRMAC, LDMAC, and STMAC are supported by the H8S/2600 CPU only. • The number of execution states of the MULXU and MULXS instructions; Execution States Instruction Mnemonic H8S/2600 H8S/2000 MULXU MULXU.B Rs, Rd 3 12 MULXU.W Rs, ERd 4 20 MULXS.B Rs, Rd 4 13 MULXS.W Rs, ERd 5 21 MULXS In addition, there are differences in address space, CCR and EXR register functions, and powerdown modes, etc., depending on the model. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 12 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.1.2 Differences from H8/300 CPU In comparison to the H8/300 CPU, the H8S/2600 CPU has the following enhancements: • More general registers and control registers Eight 16-bit extended registers, and one 8-bit and two 32-bit control registers, have been added. • Expanded address space Normal mode supports the same 64-kbyte address space as the H8/300 CPU. Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte address space. • Enhanced addressing The addressing modes have been enhanced to make effective use of the 16-Mbyte address space. • Enhanced instructions Addressing modes of bit-manipulation instructions have been enhanced. Signed multiply and divide instructions have been added. A multiply-and-accumulate instruction has been added. Two-bit shift instructions have been added. Instructions for saving and restoring multiple registers have been added. A test and set instruction has been added. • Higher speed Basic instructions execute twice as fast. 2.1.3 Differences from H8/300H CPU In comparison to the H8/300H CPU, the H8S/2600 CPU has the following enhancements: • More control registers One 8-bit and two 32-bit control registers have been added. • Enhanced instructions Addressing modes of bit-manipulation instructions have been enhanced. A multiply-and-accumulate instruction has been added. Two-bit shift instructions have been added. Instructions for saving and restoring multiple registers have been added. A test and set instruction has been added. • Higher speed Basic instructions execute twice as fast. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 13 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.2 CPU Operating Modes The H8S/2600 CPU has two operating modes: normal and advanced. Normal mode supports a maximum 64-kbyte address space. Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte total address space. The mode is selected by the mode pins. 2.2.1 Normal Mode The exception vector table and stack have the same structure as in the H8/300 CPU. • Address Space Linear access to a 64-kbyte maximum address space is provided. • Extended Registers (En) The extended registers (E7 to E0) can be used as 16-bit registers, or as the upper 16-bit segments of 32-bit registers. When En is used as a 16-bit register it can contain any value, even when the corresponding general register (Rn) is used as an address register. If the general register is referenced in the register indirect addressing mode with pre-decrement (@–Rn) or post-increment (@Rn+) and a carry or borrow occurs, however, the value in the corresponding extended register (En) will be affected. • Instruction Set All instructions and addressing modes can be used. Only the lower 16 bits of effective addresses (EA) are valid. • Exception Vector Table and Memory Indirect Branch Addresses In normal mode the top area starting at H'0000 is allocated to the exception vector table. One branch address is stored per 16 bits. The exception vector table structure in normal mode is shown in figure 2.1. For details of the exception vector table, see section 4, Exception Handling. The memory indirect addressing mode (@@aa:8) employed in the JMP and JSR instructions uses an 8-bit absolute address included in the instruction code to specify a memory operand that contains a branch address. In normal mode the operand is a 16-bit word operand, providing a 16-bit branch address. Branch addresses can be stored in the area from H'0000 to H'00FF. Note that the first part of this range is also used for the exception vector table. • Stack Structure When the program counter (PC) is pushed onto the stack in a subroutine call, and the PC, condition-code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are pushed onto the stack in exception handling, they are stored as shown in figure 2.2. EXR is not pushed onto the stack in interrupt control mode 0. For details, see section 4, Exception Handling. Note: Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 14 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU H'0000 H'0001 H'0002 H'0003 H'0004 H'0005 H'0006 H'0007 H'0008 H'0009 H'000A H'000B Exception vector 1 Exception vector 2 Exception vector 3 Exception vector table Exception vector 4 Exception vector 5 Exception vector 6 Figure 2.1 Exception Vector Table (Normal Mode) SP PC (16 bits) EXR*1 SP Reserved*1*3 2 (SP * ) CCR CCR*3 PC (16 bits) (a) Subroutine Branch (b) Exception Handling Notes: 1. When EXR is not used it is not stored on the stack. 2. SP when EXR is not used. 3. lgnored when returning. Figure 2.2 Stack Structure in Normal Mode 2.2.2 Advanced Mode • Address Space Linear access to a 16-Mbyte maximum address space is provided. • Extended Registers (En) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 15 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU The extended registers (E7 to E0) can be used as 16-bit registers, or as the upper 16-bit segments of 32-bit registers or address registers. • Instruction Set All instructions and addressing modes can be used. • Exception Vector Table and Memory Indirect Branch Addresses In advanced mode, the top area starting at H'00000000 is allocated to the exception vector table in units of 32 bits. In each 32 bits, the upper 8 bits are ignored and a branch address is stored in the lower 24 bits (figure 2.3). For details of the exception vector table, see section 4, Exception Handling. H'00000000 Reserved Exception vector 1 H'00000003 H'00000004 Reserved Exception vector 2 H'00000007 H'00000008 Reserved Exception vector table Exception vector 3 H'0000000B H'0000000C Reserved Exception vector 4 H'00000010 Reserved Exception vector 5 Figure 2.3 Exception Vector Table (Advanced Mode) The memory indirect addressing mode (@@aa:8) employed in the JMP and JSR instructions uses an 8-bit absolute address included in the instruction code to specify a memory operand that contains a branch address. In advanced mode the operand is a 32-bit longword operand, providing a 32-bit branch address. The upper 8 bits of these 32 bits is a reserved area that is regarded as H'00. Branch addresses can be stored in the area from H'00000000 to H'000000FF. Note that the first part of this range is also used for the exception vector table. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 16 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU • Stack Structure In advanced mode, when the program counter (PC) is pushed onto the stack in a subroutine call, and the PC, condition-code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are pushed onto the stack in exception handling, they are stored as shown in figure 2.4. When EXR is not pushed onto the stack in interrupt control mode 0. For details, see section 4, Exception Handling. EXR*1 SP SP Reserved PC (24 bits) (SP *2 Reserved*1*3 ) (a) Subroutine Branch CCR PC (24 bits) (b) Exception Handling Notes: 1. When EXR is not used it is not stored on the stack. 2. SP when EXR is not used. 3. Ignored when returning. Figure 2.4 Stack Structure in Advanced Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 17 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.3 Address Space Figure 2.5 shows a memory map for the H8S/2600 CPU. The H8S/2600 CPU provides linear access to a maximum 64-kbyte address space in normal mode, and a maximum 16-Mbyte (architecturally 4-Gbyte) address space in advanced mode. The usable modes and address spaces differ depending on the product. For details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating Modes. H'0000 H'00000000 64 kbytes H'FFFF 16 Mbytes H'00FFFFFF Data area Cannot be used for this LSI H'FFFFFFFF (a) Normal Mode (b) Advanced Mode Figure 2.5 Memory Map Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 18 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Program area Section 2 CPU 2.4 Registers The H8S/2600 CPU has the internal registers shown in figure 2.6. There are two types of registers; general registers and control registers. The control registers are a 24-bit program counter (PC), an 8-bit extended control register (EXR), an 8-bit condition code register (CCR), and a 64-bit multiply-accumulate register (MAC). General Registers (Rn) and Extended Registers (En) 15 0 7 0 7 0 ER0 E0 R0H R0L ER1 E1 R1H R1L ER2 E2 R2H R2L ER3 E3 R3H R3L ER4 E4 R4H R4L ER5 E5 R5H R5L ER6 E6 R6H R6L ER7 (SP) E7 R7H R7L Control Registers (CR) 0 23 PC 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 - - - - I2 I1 I0 EXR T 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CCR I UI H U N Z V C 63 41 MAC 32 MACH (Sign extension) MACL 31 0 [Legend] SP: PC: EXR: T: I2 to I0: CCR: I: UI: Stack pointer Program counter Extended control register Trace bit Interrupt mask bits Condition-code register Interrupt mask bit User bit or interrupt mask bit H: U: N: Z: V: C: MAC: Half-carry flag User bit Negative flag Zero flag Overflow flag Carry flag Multiply-accumulate register Figure 2.6 CPU Registers Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 19 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.4.1 General Registers The H8S/2600 CPU has eight 32-bit general registers. These general registers are all functionally identical and can be used as both address registers and data registers. When a general register is used as a data register, it can be accessed as a 32-bit, 16-bit, or 8-bit register. Figure 2.7 illustrates the usage of the general registers. When the general registers are used as 32-bit registers or address registers, they are designated by the letters ER (ER7 to ER0). The ER registers divide into 16-bit general registers designated by the letters E (E7 to E0) and R (R7 to R0). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum of sixteen 16-bit registers. The E registers (E7 to E0) are also referred to as extended registers. The R registers divide into 8-bit general registers designated by the letters RH (R7H to R0H) and RL (R7L to R0L). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum of sixteen 8bit registers. The usage of each register can be selected independently. General register ER7 has the function of stack pointer (SP) in addition to its general-register function, and is used implicitly in exception handling and subroutine calls. Figure 2.8 shows the stack. • Address registers • 32-bit registers • 16-bit registers • 8-bit registers E registers (extended registers) (E7 to E0) ER registers (ER7 to ER0) RH registers (R7H to R0H) R registers (R7 to R0) RL registers (R7L to R0L) Figure 2.7 Usage of General Registers Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 20 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Free area SP (ER7) Stack area Figure 2.8 Stack 2.4.2 Program Counter (PC) This 24-bit counter indicates the address of the next instruction the CPU will execute. The length of all CPU instructions is 2 bytes (one word), so the least significant PC bit is ignored (When an instruction is fetched, the least significant PC bit is regarded as 0). 2.4.3 Extended Control Register (EXR) EXR is an 8-bit register that manipulates the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. When these instructions, except for the STC instruction, are executed, all interrupts including NMI will be masked for three states after execution is completed. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W 7 T 0 R/W Description Trace Bit When this bit is set to 1, a trace exception is generated each time an instruction is executed. When this bit is cleared to 0, instructions are executed in sequence. 6 to 3 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1. 2 1 0 I2 I1 I0 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W These bits designate the interrupt mask level (7 to 0). For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 21 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.4.4 Condition-Code Register (CCR) This 8-bit register contains internal CPU status information, including an interrupt mask bit (I) and half-carry (H), negative (N), zero (Z), overflow (V), and carry (C) flags. Operations can be performed on the CCR bits by the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. The N, Z, V, and C flags are used as branching conditions for conditional branch (Bcc) instructions. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 I 1 R/W Interrupt Mask Bit Masks interrupts other than NMI when set to 1. NMI is accepted regardless of the I bit setting. The I bit is set to 1 at the start of an exceptionhandling sequence. For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller. 6 UI undefined R/W User Bit or Interrupt Mask Bit Can be read or written by software using the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. This bit cannot be used as an interrupt mask bit in this LSI. 5 H undefined R/W Half-Carry Flag When the ADD.B, ADDX.B, SUB.B, SUBX.B, CMP.B, or NEG.B instruction is executed, this flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 3, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When the ADD.W, SUB.W, CMP.W, or NEG.W instruction is executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 11, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When the ADD.L, SUB.L, CMP.L, or NEG.L instruction is executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 27, and cleared to 0 otherwise. 4 U undefined R/W User Bit Can be read or written by software using the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. 3 N undefined R/W Negative Flag Stores the value of the most significant bit of data as a sign bit. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 22 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 Z undefined R/W Zero Flag Set to 1 to indicate zero data, and cleared to 0 to indicate non-zero data. 1 V undefined R/W Overflow Flag Set to 1 when an arithmetic overflow occurs, and cleared to 0 at other times. 0 C undefined R/W Carry Flag Set to 1 when a carry occurs, and cleared to 0 otherwise. Used by: • Add instructions, to indicate a carry • Subtract instructions, to indicate a borrow • Shift and rotate instructions, to indicate a carry The carry flag is also used as a bit accumulator by bit manipulation instructions. 2.4.5 Multiply-Accumulate Register (MAC) This 64-bit register stores the results of multiply-and-accumulate operations. It consists of two 32bit registers denoted MACH and MACL. The lower 10 bits of MACH are valid; the upper bits are a sign extension. 2.4.6 Initial Values of CPU Registers Reset exception handling loads the CPU’s program counter (PC) from the vector table, clears the trace bit in EXR to 0, and sets the interrupt mask bits in CCR and EXR to 1. The other CCR bits and the general registers are not initialized. In particular, the stack pointer (ER7) is not initialized. The stack pointer should therefore be initialized by an MOV.L instruction executed immediately after a reset. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 23 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.5 Data Formats The H8S/2600 CPU can process 1-bit, 4-bit (BCD), 8-bit (byte), 16-bit (word), and 32-bit (longword) data. Bit-manipulation instructions operate on 1-bit data by accessing bit n (n = 0, 1, 2, …, 7) of byte operand data. The DAA and DAS decimal-adjust instructions treat byte data as two digits of 4-bit BCD data. 2.5.1 General Register Data Formats Figure 2.9 shows the data formats in general registers. Data Type Register Number Data Format 7 RnH 1-bit data 0 Don't care 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 1-bit data RnL 4-bit BCD data RnH 4-bit BCD data RnL Byte data RnH Don't care 7 4 3 Upper 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 Lower Don't care 7 Don't care 7 4 3 Upper 0 Don't care MSB LSB 7 Byte data RnL Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (1) REJ09B0426-0100 0 Don't care MSB Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 24 of 534 0 Lower LSB Section 2 CPU Data Type Register Number Word data Rn Data Format 15 0 MSB Word data 15 0 MSB Longword data LSB En LSB ERn 31 16 15 MSB En 0 Rn LSB [Legend] ERn: En: Rn: RnH: RnL: MSB: LSB: General register ER General register E General register R General register RH General register RL Most significant bit Least significant bit Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 25 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.5.2 Memory Data Formats Figure 2.10 shows the data formats in memory. The H8S/2600 CPU can access word data and longword data in memory, however word or longword data must begin at an even address. If an attempt is made to access word or longword data at an odd address, an address error does not occur, however the least significant bit of the address is regarded as 0, so access begins the preceding address. This also applies to instruction fetches. When ER7 is used as an address register to access the stack, the operand size should be word or longword. Data Type Address Data Format 7 1-bit data Address L 7 Byte data Address L MSB Word data Address 2M MSB 0 6 5 4 3 2 Address 2N 0 LSB LSB Address 2M+1 Longword data 1 MSB Address 2N+1 Address 2N+2 Address 2N+3 Figure 2.10 Memory Data Formats Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 26 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 LSB Section 2 CPU 2.6 Instruction Set The H8S/2600 CPU has 69 instructions. The instructions are classified by function in table 2.1. Table 2.1 Instruction Classification Function Instructions Size Types Data transfer MOV POP*1, PUSH*1 B/W/L 5 W/L Arithmetic operations LDM, STM MOVFPE*3, MOVTPE*3 L ADD, SUB, CMP, NEG B/W/L ADDX, SUBX, DAA, DAS B INC, DEC B/W/L ADDS, SUBS L B 23 MULXU, DIVXU, MULXS, DIVXS B/W EXTU, EXTS W/L TAS*4 B MAC, LDMAC, STMAC, CLRMAC Logic operations AND, OR, XOR, NOT B/W/L 4 Shift SHAL, SHAR, SHLL, SHLR, ROTL, ROTR, ROTXL, ROTXR B/W/L 8 Bit manipulation BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BTST, BLD, BILD, BST, BIST, BAND, BIAND, BOR, BIOR, BXOR, BIXOR B 14 Branch Bcc*2, JMP, BSR, JSR, RTS 5 System control TRAPA, RTE, SLEEP, LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, XORC, NOP 9 Block data transfer EEPMOV 1 Total: 69 Notes: B: W: L: 1. Byte Word Longword POP.W Rn and PUSH.W Rn are identical to MOV.W @SP+,Rn and MOV.W Rn,@-SP. POP.L ERn and PUSH.L ERn are identical to MOV.L @SP+,ERn and MOV.L ERn,@-SP. 2. Bcc is the general name for conditional branch instructions. 3. Cannot be used in this LSI. 4. Only register ER0, ER1, ER4, or ER5 should be used when using the TAS instruction. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 27 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.6.1 Table of Instructions Classified by Function Tables 2.3 to 2.10 summarize the instructions in each functional category. The notation used in tables 2.3 to 2.10 is defined below. Table 2.2 Operation Notation Symbol Description Rd Rs General register (destination)* General register (source)* Rn General register* ERn General register (32-bit register) MAC Multiply-accumulate register (32-bit register) (EAd) Destination operand (EAs) Source operand EXR Extended control register CCR Condition-code register N N (negative) flag in CCR Z Z (zero) flag in CCR V V (overflow) flag in CCR C C (carry) flag in CCR PC Program counter SP Stack pointer #IMM Immediate data disp Displacement + Addition – Subtraction × Multiplication ÷ Division ∧ Logical AND ∨ Logical OR ⊕ Logical XOR → Move ∼ NOT (logical complement) :8/:16/:24/:32 Note: * 8-, 16-, 24-, or 32-bit length General registers include 8-bit registers (R7H to R0H, R7L to R0L), 16-bit registers (R7 to R0, E7 to E0), and 32-bit registers (ER7 to ER0). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 28 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.3 Data Transfer Instructions Instruction Size* Function MOV B/W/L (EAs) → Rd, Rs → (EAd) Moves data between two general registers or between a general register and memory, or moves immediate data to a general register. MOVFPE B Cannot be used in this LSI. MOVTPE B Cannot be used in this LSI. POP W/L @SP+ → Rn Pops a general register from the stack. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W @SP+, Rn. POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, ERn. PUSH W/L Rn → @–SP Pushes a general register onto the stack. PUSH.W Rn is identical to MOV.W Rn, @–SP. PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L ERn, @–SP. LDM L @SP+ → Rn (register list) Pops two or more general registers from the stack. STM L Rn (register list) → @–SP Pushes two or more general registers onto the stack. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 29 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.4 Arithmetic Operations Instructions (1) Instruction Size* Function ADD SUB B/W/L Rd ± Rs → Rd, Rd ± #IMM → Rd Performs addition or subtraction on data in two general registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register (immediate byte data cannot be subtracted from byte data in a general register. Use the SUBX or ADD instruction). ADDX SUBX B Rd ± Rs ± C → Rd, Rd ± #IMM ± C → Rd Performs addition or subtraction with carry on byte data in two general registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register. INC DEC B/W/L Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd Increments or decrements a general register by 1 or 2 (Byte operands can be incremented or decremented by 1 only). ADDS SUBS L Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd, Rd ± 4 → Rd Adds or subtracts the value 1, 2, or 4 to or from data in a 32-bit register. DAA DAS B Rd decimal adjust → Rd Decimal-adjusts an addition or subtraction result in a general register by referring to the CCR to produce 4-bit BCD data. MULXU B/W Rd × Rs → Rd Performs unsigned multiplication on data in two general registers: either 8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits. MULXS B/W Rd × Rs → Rd Performs signed multiplication on data in two general registers: either 8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits. DIVXU B/W Rd ÷ Rs → Rd Performs unsigned division on data in two general registers: either 16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits → 16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 30 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.4 Arithmetic Operations Instructions (2) Instruction Size*1 Function DIVXS B/W Rd ÷ Rs → Rd Performs signed division on data in two general registers: either 16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits → 16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder. CMP B/W/L Rd – Rs, Rd – #IMM Compares data in a general register with data in another general register or with immediate data, and sets CCR bits according to the result. NEG B/W/L 0 – Rd → Rd Takes the two’s complement (arithmetic complement) of data in a general register. EXTU W/L Rd (zero extension) → Rd Extends the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word size, or the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword size, by padding with zeros on the left. EXTS W/L Rd (sign extension) → Rd Extends the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word size, or the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword size, by extending the sign bit. TAS*2 B @ERd – 0, 1 → (<bit 7> of @ERd) Tests memory contents, and sets the most significant bit (bit 7) to 1. MAC (EAs) × (EAd) + MAC → MAC Performs signed multiplication on memory contents and adds the result to the multiply-accumulate register. The following operations can be performed: 16 bits × 16 bits + 32 bits → 32 bits, saturating 16 bits × 16 bits + 42 bits → 42 bits, non-saturating CLRMAC 0 → MAC Clears the multiply-accumulate register to zero. LDMAC STMAC L Rs → MAC, MAC → Rd Transfers data between a general register and a multiply-accumulate register. Notes: 1. Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword 2. Only register ER0, ER1, ER4, or ER5 should be used when using the TAS instruction. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 31 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.5 Logic Operations Instructions Instruction Size* Function AND B/W/L Rd ∧ Rs → Rd, Rd ∧ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical AND operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. OR B/W/L Rd ∨ Rs → Rd, Rd ∨ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical OR operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. XOR B/W/L Rd ⊕ Rs → Rd, Rd ⊕ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical exclusive OR operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. NOT B/W/L ∼(Rd) → (Rd) Takes the one’s complement (logical complement) of general register contents. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Table 2.6 Shift Instructions Instruction Size* Function SHAL SHAR B/W/L Rd (shift) → Rd Performs an arithmetic shift on general register contents. 1-bit or 2-bit shifts are possible. SHLL SHLR B/W/L Rd (shift) → Rd Performs a logical shift on general register contents. 1-bit or 2-bit shifts are possible. ROTL ROTR B/W/L Rd (rotate) → Rd Rotates general register contents. 1-bit or 2-bit rotations are possible. ROTXL ROTXR B/W/L Rd (rotate) → Rd Rotates general register contents through the carry flag. 1-bit or 2-bit rotations are possible. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 32 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.7 Bit Manipulation Instructions (1) Instruction Size* Function BSET B 1 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Sets a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 1. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a general register. BCLR B 0 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Clears a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 0. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a general register. BNOT B ∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Inverts a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a general register. BTST B ∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → Z Tests a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and sets or clears the Z flag accordingly. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a general register. BAND B BIAND B BOR B BIOR B C ∧ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C ANDs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. C ∧ [∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C ANDs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. C ∨ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. C ∨ [∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 33 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.7 Bit Manipulation Instructions (2) Instruction Size* Function BXOR B C ⊕ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C XORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. BIXOR B C ⊕ [∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C XORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. BLD B BILD B (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C Transfers a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to the carry flag. ∼(<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C Transfers the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. BST B BIST B C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Transfers the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. ∼C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Transfers the inverse of the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 34 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.8 Branch Instructions Instruction Size Function Bcc Branches to a specified address if a specified condition is true. The branching conditions are listed below. Mnemonic Description Condition BRA (BT) Always (true) Always BRN (BF) Never (false) Never BHI High C∨Z=0 BLS Low or same C∨Z=1 BCC (BHS) Carry clear (high or same) C=0 BCS (BLO) Carry set (low) C=1 BNE Not equal Z=0 BEQ Equal Z=1 BVC Overflow clear V=0 BVS Overflow set V=1 BPL Plus N=0 BMI Minus N=1 BGE Greater or equal N⊕V=0 BLT Less than N⊕V=1 BGT Greater than Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 0 BLE Less or equal Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 1 JMP Branches unconditionally to a specified address. BSR Branches to a subroutine at a specified address. JSR Branches to a subroutine at a specified address. RTS Returns from a subroutine Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 35 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.9 System Control Instructions Instruction Size* Function TRAPA Starts trap-instruction exception handling. RTE Returns from an exception-handling routine. SLEEP Causes a transition to a power-down state. LDC B/W (EAs) → CCR, (EAs) → EXR Moves general register or memory contents or immediate data to CCR or EXR. Although CCR and EXR are 8-bit registers, word-size transfers are performed between them and memory. The upper 8 bits are valid. STC B/W CCR → (EAd), EXR → (EAd) Transfers CCR or EXR contents to a general register or memory. Although CCR and EXR are 8-bit registers, word-size transfers are performed between them and memory. The upper 8 bits are valid. ANDC B CCR ∧ #IMM → CCR, EXR ∧ #IMM → EXR Logically ANDs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data. ORC B CCR ∨ #IMM → CCR, EXR ∨ #IMM → EXR Logically ORs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data. XORC B CCR ⊕ #IMM → CCR, EXR ⊕ #IMM → EXR Logically XORs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data. NOP PC + 2 → PC Only increments the program counter. Note: * Refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 36 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.10 Block Data Transfer Instructions Instruction Size Function EEPMOV.B if R4L ≠ 0 then Repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+ R4L–1 → R4L Until R4L = 0 else next; EEPMOV.W if R4 ≠ 0 then Repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+ R4–1 → R4 Until R4 = 0 else next; Transfers a data block. Starting from the address set in ER5, transfers data for the number of bytes set in R4L or R4 to the address location set in ER6. Execution of the next instruction begins as soon as the transfer is completed. 2.6.2 Basic Instruction Formats The H8S/2600 CPU instructions consist of 2-byte (1-word) units. An instruction consists of an operation field (op field), a register field (r field), an effective address extension (EA field), and a condition field (cc). Figure 2.11 shows examples of instruction formats. • Operation Field Indicates the function of the instruction, the addressing mode, and the operation to be carried out on the operand. The operation field always includes the first four bits of the instruction. Some instructions have two operation fields. • Register Field Specifies a general register. Address registers are specified by 3 bits, and data registers by 3 bits or 4 bits. Some instructions have two register fields. Some have no register field. • Effective Address Extension 8, 16, or 32 bits specifying immediate data, an absolute address, or a displacement. • Condition Field Specifies the branching condition of Bcc instructions. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 37 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU (1) Operation field only op NOP, RTS, etc. (2) Operation field and register fields op rm rn ADD.B Rn, Rm, etc. (3) Operation field, register fields, and effective address extension op rn rm MOV.B @(d:16, Rn), Rm, etc. EA(disp) (4) Operation field, effective address extension, and condition field op cc EA(disp) BRA d:16, etc. Figure 2.11 Instruction Formats (Examples) 2.7 Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation The H8S/2600 CPU supports the eight addressing modes listed in table 2.11. Each instruction uses a subset of these addressing modes. Arithmetic and logic instructions can use the register direct and immediate modes. Data transfer instructions can use all addressing modes except programcounter relative and memory indirect. Bit manipulation instructions use register direct, register indirect, or the absolute addressing mode to specify an operand, and register direct (BSET, BCLR, BNOT, and BTST instructions) or immediate (3-bit) addressing mode to specify a bit number in the operand. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 38 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.11 Addressing Modes No. Addressing Mode Symbol 1 Register direct Rn 2 Register indirect @ERn 3 Register indirect with displacement @(d:16,ERn)/@(d:32,ERn) 4 Register indirect with post-increment Register indirect with pre-decrement @ERn+ @–ERn 5 Absolute address @aa:8/@aa:16/@aa:24/@aa:32 6 Immediate #xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32 7 Program-counter relative @(d:8,PC)/@(d:16,PC) 8 Memory indirect @@aa:8 2.7.1 Register DirectRn The register field of the instruction specifies an 8-, 16-, or 32-bit general register containing the operand. R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L can be specified as 8-bit registers. R0 to R7 and E0 to E7 can be specified as 16-bit registers. ER0 to ER7 can be specified as 32-bit registers. 2.7.2 Register Indirect@ERn The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn) which contains the address of the operand on memory. If the address is a program instruction address, the lower 24 bits are valid and the upper 8 bits are all assumed to be 0 (H'00). 2.7.3 Register Indirect with Displacement@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:32, ERn) A 16-bit or 32-bit displacement contained in the instruction is added to an address register (ERn) specified by the register field of the instruction, and the sum gives the address of a memory operand. A 16-bit displacement is sign-extended when added. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 39 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU 2.7.4 Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement@ERn+ or @-ERn Register indirect with post-increment@ERn+: The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn) which contains the address of a memory operand. After the operand is accessed, 1, 2, or 4 is added to the address register contents and the sum is stored in the address register. The value added is 1 for byte access, 2 for word transfer instruction, or 4 for longword transfer instruction. For the word or longword transfer instructions, the register value should be even. Register indirect with pre-decrement@-ERn: The value 1, 2, or 4 is subtracted from an address register (ERn) specified by the register field in the instruction code, and the result is the address of a memory operand. The result is also stored in the address register. The value subtracted is 1 for byte access, 2 for word transfer instruction, or 4 for longword transfer instruction. For the word or longword transfer instructions, the register value should be even. 2.7.5 Absolute Address@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32 The instruction code contains the absolute address of a memory operand. The absolute address may be 8 bits long (@aa:8), 16 bits long (@aa:16), 24 bits long (@aa:24), or 32 bits long (@aa:32). Table 2.12 indicates the accessible absolute address ranges. To access data, the absolute address should be 8 bits (@aa:8), 16 bits (@aa:16), or 32 bits (@aa:32) long. For an 8-bit absolute address, the upper 24 bits are all assumed to be 1 (H'FFFF). For a 16-bit absolute address the upper 16 bits are a sign extension. A 32-bit absolute address can access the entire address space. A 24-bit absolute address (@aa:24) indicates the address of a program instruction. The upper 8 bits are all assumed to be 0 (H'00). Table 2.12 Absolute Address Access Ranges Normal Mode* Absolute Address Data address 8 bits (@aa:8) H'FF00 to H'FFFF H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF 16 bits (@aa:16) H'0000 to H'FFFF H'000000 to H'007FFF, H'FF8000 to H'FFFFFF 32 bits (@aa:32) Program instruction address Note: * 24 bits (@aa:24) Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 40 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Advanced Mode H'000000 to H'FFFFFF Section 2 CPU 2.7.6 Immediate#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32 The instruction contains 8-bit (#xx:8), 16-bit (#xx:16), or 32-bit (#xx:32) immediate data as an operand. The ADDS, SUBS, INC, and DEC instructions contain immediate data implicitly. Some bit manipulation instructions contain 3-bit immediate data in the instruction code, specifying a bit number. The TRAPA instruction contains 2-bit immediate data in its instruction code, specifying a vector address. 2.7.7 Program-Counter Relative@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC) This mode is used in the Bcc and BSR instructions. An 8-bit or 16-bit displacement contained in the instruction is sign-extended and added to the 24-bit PC contents to generate a branch address. Only the lower 24 bits of this branch address are valid; the upper 8 bits are all assumed to be 0 (H'00). The PC value to which the displacement is added is the address of the first byte of the next instruction, so the possible branching range is –126 to +128 bytes (–63 to +64 words) or –32766 to +32768 bytes (–16383 to +16384 words) from the branch instruction. The resulting value should be an even number. 2.7.8 Memory Indirect@@aa:8 This mode can be used by the JMP and JSR instructions. The instruction code contains an 8-bit absolute address specifying a memory operand. This memory operand contains a branch address. The upper bits of the absolute address are all assumed to be 0, so the address range is 0 to 255 (H'0000 to H'00FF in normal mode, H'000000 to H'0000FF in advanced mode). In normal mode, the memory operand is a word operand and the branch address is 16 bits long. In advanced mode, the memory operand is a longword operand, the first byte of which is assumed to be 0 (H'00). Note that the first part of the address range is also the exception vector area. For further details, refer to section 4, Exception Handling. If an odd address is specified in word or longword memory access, or as a branch address, the least significant bit is regarded as 0, causing data to be accessed or instruction code to be fetched at the address preceding the specified address (For further information, see section 2.5.2, Memory Data Formats). Note: Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 41 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Specified by @aa:8 Branch address Specified by @aa:8 Reserved Branch address (a) Normal Mode* (a) Advanced Mode Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Figure 2.12 Branch Address Specification in Memory Indirect Mode 2.7.9 Effective Address Calculation Table 2.13 indicates how effective addresses are calculated in each addressing mode. In normal mode the upper 8 bits of the effective address are ignored in order to generate a 16-bit address. Note: Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 42 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.13 Effective Address Calculation (1) No 1 Addressing Mode and Instruction Format op 2 Effective Address Calculation Effective Address (EA) Register direct(Rn) rm Operand is general register contents. rn Register indirect(@ERn) 0 31 op 3 31 24 23 0 Don't care General register contents r Register indirect with displacement @(d:16,ERn) or @(d:32,ERn) 0 31 General register contents op r 31 disp Sign extension Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement •Register indirect with post-increment @ERn+ op disp 31 0 31 24 23 0 Don't care General register contents r •Register indirect with pre-decrement @-ERn 0 0 31 4 24 23 Don't care 1, 2, or 4 31 0 General register contents 31 24 23 0 Don't care op r 1, 2, or 4 Operand Size Byte Word Longword Offset 1 2 4 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 43 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Table 2.13 Effective Address Calculation (2) No 5 Addressing Mode and Instruction Format Effective Address Calculation Effective Address (EA) Absolute address @aa:8 31 op @aa:16 31 op 0 H'FFFF 24 23 16 15 0 Don't care Sign extension abs @aa:24 31 op 8 7 24 23 Don't care abs 24 23 0 Don't care abs @aa:32 op 31 6 Immediate #xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32 op 7 0 24 23 Don't care abs Operand is immediate data. IMM 0 23 Program-counter relative PC contents @(d:8,PC)/@(d:16,PC) op disp 23 0 Sign extension disp 31 24 23 0 Don't care 8 Memory indirect @@aa:8 • Normal mode* 8 7 31 op abs 0 abs H'000000 15 0 31 24 23 Don't care Memory contents 16 15 0 H'00 • Advanced mode 31 op abs 8 7 H'000000 31 0 Memory contents Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 44 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 0 abs 31 24 23 Don't care 0 Section 2 CPU 2.8 Processing States The H8S/2600 CPU has five main processing states: the reset state, exception handling state, program execution state, bus-released state, and power-down state. Figure 2.13 indicates the state transitions. • Reset State In this state, the CPU and all on-chip peripheral modules are initialized and not operating. When the RES input goes low, all current processing stops and the CPU enters the reset state. All interrupts are masked in the reset state. Reset exception handling starts when the RES signal changes from low to high. For details, refer to section 4, Exception Handling. The reset state can also be entered by a watchdog timer overflow. • Exception-Handling State The exception-handling state is a transient state that occurs when the CPU alters the normal processing flow due to an exception source, such as a reset, trace, interrupt, or trap instruction. The CPU fetches a start address (vector) from the exception vector table and branches to that address. For further details, refer to section 4, Exception Handling. • Program Execution State In this state, the CPU executes program instructions in sequence. • Bus-Released State The bus has been released in response to a bus request from a bus master other than the CPU. While the bus is released, the CPU halts operations. • Program stop state This is a power-down state in which the CPU stops operating. The program stop state occurs when a SLEEP instruction is executed or the CPU enters hardware standby mode. For further details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 45 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 2 CPU Reset state* igh =H , i gh = H ow BY = L ST ES R ES R Exception handling state Request for exception handling In reqterru ue p t st End of exception handling Bus-released state s Bu est u req Bus request End of bus request us fb d o st En eque r Program execution state SLEEP instruction Program halt state Notes: From any state, a transition to hardware standby mode occurs when STBY goes low. * From any state except hardware standby mode, a transition to the reset state occurs whenever RES goes low. A transition can also be made to the reset state when the watchdog timer overflows. Figure 2.13 State Transitions 2.9 Usage Note 2.9.1 Notes on Using the Bit Operation Instruction Instructions BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BST, and BIST read data in byte units, and write data in byte units after bit operation. Therefore, attention must be paid when these instructions are used for ports or registers including write-only bits. Instruction BCLR can be used to clear the flag in the internal I/O register to 0. If it is obvious that the flag has been set to 1 by the interrupt processing routine, it is unnecessary to read the flag beforehand. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 46 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.1 Operating Mode Selection This LSI supports only operating mode 7, that is, the advanced single-chip mode. The operating mode is determined by the setting of the mode pins (MD2 to MD0). Only mode 7 can be used in this LSI. Therefore, all mode pins must be fixed high, as shown in table 3.1. Do not change the mode pin settings during operation. Table 3.1 MCU Operating Mode Selection MCU Operating Mode MD2 MD1 MD0 CPU Operating Mode Description 7 Advanced mode 3.2 1 1 1 Single-chip mode External Data Bus On-Chip ROM Initial Width Max. Width Enabled Register Descriptions The following registers are related to the operating mode. • Mode control register (MDCR) • System control register (SYSCR) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 47 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.2.1 Mode Control Register (MDCR) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Descriptions 7 1 R/W Reserved Only 1 should be written to this bit. 6 to 3 All 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 2 1 0 MDS2 MDS1 MDS0 R R R Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 48 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Mode Select 2 to 0 These bits indicate the input levels at pins MD2 to MD0 (the current operating mode). Bits MDS2 to MDS0 correspond to MD2 to MD0. MDS2 to MDS0 are readonly bits and they cannot be written to. The mode pin (MD2 to MD0) input levels are latched into these bits when MDCR is read. These latches are canceled by a reset. Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.2.2 System Control Register (SYSCR) SYSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects saturating or non-saturating calculation for the MAC instruction, selects the interrupt control mode and the detected edge for NMI, and enables or disables on-chip RAM. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Descriptions 7 MACS 0 R/W MAC Saturation Selects either saturating or non-saturating calculation for the MAC instruction. 0: Non-saturating calculation for the MAC instruction 1: Saturating calculation for the MAC instruction 6 0 Reserved This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 5 4 INTM1 INTM0 0 0 R/W R/W These bits select the control mode of the interrupt controller. For details of the interrupt control modes, see section 5.6, Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt Operation. 00: Interrupt control mode 0 01: Setting prohibited 10: Interrupt control mode 2 11: Setting prohibited 3 NMIEG 0 R/W NMI Edge Select Selects the valid edge of the NMI interrupt input. 0: An interrupt is requested at the falling edge of NMI input 1: An interrupt is requested at the rising edge of NMI input 2, 1 All 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0 RAME 1 R/W RAM Enable Enables or disables on-chip RAM. The RAME bit is initialized when the reset status is released. 0: On-chip RAM is disabled 1: On-chip RAM is enabled Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 49 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.3 Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode The CPU can access a 16-Mbyte address space in advanced mode. The on-chip ROM is enabled, however external addresses cannot be accessed. All I/O ports are available for use as input-output ports. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 50 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.4 Address Map Figure 3.1 shows the address map in each operating mode. H8S/2604 H8S/2603 ROM: 128 kbytes, RAM: 8 kbytes Mode 7 Advanced single-chip mode H'000000 ROM: 64 kbytes, RAM: 8 kbytes Mode 7 Advanced single-chip mode H'000000 On-chip ROM (Mask ROM version) On-chip ROM (F-ZTAT/Mask ROM version) H'00FFFF H'01FFFF H'FFD000 H'FF0000 On-chip RAM H'FFEFBF On-chip RAM H'FFEFBF H'FFF800 H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers H'FFFF3F Internal I/O registers H'FFFF3F H'FFFF60 H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers H'FFFFBF H'FFFFC0 Internal I/O registers H'FFFFBF H'FFFFC0 On-chip RAM H'FFFFFF On-chip RAM H'FFFFFF Figure 3.1 Address Map Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 51 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 52 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling Section 4 Exception Handling 4.1 Exception Handling Types and Priority As shown in table 4.1, exception handling may be caused by a reset, trace, interrupt, or trap instruction. Exception handling is prioritized as shown in table 4.1. If two or more exceptions occur simultaneously, they are accepted and processed in order of priority. Exception sources, the stack structure, and operation of the CPU vary depending on the interrupt control mode. For details on the interrupt control mode, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller. Table 4.1 Exception Types and Priority Priority Exception Type Start of Exception Handling High Reset Starts immediately after a low-to-high transition at the RES pin, or when the watchdog timer overflows. The CPU enters the reset state when the RES pin is low. Trace*1 Starts when execution of the current instruction or exception handling ends, if the trace (T) bit in EXR is set to 1. Direct transition Starts when a direction transition occurs as the result of SLEEP instruction execution. Interrupt Starts when execution of the current instruction or exception handling ends, if an interrupt request has been issued.*2 Trap instruction *3 Started by execution of a trap instruction (TRAPA). Low Notes: 1. Traces are enabled only in interrupt control mode 2. Trace exception handling is not executed after execution of an RTE instruction. 2. Interrupt detection is not performed on completion of ANDC, ORC, XORC, or LDC instruction execution, or on completion of reset exception handling. 3. Trap instruction exception handling requests are accepted at all times in program execution state. 4.2 Exception Sources and Exception Vector Table Different vector addresses are assigned to different exception sources. Table 4.2 lists the exception sources and their vector addresses. Since the usable modes differ depending on the product, for details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating Modes. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 53 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling Table 4.2 Exception Handling Vector Table Vector Address*1 Exception Source Vector Number Normal Mode Advanced Mode Power-on reset Manual reset *2 0 H'0000 to H'0001 H'0000 to H'0003 1 H'0002 to H'0003 H'0004 to H'0007 Reserved for system use 2 H'0004 to H'0005 H'0008 to H'000B 3 H'0006 to H'0007 H'000C to H'000F 4 H'0008 to H'0019 H'0010 to H'0013 5 H'000A to H'000B H'0014 to H'0017 Interrupt (direct transitions)*2 6 H'000C to H'000D H'0018 to H'001B Trace Interrupt (NMI) 7 H'000E to H'000F H'001C to H'001F Trap instruction (#0) 8 H'0010 to H'0011 H'0020 to H'0023 (#1) 9 H'0012 to H'0013 H'0024 to H'0027 (#2) 10 H'0014 to H'0015 H'0028 to H'002B (#3) 11 H'0016 to H'0017 H'002C to H'002F 12 H'0018 to H'0019 H''0030 to H'0033 13 H'001A to H'001B H'0034 to H'0037 14 H'001C to H'001D H'0038 to H'003B Reserved for system use 15 H'001E to H'001F H'003C to H'003F IRQ0 16 H'0020 to H'0021 H'0040 to H'0043 IRQ1 17 H'0022 to H'0023 H'0044 to H'0047 IRQ2 18 H'0024 to H'0025 H'0048 to H'004B IRQ3 19 H'0026 to H'0027 H'004C to H'004F IRQ4 20 H'0028 to H'0029 H'0050 to H'0053 IRQ5 21 H'002A to H'002B H'0054 to H'0057 Reserved for system use 22 H'002C to H'002D H'0058 to H'005B 23 H'002E to H'002F H'005C to H'005F Internal interrupt*3 24 127 H'0030 to H'0031 H'00FE to H'00FF H'0060 to H'0063 H'01FC to H'01FF External interrupt Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Not available in this LSI. 3. For details of internal interrupt vectors, see section 5.5, Interrupt Exception Handling Vector Table. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 54 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.3 Reset A reset has the highest exception priority. When the RES pin goes low, all processing halts and this LSI enters the reset state. To ensure that this LSI is reset, hold the RES pin low for at least 20 ms at power-up. To reset the chip during operation, hold the RES pin low for at least 20 states. A reset initializes the internal state of the CPU and the registers of on-chip peripheral modules. The chip can also be reset by overflow of the watchdog timer. For details, see section 13, Watchdog Timer. The interrupt control mode is 0 immediately after reset. 4.3.1 Reset Exception Handling When the RES pin goes high after being held low for the necessary period, this LSI starts reset exception handling as follows: 1. The internal state of the CPU and the registers of the on-chip peripheral modules are initialized, the T bit in EXR is cleared to 0, and the I bit in EXR and CCR is set to 1. 2. The reset exception handling vector address is read and transferred to the PC, and program execution starts from the address indicated by the PC. Figures 4.1 and 4.2 show examples of the reset sequence. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 55 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling Vector fetch Fetch of first Internal processing program instruction (1) (3) φ RES Internal address bus (5) Internal read signal Internal write signal High Internal data bus (2) (4) (1)(3) Reset exception handling vector address (when reset, (1)=H'000000, (3)=H'000002) (2)(4) Start address (contents of reset exception handling vector address) (5) Start address ((5)=(2)(4)) (6) First program instruction Figure 4.1 Reset Sequence (Advanced Mode with On-Chip ROM Enabled) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 56 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 (6) Section 4 Exception Handling Internal processing Vector fetch * * Fetch of first program instruction * φ RES Address bus (1) (3) (5) RD HWR, LWR D15 to D0 High (2) (4) (6) (1)(3) Reset exception handling vector address (when reset, (1)=H'000000, (3)=H'000002) (2)(4) Start address (contents of reset exception handling vector address) (5) Start address ((5)=(2)(4)) (6) First program instruction Note: * Three program wait states are inserted. Figure 4.2 Reset Sequence (Advanced Mode with On-chip ROM Disabled: Not Available in this LSI) 4.3.2 Interrupts after Reset If an interrupt is accepted immediately after a reset and before the stack pointer (SP) is initialized, the PC and CCR will not be saved correctly, leading to a program crash. To prevent this, all interrupt requests, including NMI, are disabled immediately after a reset exception handling is executed. Since the first instruction of a program is always executed immediately after the reset, make sure that this instruction initializes the stack pointer (example: MOV.L #xx: 32, SP). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 57 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.3.3 State of On-Chip Peripheral Modules after Reset Release After reset release, MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC are initialized to H'3F, H'FF, and H'FF, respectively, and all modules except the DTC enter module stop mode. Consequently, on-chip peripheral module registers cannot be read or written to. Register reading and writing is enabled when the module stop mode is cancelled. 4.4 Traces Traces are enabled in interrupt control mode 2. Trace mode is not activated in interrupt control mode 0, irrespective of the state of the T bit. For details of interrupt control modes, see section 5, Interrupt Controller. If the T bit in EXR is set to 1, trace mode is activated. In trace mode, a trace exception occurs on completion of each instruction. Trace mode is not affected by interrupt mask bit in CCR. Table 4.3 shows the states of CCR and EXR after execution of trace exception handling. Trace mode is cancelled by clearing the T bit in EXR to 0 with the trace exception handling. The T bit saved on the stack retains its value of 1, and when control is returned from the trace exception handling routine by the RTE instruction, trace mode resumes. Trace exception handling is not carried out after execution of the RTE instruction. Interrupts are accepted even within the trace exception handling routine. Table 4.3 Statuses of CCR and EXR after Trace Exception Handling Interrupt Control Mode CCR I 0 2 [Legend] 1: Set to 1 0: Cleared to 0 —: Retains value prior to execution Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 58 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 EXR UI I2 to I0 T Trace exception handling cannot be used. 1 — — 0 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.5 Interrupts Interrupts are controlled by the interrupt controller. The interrupt controller has two interrupt control modes and can assign interrupts other than NMI to eight priority/mask levels to enable multiplexed interrupt control. The source to start interrupt exception handling and the vector address differ depending on the product. For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller. Interrupt exception handling is conducted as follows: 1. The values in the program counter (PC), condition code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are saved to the stack. 2. The interrupt mask bit is updated and the T bit is cleared to 0. 3. A vector address corresponding to the interrupt source is generated, the start address is loaded from the vector table to the PC, and program execution begins from that address. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 59 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.6 Trap Instruction Trap instruction exception handling starts when a TRAPA instruction is executed. Trap instruction exception handling can be executed at all times in the program execution state. Trap instruction exception handling is conducted as follows: 1. The values in the program counter (PC), condition code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are saved to the stack. 2. The interrupt mask bit is updated and the T bit is cleared to 0. 3. A vector address corresponding to the interrupt source is generated, the start address is loaded from the vector table to the PC, and program execution starts from that address. The TRAPA instruction fetches a start address from a vector table entry corresponding to a vector number from 0 to 3, as specified in the instruction code. Table 4.4 shows the statuses of CCR and EXR after execution of trap instruction exception handling. Table 4.4 Statuses of CCR and EXR after Trap Instruction Exception Handling Interrupt Control Mode CCR EXR I UI I2 to I0 T 0 1 — — — 2 1 — — 0 [Legend] 1: Set to 1 0: Cleared to 0 —: Retains value prior to execution Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 60 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.7 Stack Status after Exception Handling Figures 4.3 shows the stack after completion of trap instruction exception handling and interrupt exception handling. (a) Normal Modes*2 SP EXR Reserved*1 SP CCR CCR CCR*1 CCR*1 PC (16 bits) PC (16 bits) Interrupt control mode 0 Interrupt control mode 2 (b) Advanced Modes SP EXR Reserved*1 SP CCR PC (24 bits) Interrupt control mode 0 CCR PC (24 bits) Interrupt control mode 2 Notes: 1. Ignored on return. 2. Normal modes are not available in this LSI. Figure 4.3 Stack Status after Exception Handling Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 61 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.8 Usage Note When accessing word data or longword data, this LSI assumes that the lowest address bit is 0. The stack should always be accessed by word transfer instruction or longword transfer instruction, and the value of the stack pointer (SP: ER7) should always be kept even. Use the following instructions to save registers: PUSH.W Rn (or MOV.W Rn, @-SP) PUSH.L ERn (or MOV.L ERn, @-SP) Use the following instructions to restore registers: POP.W Rn (or MOV.W @SP+, Rn) POP.L ERn (or MOV.L @SP+, ERn) Setting SP to an odd value may lead to a malfunction. Figure 4.4 shows an example of what happens when the SP value is odd. Address CCR SP R1L SP H'FFFEFA H'FFFEFB PC PC H'FFFEFC H'FFFEFD H'FFFEFE SP H'FFFEFF SP set to H'FFFEFF TRAP instruction executed MOV.B R1L, @-ER7 instruction executed Data saved above SP Contents of CCR lost [Legend] CCR: Condition code register PC: Program counter R1L: General register R1L SP: Stack pointer Note: This diagram illustrates an example in which the interrupt control mode is 0, in advanced mode. Figure 4.4 Operation when SP Value Is Odd Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 62 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.1 Features • Two interrupt control modes Any of two interrupt control modes can be set by means of the INTM1 and INTM0 bits in the system control register (SYSCR). • Priorities settable with IPR An interrupt priority register (IPR) is provided for setting interrupt priorities. Eight priority levels can be set for each module for all interrupts except NMI. NMI is assigned the highest priority level of 8, and can be accepted at all times. • Independent vector addresses All interrupt sources are assigned independent vector addresses, making it unnecessary for the source to be identified in the interrupt handling routine. • Seven external interrupts NMI is the highest-priority interrupt, and is accepted at all times. Rising edge or falling edge can be selected for NMI. Falling edge, rising edge, or both edge detection, or level sensing, can be selected for IRQ5 to IRQ0. • DTC control The DTC can be activated by an interrupt request. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 63 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller A block diagram of the interrupt controller is shown in figure 5.1. CPU INTM1, INTM0 SYSCR NMIEG NMI input NMI input unit IRQ input IRQ input unit ISR ISCR IER Interrupt request Vector number Priority determination I Internal interrupt request SWDTEND to SSERT_i1 CCR I2 to I0 IPR Interrupt controller [Legend] IRQ sense control register ISCR: IRQ enable register IER: IRQ status register ISR: Interrupt priority register IPR: SYSCR: System control register Figure 5.1 Block Diagram of Interrupt Controller Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 64 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 EXR Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.2 Input/Output Pins Table 5.1 summarizes the pins of the interrupt controller. Table 5.1 Pin Configuration Name I/O Function NMI Input Nonmaskable external interrupt Rising or falling edge can be selected. IRQ5 IRQ4 IRQ3 IRQ2 IRQ1 IRQ0 Input Input Input Input Input Input Maskable external interrupts Rising, falling, or both edges, or level sensing, can be selected. 5.3 Register Descriptions The interrupt controller has the following registers. For the system control register (SYSCR), refer to section 3.2.2, System Control Register (SYSCR). • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • System control register (SYSCR) IRQ sense control register H (ISCRH) IRQ sense control register L (ISCRL) IRQ enable register (IER) IRQ status register (ISR) Interrupt priority register A (IPRA) Interrupt priority register B (IPRB) Interrupt priority register C (IPRC) Interrupt priority register D (IPRD) Interrupt priority register E (IPRE) Interrupt priority register F (IPRF) Interrupt priority register G (IPRG) Interrupt priority register H (IPRH) Interrupt priority register I (IPRI) Interrupt priority register J (IPRJ) Interrupt priority register K (IPRK) Interrupt priority register L (IPRL) Interrupt priority register M (IPRM) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 65 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.3.1 Interrupt Priority Registers A to M (IPRA to IPRM) The IPR registers are thirteen 8-bit readable/writable registers that set priorities (levels 7 to 0) for interrupts other than NMI. The correspondence between interrupt sources and IPR settings is shown in table 5.2. Setting a value in the range from H'7 to H'0 in the 3-bit groups of bits 2 to 0 and 6 to 4 sets the priority of the corresponding interrupt. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 0 Reserved 6 5 4 IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W This bit is always read as 0. Sets the priority of the corresponding interrupt source. 000: Priority level 0 (Lowest) 001: Priority level 1 010: Priority level 2 011: Priority level 3 100: Priority level 4 101: Priority level 5 110: Priority level 6 111: Priority level 7 (Highest) 3 0 Reserved This bit is always read as 0. 2 1 0 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W Sets the priority of the corresponding interrupt source. 000: Priority level 0 (Lowest) 001: Priority level 1 010: Priority level 2 011: Priority level 3 100: Priority level 4 101: Priority level 5 110: Priority level 6 111: Priority level 7 (Highest) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 66 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.3.2 IRQ Enable Register (IER) IER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the enabling and disabling of interrupt requests IRQ5 to IRQ0. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7, 6 All 0 R/W Reserved Only 0 should be written to these bits. 5 IRQ5E 0 R/W IRQ5 Enable The IRQ5 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. 4 IRQ4E 0 R/W IRQ4 Enable The IRQ4 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. 3 IRQ3E 0 R/W IRQ3 Enable The IRQ3 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. 2 IRQ2E 0 R/W IRQ2 Enable The IRQ2 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. 1 IRQ1E 0 R/W IRQ1 Enable The IRQ1 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. 0 IRQ0E 0 R/W IRQ0 Enable The IRQ0 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 67 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.3.3 IRQ Sense Control Registers H and L (ISCRH, ISCRL) The ISCR registers are 16-bit readable/writable registers that select the source that generates an interrupt request at pins IRQ5 to IRQ0. • Bit ISCRH Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 15 to 12 All 0 R/W Reserved 11 10 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ5 Sense Control B IRQ5 Sense Control A Only 0 should be written to these bits. IRQ5SCB IRQ5SCA 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ5 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ5 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ5 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ5 input 9 8 IRQ4SCB IRQ4SCA 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ4 Sense Control B IRQ4 Sense Control A 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ4 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ4 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ4 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ4 input Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 68 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller • ISCRL Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 6 IRQ3SCB IRQ3SCA 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ3 Sense Control B IRQ3 Sense Control A 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ3 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ3 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ3 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ3 input 5 4 IRQ2SCB IRQ2SCA 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ2 Sense Control B IRQ2 Sense Control A 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ2 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ2 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ2 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ2 input 3 2 IRQ1SCB IRQ1SCA 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ1 Sense Control B IRQ1 Sense Control A 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ1 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ1 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ1 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ1 input Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 69 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 1 0 IRQ0SCB IRQ0SCA 0 0 R/W R/W IRQ0 Sense Control B IRQ0 Sense Control A 00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ0 input level low 01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ0 input 10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ0 input 11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising edges of IRQ0 input 5.3.4 IRQ Status Register (ISR) ISR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that indicates the status of IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupt requests. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7, 6 All 0 R/W Reserved 5 4 3 2 1 0 IRQ5F IRQ4F IRQ3F IRQ2F IRQ1F IRQ0F 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W [Setting condition] Only 0 should be written to these bits. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 70 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 • When the interrupt source selected by the ISCR registers occurs [Clearing conditions] • Cleared by reading IRQnF flag when IRQnF = 1, then writing 0 to IRQnF flag • When interrupt exception handling is executed when low-level detection is set and IRQn input is high • When IRQn interrupt exception handling is executed when falling, rising, or both-edge detection is set • When the DTC is activated by an IRQn interrupt, and the DISEL bit in MRB of the DTC is cleared to 0 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.4 Interrupt Sources 5.4.1 External Interrupts There are seven external interrupts: NMI and IRQ5 to IRQ0. These interrupts can be used to restore this LSI from software standby mode. NMI Interrupt: NMI is the highest-priority interrupt, and is always accepted by the CPU regardless of the interrupt control mode or the status of the CPU interrupt mask bits. The NMIEG bit in SYSCR can be used to select whether an interrupt is requested at a rising edge or a falling edge on the NMI pin. IRQ5 to IRQ0 Interrupts: Interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 are requested by an input signal at pins IRQ5 to IRQ0. Interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 have the following features: • Using ISCR, it is possible to select whether an interrupt is generated by a low level, falling edge, rising edge, or both edges, at pins IRQ5 to IRQ0. • Enabling or disabling of interrupt requests IRQ5 to IRQ0 can be selected with IER. • The interrupt priority level can be set with IPR. • The status of interrupt requests IRQ5 to IRQ0 is indicated in ISR. ISR flags can be cleared to 0 by software. The detection of IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts does not depend on whether the relevant pin has been set for input or output. However, when a pin is used as an external interrupt input pin, do not clear the corresponding DDR to 0; and use the pin as an I/O pin for another function. A block diagram of interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 is shown in figure 5.2. IRQnE IRQnSCA, IRQnSCB IRQnF Edge/level detection circuit S Q IRQn interrupt request R IRQn input Clear signal Note: n = 5 to 0 Figure 5.2 Block Diagram of Interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 71 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.4.2 Internal Interrupts The sources for internal interrupts from on-chip peripheral modules have the following features: • For each on-chip peripheral module there are flags that indicate the interrupt request status, and enable bits that select enabling or disabling of these interrupts. If both of these are set to 1 for a particular interrupt source, an interrupt request is issued to the interrupt controller. • The interrupt priority level can be set by means of IPR. • The DTC can be activated by a TPU, SCI, or other interrupt request. • When the DTC is activated by an interrupt request, it is not affected by the interrupt control mode or CPU interrupt mask bit. 5.5 Interrupt Exception Handling Vector Table Table 5.2 shows interrupt exception handling sources, vector addresses, and interrupt priorities. For default priorities, the lower the vector number, the higher the priority. Priorities among modules can be set by means of IPR. Modules set at the same priority will conform to their default priorities. Priorities within a module are fixed. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 72 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Table 5.2 Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Interrupt Priorities Vector Address* Interrupt Source Origin of Interrupt Source Vector Number Advanced Mode External pin NMI 7 H'001C IRQ0 16 H'0040 IPRA6 to IPRA4 IRQ1 17 H'0044 IPRA2 to IPRA0 IRQ2 18 H'0048 IPRB6 to IPRB4 IPR High IRQ3 19 H'004C IRQ4 20 H'0050 IRQ5 21 H'0054 Reserved for system use 22 H'0058 23 H'005C DTC SWDTEND 24 H'0060 IPRC2 to IPRC0 Watchdog timer 0 WOVI0 25 H'0064 IPRD6 to IPRD4 PC break control PC break 27 H'006C IPRE6 to IPRE4 A/D ADI 28 H'0070 IPRE2 to IPRE0 TPU channel 0 TGIA_0 32 H'0080 IPRF6 to IPRF4 TGIB_0 33 H'0084 TGIC_0 34 H'0088 TGID_0 35 H'008C TCIV_0 36 H'0090 TGIA_1 40 H'00A0 TGIB_1 41 H'00A4 TCIV_1 42 H'00A8 TCIU_1 43 H'00AC TGIA_2 44 H'00B0 TGIB_2 45 H'00B4 TCIV_2 46 H'00B8 TCIU_2 47 H'00BC — TPU channel 1 TPU channel 2 Priority IPRB2 to IPRB0 IPRF2 to IPRF0 IPRG6 to IPRG4 Low Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 73 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Vector Address* Interrupt Source Origin of Interrupt Source Vector Number Advanced Mode IPR Priority TPU channel 3 TGIA_3 48 H'00C0 IPRG2 to IPRG0 High TGIB_3 49 H'00C4 TGIC_3 50 H'00C8 TGID_3 51 H'00CC TCIV_3 52 H'00D0 TGIA_4 56 H'00E0 TGIB_4 57 H'00E4 TCIV_4 58 H'00E8 TCIU_4 59 H'00EC TGIA_5 60 H'00F0 TGIB_5 61 H'00F4 TCIV_5 62 H'00F8 TCIU_5 63 H'00FC CMIA_0 64 H'0100 CMIB_0 65 H'0104 OVI_0 66 H'0108 CMIA_1 68 H'0110 CMIB_1 69 H'0114 OVI_1 70 H'0118 ERI_0 80 H'0140 RXI_0 81 H'0144 TXI_0 82 H'0148 TEI_0 83 H'014C ERI_1 84 H'0150 RXI_1 85 H'0154 TXI_1 86 H'0158 TEI_1 87 H'015C TPU channel 4 TPU channel 5 8-bit timer channel 0 8-bit timer channel 1 SCI channel 0 SCI channel 1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 74 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 IPRH6 to IPRH4 IPRH2 to IPRH0 IPRI6 to IPRI4 IPRI2 to IPRI0 IPRJ2 to IPRJ0 IPRK6 to IPRK4 Low Section 5 Interrupt Controller Vector Address* Interrupt Source Origin of Interrupt Source Vector Number Advanced Mode IPR Priority SCI channel 2 ERI_2 88 H'0160 IPRK2 to IPRK0 High RXI_2 89 H'0164 8-bit timer channel 2 8-bit timer channel 3 SSU channel 0 SSU channel 1 Note: * TXI_2 90 H'0168 TEI_2 91 H'016C CMIA_2 92 H'0170 CMIB_2 93 H'0174 OVI_2 94 H'0178 CMIA_3 96 H'0180 CMIB_3 97 H'0184 OVI_3 98 H'0188 SSEr_i0 108 H'01B0 SSRx_i0 109 H'01B4 SSTx_i0 110 H'01B8 SSERT_i1 111 H'01BC IPRL6 to IPRL4 IPRM2 to IPRM0 Low Lower 16 bits of the start address. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 75 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.6 Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt Operation The interrupt controller has two modes: interrupt control mode 0 and interrupt control mode 2. Interrupt operations differ depending on the interrupt control mode. The interrupt control mode is selected by SYSCR. Table 5.3 shows the differences between interrupt control mode 0 and interrupt control mode 2. Table 5.3 Interrupt Control Modes Interrupt Priority Setting Control Mode Registers Interrupt Mask Bits Description 0 Default I The priorities of interrupt sources are fixed at the default settings. Interrupt sources, except for NMI, are masked by the I bit. 2 IPR I2 to I0 8 priority levels other than NMI can be set with IPR. 8-level interrupt mask control is performed by bits I2 to I0. 5.6.1 Interrupt Control Mode 0 In interrupt control mode 0, interrupt requests other than for NMI are masked by the I bit in CCR in the CPU. Figure 5.3 shows a flowchart of the interrupt acceptance operation in this case. 1. If an interrupt source occurs when the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller. 2. If the I bit in CCR is set to 1, only an NMI interrupt is accepted, and other interrupt requests are held pending. If the I bit is cleared, an interrupt request is accepted. 3. When interrupt requests are sent to the interrupt controller, the interrupt with the highest priority according to the interrupt priority levels is selected and other interrupt requests are held pending. 4. When the CPU accepts an interrupt request, it starts interrupt exception handling after execution of the current instruction has been completed. 5. The PC and CCR are saved to the stack area by interrupt exception handling. The PC saved on the stack shows the address of the first instruction to be executed after returning from the interrupt handling routine. 6. Next, the I bit in CCR is set to 1. This masks all interrupts except NMI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 76 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 7. The CPU generates a vector address for the accepted interrupt and starts execution of the interrupt handling routine at the address indicated by the contents of the vector address in the vector table. Program execution status No Interrupt generated? Yes Yes NMI No No I=0 Hold pending Yes IRQ0 Yes No IRQ1 No Yes TEI_2 Yes Save PC and CCR I←1 Read vector address Branch to interrupt handling routine Figure 5.3 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Interrupt Control Mode 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 77 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.6.2 Interrupt Control Mode 2 In interrupt control mode 2, mask control is applied to eight levels for interrupt requests other than NMI by comparing the EXR interrupt mask level (I2 to I0 bits) in the CPU and the IPR setting. Figure 5.4 shows a flowchart of the interrupt acceptance operation in this case. 1. If an interrupt source occurs when the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller. 2. When interrupt requests are sent to the interrupt controller, the interrupt with the highest priority according to the interrupt priority levels set in IPR is selected, and lower-priority interrupt requests are held pending. If a number of interrupt requests with the same priority are generated at the same time, the interrupt request with the highest priority according to the priority system shown in table 5.2 is selected. 3. Next, the priority of the selected interrupt request is compared with the interrupt mask level set in EXR. An interrupt request with a priority no higher than the mask level set at that time is held pending, and only an interrupt request with a priority higher than the interrupt mask level is accepted. 4. When the CPU accepts an interrupt request, it starts interrupt exception handling after execution of the current instruction has been completed. 5. The PC, CCR, and EXR are saved to the stack area by interrupt exception handling. The PC saved on the stack shows the address of the first instruction to be executed after returning from the interrupt handling routine. 6. The T bit in EXR is cleared to 0. The interrupt mask level is rewritten with the priority level of the accepted interrupt. If the accepted interrupt is NMI, the interrupt mask level is set to H'7. 7. The CPU generates a vector address for the accepted interrupt and starts execution of the interrupt handling routine at the address indicated by the contents of the vector address in the vector table. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 78 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Program execution status Interrupt generated? No Yes Yes NMI No Level 7 interrupt? No Yes Mask level 6 or below? Yes Level 6 interrupt? No No Yes Level 1 interrupt? Mask level 5 or below? No No Yes Yes Mask level 0? No Yes Save PC, CCR, and EXR Hold pending Clear T bit to 0 Update mask level Read vector address Branch to interrupt handling routine Figure 5.4 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Control Mode 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 79 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.6.3 Interrupt Exception Handling Sequence Figure 5.5 shows the interrupt exception handling sequence. The example shown is for the case where interrupt control mode 0 is set in advanced mode, and the program area and stack area are in on-chip memory. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 80 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 (1) (2) (4) (3) Internal operation Instruction prefetch address (Not executed. This is the contents of the saved PC, the return address) (2) (4) Instruction code (Not executed) (3) Instruction prefetch address (Not executed) (5) SP-2 (7) SP-4 (1) Internal data bus Internal write signal Internal read signal Internal address bus Interrupt request signal φ Interrupt level determination Instruction Wait for end of instruction prefetch Interrupt acceptance (7) (8) (10) (9) Vector fetch (12) (11) (14) (13) Interrupt service routine instruction prefetch Saved PC and saved CCR Vector address Interrupt handling routine start address (Vector address contents) Interrupt handling routine start address ((13) = (10)(12)) First instruction of interrupt handling routine (6) (6) (8) (9) (11) (10) (12) (13) (14) (5) stack Internal operation Section 5 Interrupt Controller Figure 5.5 Interrupt Exception Handling Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 81 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.6.4 Interrupt Response Times Table 5.4 shows interrupt response times—the interval between generation of an interrupt request and execution of the first instruction in the interrupt handling routine. The execution status symbols used in table 5.4 are explained in table 5.5. This LSI is capable of fast word transfer to on-chip memory, has the program area in on-chip ROM and the stack area in on-chip RAM, enabling high-speed processing. Table 5.4 Interrupt Response Times Normal Mode*5 Advanced Mode Interrupt control mode 2 Interrupt control mode 0 Interrupt control mode 2 3 3 3 No. Execution Status Interrupt control mode 0 1 Interrupt priority determination*1 3 2 Number of wait states until executing 19 to 1+2·SI 19 to 1+2·SI instruction ends*2 19 to 1+2·SI 19 to 1+2·SI 3 PC, CCR, EXR stack save 2·SK 3·SK 2·SK 3·SK 4 Vector fetch SI SI 2·SI 2·SI 5 Instruction fetch*3 2·SI 2·SI 2·SI 2·SI 6 Internal processing*4 Total (using on-chip memory) Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 2 2 2 2 31 to 11 32 to 12 32 to 12 33 to 13 Two states in case of internal interrupt. Refers to MULXS and DIVXS instructions. Prefetch after interrupt acceptance and interrupt handling routine prefetch. Internal processing after interrupt acceptance and internal processing after vector fetch. Not available in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 82 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Table 5.5 Number of States in Interrupt Handling Routine Execution Status Object of Access External Device* 8-Bit Bus Symbol Instruction fetch SI Branch address read SJ Stack manipulation SK 16-Bit Bus Internal Memory 2-State Access 3-State Access 2-State Access 3-State Access 1 4 6+2m 2 3+m [Legend] m: Number of wait states in an external device access. Note: * Not available in this LSI. 5.6.5 DTC Activation by Interrupt The DTC can be activated by an interrupt. For details, see section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). 5.7 Usage Notes 5.7.1 Conflict between Interrupt Generation and Disabling When an interrupt enable bit is cleared to 0 to disable interrupts, the disabling becomes effective after execution of the instruction. When an interrupt enable bit is cleared to 0 by an instruction such as BCLR or MOV, and if an interrupt is generated during execution of the instruction, the interrupt concerned will still be enabled on completion of the instruction, and so interrupt exception handling for that interrupt will be executed on completion of the instruction. However, if there is an interrupt request of higher priority than that interrupt, interrupt exception handling will be executed for the higher-priority interrupt, and the lower-priority interrupt will be ignored. The same also applies when an interrupt source flag is cleared to 0. Figure 5.6 shows an example in which the TCIEV bit in TIER_0 of the TPU is cleared to 0. The above conflict will not occur if an enable bit or interrupt source flag is cleared to 0 while the interrupt is masked. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 83 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller TIER_0 write cycle by CPU TCIV exception handling φ Internal address bus TIER_0 address Internal write signal TCIEV TCFV TCIV interrupt signal Figure 5.6 Conflict between Interrupt Generation and Disabling 5.7.2 Instructions that Disable Interrupts The instructions that disable interrupts are LDC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC. After any of these instructions are executed, all interrupts including NMI are disabled and the next instruction is always executed. When the I bit is set by one of these instructions, the new value becomes valid two states after execution of the instruction ends. 5.7.3 When Interrupts Are Disabled There are times when interrupt acceptance is disabled by the interrupt controller. The interrupt controller disables interrupt acceptance for a 3-state period after the CPU has updated the mask level with an LDC, ANDC, ORC, or XORC instruction. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 84 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.7.4 Interrupts during Execution of EEPMOV Instruction Interrupt operation differs between the EEPMOV.B instruction and the EEPMOV.W instruction. With the EEPMOV.B instruction, an interrupt request (including NMI) issued during the transfer is not accepted until the transfer is completed. With the EEPMOV.W instruction, if an interrupt request is issued during the transfer, interrupt exception handling starts at a break in the transfer cycle. The PC value saved on the stack in this case is the address of the next instruction. Therefore, if an interrupt is generated during execution of an EEPMOV.W instruction, the following coding should be used. L1: 5.7.5 EEPMOV.W MOV.W R4,R4 BNE L1 IRQ Interrupt When operating by clock input, acceptance of input to an IRQ is synchronized with the clock. In software standby mode, the input is accepted asynchronously. For details on the input conditions, see section 22.3.2, Control Signal Timing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 85 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 86 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) The PC break controller (PBC) provides functions that simplify program debugging. Using these functions, it is easy to create a self-monitoring debugger, enabling programs to be debugged with the chip alone, without using an in-circuit emulator. A block diagram of the PC break controller is shown in figure 6.1. 6.1 Features • Two break channels (A and B) • 24-bit break address Bit masking possible • Four types of break compare conditions Instruction fetch Data read Data write Data read/write • Bus master Either CPU or CPU/DTC can be selected • The timing of PC break exception handling after the occurrence of a break condition is as follows Immediately before execution of the instruction fetched at the set address (instruction fetch) Immediately after execution of the instruction that accesses data at the set address (data access) • Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 87 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) BCRA Output control BARA Mask control Control logic Comparator Internal address PC break interrupt Access status Control logic Comparator Output control Match signal Mask control BARB BCRB Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of PC Break Controller 6.2 Register Descriptions The PC break controller has the following registers. • • • • Break address register A (BARA) Break address register B (BARB) Break control register A (BCRA) Break control register B (BCRB) 6.2.1 Break Address Register A (BARA) BARA is a 32-bit readable/writable register that specifies the channel A break address. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 31 to 24 − Undefined − Reserved These bits are read as an undefined value and cannot be modified. 23 to 0 BAA23 to BAA0 H'000000 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 88 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 R/W These bits set the channel A PC break address. Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) 6.2.2 Break Address Register B (BARB) BARB is the channel B break address register. The bit configuration is the same as for BARA. 6.2.3 Break Control Register A (BCRA) BCRA controls channel A PC breaks. BCRA also contains a condition match flag. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 CMFA 0 R/W Condition Match Flag A [Setting condition] • When a condition set for channel A is satisfied [Clearing condition] • 6 CDA 0 R/W When 0 is written to CMFA after reading CMFA = 1 CPU Cycle/DTC Cycle Select A Selects the channel A break condition bus master. 0: CPU 1: CPU or DTC 5 4 3 BAMRA2 BAMRA1 BAMRA0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W Break Address Mask Register A2 to A0 These bits specify which bits of the break address set in BARA are to be masked. 000: BAA23 to BAA0 (All bits are unmasked) 001: BAA23 to BAA1 (Lowest bit is masked) 010: BAA23 to BAA2 (Lower 2 bits are masked) 011: BAA23 to BAA3 (Lower 3 bits are masked) 100: BAA23 to BAA4 (Lower 4 bits are masked) 101: BAA23 to BAA8 (Lower 8 bits are masked) 110: BAA23 to BAA12 (Lower 12 bits are masked) 111: BAA23 to BAA16 (Lower 16 bits are masked) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 89 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 1 CSELA1 CSELA0 0 0 R/W R/W Break Condition Select A Selects break condition of channel A. 00: Instruction fetch is used as break condition 01: Data read cycle is used as break condition 10: Data write cycle is used as break condition 11: Data read/write cycle is used as break condition 0 BIEA 0 R/W Break Interrupt Enable A When this bit is 1, the PC break interrupt request of channel A is enabled. 6.2.4 Break Control Register B (BCRB) BCRB is the channel B break control register. The bit configuration is the same as for BCRA. 6.3 Operation The operation flow from break condition setting to PC break interrupt exception handling is shown in section 6.3.1, PC Break Interrupt Due to Instruction Fetch, and section 6.3.2, PC Break Interrupt Due to Data Access, taking the example of channel A. 6.3.1 PC Break Interrupt Due to Instruction Fetch 1. Set the break address in BARA. For a PC break caused by an instruction fetch, set the address of the first instruction byte as the break address. 2. Set the break conditions in BCR. Set bit 6 (CDA) to 0 to select the CPU because the bus master must be the CPU for a PC break caused by an instruction fetch. Set the address bits to be masked to bits 5 to 3 (BAMA2 to BAMA0). Set bits 2 and 1 (CSELA1 and CSELA0) to 00 to specify an instruction fetch as the break condition. Set bit 0 (BIEA) to 1 to enable break interrupts. 3. When the instruction at the set address is fetched, a PC break request is generated immediately before execution of the fetched instruction, and the condition match flag (CMFA) is set. 4. After priority determination by the interrupt controller, PC break interrupt exception handling is started. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 90 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) 6.3.2 PC Break Interrupt Due to Data Access 1. Set the break address in BARA. For a PC break caused by a data access, set the target ROM, RAM, I/O, or external address space address as the break address. Stack operations and branch address reads are included in data accesses. 2. Set the break conditions in BCRA. Select the bus master with bit 6 (CDA). Set the address bits to be masked to bits 5 to 3 (BAMA2 to BAMA0). Set bits 2 and 1 (CSELA1 and CSELA0) to 01, 10, or 11 to specify data access as the break condition. Set bit 0 (BIEA) to 1 to enable break interrupts. 3. After execution of the instruction that performs a data access on the set address, a PC break request is generated and the condition match flag (CMFA) is set. 4. After priority determination by the interrupt controller, PC break interrupt exception handling is started. 6.3.3 PC Break Operation at Consecutive Data Transfer • When a PC break interrupt is generated at the transfer address of an EEPMOV.B instruction PC break exception handling is executed after all data transfers have been completed and the EEPMOV.B instruction has ended. • When a PC break interrupt is generated at a DTC transfer address PC break exception handling is executed after the DTC has completed the specified number of data transfers, or after data for which the DISEL bit is set to 1 has been transferred. 6.3.4 Operation in Transitions to Power-Down Modes The operation when a PC break interrupt is set for an instruction fetch at the address after a SLEEP instruction is shown below. • When the SLEEP instruction causes a transition from high-speed (medium-speed) mode to sleep mode: After execution of the SLEEP instruction, a transition is not made to sleep mode, and PC break exception handling is executed. After execution of PC break exception handling, the instruction at the address after the SLEEP instruction is executed (figure 6.2 (A)). • When the SLEEP instruction causes a transition to software standby mode: After execution of the SLEEP instruction, a transition is made to software standby mode, and PC break exception handling is not executed. However, the CMFA or CMFB flag is set (figure 6.2 (B)). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 91 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) SLEEP instruction execution SLEEP instruction execution PC break exception handling Transition to respective mode (B) Execution of instruction after sleep instruction (A) Figure 6.2 Operation in Power-Down Mode Transitions 6.3.5 When Instruction Execution Is Delayed by One State While the break interrupt enable bit is set to 1, instruction execution is one state later than usual. • For 1-word branch instructions (Bcc d:8, BSR, JSR, JMP, TRAPA, RTE, and RTS) in on-chip ROM or RAM. • When break interrupt by instruction fetch is set, the set address indicates on-chip ROM or RAM space, and that address is used for data access, the instruction will be one state later than in normal operation. • When break interrupt by instruction fetch is set and a break interrupt is generated, if the executing instruction immediately preceding the set instruction has one of the addressing modes shown below, and that address indicates on-chip ROM or RAM, the instruction will be one state later than in normal operation. Addressing modes: @ERn, @(d:16,ERn), @(d:32,ERn), @-ERn/ERn+, @aa:8, @aa:24, @aa:32, @(d:8,PC), @(d:16,PC), @@aa:8 • When break interrupt by instruction fetch is set and a break interrupt is generated, if the executing instruction immediately preceding the set instruction is NOP or SLEEP, or has #xx,Rn as its addressing mode, and that instruction is located in on-chip ROM or RAM, the instruction will be one state later than in normal operation. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 92 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) 6.4 Usage Notes 6.4.1 Module Stop Mode Setting PBC operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for PBC operation to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 6.4.2 PC Break Interrupts The PC break interrupt is shared by channels A and B. The channel from which the request was issued must be determined by the interrupt handler. 6.4.3 CMFA and CMFB The CMFA and CMFB flags are not automatically cleared to 0, so 0 must be written to CMFA or CMFB after first reading the flag while it is set to 1. If the flag is left set to 1, another interrupt will be requested after interrupt handling ends. 6.4.4 PC Break Interrupt when DTC Is Bus Master A PC break interrupt generated when the DTC is the bus master is accepted after the bus mastership has been transferred to the CPU by the bus controller. 6.4.5 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Address Following BSR, JSR, JMP, TRAPA, RTE, or RTS Instruction Even if the instruction at the address following a BSR, JSR, JMP, TRAPA, RTE, or RTS instruction is fetched, it is not executed, and so a PC break interrupt is not generated by the instruction fetch at the next address. 6.4.6 I Bit Set by LDC, ANDC, ORC, or XORC Instruction When the I bit is set by an LDC, ANDC, ORC, or XORC instruction, a PC break interrupt becomes valid two states after the end of the instruction execution. If a PC break interrupt is set for the instruction following one of these instructions, since interrupts, including NMI, are disabled for a 3-state period in the case of LDC, ANDC, ORC, and XOR, the next instruction is always executed. For details, see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 93 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 6 PC Break Controller (PBC) 6.4.7 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Address Following Bcc Instruction A PC break interrupt is generated if the instruction at the next address is executed in accordance with the branch condition, and is not generated if the instruction at the next address is not executed. 6.4.8 PC Break Set for Instruction Fetch at Branch Destination Address of Bcc Instruction A PC break interrupt is generated if the instruction at the branch destination is executed in accordance with the branch condition, and is not generated if the instruction at the branch destination is not executed. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 94 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 7 Bus Controller Section 7 Bus Controller The H8S/2600 CPU is driven by a system clock, denoted by the symbol φ. The bus controller controls a memory cycle and a bus cycle. Different methods are used to access on-chip memory and on-chip peripheral modules. The bus controller also has a bus arbitration function, and controls the operation of the internal bus masters: the CPU and data transfer controller (DTC). 7.1 Basic Timing The period from one rising edge of φ to the next is referred to as a “state”. The memory cycle or bus cycle consists of one, two, three, or four states. Different methods are used to access on-chip memory and on-chip peripheral modules. 7.1.1 On-Chip Memory Access Timing (ROM, RAM) On-chip memory is accessed in one state. The data bus is 16 bits wide, permitting both byte and word transfer instruction. Figure 7.1 shows the on-chip memory access cycle. Bus cycle T1 φ Internal address bus Address Internal read signal Read Internal data bus Read data Internal write signal Write Internal data bus Write data Figure 7.1 On-Chip Memory Access Cycle Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 95 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 7 Bus Controller 7.1.2 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Timing The on-chip peripheral modules, except for the SSU and realtime input port data register, are accessed in two states. The data bus is either 8 bits or 16 bits wide, depending on the particular internal I/O register being accessed. For details, refer to section 21, List of Registers. Figure 7.2 shows access timing for the on-chip peripheral modules. Bus cycle T1 T2 φ Internal address bus Address Internal read signal Read Internal data bus Read data Internal write signal Write Internal data bus Write data Figure 7.2 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Cycle Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 96 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 7 Bus Controller 7.1.3 On-Chip SSU Module and Realtime Input Port Data Register Access Timing The on-chip SSU module or realtime input port data register is accessed in three states. At this time, a data bus width is 16 bits. Figure 7.3 shows the SSU module access timing. Bus cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Internal address bus Address SSU read signal Read Internal data bus Read data SSU write signal Write Internal data bus Write data Figure 7.3 On-Chip SSU Module Access Cycle Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 97 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 7 Bus Controller 7.2 Bus Arbitration The Bus Controller has a bus arbiter that arbitrates bus master operations. There are two bus masters, the CPU and DTC, which perform read/write operations when they control the bus. 7.2.1 Order of Priority of the Bus Masters Each bus master requests the bus mastership by means of a bus request signal. The bus arbiter detects the bus masters’ bus request signals, and if the bus mastership is requested, sends a bus request acknowledge signal to the bus master making the request. If there are bus requests from more than one bus master, the bus request acknowledge signal is sent to the one with the highest priority. When a bus master receives the bus request acknowledge signal, it takes possession of the bus until that signal is cancelled. The order of priority of the bus mastership is as follows: (High) 7.2.2 DTC > CPU (Low) Bus Transfer Timing Even if a bus request is received from a bus master with a higher priority than that of the bus master that has acquired the bus mastership and is currently operating, the bus mastership is not necessarily transferred immediately. The CPU is the lowest-priority bus master, and if a bus request is received from the DTC, the bus arbiter transfers the bus mastership to the bus master that issued the request. The timing for transfer of the bus mastership is as follows: • The bus mastership is transferred at a break between bus cycles. However, if a bus cycle is executed in discrete operations, as in the case of a longword-size access, the bus mastership is not transferred between such operations. For details, refer to section 2.7, Bus Status in Instruction Execution in the H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual. • If the CPU is in sleep mode, it transfers the bus mastership immediately. The DTC can release the bus mastership after a vector read, a register information read (3 states), a single data transfer, or a register information write (3 states). It does not release the bus mastership during a register information read (3 states), a single data transfer, or a register information write (3 states). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 98 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) This LSI includes a data transfer controller (DTC). The DTC can be activated by an interrupt or software, to transfer data. Figure 8.1 shows a block diagram of the DTC. The DTC’s register information is stored in the on-chip RAM. When the DTC is used, the RAME bit in SYSCR must be set to 1. A 32-bit bus connects the DTC to the on-chip RAM (1 kbyte), enabling 32-bit/1-state reading and writing of the DTC register information. 8.1 Features • Transfer is possible over any number of channels • Three transfer modes Normal, repeat, and block transfer modes are available • One activation source can trigger a number of data transfers (chain transfer) • The direct specification of 16-Mbyte address space is possible • Activation by software is possible • Transfer can be set in byte or word units • A CPU interrupt can be requested for the interrupt that activated the DTC • Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 99 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Internal address bus CPU interrupt request [Legend] MRA, MRB: CRA, CRB: SAR: DAR: DTCERA to DTCERG: DTVECR: Internal data bus DTC mode registers A and B DTC transfer count registers A and B DTC source address register DTC destination address register DTC enable registers A to G DTC vector register Figure 8.1 Block Diagram of DTC Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 100 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Register information MRA MRB CRA CRB DAR SAR Control logic DTC service request DTCERA to DTCERG Interrupt request On-chip RAM DTC DTVECR Interrupt controller Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.2 Register Descriptions The DTC has the following registers. • • • • • • DTC mode register A (MRA) DTC mode register B (MRB) DTC source address register (SAR) DTC destination address register (DAR) DTC transfer count register A (CRA) DTC transfer count register B (CRB) These six registers cannot be directly accessed from the CPU. When activated, the DTC reads a set of register information that is stored in on-chip RAM to the corresponding DTC registers and transfers data. After the data transfer, it writes a set of updated register information back to the RAM. • DTC enable registers (DTCER) • DTC vector register (DTVECR) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 101 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.2.1 DTC Mode Register A (MRA) MRA is an 8-bit register that selects the DTC operating mode. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 6 SM1 SM0 Undefined Undefined Source Address Mode 1 and 0 These bits specify an SAR operation after a data transfer. 0×: SAR is fixed 10: SAR is incremented after a transfer (by +1 when Sz = 0; by +2 when Sz = 1) 11: SAR is decremented after a transfer (by –1 when Sz = 0; by –2 when Sz = 1) 5 4 DM1 DM0 Undefined Undefined Destination Address Mode 1 and 0 These bits specify a DAR operation after a data transfer. 0×: DAR is fixed 10: DAR is incremented after a transfer (by +1 when Sz = 0; by +2 when Sz = 1) 11: DAR is decremented after a transfer (by –1 when Sz = 0; by –2 when Sz = 1) 3 2 MD1 MD0 Undefined Undefined DTC Mode These bits specify the DTC transfer mode. 00: Normal mode 01: Repeat mode 10: Block transfer mode 11: Setting prohibited 1 DTS Undefined DTC Transfer Mode Select Specifies whether the source side or the destination side is set to be a repeat area or block area, in repeat mode or block transfer mode. 0: Destination side is repeat area or block area 1: Source side is repeat area or block area 0 Sz Undefined DTC Data Transfer Size Specifies the size of data to be transferred. 0: Byte-size transfer 1: Word-size transfer [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 102 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.2.2 DTC Mode Register B (MRB) MRB is an 8-bit register that selects the DTC operating mode. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 CHNE Undefined DTC Chain Transfer Enable When this bit is set to 1, a chain transfer will be performed. For details, refer to section 8.5.4, Chain Transfer. In data transfer with CHNE set to 1, determination of the end of the specified number of transfers, clearing of the interrupt source flag, and clearing of DTCER, are not performed. 6 DISEL Undefined DTC Interrupt Select When this bit is set to 1, a CPU interrupt request is generated every time after the end of a data transfer. When this bit is set to 0, a CPU interrupt request is generated at the time when the specified number of data transfer ends. 5 to 0 Undefined Reserved These bits have no effect on DTC operation. Only 0 should be written to these bits. 8.2.3 DTC Source Address Register (SAR) SAR is a 24-bit register that designates the source address of data to be transferred by the DTC. For word-size transfer, specify an even source address. 8.2.4 DTC Destination Address Register (DAR) DAR is a 24-bit register that designates the destination address of data to be transferred by the DTC. For word-size transfer, specify an even destination address. 8.2.5 DTC Transfer Count Register A (CRA) CRA is a 16-bit register that designates the number of times data is to be transferred by the DTC. In normal mode, the entire CRA functions as a 16-bit transfer counter (1 to 65,536). It is decremented by 1 every time data is transferred, and transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 103 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) In repeat mode or block transfer mode, the CRA is divided into two parts; the upper 8 bits (CRAH) and the lower 8 bits (CRAL). CRAH holds the number of transfers while CRAL functions as an 8-bit transfer counter (1 to 256). CRAL is decremented by 1 every time data is transferred, and the contents of CRAH are sent when the count reaches H'00. 8.2.6 DTC Transfer Count Register B (CRB) CRB is a 16-bit register that designates the number of times data is to be transferred by the DTC in block transfer mode. It functions as a 16-bit transfer counter (1 to 65,536) that is decremented by 1 every time data is transferred, and transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. 8.2.7 DTC Enable Registers (DTCER) DTCER is comprised of seven registers; DTCERA to DTCERG, and is a register that specifies DTC activation interrupt sources. The correspondence between interrupt sources and DTCE bits is shown in table 8.1. For DTCE bit setting, use bit manipulation instructions such as BSET and BCLR for reading and writing. If all interrupts are masked, multiple activation sources can be set at one time (only at the initial setting) by writing data after executing a dummy read on the relevant register. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTCE7 DTCE6 DTCE5 DTCE4 DTCE3 DTCE2 DTCE1 DTCE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W DTC Activation Enable Setting these bits to 1 specifies a relevant interrupt source as a DTC activation source. [Clearing conditions] • When the DISEL bit in MRB is 1 and the data transfer has ended • When the specified number of transfers have ended These bits are not cleared when the DISEL bit is 0 and the specified number of transfers have not been completed. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 104 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.2.8 DTC Vector Register (DTVECR) DTVECR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables DTC activation by software, and sets a vector number for the software activation interrupt. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 SWDTE 0 R/W DTC Software Activation Enable Setting this bit to 1 activates DTC. Only 1 can be written to this bit. [Clearing conditions] • When the DISEL bit is 0 and the specified number of transfers have not ended • When 0 is written to the DISEL bit after a software-activated data transfer end interrupt (SWDTEND) request has been sent to the CPU. When the DISEL bit is 1 and data transfer has ended or when the specified number of transfers have ended, this bit will not be cleared. 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTVEC6 DTVEC5 DTVEC4 DTVEC3 DTVEC2 DTVEC1 DTVEC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W DTC Software Activation Vectors 6 to 0 These bits specify a vector number for DTC software activation. The vector address is expressed as H'0400 + (vector number × 2). For example, when DTVEC6 to DTVEC0 = H'10, the vector address is H'0420. When the bit SWDTE is 0, these bits can be written. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 105 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.3 Activation Sources The DTC operates when activated by an interrupt or by a write to DTVECR by software. An interrupt request can be directed to the CPU or DTC, as designated by the corresponding DTCER bit. At the end of a data transfer (or the last consecutive transfer in the case of chain transfer), the activation source or corresponding DTCER bit is cleared. The activation source flag, in the case of RXI_0, for example, is the RDRF flag of SCI_0. When an interrupt has been designated a DTC activation source, the existing CPU mask level and interrupt controller priorities have no effect. If there is more than one activation source at the same time, the DTC operates in accordance with the default priorities. Figure 8.2 shows a block diagram of DTC activation source control. For details, see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Source flag cleared Clear controller Clear DTCER On-chip supporting module IRQ interrupt Interrupt request Selection circuit Select DTVECR Clear request DTC CPU Interrupt controller Interrupt mask Figure 8.2 Block Diagram of DTC Activation Source Control Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 106 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.4 Location of Register Information and DTC Vector Table Locate the register information in the on-chip RAM (addresses: H'FFEBC0 to H'FFEFBF). Register information should be located at an address that is a multiple of four within the range. Locating the register information in address space is shown in figure 8.3. Locate the MRA, SAR, MRB, DAR, CRA, and CRB registers, in that order, from the start address of the register information. In the case of chain transfer, register information should be located in consecutive areas and the register information start address should be located at the vector address corresponding to the interrupt source as shown in figure 8.3. The DTC reads the start address of the register information from the vector address set for each activation source, and then reads the register information from that start address. When the DTC is activated by software, the vector address is obtained from: H'0400 + (DTVECR[6:0] × 2). For example, if DTVECR is H'10, the vector address is H'0420. The configuration of the vector address is the same in both normal and advanced modes, a 2-byte unit being used in both cases. These two bytes specify the lower bits of the register information start address. Lower address 0 Register information start address Chain transfer 1 2 MRA SAR MRB DAR 3 Register information CRB CRA MRA SAR MRB DAR Register information for 2nd transfer in chain transfer CRB CRA 4 bytes Figure 8.3 Location of DTC Register Information in Address Space Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 107 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Table 8.1 Interrupt Sources, DTC Vector Addresses, and Corresponding DTCEs Interrupt Source Origin of Interrupt Source Vector Number Software Write to DTVECR DTVECR External pin IRQ0 DTC Vector Address DTCE* Priority H'0400 + (vector number × 2) High 16 H'0420 DTCEA7 IRQ1 17 H'0422 DTCEA6 IRQ2 18 H'0424 DTCEA5 IRQ3 19 H'0426 DTCEA4 IRQ4 20 H'0428 DTCEA3 IRQ5 21 H'042A DTCEA2 Reserved for system use 22 H'042C DTCEA1 23 H'042E DTCEA0 A/D counter ADI (A/D conversion 28 end) H'0438 DTCEB6 TPU channel 0 TGIA_0 32 H'0440 DTCEB5 TGIB_0 33 H'0442 DTCEB4 TGIC_0 34 H'0444 DTCEB3 TGID_0 35 H'0446 DTCEB2 TPU channel 1 TGIA_1 40 H'0450 DTCEB1 TGIB_1 41 H'0452 DTCEB0 TPU channel 2 TGIA_2 44 H'0458 DTCEC7 TGIB_2 45 H'045A DTCEC6 TPU channel 3 TGIA_3 48 H'0460 DTCEC5 TGIB_3 49 H'0462 DTCEC4 TGIC_3 50 H'0464 DTCEC3 TGID_3 51 H'0466 DTCEC2 TPU channel 4 TGIA_4 56 H'0470 DTCEC1 TGIB_4 57 H'0472 DTCEC0 TPU channel 5 TGIA_5 60 H'0478 DTCED5 TGIB_5 61 H'047A DTCED4 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 108 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Low Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Interrupt Source Origin of Interrupt Source Vector Number DTC Vector Address DTCE* Priority 8-bit timer channel 0 CMIA_1 64 H'0480 DTCED3 High 65 H'0482 DTCED2 8-bit timer channel 1 CMIB_1 68 H'0488 DTCED1 69 H'048A DTCED0 Reserved for system use 72 H'0490 DTCEE7 73 H'0492 DTCEE6 74 H'0494 DTCEE5 75 H'0496 DTCEE4 SCI channel 0 RXI_0 81 H'04A2 DTCEE3 TXI_0 82 H'04A4 DTCEE2 SCI channel 1 RXI_1 85 H′04A8 DTCEE1 TXI_1 86 H′04AA DTCEE0 SCI channel 2 RXI_2 89 H'04B2 DTCEF7 TXI_2 90 H'04B4 DTCEF6 8-bit timer channel 2 CMIA_2 92 H'04B8 DTCEF5 CMIB_2 93 H'04BA DTCEF4 8-bit timer channel 3 CMIA_3 96 H'04C0 DTCEF3 CMIB3 97 H'04C2 DTCEF2 Reserved for system use 104 H'04D0 DTCEG7 105 H'04D2 DTCEG6 106 H'04D4 DTCEG5 107 H'04D6 DTCEG4 SSRx_i0 109 H'04DA DTCEG2 SSTx_i0 110 H'04DC DTCEG1 SSU channel 0 Note: * Low DTCE bits with no corresponding interrupt are reserved, and the write value should always be 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 109 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5 Operation Register information is stored in on-chip RAM. When activated, the DTC reads register information in on-chip RAM and transfers data. After the data transfer, the DTC writes updated register information back to the on-chip RAM. The pre-storage of register information in the on-chip RAM makes it possible to transfer data over any required number of channels. The transfer mode can be specified as normal, repeat, and block transfer mode. Setting the CHNE bit in MRB to 1 makes it possible to perform a number of transfers with a single activation source (chain transfer). The 24-bit SAR designates the DTC transfer source address, and the 24-bit DAR designates the transfer destination address. After each transfer, SAR and DAR are independently incremented, decremented, or left fixed depending on its register information. Start Read DTC vector Next transfer Read register information Data transfer Write register information CHNE=1 Yes No Transfer Counter=0 or DISEL=1 Yes No Clear an activation flag Clear DTCER End Interrupt exception handling Figure 8.4 Flowchart of DTC Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 110 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5.1 Normal Mode In normal mode, one operation transfers one byte or one word of data. Table 8.2 lists the register information in normal mode. From 1 to 65,536 transfers can be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have been completed, a CPU interrupt can be requested. Table 8.2 Register Information in Normal Mode Name Abbreviation Function DTC source address register SAR Designates source address DTC destination address register DAR Designates destination address DTC transfer count register A CRA Designates transfer count DTC transfer count register B CRB Not used SAR DAR Transfer Figure 8.5 Memory Mapping in Normal Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 111 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5.2 Repeat Mode In repeat mode, one operation transfers one byte or one word of data. Table 8.3 lists the register information in repeat mode. From 1 to 256 transfers can be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have ended, the initial state of the transfer counter and the address register specified as the repeat area is restored, and transfer is repeated. In repeat mode the transfer counter value does not reach H'00, and therefore CPU interrupts cannot be requested when DISEL = 0. Table 8.3 Register Information in Repeat Mode Name Abbreviation Function DTC source address register SAR Designates source address DTC destination address register DAR Designates destination address DTC transfer count register AH CRAH Holds number of transfers DTC transfer count register AL CRAL Designates transfer count DTC transfer count register B CRB Not used SAR or DAR Repeat area Transfer Figure 8.6 Memory Mapping in Repeat Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 112 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 DAR or SAR Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5.3 Block Transfer Mode In block transfer mode, one operation transfers one block of data. Either the transfer source or the transfer destination is designated as a block area. Table 8.4 lists the register information in block transfer mode. The block size can be between 1 and 256. When the transfer of one block ends, the initial state of the block size counter and the address register specified as the block area is restored. The other address register is then incremented, decremented, or left fixed. From 1 to 65,536 transfers can be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have been completed, a CPU interrupt is requested. Table 8.4 Register Information in Block Transfer Mode Name Abbreviation Function DTC source address register SAR Designates source address DTC destination address register DAR Designates destination address DTC transfer count register AH CRAH Holds block size DTC transfer count register AL CRAL Designates block size count DTC transfer count register B CRB Transfer count Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 113 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) First block SAR or DAR . . . Block area Transfer Nth block Figure 8.7 Memory Mapping in Block Transfer Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 114 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 DAR or SAR Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5.4 Chain Transfer Setting the CHNE bit in MRB to 1 enables a number of data transfers to be performed consecutively in response to a single transfer request. SAR, DAR, CRA, CRB, MRA, and MRB, which define data transfers, can be set independently. Figure 8.8 shows the outline of the chain transfer operation. When activated, the DTC reads the register information start address stored at the vector address corresponding to the activation source, and then reads the first register information at that start address. After data transfer ends, the CHNE bit will be tested. When it has been set to 1, DTC reads the next register information located in a consecutive area and performs the data transfer. These sequences are repeated until the CHNE bit is cleared to 0. In the case of transfer with CHNE set to 1, an interrupt request to the CPU is not generated at the end of the specified number of transfers or by setting of the DISEL bit to 1, and the interrupt source flag for the activation source is not affected. Source Destination Register information CHNE=1 DTC vector address Register information start address Register information CHNE=0 Source Destination Figure 8.8 Chain Transfer Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 115 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.5.5 Interrupts An interrupt request is issued to the CPU when the DTC has completed the specified number of data transfers, or a data transfer for which the DISEL bit was set to 1. In the case of interrupt activation, the interrupt set as the activation source is generated. These interrupts to the CPU are subject to CPU mask level and interrupt controller priority level control. In the case of software activation, a software-activated data transfer end interrupt (SWDTEND) is generated. When the DISEL bit is 1 and one data transfer has been completed, or the specified number of transfers have been completed, after data transfer ends the SWDTE bit is held at 1 and an SWDTEND interrupt is generated. The interrupt handling routine will then clear the SWDTE bit to 0. When the DTC is activated by software, an SWDTEND interrupt is not generated during a data transfer wait or during data transfer even if the SWDTE bit is set to 1. 8.5.6 Operation Timing φ DTC activation request DTC request Vector read Data transfer Address Read Write Transfer information read Transfer information write Figure 8.9 DTC Operation Timing (Example in Normal Mode or Repeat Mode) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 116 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) φ DTC activation request DTC request Data transfer Vector read Read Write Read Write Address Transfer information read Transfer information write Figure 8.10 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Block Transfer Mode, with Block Size of 2) φ DTC activation request DTC request Data transfer Data transfer Read Write Read Write Vector read Address Transfer information read Transfer information write Transfer information read Transfer information write Figure 8.11 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Chain Transfer) 8.5.7 Number of DTC Execution States Table 8.5 lists execution status for a single DTC data transfer, and table 8.6 shows the number of states required for each execution status. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 117 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Table 8.5 DTC Execution Status Mode Vector Read I Register Information Read/Write Data Read J K Data Write L Internal Operations M Normal 1 6 1 1 3 Repeat 1 6 1 1 3 Block transfer 1 6 N N 3 [Legend] N: Block size (initial setting of CRAH and CRAL) Table 8.6 Number of States Required for Each Execution Status OnChip RAM OnChip ROM Bus width 32 16 8 16 Access states 1 1 2 2 Object to be Accessed Execution status Note: * On-Chip I/O Registers External Devices* 8 16 2 3 2 3 SI 1 4 6+2m 2 3+m Register information read/write SJ 1 Byte data read SK 1 1 2 2 2 3+m 2 3+m Word data read SK 1 1 4 2 4 6+2m 2 3+m Byte data write SL 1 1 2 2 2 3+m 2 3+m Word data write SL 1 1 4 2 4 6+2m 2 3+m Internal operation SM Vector read 1 Not available in this LSI. The number of execution states is calculated from using the formula below. Note that Σ is the sum of all transfers activated by one activation source (the number in which the CHNE bit is set to 1, plus 1). Number of execution states = I · (1 + SI) + Σ (J · SJ + K · SK + L · SL) + M · SM For example, when the DTC vector address table is located in the on-chip ROM, normal mode is set, and data is transferred from on-chip ROM to an internal I/O register, then the time required for the DTC operation is 13 states. The time from activation to the end of the data write is 10 states. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 118 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.6 Procedures for Using DTC 8.6.1 Activation by Interrupt The procedure for using the DTC with interrupt activation is as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. Set the MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB register information in on-chip RAM. Set the start address of the register information in the DTC vector address. Set the corresponding bit in DTCER to 1. Set the enable bits for the interrupt sources to be used as the activation sources to 1. The DTC is activated when an interrupt used as an activation source is generated. 5. After one data transfer has been completed, or after the specified number of data transfers have been completed, the DTCE bit is cleared to 0 and a CPU interrupt is requested. If the DTC is to continue transferring data, set the DTCE bit to 1. 8.6.2 Activation by Software The procedure for using the DTC with software activation is as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Set the MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB register information in on-chip RAM. Set the start address of the register information in the DTC vector address. Check that the SWDTE bit is 0. Write 1 to SWDTE bit and the vector number to DTVECR. Check the vector number written to DTVECR. After one data transfer has been completed, if the DISEL bit is 0 and a CPU interrupt is not requested, the SWDTE bit is cleared to 0. If the DTC is to continue transferring data, set the SWDTE bit to 1. When the DISEL bit is 1, or after the specified number of data transfers have been completed, the SWDTE bit is held at 1 and a CPU interrupt is requested. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 119 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.7 Examples of Use of the DTC 8.7.1 Normal Mode An example is shown in which the DTC is used to receive 128 bytes of data via the SCI. 1. Set MRA to a fixed source address (SM1 = SM0 = 0), incrementing destination address (DM1 = 1, DM0 = 0), normal mode (MD1 = MD0 = 0), and byte size (Sz = 0). The DTS bit can have any value. Set MRB for one data transfer by one interrupt (CHNE = 0, DISEL = 0). Set the SCI RDR address in SAR, the start address of the RAM area where data will be received in DAR, and 128 (H'0080) in CRA. CRB can be set to any value. 2. Set the start address of the register information at the DTC vector address. 3. Set the corresponding bit in DTCER to 1. 4. Set the SCI to the appropriate receive mode. Set the RIE bit in SCR to 1 to enable the reception complete (RXI) interrupt. Since the generation of a receive error during the SCI reception operation will disable subsequent reception, the CPU should be enabled to accept receive error interrupts. 5. Each time the reception of one byte of data has been completed on the SCI, the RDRF flag in SSR is set to 1, an RXI interrupt is generated, and the DTC is activated. The receive data is transferred from RDR to RAM by the DTC. DAR is incremented and CRA is decremented. The RDRF flag is automatically cleared to 0. 6. When CRA becomes 0 after the 128 data transfers have been completed, the RDRF flag is held at 1, the DTCE bit is cleared to 0, and an RXI interrupt request is sent to the CPU. The interrupt handling routine will perform wrap-up processing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 120 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.7.2 Chain Transfer An example of DTC chain transfer is shown in which pulse output is performed using the PPG. Chain transfer can be used to perform pulse output data transfer and PPG output trigger cycle updating. Repeat mode transfer to the PPG’s NDR is performed in the first half of the chain transfer, and normal mode transfer to the TPU’s TGR in the second half. This is because clearing of the activation source and interrupt generation at the end of the specified number of transfers are restricted to the second half of the chain transfer (transfer when CHNE = 0). 1. Perform settings for transfer to the PPG’s NDR. Set MRA to incrementing source address (SM1 = 1, SM0 = 0), a fixed destination address (DM1 = DM0 = 0), repeat mode (MD1 = 0, MD0 = 1), and word size (Sz = 1). Set the source side as a repeat area (DTS = 1). Set MRB to chain mode (CHNE = 1, DISEL = 0). Set the data table start address in SAR, the NDRH address in DAR, and the data table size in CRAH and CRAL. CRB can be set to any value. 2. Perform settings for transfer to the TPU’s TGR. Set MRA to incrementing source address (SM1 = 1, SM0 = 0), a fixed destination address (DM1 = DM0 = 0), normal mode (MD1 = MD0 = 0), and word size (Sz = 1). Set the data table start address in SAR, the TGRA address in DAR, and the data table size in CRA. CRB can be set to any value. 3. Locate the TPU transfer register information consecutively after the NDR transfer register information. 4. Set the start address of the NDR transfer register information to the DTC vector address. 5. Set the bit corresponding to TGIA in DTCER to 1. 6. Set TGRA as an output compare register (output disabled) with TIOR, and enable the TGIA interrupt with TIER. 7. Set the initial output value in PODR, and the next output value in NDR. Set bits in DDR and NDER for which output is to be performed to 1. Using PCR, select the TPU compare match to be used as the output trigger. 8. Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1, and start the TCNT count operation. 9. Each time a TGRA compare match occurs, the next output value is transferred to NDR and the set value of the next output trigger period is transferred to TGRA. The activation source TGFA flag is cleared. 10. When the specified number of transfers are completed (the TPU transfer CRA value is 0), the TGFA flag is held at 1, the DTCE bit is cleared to 0, and a TGIA interrupt request is sent to the CPU. Termination processing should be performed in the interrupt handling routine. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 121 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.7.3 Software Activation An example is shown in which the DTC is used to transfer a block of 128 bytes of data by means of software activation. The transfer source address is H'1000 and the destination address is H'2000. The vector number is H'60, so the vector address is H'04C0. 1. Set MRA to incrementing source address (SM1 = 1, SM0 = 0), incrementing destination address (DM1 = 1, DM0 = 0), block transfer mode (MD1 = 1, MD0 = 0), and byte size (Sz = 0). The DTS bit can have any value. Set MRB for one block transfer by one interrupt (CHNE = 0). Set the transfer source address (H'1000) in SAR, the destination address (H'2000) in DAR, and 128 (H'8080) in CRA. Set 1 (H'0001) in CRB. 2. Set the start address of the register information at the DTC vector address (H'04C0). 3. Check that the SWDTE bit in DTVECR is 0. Check that there is currently no transfer activated by software. 4. Write 1 to the SWDTE bit and the vector number (H'60) to DTVECR. The write data is H'E0. 5. Read DTVECR again and check that it is set to the vector number (H'60). If it is not, this indicates that the write failed. This is presumably because an interrupt occurred between steps 3 and 4 and led to a different software activation. To activate this transfer, go back to step 3. 6. If the write was successful, the DTC is activated and a block of 128 bytes of data is transferred. 7. After the transfer, an SWDTEND interrupt occurs. The interrupt handling routine should clear the SWDTE bit to 0 and perform other wrap-up processing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 122 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) 8.8 Usage Notes 8.8.1 Module Stop Mode Setting DTC operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for DTC operation to be enabled. Register access is disabled by setting module stop mode. Note that module stop mode cannot be set during DTC being activated. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 8.8.2 On-Chip RAM The MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB registers are all located in on-chip RAM. When the DTC is used, the RAME bit in SYSCR must not be cleared to 0. 8.8.3 DTCE Bit Setting For DTCE bit setting, use bit manipulation instructions such as BSET and BCLR. If all interrupts are masked, multiple activation sources can be set at one time (only at the initial setting) by writing data after executing a dummy read on the relevant register. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 123 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 124 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.1 summarizes the port functions. The pins of each port also have other functions such as input/output or interrupt input pins of on-chip peripheral modules. Each I/O port includes a data direction register (DDR) that controls input/output, a data register (DR) that stores output data, and a port register (PORT) used to read the pin states. The input-only ports do not have a DR or DDR register. Ports A to D have built-in input pull-up MOS functions and input pull-up MOS control registers (PCR) to control the on/off state of input pull-up MOS. Ports A to C include an open-drain control register (ODR) that controls the on/off state of the output buffer PMOS. All the I/O ports can drive a single TTL load and a 30 pF capacitive load. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 125 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.1 Port Functions Port Description Port 1 General I/O port also functioning as TPU_2, TPU_1, and TPU_0 I/O pins, PPG output pins, and interrupt input pins Port and Other Functions Name P17/PO15/TIOCB2/TCLKD P16/PO14/TIOCA2/IRQ1 P15/PO13/TIOCB1/TCLKC P14/PO12/TIOCA1/IRQ0 P13/PO11/TIOCD0/TCLKB P12/PO10/TIOCC0/TCLKA P11/PO9/TIOCB0 P10/PO8/TIOCA0 Port 3 General I/O port also functioning as SCI_0 and SCI_1, I/O pins and interrupt input pins P37 P36 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P34/RxD1 P33/TxD1 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P31/RxD0 P30/TxD0 Port 4 General input port also functioning as A/D converter analog inputs P47/AN7 P46/AN6 P45/AN5 P44/AN4 P43/AN3 P42/AN2 P41/AN1 P40/AN0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 126 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Input/Output and Output Type Section 9 I/O Ports Port Description Port 7 General I/O port also functioning as TMR_0, TMR_1, TMR_2, and TMR_3 I/O pins Port and Other Functions Name Input/Output and Output Type P77 P76 P75/TMO3 P74/TMO2 P73/TMO1 P72/TMO0 P71/TMCI23/TMRI23 P70/TMCI01/TMRI01 Port 9 General input port also functioning as A/D converter analog inputs P97/AN15 P96/AN14 P95/AN13 P94/AN12 P93/AN11 P92/AN10 P91/AN9 P90/AN8 Port A General I/O port also functioning as SCI_2 I/O pins PA3/SCK2 Built-in input pull-up MOS PA2/RxD2 Push-pull or open-drain output selectable PA1/TxD2 PA0 Port B General I/O port also functioning as TPU_5, TPU_4, and TPU_3 I/O pins PB7/TIOCB5 Built-in input pull-up MOS PB6/TIOCA5 Push-pull or open-drain output selectable PB5/TIOCB4 PB4/TIOCA4 PB3/TIOCD3 PB2/TIOCC3 PB1/TIOCB3 PB0/TIOCA3 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 127 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Port Description Port C General I/O port also functioning as SSU_0 and SSU_1 I/O pins Port and Other Functions Name Input/Output and Output Type PC7/SCS1 Built-in input pull-up MOS PC6/SSCK1 Push-pull or open-drain output selectable PC5/SSI1 PC4/SSO1 PC3/SCS0 PC2/SSCK0 PC1/SSI0 PC0/SSO0 Port D General I/O port PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 Port F General I/O port also functioning as interrupt input pins, an A/D converter start trigger input pin, and a system clock output pin (φ) PF7/φ PF6 PF5 PF4 PF3/ADTRG/IRQ3 PF2 PF1 PF0/IRQ2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 128 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Built-in input pull-up MOS Section 9 I/O Ports 9.1 Port 1 Port 1 is an 8-bit I/O port and has the following registers. • Port 1 data direction register (P1DDR) • Port 1 data register (P1DR) • Port 1 register (PORT1) 9.1.1 Port 1 Data Direction Register (P1DDR) P1DDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify input or output for the pins of port 1. P1DDR cannot be read; if it is, an undefined value will be read. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P17DDR 0 W 6 P16DDR 0 W 5 P15DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 1 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 P14DDR 0 W 3 P13DDR 0 W 2 P12DDR 0 W 1 P11DDR 0 W 0 P10DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 129 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.1.2 Port 1 Data Register (P1DR) P1DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for port 1 pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P17DR 0 R/W 6 P16DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. 5 P15DR 0 R/W 4 P14DR 0 R/W 3 P13DR 0 R/W 2 P12DR 0 R/W 1 P11DR 0 R/W 0 P10DR 0 R/W 9.1.3 Port 1 Register (PORT1) PORT1 is an 8-bit read-only register that shows the pin states. PORT1 cannot be modified. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P17 R 6 P16 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port 1 read is performed while P1DDR bits are set to 1, the P1DR values are read. If a port 1 read is performed while P1DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 P15 4 P14 3 P13 2 P12 1 P11 0 P10 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins P17 to P10. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 130 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.1.4 Pin Functions Port 1 pins also function as TPU I/O pins, PPG output pins, and interrupt input pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.2 P17 Pin Function TPU channel 2 setting* P17DDR NDER15 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCB2 output P17 input P17 output PO15 output TIOCB2 input TCLKD input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.3 P16 Pin Function TPU channel 2 setting* P16DDR NDER14 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 TIOCA2 output P16 input P16 output PO14 output 0 1 1 TIOCA2 input IRQ1 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 131 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.4 P15 Pin Function TPU channel 1 setting* P15DDR NDER13 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCB1 output P15 input P15 output PO13 output TIOCB1 input TCLKC input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.5 P14 Pin Function TPU channel 1 setting* P14DDR NDER12 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCA1 output P14 input P14 output PO12 output TIOCA1 input IRQ0 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.6 P13 Pin Function TPU channel 0 setting* P13DDR NDER11 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCD0 output P13 input P13 output PO11 output TIOCD0 input TCLKB input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 132 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.7 P12 Pin Function TPU channel 0 setting* P12DDR NDER10 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCC0 output P12 input P12 output PO10 output TIOCC0 input TCLKA input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.8 P11 Pin Function TPU channel 0 setting* P11DDR NDER9 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 1 0 1 TIOCB0 output P11 input P11 output PO9 output TIOCB0 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.9 P10 Pin Function TPU channel 0 setting* P10DDR NDER8 Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 TIOCA0 output P10 input P10 output PO8 output 0 1 1 TIOCA0 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 133 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.2 Port 3 Port 3 is an 8-bit I/O port and has the following registers. • • • • Port 3 data direction register (P3DDR) Port 3 data register (P3DR) Port 3 register (PORT3) Port 3 open-drain control register (P3ODR) 9.2.1 Port 3 Data Direction Register (P3DDR) P3DDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify input or output for the pins of port 3. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P37DDR 0 W 6 P36DDR 0 W 5 P35DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 3 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 P34DDR 0 W 3 P33DDR 0 W 2 P32DDR 0 W 1 P31DDR 0 W 0 P30DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 134 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.2.2 Port 3 Data Register (P3DR) P3DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for port 3 pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P37DR 0 R/W 6 P36DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general I/O port. 5 P35DR 0 R/W 4 P34DR 0 R/W 3 P33DR 0 R/W 2 P32DR 0 R/W 1 P31DR 0 R/W 0 P30DR 0 R/W 9.2.3 Port 3 Register (PORT3) PORT3 is an 8-bit read-only register that shows the pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P37 R 6 P36 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port 3 read is performed while P3DDR bits are set to 1, the P3DR values are read. If a port 3 read is performed while P3DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 P35 4 P34 3 P33 2 P32 1 P31 0 P30 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins P37 to P30. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 135 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.2.4 Port 3 Open-Drain Control Register (P3ODR) P3ODR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies the output type of port 3. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P37ODR 0 R/W 6 P36ODR 0 R/W 5 P35ODR 0 R/W 4 P34ODR 0 R/W When a pin is specified as an output port, setting the corresponding bits to 1 specifies pin output to opendrain and the input pull-up MOS to the off state. Clearing these bits to 0 specifies that to push-pull output. 3 P33ODR 0 R/W 2 P32ODR 0 R/W 1 P31ODR 0 R/W 0 P30ODR 0 R/W 9.2.5 Pin Functions Port 3 pins also function as SCI_0 I/O pins and interrupt input pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.10 P37 Pin Function P37DDR Pin function 0 1 P37 input P37 output Table 9.11 P36 Pin Function P36DDR Pin function 0 1 P36 input P36 output Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 136 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.12 P35 Pin Function CKE1 in SCR_1 0 C/A in SMR_1 0 Pin function SCK1 input 1 0 1 P35 input P35 output SCK1 output SCK1 output CKE0 in SCR_1 P35DDR 1 0 1 IRQ5 input* Note: * When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use it for another function. Table 9.13 P34 Pin Function RE in SCR_1 0 0 1 P34 input P34 output RxD1 input P34DDR Pin function 1 Table 9.14 P33 Pin Function TE in SCR_1 0 0 1 P33 input P33 output TxD1 output P33DDR Pin function 1 Table 9.15 P32 Pin Function CKE1 in SCR_0 0 0 1 P32 input P32 output SCK0 output SCK0 output SCK0 input C/A in SMR_0 0 CKE0 in SCR_0 P32DDR Pin function 1 0 1 1 IRQ4 input* Note: * When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use it for another function. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 137 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.16 P31 Pin Function RE in SCR_0 0 0 1 P31 input P31 output RxD0 output P31DDR Pin function 1 Table 9.17 P30 Pin Function TE in SCR_0 0 0 1 P30 input P30 output TxD0 output P30DDR Pin function 9.3 1 Port 4 Port 4 is an input-only port. Port 4 pins also function as A/D converter analog input pins. Port 4 has the following register. • Port 4 register (PORT4) 9.3.1 Port 4 Register (PORT4) PORT4 is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port 4 pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P47 R 6 P46 Undefined* Undefined* The pin states are always read when a port 4 read is performed. 5 P45 R 4 P44 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 3 P43 2 P42 1 P41 0 P40 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins P47 to P40. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 138 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.4 Port 7 Port 7 is an 8-bit I/O port and has the following registers. • Port 7 data direction register (P7DDR) • Port 7 data register (P7DR) • Port 7 register (PORT7) 9.4.1 Port 7 Data Direction Register (P7DDR) P7DDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify input or output for the pins of port 7. P7DDR cannot be read, if it is, an undefined value will be read. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P77DDR 0 W 6 P76DDR 0 W 5 P75DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 7 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 P74DDR 0 W 3 P73DDR 0 W 2 P72DDR 0 W 1 P71DDR 0 W 0 P70DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 139 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.4.2 Port 7 Data Register (P7DR) P7DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for port 7 pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P77DR 0 R/W 6 P76DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. 5 P75DR 0 R/W 4 P74DR 0 R/W 3 P73DR 0 R/W 2 P72DR 0 R/W 1 P71DR 0 R/W 0 P70DR 0 R/W 9.4.3 Port 7 Register (PORT7) PORT7 is an 8-bit read-only register that shows the pin states. PORT7 cannot be modified. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P77 R 6 P76 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port 7 read is performed while P7DDR bits are set to 1, the P7DR values are read. If a port 7 read is performed while P7DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 P75 4 P74 3 P73 2 P72 1 P71 0 P70 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins P77 to P70. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 140 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.4.4 Pin Functions Port 7 pins also function as TMR_3, TMR_2, TMR_1, and TMR_0 I/O pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.18 P77 Pin Function P77DDR Pin function 0 1 P77 input P77 output Table 9.19 P76 Pin Function P76DDR Pin function 0 1 P76 input P76 output Table 9.20 P75 Pin Function OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_3 P75DDR Pin function All 0 Any of 1 0 1 P75 input P75 output TMO3 output Table 9.21 P74 Pin Function OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_2 P74DDR Pin function All 0 Any of 1 0 1 P74 input P74 output TMO2 output Table 9.22 P73 Pin Function OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_1 P73DDR Pin function All 0 Any of 1 0 1 P73 input P73 output TMO1 output Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 141 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.23 P72 Pin Function OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_0 All 0 0 1 P72 input P72 output TMO0 output P72DDR Pin function Any of 1 Table 9.24 P71 Pin Function P71DDR Pin function 0 1 P71 input P71 output TMCI23 input/TMRI23 input Table 9.25 P70 Pin Function P70DDR Pin function 0 1 P70 input P70 output TMCI01 input/TMRI01 input Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 142 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.5 Port 9 Port 9 is an input-only port. Port 9 pins also function as A/D converter analog input pins. Port 9 has the following register. • Port 9 register (PORT9) 9.5.1 Port 9 Register (PORT9) PORT9 is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port 9 pin states. PORT9 cannot be modified. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 P97 R 6 P96 Undefined* Undefined* The pin states are always read when a port 9 read is performed. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 P95 4 P94 3 P93 2 P92 1 P91 0 P90 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins P97 to P90. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 143 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6 Port A Port A is a 4-bit I/O port that also has other functions. Port A has the following registers. • • • • • Port A data direction register (PADDR) Port A data register (PADR) Port A register (PORTA) Port A pull-up MOS control register (PAPCR) Port A open-drain control register (PAODR) 9.6.1 Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) PADDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify whether the pins of port A are used for input or output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 4 Undefined Reserved These bits are read as undefined value and cannot be modified. 3 PA3DDR 0 W 2 PA2DDR 0 W 1 PA1DDR 0 W 0 PA0DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 144 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port A pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6.2 Port A Data Register (PADR) PADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for port A pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 4 Undefined Reserved These bits are read as an undefined value and cannot be modified. 3 PA3DR 0 R/W 2 PA2DR 0 R/W 1 PA1DR 0 R/W 0 PA0DR 0 R/W 9.6.3 Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. Port A Register (PORTA) PORTA is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port A pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 4 Undefined Reserved These bits are read as an undefined value. 3 PA3 2 PA2 1 PA1 0 PA0 Note: * Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R R If a port A read is performed while PADDR bits are set to 1, the PADR values are read. If a port A read is performed while PADDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. R Determined by the states of pins PA3 to PA0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 145 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6.4 Port A Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PAPCR) PAPCR is an 8-bit register that controls the input pull-up MOS function. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to4 Undefined Reserved These bits are read as an undefined value and cannot be modified. 3 PA3PCR 0 R/W 2 PA2PCR 0 R/W 1 PA1PCR 0 R/W 0 PA0PCR 0 R/W 9.6.5 When a pin is specified as an input port, setting the corresponding bit to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS for that pin. Port A Open-Drain Control Register (PAODR) PAODR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies the output type of port A. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 4 Undefined Reserved These bits are read as an undefined value and cannot be modified. 3 PA3ODR 0 R/W 2 PA2ODR 0 R/W 1 PA1ODR 0 R/W 0 PA0ODR 0 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 146 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 When a pin is specified as an output port, setting the corresponding bits to 1 specifies pin output to opendrain and the input pull-up MOS to the off state. Clearing these bits to 0 specifies that to push-pull output. Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6.6 Pin Functions Port A pins also function as SCI_2 I/O pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.26 PA3 Pin Function CKE1 in SCR_2 0 C/A in SMR_2 0 Pin function SCK2 input 1 0 1 PA3 input PA3 output SCK2 output SCK2 output CKE0 in SCR_2 PA3DDR 1 0 1 Table 9.27 PA2 Pin Function RE in SCR_2 PA2DDR Pin function 0 1 0 1 PA2 input PA2 output RxD2 input Table 9.28 PA1 Pin Function TE in SCR_2 PA1DDR Pin function 0 1 0 1 PA1 input PA1 output TxD2 output Table 9.29 PA0 Pin Function PA0DDR Pin function 0 1 PA0 input PA0 output Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 147 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7 Port B Port B is an 8-bit I/O port that also has other functions. Port B has the following registers. • • • • • Port B data direction register (PBDDR) Port B data register (PBDR) Port B register (PORTB) Port B pull-up MOS control register (PBPCR) Port B open-drain control register (PBODR) 9.7.1 Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) PBDDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify whether the pins of port B are used for input or output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PB7DDR 0 W 6 PB6DDR 0 W 5 PB5DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 1 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 PB4DDR 0 W 3 PB3DDR 0 W 2 PB2DDR 0 W 1 PB1DDR 0 W 0 PB0DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 148 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7.2 Port B Data Register (PBDR) PBDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for the port B pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PB7DR 0 R/W 6 PB6DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. 5 PB5DR 0 R/W 4 PB4DR 0 R/W 3 PB3DR 0 R/W 2 PB2DR 0 R/W 1 PB1DR 0 R/W 0 PB0DR 0 R/W 9.7.3 Port B Register (PORTB) PORTB is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port B pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PB7 R 6 PB6 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port B read is performed while PBDDR bits are set to 1, the PBDR values are read. If a port B read is performed while PBDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 PB5 4 PB4 3 PB3 2 PB2 1 PB1 0 PB0 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins PB7 to PB0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 149 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7.4 Port B Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PBPCR) PBPCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the on/off state of input pull-up MOS of port B. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PB7PCR 0 R/W 6 PB6PCR 0 R/W 5 PB5PCR 0 R/W When a pin is specified as an input port, setting the corresponding bits to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS for that pin. 4 PB4PCR 0 R/W 3 PB3PCR 0 R/W 2 PB2PCR 0 R/W 1 PB1PCR 0 R/W 0 PB0PCR 0 R/W 9.7.5 Port B Open-Drain Control Register (PBODR) PBODR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies the output type of port B. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PB7ODR 0 R/W 6 PB6ODR 0 R/W 5 PB5ODR 0 R/W 4 PB4ODR 0 R/W When a pin function is specified as an output port, setting the corresponding bits to 1 specifies pin output as open-drain and the input pull-up MOS to the off state. Clearing these bits to 0 specifies pushpull output. 3 PB3ODR 0 R/W 2 PB2ODR 0 R/W 1 PB1ODR 0 R/W 0 PB0ODR 0 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 150 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7.6 Pin Functions Port B pins also function as TPU I/O pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.30 PB7 Pin Function TPU channel 5 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCB5 output PB7 input PB7 output PB7DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCB5 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.31 PB6 Pin Function TPU channel 5 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCA5 output PB6 input PB6 output PB6DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCA5 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.32 PB5 Pin Function TPU channel 4 setting* PB5DDR Pin function Output Input or initial value 0 1 TIOCB4 output PB5 input PB5 output TIOCB4 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 151 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.33 PB4 Pin Function TPU channel 4 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCA4 output PB4 input PB4 output PB4DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCA4 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.34 PB3 Pin Function TPU channel 3 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCD3 output PB3 input PB3 output PB3DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCD3 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.35 PB2 Pin Function TPU channel 3 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCC3 output PB2 input PB2 output PB2DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCC3 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Table 9.36 PB1 Pin Function TPU channel 3 setting* Output Pin function Input or initial value 0 1 TIOCB3 output PB1 input PB1 output PB1DDR TIOCB3 input Note: * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 152 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.37 PB0 Pin Function TPU channel 3 setting* Output 0 1 TIOCA3 output PB0 input PB0 output PB0DDR Pin function Input or initial value TIOCA3 input Note: 9.8 * For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU). Port C Port C is an 8-bit I/O port that also has other functions. Port C has the following registers. • • • • • Port C data direction register (PCDDR) Port C data register (PCDR) Port C register (PORTC) Port C pull-up MOS control register (PCPCR) Port C open-drain control register (PCODR) 9.8.1 Port C Data Direction Register (PCDDR) PCDDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify whether the pins of port C are used for input or output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PC7DDR 0 W 6 PC6DDR 0 W 5 PC5DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 1 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 PC4DDR 0 W 3 PC3DDR 0 W 2 PC2DDR 0 W 1 PC1DDR 0 W 0 PC0DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 153 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.8.2 Port C Data Register (PCDR) PCDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for the port C pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PC7DR 0 R/W 6 PC6DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. 5 PC5DR 0 R/W 4 PC4DR 0 R/W 3 PC3DR 0 R/W 2 PC2DR 0 R/W 1 PC1DR 0 R/W 0 PC0DR 0 R/W 9.8.3 Port C Register (PORTC) PORTC is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port C pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PC7 R 6 PC6 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port C read is performed while PCDDR bits are set to 1, the PCDR values are read. If a port C read is performed while PCDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 PC5 4 PC4 3 PC3 2 PC2 1 PC1 0 PC0 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins PC7 to PC0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 154 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.8.4 Port C Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PCPCR) PCPCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the on/off state of input pull-up MOS of port C. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PC7PCR 0 R/W 6 PC6PCR 0 R/W 5 PC5PCR 0 R/W When a pin is specified as an input port, setting the corresponding bit to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS for that pin. 4 PC4PCR 0 R/W 3 PC3PCR 0 R/W 2 PC2PCR 0 R/W 1 PC1PCR 0 R/W 0 PC0PCR 0 R/W 9.8.5 Port C Open-Drain Control Register (PCODR) PCODR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies an output type of port C. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PC7ODR 0 R/W 6 PC6ODR 0 R/W 5 PC5ODR 0 R/W When a pin is specified as an output port, setting the corresponding bits to 1 specifies pin output as opendrain and the input pull-up MOS to the off state. Clearing these bits to 0 specifies push-pull output. 4 PC4ODR 0 R/W 3 PC3ODR 0 R/W 2 PC2ODR 0 R/W 1 PC1ODR 0 R/W 0 PC0ODR 0 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 155 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.8.6 Pin Functions Port C pins also function as SSU_1 and SSU_0 I/O pins. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin functions is shown below. Table 9.38 PC7 Pin Function CSS1 0 CSS0 1 0 0 1 0 1 PC7 input PC7 output SCS1 input SCS1 input/output auto switch SCS1 output PC7DDR Pin function 1 Table 9.39 PC6 Pin Function MSS 0 SCKS 1 0 1 0 0 1 PC6 input PC6 output SSCK1 input SSCK1 output Setting prohibited PC6DDR Pin function 1 Table 9.40 PC5 Pin Function MSS 0 BIDE 0 1 TE 0 0 SCS1 input Pin function 0 RE PC5DDR 1 1 1 PC5 input 0 PC5 output 0 0 1 SSI1 output SSI1 Hi-Z Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 156 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 1 1 1 0 1 0 1 SSI1 input PC5 input PC5 output PC5 input PC5 output PC5 input PC5 output Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.41 PC4 Pin Function MSS 0 BIDE 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 TE 1 0 1 SCS1 input Pin function 0 0 RE PC4DDR 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 PC4 PC4 SSO1 PC4 PC4 SSO1 PC4 PC4 SSO1 Setting SSO1 SSO1 SSO1 input output input input output output input output input pro- output Hi-Z output hibited Table 9.42 PC3 Pin Function CSS1 0 CSS0 PC3DDR Pin function 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 PC3 input PC3 output SCS0 input SCS0 input/output auto switch SCS0 output Table 9.43 PC2 Pin Function MSS 0 SCKS PC2DDR Pin function 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 PC2 input PC2 output SSCK0 input SSCK0 output Setting prohibited Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 157 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.44 PC1 Pin Function MSS 0 BIDE 0 1 TE 0 PC1 input PC1 output 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 SCS0 input Pin function 0 RE PC1DDR 1 1 0 1 0 1 SSI0 input PC1 input PC1 output 0 1 SSI0 output SSI0 Hi-Z PC1 input PC1 output PC1 input PC1 output Table 9.45 PC0 Pin Function MSS 0 BIDE 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 TE 0 SCS0 input Pin function 0 0 RE PC0DDR 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 PC0 PC0 SSO0 PC0 PC0 SSO0 PC0 PC0 SSO0 Setting SSO0 SSO0 SSO0 input output input input output output input output input pro- output Hi-Z output hibited Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 158 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.9 Port D Port D is an 8-bit I/O port that also functions as the realtime input port pins. The realtime input port stores the pin states of port D in PDRTIDR using the IRQ3 pin as the trigger input. The falling, rising, or both edges of the IRQ3 pin can be used as a trigger timing. Port D has the following registers. • • • • • Port D data direction register (PDDDR) Port D data register (PDDR) Port D register (PORTD) Port D pull-up MOS control register (PDPCR) Port D realtime input data register (PDRTIDR) 9.9.1 Port D Data Direction Register (PDDDR) PDDDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify whether the pins of port D are used for input or output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PD7DDR 0 W 6 PD6DDR 0 W 5 PD5DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port 1 pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 4 PD4DDR 0 W 3 PD3DDR 0 W 2 PD2DDR 0 W 1 PD1DDR 0 W 0 PD0DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 159 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.9.2 Port D Data Register (PDDR) PDDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for the port D pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PD7DR 0 R/W 6 PD6DR 0 R/W Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. 5 PD5DR 0 R/W 4 PD4DR 0 R/W 3 PD3DR 0 R/W 2 PD2DR 0 R/W 1 PD1DR 0 R/W 0 PD0DR 0 R/W 9.9.3 Port D Register (PORTD) PORTD is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port D pin states. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PD7 R 6 PD6 Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* Undefined* R If a port D read is performed while PDDDR bits are set to 1, the PDDR values are read. If a port D read is performed while PDDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. Undefined* Undefined* R Undefined* Undefined* R 5 PD5 4 PD4 3 PD3 2 PD2 1 PD1 0 PD0 Note: * R R R R Determined by the states of pins PD7 to PD0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 160 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.9.4 Port D Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PDPCR) PDPCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls on/off states of the input pull-up MOS of port D. Bit Bit Name 7 PD7PCR 0 R/W 6 PD6PCR 0 R/W 5 PD5PCR 0 R/W 4 PD4PCR 0 R/W 3 PD3PCR 0 R/W 2 PD2PCR 0 R/W 1 PD1PCR 0 R/W 0 PD0PCR 0 R/W 9.9.5 Initial Value R/W Description When the pin is in its input state, the input pull-up MOS of the input pin is on when the corresponding bits are set to 1. Port D RealTime Input Data Register (PDRTIDR) The realtime input port stores the pin states of port D in PDRTIDR using the IRQ3 pin as the trigger input. The falling, rising, or both edges of the IRQ3 pin can be specified as a trigger timing by bits 7 and 6 in the IRQ sense control register L (ISCRL). For details of this setting, see section 5.3.3, IRQ Sense Control Registers H and L (ISCRH, ISCRL). Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W 7 PDRTIDR7 0 R/W 6 PDRTIDR6 0 R/W 5 PDRTIDR5 0 R/W 4 PDRTIDR4 0 R/W 3 PDRTIDR3 0 R/W 2 PDRTIDR2 0 R/W 1 PDRTIDR1 0 R/W 0 PDRTIDR0 0 R/W Description Stores pin states using the IRQ3 pin as a trigger input. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 161 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.10 Port F Port F is an 8-bit I/O port that also has other functions. Port F has the following registers. • Port F data direction register (PFDDR) • Port F data register (PFDR) • Port F register (PORTF) 9.10.1 Port F Data Direction Register (PFDDR) PFDDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify whether the pins of port F are used for input or output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PF7DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting this bit to 1 makes the PF7 pin a φ output pin. Clearing this bit to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 6 PF6DDR 0 W 5 PF5DDR 0 W 4 PF4DDR 0 W When a pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port, setting these bits to 1 makes the corresponding port F pin an output pin. Clearing these bits to 0 makes the pin an input pin. 3 PF3DDR 0 W 2 PF2DDR 0 W 1 PF1DDR 0 W 0 PF0DDR 0 W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 162 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.10.2 Port F Data Register (PFDR) PFDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for the port F pins. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 0 R/W Reserved 6 PF6DR 0 R/W 5 PF5DR 0 R/W 4 PF4DR 0 R/W 3 PF3DR 0 R/W 2 PF2DR 0 R/W 1 PF1DR 0 R/W 0 PF0DR 0 R/W The write value should always be 0. 9.10.3 Output data for a pin is stored when the pin is specified as a general purpose I/O port. Port F Register (PORTF) PORTF is an 8-bit read-only register that shows port F pin states. PORTF cannot be modified. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PF7 R 6 PF6 Undefined* Undefined* PF5 Undefined* R If a port F read is performed while PFDDR bits are set to 1, the PFDR values are read. If a port F read is performed while PFDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read. 4 PF4 Undefined* R 3 PF3 R 2 PF2 Undefined* Undefined* PF1 Undefined* R PF0 Undefined* R 5 1 0 Note: * R R Determined by the states of pins PF7 to PF0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 163 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.10.4 Pin Functions Port F is an 8-bit I/O port. Port F pins also function as external interrupt input, IRQ3 and IRQ2, A/D trigger input (ADTRG), and system clock output (φ). Table 9.46 PF7 Pin Function PF7DDR Pin function 0 1 PF7 input φ output Table 9.47 PF6 Pin Function PF6DDR Pin function 0 1 PF6 input PF6 output Table 9.48 PF5 Pin Function PF5DDR Pin function 0 1 PF5 input PF5 output Table 9.49 PF4 Pin Function PF4DDR Pin function 0 1 PF4 input PF4 output Table 9.50 PF3 Pin Function PF3DDR Pin function 0 1 PF3 input PF3 output ADTRG input*1 IRQ3 input*2 Notes: 1. ADTRG input when TRGS0 = TRGS1 = 1. 2. When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use as an I/O pin for another function. This pin also functions as the trigger input for the realtime input port. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 164 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.51 PF2 Pin Function PF2DDR Pin function 0 1 PF2 input PF2 output Table 9.52 PF1 Pin Function PF1DDR Pin function 0 1 PF1 input PF1 output Table 9.53 PF0 Pin Function PF0DDR Pin function 0 1 PF0 input PF0 output IRQ2 input* Note: * When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use as an I/O pin for another function. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 165 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 9 I/O Ports Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 166 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) This LSI has an on-chip 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) comprised of six 16-bit timer channels. The function list of the 16-bit timer unit and its block diagram are shown in table 10.1 and figure 10.1, respectively. 10.1 Features • Maximum 16-pulse input/output • Selection of 8 counter input clocks for each channel • The following operations can be set for each channel: Waveform output at compare match Input capture function Counter clear operation Synchronous operation: Multiple timer counters (TCNT) can be written to simultaneously Simultaneous clearing by compare match and input capture is possible Register simultaneous input/output is possible by synchronous counter operation A maximum 15-phase PWM output is possible in combination with synchronous operation • Buffer operation settable for channels 0 and 3 • Phase counting mode settable independently for each of channels 1, 2, 4, and 5 • Cascaded operation • Fast access via internal 16-bit bus • 26 interrupt sources • Automatic transfer of register data • Programmable pulse generator (PPG) output trigger can be generated • A/D converter conversion start trigger can be generated • Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 167 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.1 TPU Functions Item Channel 0 Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 3 Channel 4 Channel 5 Count clock φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 TCLKA TCLKB TCLKC TCLKD φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/256 TCLKA TCLKB φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/1024 TCLKA TCLKB TCLKC φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/256 φ/1024 φ/4096 TCLKA φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/1024 TCLKA TCLKC φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/256 TCLKA TCLKC TCLKD General registers (TGR) TGRA_0 TGRB_0 TGRA_1 TGRB_1 TGRA_2 TGRB_2 TGRA_3 TGRB_3 TGRA_4 TGRB_4 TGRA_5 TGRB_5 General registers/ buffer registers TGRC_0 TGRD_0 TGRC_3 TGRD_3 I/O pins TIOCA0 TIOCB0 TIOCC0 TIOCD0 TIOCA1 TIOCB1 TIOCA2 TIOCB2 TIOCA3 TIOCB3 TIOCC3 TIOCD3 TIOCA4 TIOCB4 TIOCA5 TIOCB5 Counter clear function TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture Compare 0 output match 1 output output Toggle output Input capture function Synchronous operation PWM mode Phase counting mode Buffer operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 168 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Item Channel 0 Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 3 Channel 4 Channel 5 DTC TGR activation compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture TGR compare match or input capture A/D TGRA_0 converter compare trigger match or input capture TGRA_1 compare match or input capture TGRA_2 compare match or input capture TGRA_3 compare match or input capture TGRA_4 compare match or input capture TGRA_5 compare match or input capture PPG trigger TGRA_0/ TGRB_0 compare match or input capture TGRA_1/ TGRB_1 compare match or input capture TGRA_2/ TGRB_2 compare match or input capture TGRA_3/ TGRB_3 compare match or input capture Interrupt sources 5 sources 4 sources 4 sources 5 sources 4 sources 4 sources • Compare match or input capture 0A • Compare match or input capture 1A • Compare match or input capture 2A • Compare match or input capture 3A • Compare match or input capture 4A • Compare match or input capture 5A • Compare match or input capture 0B • Compare match or input capture 1B • Compare match or input capture 2B • Compare match or input capture 3B • Compare match or input capture 4B • Compare match or input capture 5B • Overflow • Overflow • Compare match or • Underflow input capture 3C • Overflow • Compare match or • Underflow input capture 0C • Underflow • Compare match or input capture 0D • Compare match or input capture 3D • Overflow • Overflow • Overflow • Underflow [Legend] : Possible : Not possible Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 169 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 [Legend] TSTR: Timer start register TSYR: Timer synchro register TCR: Timer control register TMDR: Timer mode register TGRD TGRC TGRB TGRB TGRB TCNT TGRA TCNT TGRA TCNT TGRA Module data bus Bus interface TGRB TGRD TGRB TGRB TGRC TCNT TGRA TCNT TCNT PPG output trigger signal TGRA TSTR TSR TSR TIER TIER TSR TIOR TIORH TIORL A/D converter conversion start signal Timer I/O control registers (H, L) Timer interrupt enable register Timer status register Timer general registers (A, B, C, D) Figure 10.1 Block Diagram of TPU Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 170 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Interrupt request signals Channel 3: TGIA_3 TGIB_3 TGIC_3 TGID_3 TCIV_3 Channel 4: TGIA_4 TGIB_4 TCIV_4 TCIU_4 Channel 5: TGIA_5 TGIB_5 TCIV_5 TCIU_5 Internal data bus TGRA TSR TIER TSR TSYR TIER TSR TIER TIOR TIOR Control logic TIOR TIER TMDR TIORH TIORL TCR TMDR TCR TMDR Channel 4 TIOR (H, L): TIER: TSR: TGR (A, B, C, D): TCR Channel 5 Common Channel 0 Channel 2: Control logic for channels 0 to 2 Channel 1: TIOCA0 TIOCB0 TIOCC0 TIOCD0 TIOCA1 TIOCB1 TIOCA2 TIOCB2 Channel 1 Input/output pins Channel 0: TMDR Channel 2 External clock: φ/1 φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 φ/256 φ/1024 φ/4096 TCLKA TCLKB TCLKC TCLKD TCR Clock input Internal clock: TMDR Channel 5: TCR Channel 4: TIOCA3 TIOCB3 TIOCC3 TIOCD3 TIOCA4 TIOCB4 TIOCA5 TIOCB5 Control logic for channels 3 to 5 Channel 3: TMDR Input/output pins TCR Channel 3 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Interrupt request signals Channel 3: TGIA_0 TGIB_0 TGIC_0 TGID_0 TCIV_0 Channel 4: TGIA_1 TGIB_1 TCIV_1 TCIU_1 Channel 5: TGIA_2 TGIB_2 TCIV_2 TCIU_2 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.2 Input/Output Pins Table 10.2 TPU Pins Channel Symbol I/O Function All TCLKA Input External clock A input pin (Channel 1 and 5 phase counting mode A phase input) TCLKB Input External clock B input pin (Channel 1 and 5 phase counting mode B phase input) TCLKC Input External clock C input pin (Channel 2 and 4 phase counting mode A phase input) TCLKD Input External clock D input pin (Channel 2 and 4 phase counting mode B phase input) TIOCA0 I/O TGRA_0 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB0 I/O TGRB_0 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCC0 I/O TGRC_0 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCD0 I/O TGRD_0 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCA1 I/O TGRA_1 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB1 I/O TGRB_1 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin 0 1 2 3 4 5 TIOCA2 I/O TGRA_2 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB2 I/O TGRB_2 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCA3 I/O TGRA_3 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB3 I/O TGRB_3 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCC3 I/O TGRC_3 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCD3 I/O TGRD_3 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCA4 I/O TGRA_4 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB4 I/O TGRB_4 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCA5 I/O TGRA_5 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin TIOCB5 I/O TGRB_5 input capture input/output compare output/PWM output pin Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 171 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3 Register Descriptions The TPU has the following registers. To distinguish registers in each channel, an underscore and the channel number are added as a suffix to the register name; TCR for channel 0 is expressed as TCR_0. • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Timer control register_0 (TCR_0) Timer mode register_0 (TMDR_0) Timer I/O control register H_0 (TIORH_0) Timer I/O control register L_0 (TIORL_0) Timer interrupt enable register_0 (TIER_0) Timer status register_0 (TSR_0) Timer counter_0 (TCNT_0) Timer general register A_0 (TGRA_0) Timer general register B_0 (TGRB_0) Timer general register C_0 (TGRC_0) Timer general register D_0 (TGRD_0) Timer control register_1 (TCR_1) Timer mode register_1 (TMDR_1) Timer I/O control register _1 (TIOR_1) Timer interrupt enable register_1 (TIER_1) Timer status register_1 (TSR_1) Timer counter_1 (TCNT_1) Timer general register A_1 (TGRA_1) Timer general register B_1 (TGRB_1) Timer control register_2 (TCR_2) Timer mode register_2 (TMDR_2) Timer I/O control register_2 (TIOR_2) Timer interrupt enable register_2 (TIER_2) Timer status register_2 (TSR_2) Timer counter_2 (TCNT_2) Timer general register A_2 (TGRA_2) Timer general register B_2 (TGRB_2) Timer control register_3 (TCR_3) Timer mode register_3 (TMDR_3) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 172 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Timer I/O control register H_3 (TIORH_3) Timer I/O control register L_3 (TIORL_3) Timer interrupt enable register_3 (TIER_3) Timer status register_3 (TSR_3) Timer counter_3 (TCNT_3) Timer general register A_3 (TGRA_3) Timer general register B_3 (TGRB_3) Timer general register C_3 (TGRC_3) Timer general register D_3 (TGRD_3) Timer control register_4 (TCR_4) Timer mode register_4 (TMDR_4) Timer I/O control register _4 (TIOR_4) Timer interrupt enable register_4 (TIER_4) Timer status register_4 (TSR_4) Timer counter_4 (TCNT_4) Timer general register A_4 (TGRA_4) Timer general register B_4 (TGRB_4) Timer control register_5 (TCR_5) Timer mode register_5 (TMDR_5) Timer I/O control register_5 (TIOR_5) Timer interrupt enable register_5 (TIER_5) Timer status register_5 (TSR_5) Timer counter_5 (TCNT_5) Timer general register A_5 (TGRA_5) Timer general register B_5 (TGRB_5) Common Register: • Timer start register (TSTR) • Timer synchro register (TSYR) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 173 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.1 Timer Control Register (TCR) The TCR registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control the TCNT operation for each channel. The TPU has a total of six TCR registers, one for each channel (channels 5 to 0). TCR register settings should be conducted only when TCNT operation is stopped. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7 6 5 CCLR2 CCLR1 CCLR0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W Counter Clear 2 to 0 4 3 CKEG1 CKEG0 0 0 R/W R/W Clock Edge 1 and 0 These bits select the TCNT counter clearing source. See tables 10.3 and 10.4 for details. These bits select the input clock edge. When the input clock is counted using both edges, the input clock period is halved (e.g. φ/4 both edges = φ/2 rising edge). If phase counting mode is used on channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, this setting is ignored and the phase counting mode setting has priority. Internal clock edge selection is valid when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. This setting is ignored if the input clock is φ/1, or when overflow/underflow of another channel is selected. 00: Count at rising edge 01: Count at falling edge 1×: Count at both edges [Legend] ×: Don’t care 2 1 0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 174 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Time Prescaler 2 to 0 These bits select the TCNT counter clock. The clock source can be selected independently for each channel. See tables 10.5 to 10.10 for details. Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.3 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (Channels 0 and 3) Channel Bit 7 CCLR2 Bit 6 CCLR1 Bit 5 CCLR0 Description 0, 3 0 0 0 TCNT clearing disabled 1 TCNT cleared by TGRA compare match/input capture 0 TCNT cleared by TGRB compare match/input capture 1 TCNT cleared by counter clearing for another channel performing synchronous clearing/ 1 synchronous operation* 0 TCNT clearing disabled 1 TCNT cleared by TGRC compare match/input 2 capture* 0 TCNT cleared by TGRD compare match/input capture*2 1 TCNT cleared by counter clearing for another channel performing synchronous clearing/ synchronous operation*1 1 1 0 1 Notes: 1. Synchronous operation is set by setting the SYNC bit in TSYR to 1. 2. When TGRC or TGRD is used as a buffer register, TCNT is not cleared because the buffer register setting has priority, and compare match/input capture does not occur. Table 10.4 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (Channels 1, 2, 4, and 5) Channel Bit 7 Bit 6 Reserved*2 CCLR1 Bit 5 CCLR0 Description 1, 2, 4, 5 0 0 TCNT clearing disabled 1 TCNT cleared by TGRA compare match/input capture 0 TCNT cleared by TGRB compare match/input capture 1 TCNT cleared by counter clearing for another channel performing synchronous clearing/ synchronous operation*1 0 1 Notes: 1. Synchronous operation is selected by setting the SYNC bit in TSYR to 1. 2. Bit 7 is reserved in channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 175 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.5 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 0) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 0 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input 1 1 0 1 0 External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKD pin input Table 10.6 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 1) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 1 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/256 1 Counts on TCNT2 overflow/underflow 1 1 0 1 Note: This setting is ignored when channel 1 is in phase counting mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 176 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.7 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 2) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 2 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input 1 1 0 1 0 External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/1024 Note: This setting is ignored when channel 2 is in phase counting mode. Table 10.8 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 3) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 3 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/1024 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/256 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4096 1 1 0 1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 177 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.9 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 4) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 4 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input 1 1 0 1 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1024 1 Counts on TCNT5 overflow/underflow Note: This setting is ignored when channel 4 is in phase counting mode. Table 10.10 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (Channel 5) Channel Bit 2 TPSC2 Bit 1 TPSC1 Bit 0 TPSC0 Description 5 0 0 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/1 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/4 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/16 1 Internal clock: counts on φ/64 0 External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input 1 External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input 0 Internal clock: counts on φ/256 1 External clock: counts on TCLKD pin input 1 1 0 1 Note: This setting is ignored when channel 5 is in phase counting mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 178 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.2 Timer Mode Register (TMDR) The TMDR registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers that are used to set the operating mode of each channel. The TPU has six TMDR registers, one for each channel. TMDR register settings should be changed only when TCNT operation is stopped. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7, 6 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 5 BFB 0 R/W Buffer Operation B Specifies whether TGRB is to operate in the normal way, or TGRB and TGRD are to be used together for buffer operation. When TGRD is used as a buffer register, TGRD input capture/output compare is not generated. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, which have no TGRD, bit 5 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0: TGRB operates normally 1: TGRB and TGRD used together for buffer operation 4 BFA 0 R/W Buffer Operation A Specifies whether TGRA is to operate in the normal way, or TGRA and TGRC are to be used together for buffer operation. When TGRC is used as a buffer register, TGRC input capture/output compare is not generated. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, which have no TGRC, bit 4 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0: TGRA operates normally 1: TGRA and TGRC used together for buffer operation 3 2 1 0 MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W Modes 3 to 0 These bits are used to set the timer operating mode. MD3 is a reserved bit. In a write, it should always be written with 0. See table 10.11 for details. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 179 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.11 MD3 to MD0 Bit 3 1 MD3* Bit 2 MD2*2 Bit 1 MD1 Bit 0 MD0 Description 0 0 0 0 Normal operation 1 Reserved 0 PWM mode 1 1 PWM mode 2 0 Phase counting mode 1 1 Phase counting mode 2 1 1 0 1 1 × × 0 Phase counting mode 3 1 Phase counting mode 4 × [Legend] ×: Don’t care Notes: 1. MD3 is a reserved bit. In a write, it should always be written with 0. 2. Phase counting mode cannot be set for channels 0 and 3. In this case, 0 should always be written to MD2. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 180 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.3 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR) The TIOR registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control the TGR registers. The TPU has eight TIOR registers, two each for channels 0 and 3, and one each for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. Care is required as TIOR is affected by the TMDR setting. The initial output specified by TIOR is valid when the counter is stopped (the CST bit in TSTR is cleared to 0). Note also that, in PWM mode 2, the output at the point at which the counter is cleared to 0 is specified. When TGRC or TGRD is designated for buffer operation, this setting is invalid and the register operates as a buffer register. • TIORH_5, TIOR_4, TIOR_3, TIORH_2, TIOR_1, TIOR_0 Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7 6 5 4 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W I/O Control B3 to B0 3 2 1 0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W I/O Control A3 to A0 Specify the function of TGRB. Specify the function of TGRA. • TIORL_3, TIORL_0 Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7 6 5 4 IOD3 IOD2 IOD1 IOD0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W I/O Control D3 to D0 3 2 1 0 IOC3 IOC2 IOC1 IOC0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W I/O Control C3 to C0 Specify the function of TGRD. Specify the function of TGRC. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 181 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.12 TIORH_0 (Channel 0) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_0 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB0 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCB0 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB0 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB0 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 1/count clock Input capture at TCNT_1 count-up/count-down* [Legend] ×: Don’t care Note: * When bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR_1 are set to B'000 and φ/1 is used as the TCNT_1 count clock, this setting is invalid and input capture is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 182 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.13 TIORL_0 (Channel 0) Description Bit 7 IOD3 Bit 6 IOD2 Bit 5 IOD1 Bit 4 IOD0 TGRD_0 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register*2 1 TIOCD0 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 1 Input capture register*2 Capture input source is the TIOCD0 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCD0 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCD0 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 1/count clock Input capture at TCNT_1 count-up/count-down* 1 [Legend] ×: Don’t care Notes: 1. When bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR_1 are set to B'000 and φ/1 is used as the TCNT_1 count clock, this setting is invalid and input capture is not generated. 2. When the BFB bit in TMDR_0 is set to 1 and TGRD_0 is used as a buffer register, this setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 183 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.14 TIOR_1 (Channel 1) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_1 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB1 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCB1 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB1 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB1 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × TGRC_0 compare match/ input capture Input capture at generation of TGRC_0 compare match/input capture [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 184 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.15 TIOR_2 (Channel 2) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_2 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB2 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 × 0 0 1 Input capture register Capture input source is the TIOCB2 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB2 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB2 pin Input capture at both edges [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 185 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.16 TIORH_3 (Channel 3) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_3 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB3 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCB3 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB3 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB3 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 4/count clock Input capture at TCNT_4 count-up/count-down* [Legend] ×: Don’t care Note: * When bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR_4 are set to B'000 and φ/1 is used as the TCNT_4 count clock, this setting is invalid and input capture is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 186 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.17 TIORL_3 (Channel 3) Description Bit 7 IOD3 Bit 6 IOD2 Bit 5 IOD1 Bit 4 IOD0 TGRD_3 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register*2 1 TIOCD3 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 1 Input capture register*2 Capture input source is the TIOCD3 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCD3 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCD3 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 4/count clock Input capture at TCNT_4 count-up/count-down* 1 [Legend] ×: Don’t care Notes: 1. When bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR_4 are set to B'000 and φ/1 is used as the TCNT_4 count clock, this setting is invalid and input capture is not generated. 2. When the BFB bit in TMDR_3 is set to 1 and TGRD_3 is used as a buffer register, this setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 187 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.18 TIOR_4 (Channel 4) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_4 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB4 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCB4 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB4 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB4 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is TGRC_3 compare match/input capture Input capture at generation of TGRC_3 compare match/input capture [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 188 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.19 TIOR_5 (Channel 5) Description Bit 7 IOB3 Bit 6 IOB2 Bit 5 IOB1 Bit 4 IOB0 TGRB_5 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCB5 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 × 0 0 1 Input capture register Capture input source is the TIOCB5 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCB5 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCB5 pin Input capture at both edges [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 189 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.20 TIORH_0 (Channel 0) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_0 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA0 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCA0 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA0 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA0 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 1/count clock Input capture at TCNT_1 count-up/count-down [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 190 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.21 TIORL_0 (Channel 0) Description Bit 3 IOC3 Bit 2 IOC2 Bit 1 IOC1 Bit 0 IOC0 TGRC_0 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register* 1 TIOCC0 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 1 Input capture register* Capture input source is the TIOCC0 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCC0 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCC0 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 1/count clock Input capture at TCNT_1 count-up/count-down [Legend] ×: Don’t care Note: * When the BFA bit in TMDR_0 is set to 1 and TGRC_0 is used as a buffer register, this setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 191 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.22 TIOR_1 (Channel 1) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_1 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA1 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCA1 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA1 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA1 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is TGRA_0 compare match/input capture Input capture at generation of channel 0/TGRA_0 compare match/input capture [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 192 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.23 TIOR_2 (Channel 2) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_2 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA2 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 × 0 0 1 Input capture register Capture input source is the TIOCA2 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA2 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA2 pin Input capture at both edges [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 193 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.24 TIORH_3 (Channel 3) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_3 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA3 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCA3 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA3 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA3 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 4/count clock Input capture at TCNT_4 count-up/count-down [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 194 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.25 TIORL_3 (Channel 3) Description Bit 3 IOC3 Bit 2 IOC2 Bit 1 IOC1 Bit 0 IOC0 TGRC_3 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register* 1 TIOCC3 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 1 Input capture register* Capture input source is the TIOCC3 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCC3 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCC3 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is channel 4/count clock Input capture at TCNT_4 count-up/count-down [Legend] ×: Don’t care Note: * When the BFA bit in TMDR_3 is set to 1 and TGRC_3 is used as a buffer register, this setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 195 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.26 TIOR_4 (Channel 4) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_4 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA4 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 0 Input capture register 1 Capture input source is the TIOCA4 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA4 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA4 pin Input capture at both edges 1 × × Capture input source is TGRA_3 compare match/input capture Input capture at generation of TGRA_3 compare match/input capture [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 196 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.27 TIOR_5 (Channel 5) Description Bit 3 IOA3 Bit 2 IOA2 Bit 1 IOA1 Bit 0 IOA0 TGRA_5 Function 0 0 0 0 Output compare register 1 TIOCA5 Pin Function Output disabled Initial output is 0 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 0 1 output at compare match 1 Initial output is 0 Toggle output at compare match 1 0 0 Output disabled 1 Initial output is 1 0 output at compare match 1 0 Initial output is 1 1 output at compare match Initial output is 1 1 Toggle output at compare match 1 × 0 0 1 Input capture register Capture input source is the TIOCA5 pin Input capture at rising edge Capture input source is the TIOCA5 pin Input capture at falling edge 1 × Capture input source is the TIOCA5 pin Input capture at both edges [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 197 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.4 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER) The TIER registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control enabling or disabling of interrupt requests for each channel. The TPU has six TIER registers, one for each channel. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7 TTGE 0 R/W A/D Conversion Start Request Enable Enables or disables generation of A/D conversion start requests by TGRA input capture/compare match. 0: A/D conversion start request generation disabled 1: A/D conversion start request generation enabled 6 1 Reserved This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 5 TCIEU 0 R/W Underflow Interrupt Enable Enables or disables interrupt requests (TCIU) by the TCFU flag when the TCFU flag in TSR is set to 1 in channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. In channels 0 and 3, bit 5 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0: Interrupt requests (TCIU) by TCFU disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TCIU) by TCFU enabled 4 TCIEV 0 R/W Overflow Interrupt Enable Enables or disables interrupt requests (TCIV) by the TCFV flag when the TCFV flag in TSR is set to 1. 0: Interrupt requests (TCIV) by TCFV disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TCIV) by TCFV enabled 3 TGIED 0 R/W TGR Interrupt Enable D Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGID) by the TGFD bit when the TGFD bit in TSR is set to 1 in channels 0 and 3. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, bit 3 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0: Interrupt requests (TGID) by TGFD bit disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TGID) by TGFD bit enabled Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 198 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 2 TGIEC 0 R/W TGR Interrupt Enable C Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIC) by the TGFC bit when the TGFC bit in TSR is set to 1 in channels 0 and 3. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, bit 2 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. 0: Interrupt requests (TGIC) by TGFC bit disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TGIC) by TGFC bit enabled 1 TGIEB 0 R/W TGR Interrupt Enable B Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIB) by the TGFB bit when the TGFB bit in TSR is set to 1. 0: Interrupt requests (TGIB) by TGFB bit disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TGIB) by TGFB bit enabled 0 TGIEA 0 R/W TGR Interrupt Enable A Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIA) by the TGFA bit when the TGFA bit in TSR is set to 1. 0: Interrupt requests (TGIA) by TGFA bit disabled 1: Interrupt requests (TGIA) by TGFA bit enabled Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 199 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.5 Timer Status Register (TSR) The TSR registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers that indicate the status of each channel. The TPU has six TSR registers, one for each channel. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7 TCFD 1 R Count Direction Flag Status flag that shows the direction in which TCNT counts in channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. In channels 0 and 3, bit 7 is reserved. It is always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 0: TCNT counts down 1: TCNT counts up 6 1 Reserved This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 5 TCFU 0 R/(W) Underflow Flag Status flag that indicates that TCNT underflow has occurred when channels 1, 2, 4, and 5 are set to phase counting mode. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. In channels 0 and 3, bit 5 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. [Setting condition] • When the TCNT value underflows (changes from H'0000 to H'FFFF) [Clearing condition] • 4 TCFV 0 R/(W) When 0 is written to TCFU after reading TCFU = 1 Overflow Flag Status flag that indicates that TCNT overflow has occurred. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. [Setting condition] • When the TCNT value overflows (changes from H'FFFF to H'0000 ) [Clearing condition] • Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 200 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 When 0 is written to TCFV after reading TCFV = 1 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 3 TGFD 0 R/(W) Input Capture/Output Compare Flag D Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRD input capture or compare match in channels 0 and 3. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, bit 3 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. [Setting conditions] • When TCNT = TGRD and TGRD is functioning as output compare register • When TCNT value is transferred to TGRD by input capture signal and TGRD is functioning as input capture register [Clearing conditions] 2 TGFC 0 R/(W) • When DTC is activated by TGID interrupt and the DISEL bit of MRB in DTC is 0 • When 0 is written to TGFD after reading TGFD = 1 Input Capture/Output Compare Flag C Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRC input capture or compare match in channels 0 and 3. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. In channels 1, 2, 4, and 5, bit 2 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified. [Setting conditions] • When TCNT = TGRC and TGRC is functioning as output compare register • When TCNT value is transferred to TGRC by input capture signal and TGRC is functioning as input capture register [Clearing conditions] • When DTC is activated by TGIC interrupt and the DISEL bit of MRB in DTC is 0 • When 0 is written to TGFC after reading TGFC = 1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 201 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 1 TGFB 0 R/(W) Input Capture/Output Compare Flag B Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRB input capture or compare match. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. [Setting conditions] • When TCNT = TGRB and TGRB is functioning as output compare register • When TCNT value is transferred to TGRB by input capture signal and TGRB is functioning as input capture register [Clearing conditions] 0 TGFA 0 R/(W) • When DTC is activated by TGIB interrupt and the DISEL bit of MRB in DTC is 0 • When 0 is written to TGFB after reading TGFB = 1 Input Capture/Output Compare Flag A Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRA input capture or compare match. Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. [Setting conditions] • When TCNT = TGRA and TGRA is functioning as output compare register • When TCNT value is transferred to TGRA by input capture signal and TGRA is functioning as input capture register [Clearing conditions] Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 202 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 • When DTC is activated by TGIA interrupt and the DISEL bit of MRB in DTC is 0 • When 0 is written to TGFA after reading TGFA = 1 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.6 Timer Counter (TCNT) The TCNT registers are 16-bit readable/writable counters. The TPU has six TCNT counters, one for each channel. The TCNT counters are initialized to H'0000 by a reset, and in hardware standby mode. The TCNT counters cannot be accessed in 8-bit units; they must always be accessed as a 16-bit unit. 10.3.7 Timer General Register (TGR) The TGR registers are dual function 16-bit readable/writable registers, functioning as either output compare or input capture registers. The TPU has 16 TGR registers, four each for channels 0 and 3 and two each for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. TGRC and TGRD for channels 0 and 3 can also be designated for operation as buffer registers. The TGR registers cannot be accessed in 8-bit units; they must always be accessed as a 16-bit unit. TGR buffer register combinations are TGRA– TGRC and TGRB–TGRD. 10.3.8 Timer Start Register (TSTR) TSTR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects operation/stoppage for channels 0 to 5. When setting the operating mode in TMDR or setting the count clock in TCR, first stop the TCNT counter. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7, 6 All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 5 4 3 2 1 0 CST5 CST4 CST3 CST2 CST1 CST0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Counter Start 5 to 0 (CST5 to CST0) These bits select operation or stoppage for TCNT. If 0 is written to the CST bit during operation with the TIOC pin designated for output, the counter stops but the TIOC pin output compare output level is retained. If TIOR is written to when the CST bit is cleared to 0, the pin output level will be changed to the set initial output value. 0: TCNT_5 to TCNT_0 count operation is stopped 1: TCNT_5 to TCNT_0 performs count operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 203 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.3.9 Timer Synchro Register (TSYR) TSYR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects independent operation or synchronous operation for the channel 0 to 5 TCNT counters. A channel performs synchronous operation when the corresponding bit in TSYR is set to 1. Bit Bit Name Initial value R/W Description 7, 6 All 0 R/W Reserved The write value should always be 0. 5 4 3 2 1 0 SYNC5 SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Timer Synchro 0 to 5 These bits are used to select whether operation is independent of or synchronized with other channels. When synchronous operation is selected, the TCNT synchronous presetting of multiple channels, and synchronous clearing by counter clearing on another channel, are possible. To set synchronous operation, the SYNC bits for at least two channels must be set to 1. To set synchronous clearing, in addition to the SYNC bit , the TCNT clearing source must also be set by means of bits CCLR0 to CCLR2 in TCR. 0: TCNT_0 to TCNT_5 operates independently (TCNT presetting/clearing is unrelated to other channels) 1: TCNT_0 to TCNT_5 performs synchronous operation TCNT synchronous presetting/synchronous clearing is possible Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 204 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.4 Operation 10.4.1 Basic Functions Each channel has a TCNT and TGR register. TCNT performs up-counting, and is also capable of free-running operation, periodic counting, and external event counting. Each TGR can be used as an input capture register or output compare register. Counter Operation: When one of bits CST5 to CST0 is set to 1 in TSTR, the TCNT counter for the corresponding channel begins counting. TCNT can operate as a free-running counter, periodic counter, for example. 1. Example of count operation setting procedure Figure 10.2 shows an example of the count operation setting procedure. Operation selection Select counter clock [1] Periodic counter Select counter clearing source Free-running counter [2] [3] Select output compare register Set period [4] Start count operation [5] <Periodic counter> Start count operation <Free-running counter> [1] Select the counter clock with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. At the same time, select the input clock edge with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. [2] For periodic counter operation, select the TGR to be used as the TCNT clearing source with bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR. [3] Designate the TGR selected in [2] as an output compare register by means of TIOR. [4] Set the periodic counter cycle in the TGR selected in [2]. [5] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the counter operation. Figure 10.2 Example of Counter Operation Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 205 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 2. Free-running count operation and periodic count operation Immediately after a reset, the TPU’s TCNT counters are all designated as free-running counters. When the relevant bit in TSTR is set to 1 the corresponding TCNT counter starts upcount operation as a free-running counter. When TCNT overflows (from H'FFFF to H'0000), the TCFV bit in TSR is set to 1. If the value of the corresponding TCIEV bit in TIER is 1 at this point, the TPU requests an interrupt. After overflow, TCNT starts counting up again from H'0000. Figure 10.3 illustrates free-running counter operation. TCNT value H'FFFF H'0000 Time CST bit TCFV Figure 10.3 Free-Running Counter Operation When compare match is selected as the TCNT clearing source, the TCNT counter for the relevant channel performs periodic count operation. The TGR register for setting the period is designated as an output compare register, and counter clearing by compare match is selected by means of bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR. After the settings have been made, TCNT starts up-count operation as a periodic counter when the corresponding bit in TSTR is set to 1. When the count value matches the value in TGR, the TGF bit in TSR is set to 1 and TCNT is cleared to H'0000. If the value of the corresponding TGIE bit in TIER is 1 at this point, the TPU requests an interrupt. After a compare match, TCNT starts counting up again from H'0000. Figure 10.4 illustrates periodic counter operation. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 206 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Counter cleared by TGR compare match TCNT value TGR H'0000 Time CST bit Flag cleared by software or DTC activation TGF Figure 10.4 Periodic Counter Operation Waveform Output by Compare Match: The TPU can perform 0, 1, or toggle output from the corresponding output pin using compare match. 1. Example of setting procedure for waveform output by compare match Figure 10.5 shows an example of the setting procedure for waveform output by compare match. Output selection Select waveform output mode [1] Set output timing [2] Start count operation [3] [1] Select initial value 0 output or 1 output, and compare match output value 0 output, 1 output, or toggle output, by means of TIOR. The set initial value is output at the TIOC pin unit the first compare match occurs. [2] Set the timing for compare match generation in TGR. [3] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count operation. <Waveform output> Figure 10.5 Example of Setting Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 207 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 2. Examples of waveform output operation Figure 10.6 shows an example of 0 output/1 output. In this example TCNT has been designated as a free-running counter, and settings have been made such that 1 is output by compare match A, and 0 is output by compare match B. When the set level and the pin level coincide, the pin level does not change. TCNT value H'FFFF TGRA TGRB Time H'0000 No change No change 1 output TIOCA No change TIOCB No change 0 output Figure 10.6 Example of 0 Output/1 Output Operation Figure 10.7 shows an example of toggle output. In this example, TCNT has been designated as a periodic counter (with counter clearing on compare match B), and settings have been made such that the output is toggled by both compare match A and compare match B. TCNT value Counter cleared by TGRB compare match H'FFFF TGRB TGRA Time H'0000 Toggle output TIOCB Toggle output TIOCA Figure 10.7 Example of Toggle Output Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 208 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Input Capture Function: The TCNT value can be transferred to TGR on detection of the TIOC pin input edge. Rising edge, falling edge, or both edges can be selected as the detected edge. For channels 0, 1, 3, and 4, it is also possible to specify another channel’s counter input clock or compare match signal as the input capture source. Note: When another channel’s counter input clock is used as the input capture input for channels 0 and 3, φ/1 should not be selected as the counter input clock used for input capture input. Input capture will not be generated if φ/1 is selected. 1. Example of input capture operation setting procedure Figure 10.8 shows an example of the input capture operation setting procedure. Input selection Select input capture input Start count [1] Designate TGR as an input capture register by means of TIOR, and select rising edge, falling edge, or both edges as the input capture source and input signal edge. [2] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count operation. [1] [2] <Input capture operation> Figure 10.8 Example of Input Capture Operation Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 209 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 2. Example of input capture operation Figure 10.9 shows an example of input capture operation. In this example both rising and falling edges have been selected as the TIOCA pin input capture input edge, the falling edge has been selected as the TIOCB pin input capture input edge, and counter clearing by TGRB input capture has been designated for TCNT. Counter cleared by TIOCB input (falling edge) TCNT value H'0180 H'0160 H'0010 H'0005 Time H'0000 TIOCA TGRA H'0005 H'0160 H'0010 TIOCB TGRB H'0180 Figure 10.9 Example of Input Capture Operation 10.4.2 Synchronous Operation In synchronous operation, the values in a number of TCNT counters can be rewritten simultaneously (synchronous presetting). Also, a number of TCNT counters can be cleared simultaneously by making the appropriate setting in TCR (synchronous clearing). Synchronous operation enables TGR to be incremented with respect to a single time base. Channels 0 to 5 can all be designated for synchronous operation. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 210 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure: Figure 10.10 shows an example of the synchronous operation setting procedure. Synchronous operation selection Set synchronous operation [1] Synchronous presetting Set TCNT Synchronous clearing [2] Clearing source generation channel? No Yes <Synchronous presetting> Select counter clearing source [3] Set synchronous counter clearing [4] Start count [4] Start count [5] <Counter clearing> <Synchronous clearing> [1] Set to 1 the SYNC bits in TSYR corresponding to the channels to be designated for synchronous operation. [2] When the TCNT counter of any of the channels designated for synchronous operation is written to, the same value is simultaneously written to the other TCNT counters. [3] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to specify TCNT clearing by input capture/output compare, etc. [4] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to designate synchronous clearing for the counter clearing source. [5] Set to 1 the CST bits in TSTR for the relevant channels, to start the count operation. Figure 10.10 Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 211 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Example of Synchronous Operation: Figure 10.11 shows an example of synchronous operation. In this example, synchronous operation and PWM mode 1 have been designated for channels 0 to 2, TGRB_0 compare match has been set as the channel 0 counter clearing source, and synchronous clearing has been set for the channel 1 and 2 counter clearing sources. Three-phase PWM waveforms are output from pins TIOCA0, TIOCA1, and TIOCA2. At this time, synchronous presetting, and synchronous clearing by TGRB_0 compare match, are performed for channel 0 to 2 TCNT counters, and the data set in TGRB_0 is used as the PWM cycle. For details of PWM modes, see section 10.4.5, PWM Modes. Synchronous clearing by TGRB_0 compare match TCNT0 to TCNT2 values TGRB_0 TGRB_1 TGRA_0 TGRB_2 TGRA_1 TGRA_2 Time H'0000 TIOCA_0 TIOCA_1 TIOCA_2 Figure 10.11 Example of Synchronous Operation 10.4.3 Buffer Operation Buffer operation, provided for channels 0 and 3, enables TGRC and TGRD to be used as buffer registers. Buffer operation differs depending on whether TGR has been designated as an input capture register or as a compare match register. Table 10.28 shows the register combinations used in buffer operation. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 212 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.28 Register Combinations in Buffer Operation Channel 0 3 Timer General Register Buffer Register TGRA_0 TGRC_0 TGRB_0 TGRD_0 TGRA_3 TGRC_3 TGRB_3 TGRD_3 • When TGR is an output compare register When a compare match occurs, the value in the buffer register for the corresponding channel is transferred to the timer general register. This operation is illustrated in figure 10.12. Compare match signal Timer general register Buffer register Comparator TCNT Figure 10.12 Compare Match Buffer Operation • When TGR is an input capture register When input capture occurs, the value in TCNT is transferred to TGR and the value previously held in the timer general register is transferred to the buffer register. This operation is illustrated in figure 10.13. Input capture signal Buffer register Timer general register TCNT Figure 10.13 Input Capture Buffer Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 213 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure: Figure 10.14 shows an example of the buffer operation setting procedure. Buffer operation Select TGR function [1] Set buffer operation [2] Start count [3] [1] Designate TGR as an input capture register or output compare register by means of TIOR. [2] Designate TGR for buffer operation with bits BFA and BFB in TMDR. [3] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 start the count operation. <Buffer operation> Figure 10.14 Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 214 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Examples of Buffer Operation: 1. When TGR is an output compare register Figure 10.15 shows an operation example in which PWM mode 1 has been designated for channel 0, and buffer operation has been designated for TGRA and TGRC. The settings used in this example are TCNT clearing by compare match B, 1 output at compare match A, and 0 output at compare match B. As buffer operation has been set, when compare match A occurs the output changes and the value in buffer register TGRC is simultaneously transferred to timer general register TGRA. This operation is repeated each time that compare match A occurs. For details of PWM modes, see section 10.4.5, PWM Modes. TCNT value TGRB_0 H'0520 H'0450 H'0200 TGRA_0 Time H'0000 TGRC_0 H'0200 H'0450 H'0520 Transfer TGRA_0 H'0200 H'0450 TIOCA Figure 10.15 Example of Buffer Operation (1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 215 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 2. When TGR is an input capture register Figure 10.16 shows an operation example in which TGRA has been designated as an input capture register, and buffer operation has been designated for TGRA and TGRC. Counter clearing by TGRA input capture has been set for TCNT, and both rising and falling edges have been selected as the TIOCA pin input capture input edge. As buffer operation has been set, when the TCNT value is stored in TGRA upon the occurrence of input capture A, the value previously stored in TGRA is simultaneously transferred to TGRC. TCNT value H'0F07 H'09FB H'0532 H'0000 Time TIOCA TGRA H'0532 TGRC H'0F07 H'09FB H'0532 H'0F07 Figure 10.16 Example of Buffer Operation (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 216 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.4.4 Cascaded Operation In cascaded operation, two 16-bit counters for different channels are used together as a 32-bit counter. This function works by counting the channel 1 (channel 4) counter clock upon overflow/underflow of TCNT_2 (TCNT_5) as set in bits TPSC0 to TPSC2 in TCR. Underflow occurs only when the lower 16-bit TCNT is in phase-counting mode. Table 10.29 shows the register combinations used in cascaded operation. Note: When phase counting mode is set for channel 1 or 4, the counter clock setting is invalid and the counters operates independently in phase counting mode. Table 10.29 Cascaded Combinations Combination Upper 16 Bits Lower 16 Bits Channels 1 and 2 TCNT_1 TCNT_2 Channels 4 and 5 TCNT_4 TCNT_5 Example of Cascaded Operation Setting Procedure: Figure 10.17 shows an example of the setting procedure for cascaded operation. Cascaded operation Set cascading [1] Start count [2] [1] Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in the channel 1 (channel 4) TCR to B'111 to select TCNT_2 (TCNT_5) overflow/underflow counting. [2] Set the CST bit in TSTR for the upper and lower channel to 1 to start the count operation. <Cascaded operation> Figure 10.17 Cascaded Operation Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 217 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Examples of Cascaded Operation: Figure 10.18 illustrates the operation when TCNT_2 overflow/underflow counting has been set for TCNT_1, when TGRA_1 and TGRA_2 have been designated as input capture registers, and when TIOC pin rising edge has been selected. When a rising edge is input to the TIOCA1 and TIOCA2 pins simultaneously, the upper 16 bits of the 32-bit data are transferred to TGRA_1, and the lower 16 bits to TGRA_2. TCNT_1 clock TCNT_1 H'03A1 H'03A2 TCNT_2 clock TCNT_2 H'FFFF H'0001 H'0000 TIOCA2, TIOCA1 TGRA_1 H'03A2 TGRA_2 H'0000 Figure 10.18 Example of Cascaded Operation (1) Figure 10.19 illustrates the operation when TCNT_2 overflow/underflow counting has been set for TCNT_1 and phase counting mode has been designated for channel 2. TCNT_1 is incremented by TCNT_2 overflow and decremented by TCNT_2 underflow. TCLKA TCLKB TCNT_2 TCNT_1 FFFD FFFE FFFF 0000 0000 0001 0002 0001 0000 0001 Figure 10.19 Example of Cascaded Operation (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 218 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 FFFF 0000 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.4.5 PWM Modes In PWM mode, PWM waveforms are output from the output pins. The output level can be selected as 0, 1, or toggle output in response to a compare match of each TGR. TGR registers settings can be used to output a PWM waveform in the range of 0% to 100% duty cycle. Designating TGR compare match as the counter clearing source enables the period to be set in that register. All channels can be designated for PWM mode independently. Synchronous operation is also possible. There are two PWM modes, as described below. • PWM mode 1 PWM output is generated from the TIOCA and TIOCC pins by pairing TGRA with TGRB and TGRC with TGRD. The output specified by bits IOA3 to IOA0 and IOC3 to IOC0 in TIOR is output from the TIOCA and TIOCC pins at compare matches A and C, and the output specified by bits IOB3 to IOB0 and IOD3 to IOD0 in TIOR is output at compare matches B and D. The initial output value is the value set in TGRA or TGRC. If the set values of paired TGRs are identical, the output value does not change when a compare match occurs. In PWM mode 1, a maximum 8-phase PWM output is possible. • PWM mode 2 PWM output is generated using one TGR as the cycle register and the others as duty cycle registers. The output specified in TIOR is performed by means of compare matches. Upon counter clearing by a duty cycle register compare match, the output value of each pin is the initial value set in TIOR. If the set values of the cycle and duty cycle registers are identical, the output value does not change when a compare match occurs. In PWM mode 2, a maximum 15-phase PWM output is possible in combination use with synchronous operation. The correspondence between PWM output pins and registers is shown in table 10.30. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 219 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.30 PWM Output Registers and Output Pins Output Pins Channel 0 Registers PWM Mode 1 PWM Mode 2 TGRA_0 TIOCA0 TIOCA0 TGRB_0 TGRC_0 TIOCB0 TIOCC0 TGRD_0 1 TGRA_1 TIOCD0 TIOCA1 TGRB_1 2 TGRA_2 TGRA_3 TIOCA2 TIOCA3 TGR4A_4 TIOCC3 TGRA_5 TGRB_5 Note: * TIOCC3 TIOCD3 TIOCA4 TGR4B_4 5 TIOCA3 TIOCB3 TGRD_3 4 TIOCA2 TIOCB2 TGRB_3 TGRC_3 TIOCA1 TIOCB1 TGRB_2 3 TIOCC0 TIOCA4 TIOCB4 TIOCA5 TIOCA5 TIOCB5 In PWM mode 2, PWM output is not possible for the TGR register in which the period is set. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 220 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure: Figure 10.20 shows an example of the PWM mode setting procedure. PWM mode Select counter clock [1] Select counter clearing source [2] Select waveform output level [3] Set TGR [4] Set PWM mode [5] Start count [6] [1] Select the counter clock with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. At the same time, select the input clock edge with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. [2] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to select the TGR to be used as the TCNT clearing source. [3] Use TIOR to designate the TGR as an output compare register, and select the initial value and output value. [4] Set the cycle in the TGR selected in [2], and set the duty in the other the TGR. [5] Select the PWM mode with bits MD3 to MD0 in TMDR. [6] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 start the count operation. <PWM mode> Figure 10.20 Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 221 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Examples of PWM Mode Operation: Figure 10.21 shows an example of PWM mode 1 operation. In this example, TGRA compare match is set as the TCNT clearing source, 0 is set for the TGRA initial output value and output value, and 1 is set as the TGRB output value. In this case, the value set in TGRA is used as the period, and the values set in the TGRB registers are used as the duty cycle levels. TCNT value Counter cleared by TGRA compare match TGRA TGRB H'0000 Time TIOCA Figure 10.21 Example of PWM Mode Operation (1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 222 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Figure 10.22 shows an example of PWM mode 2 operation. In this example, synchronous operation is designated for channels 0 and 1, TGRB_1 compare match is set as the TCNT clearing source, and 0 is set for the initial output value and 1 for the output value of the other TGR registers (TGRA_0 to TGRD_0, TGRA_1), outputting a 5-phase PWM waveform. In this case, the value set in TGRB_1 is used as the cycle, and the values set in the other TGRs are used as the duty cycle levels. TCNT value Counter cleared by TGRB_1 compare match TGRB_1 TGRA_1 TGRD_0 TGRC_0 TGRB_0 TGRA_0 H'0000 Time TIOCA0 TIOCB0 TIOCC0 TIOCD0 TIOCA1 Figure 10.22 Example of PWM Mode Operation (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 223 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Figure 10.23 shows examples of PWM waveform output with 0% duty cycle and 100% duty cycle in PWM mode. TCNT value TGRB rewritten TGRA TGRB TGRB rewritten TGRB rewritten H'0000 Time 0% duty TIOCA Output does not change when cycle register and duty register compare matches occur simultaneously TCNT value TGRB rewritten TGRA TGRB rewritten TGRB rewritten TGRB H'0000 Time 100% duty TIOCA Output does not change when cycle register and duty register compare matches occur simultaneously TCNT value TGRB rewritten TGRA TGRB rewritten TGRB TGRB rewritten Time H'0000 100% duty TIOCA 0% duty Figure 10.23 Example of PWM Mode Operation (3) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 224 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.4.6 Phase Counting Mode In phase counting mode, the phase difference between two external clock inputs is detected and TCNT is incremented/decremented accordingly. This mode can be set for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. When phase counting mode is set, an external clock is selected as the counter input clock and TCNT operates as an up/down-counter regardless of the setting of bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 and bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. However, the functions of bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR, and of TIOR, TIER, and TGR, are valid, and input capture/compare match and interrupt functions can be used. This can be used for two-phase encoder pulse input. If overflow occurs when TCNT is counting up, the TCFV flag in TSR is set; if underflow occurs when TCNT is counting down, the TCFU flag is set. The TCFD bit in TSR is the count direction flag. Reading the TCFD flag reveals whether TCNT is counting up or down. Table 10.31 shows the correspondence between external clock pins and channels. Table 10.31 Phase Counting Mode Clock Input Pins External Clock Pins Channels A-Phase B-Phase When channel 1 or 5 is set to phase counting mode TCLKA TCLKB When channel 2 or 4 is set to phase counting mode TCLKC TCLKD Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 225 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure: Figure 10.24 shows an example of the phase counting mode setting procedure. [1] Select phase counting mode with bits MD3 to MD0 in TMDR. [2] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count operation. Phase counting mode Select phase counting mode [1] Start count [2] <Phase counting mode> Figure 10.24 Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure Examples of Phase Counting Mode Operation: In phase counting mode, TCNT counts up or down according to the phase difference between two external clocks. There are four modes, according to the count conditions. 1. Phase counting mode 1 Figure 10.25 shows an example of phase counting mode 1 operation, and table 10.32 summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions. TCLKA (channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (channels 2 and 4) TCNT value Up-count Down-count Time Figure 10.25 Example of Phase Counting Mode 1 Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 226 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.32 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 1 TCLKA (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (Channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (Channels 2 and 4) Operation Up-count High level Low level Low level High level Down-count High level Low level High level Low level [Legend] : Rising edge : Falling edge 2. Phase counting mode 2 Figure 10.26 shows an example of phase counting mode 2 operation, and table 10.33 summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions. TCLKA (channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (channels 2 and 4) TCNT value Up-count Down-count Time Figure 10.26 Example of Phase Counting Mode 2 Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 227 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.33 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 2 TCLKA (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (Channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (Channels 2 and 4) Operation High level Don’t care Low level Don’t care Low level Don’t care High level Up-count High level Don’t care Low level Don’t care [Legend] : Rising edge : Falling edge Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 228 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 High level Don’t care Low level Down-count Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 3. Phase counting mode 3 Figure 10.27 shows an example of phase counting mode 3 operation, and table 10.34 summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions. TCLKA (channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (channels 2 and 4) TCNT value Down-count Up-count Time Figure 10.27 Example of Phase Counting Mode 3 Operation Table 10.34 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 3 TCLKA (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (Channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (Channels 2 and 4) Operation High level Don’t care Low level Don’t care Low level Don’t care High level Up-count High level Down-count Low level Don’t care High level Don’t care Low level Don’t care [Legend] : Rising edge : Falling edge Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 229 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 4. Phase counting mode 4 Figure 10.28 shows an example of phase counting mode 4 operation, and table 10.35 summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions. TCLKA (channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (channels 2 and 4) TCNT value Down-count Up-count Time Figure 10.28 Example of Phase Counting Mode 4 Operation Table 10.35 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 4 TCLKA (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKC (Channels 2 and 4) TCLKB (Channels 1 and 5) TCLKD (Channels 2 and 4) Operation Up-count High level Low level Low level Don’t care High level Down-count High level Low level High level Low level [Legend] : Rising edge : Falling edge Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 230 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Don’t care Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Phase Counting Mode Application Example: Figure 10.29 shows an example in which channel 1 is in phase counting mode, and channel 1 is coupled with channel 0 to input servo motor 2-phase encoder pulses in order to detect position or speed. Channel 1 is set to phase counting mode 1, and the encoder pulse A-phase and B-phase are input to TCLKA and TCLKB. Channel 0 operates with TCNT counter clearing by TGRC_0 compare match; TGRA_0 and TGRC_0 are used for the compare match function and are set with the speed control period and position control period. TGRB_0 is used for input capture, with TGRB_0 and TGRD_0 operating in buffer mode. The channel 1 counter input clock is designated as the TGRB_0 input capture source, and the pulse widths of 2-phase encoder 4-multiplication pulses are detected. TGRA_1 and TGRB_1 for channel 1 are designated for input capture, and channel 0 TGRA_0 and TGRC_0 compare matches are selected as the input capture source and store the up/down-counter values for the control periods. This procedure enables the accurate detection of position and speed. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 231 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Channel 1 TCLKA TCLKB Edge detection circuit TCNT_1 TGRA_1 (speed period capture) TGRB_1 (speed period capture) TCNT_0 TGRA_0 (speed control period) + - TGRC_0 (position control period) + - TGRB_0 (pulse width capture) TGRD_0 (buffer operation) Channel 0 Figure 10.29 Phase Counting Mode Application Example Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 232 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.5 Interrupt Sources There are three kinds of TPU interrupt source; TGR input capture/compare match, TCNT overflow, and TCNT underflow. Each interrupt source has its own status flag and enable/disabled bit, allowing the generation of interrupt request signals to be enabled or disabled individually. When an interrupt request is generated, the corresponding status flag in TSR is set to 1. If the corresponding enable/disable bit in TIER is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt is requested. The interrupt request is cleared by clearing the status flag to 0. Relative channel priorities can be changed by the interrupt controller, however the priority order within a channel is fixed. For details, see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Table 10.36 lists the TPU interrupt sources. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 233 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Table 10.36 TPU Interrupts Channel Name Interrupt Source DTC Interrupt Flag Activation 0 TGIA_0 TGRA_0 input capture/compare match TGFA_0 Possible TGIB_0 TGRB_0 input capture/compare match TGFB_0 Possible TGIC_0 TGRC_0 input capture/compare match TGFC_0 Possible TGID_0 TGRD_0 input capture/compare match TGFD_0 Possible TCIV_0 TCNT_0 overflow TCFV_0 Not possible TGIA_1 TGRA_1 input capture/compare match TGFA_1 Possible TGIB_1 TGRB_1 input capture/compare match TGFB_1 Possible TCIV_1 TCNT_1 overflow TCFV_1 Not possible TCIU_1 TCNT_1 underflow TCFU_1 Not possible TGIA_2 TGRA_2 input capture/compare match TGFA_2 Possible TGIB_2 TGRB_2 input capture/compare match TGFB_2 Possible TCIV_2 TCNT_2 overflow TCFV_2 Not possible TCIU_2 TCNT_2 underflow TCFU_2 Not possible TGIA_3 TGRA_3 input capture/compare match TGFA_3 Possible TGIB_3 TGRB_3 input capture/compare match TGFB_3 Possible TGIC_3 TGRC_3 input capture/compare match TGFC_3 Possible TGID_3 TGRD_3 input capture/compare match TGFD_3 Possible TCIV_3 TCNT_3 overflow TCFV_3 Not possible TGIA_4 TGRA_4 input capture/compare match TGFA_4 Possible TGIB_4 TGRB_4 input capture/compare match TGFB_4 Possible TCIV_4 TCNT_4 overflow TCFV_4 Not possible TCIU_4 TCNT_4 underflow TCFU_4 Not possible 1 2 3 4 5 TGIA_5 TGRA_5 input capture/compare match TGFA_5 Possible TGIB_5 TGRB_5 input capture/compare match TGFB_5 Possible TCIV_5 TCNT_5 overflow TCFV_5 Not possible TCIU_5 TCNT_5 underflow TCFU_5 Not possible Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 234 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TGIE bit in TIER is set to 1 when the TGF flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of a TGR input capture/compare match on a particular channel. The interrupt request is cleared by clearing the TGF flag to 0. The TPU has 16 input capture/compare match interrupts, four each for channels 0 and 3, and two each for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. Overflow Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TCIEV bit in TIER is set to 1 when the TCFV flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of TCNT overflow on a channel. The interrupt request is cleared by clearing the TCFV flag to 0. The TPU has six overflow interrupts, one for each channel. Underflow Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TCIEU bit in TIER is set to 1 when the TCFU flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of TCNT underflow on a channel. The interrupt request is cleared by clearing the TCFU flag to 0. The TPU has four underflow interrupts, one each for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. 10.6 DTC Activation The DTC can be activated by the TGR input capture/compare match interrupt for a channel. For details, see section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). A total of 16 TPU input capture/compare match interrupts can be used as DTC activation sources, four each for channels 0 and 3, and two each for channels 1, 2, 4, and 5. 10.7 A/D Converter Activation The A/D converter can be activated by the TGRA input capture/compare match for a channel. If the TTGE bit in TIER is set to 1 when the TGFA flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of a TGRA input capture/compare match on a particular channel, a request to begin A/D conversion is sent to the A/D converter. If the TPU conversion start trigger has been selected on the A/D converter side at this time, A/D conversion is begun. In the TPU, a total of six TGRA input capture/compare match interrupts can be used as A/D converter conversion start sources, one for each channel. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 235 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.8 Operation Timing 10.8.1 Input/Output Timing TCNT Count Timing: Figure 10.30 shows TCNT count timing in internal clock operation, and figure 10.31 shows TCNT count timing in external clock operation. φ Internal clock Falling edge Rising edge TCNT input clock TCNT N-1 N N+1 N+2 Figure 10.30 Count Timing in Internal Clock Operation φ External clock Falling edge Rising edge Falling edge TCNT input clock TCNT N-1 N N+1 Figure 10.31 Count Timing in External Clock Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 236 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 N+2 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Output Compare Output Timing: A compare match signal is generated in the final state in which TCNT and TGR match (the point at which the count value matched by TCNT is updated). When a compare match signal is generated, the output value set in TIOR is output at the output compare output pin. After a match between TCNT and TGR, the compare match signal is not generated until the TCNT input clock is generated. Figure 10.32 shows output compare output timing. φ TCNT input clock N+1 N TCNT N TGR Compare match signal TIOC pin Figure 10.32 Output Compare Output Timing Input Capture Signal Timing: Figure 10.33 shows input capture signal timing. φ Input capture input Input capture signal TCNT TGR N N+1 N+2 N N+2 Figure 10.33 Input Capture Input Signal Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 237 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Timing for Counter Clearing by Compare Match/Input Capture: Figure 10.34 shows the timing when counter clearing on compare match is specified, and figure 10.35 shows the timing when counter clearing on input capture is specified. φ Compare match signal Counter clear signal TCNT N TGR N H'0000 Figure 10.34 Counter Clear Timing (Compare Match) φ Input capture signal Counter clear signal TCNT N H'0000 N TGR Figure 10.35 Counter Clear Timing (Input Capture) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 238 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Buffer Operation Timing: Figures 10.36 and 10.37 show the timing in buffer operation. φ TCNT n n+1 Compare match signal TGRA, TGRB n TGRC, TGRD N N Figure 10.36 Buffer Operation Timing (Compare Match) φ Input capture signal TCNT N TGRA, TGRB n TGRC, TGRD N+1 N N+1 n N Figure 10.37 Buffer Operation Timing (Input Capture) 10.8.2 Interrupt Signal Timing TGF Flag Setting Timing in Case of Compare Match: Figure 10.38 shows the timing for setting of the TGF flag in TSR on compare match, and TGI interrupt request signal timing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 239 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) φ TCNT input clock TCNT N TGR N N+1 Compare match signal TGF flag TGI interrupt Figure 10.38 TGI Interrupt Timing (Compare Match) TGF Flag Setting Timing in Case of Input Capture: Figure 10.39 shows the timing for setting of the TGF flag in TSR on input capture, and TGI interrupt request signal timing. φ Input capture signal TCNT N TGR N TGF flag TGI interrupt Figure 10.39 TGI Interrupt Timing (Input Capture) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 240 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) TCFV Flag/TCFU Flag Setting Timing: Figure 10.40 shows the timing for setting of the TCFV flag in TSR on overflow, and TCIV interrupt request signal timing. Figure 10.41 shows the timing for setting of the TCFU flag in TSR on underflow, and TCIU interrupt request signal timing. φ TCNT input clock TCNT (overflow) H'FFFF H'0000 Overflow signal TCFV flag TCIV interrupt Figure 10.40 TCIV Interrupt Setting Timing φ TCNT input clock TCNT (underflow) H'0000 H'FFFF Underflow signal TCFU flag TCIU interrupt Figure 10.41 TCIU Interrupt Setting Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 241 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) Status Flag Clearing Timing: After a status flag is read as 1 by the CPU, it is cleared by writing 0 to it. When the DTC is activated, the flag is cleared automatically. Figure 10.42 shows the timing for status flag clearing by the CPU, and figure 10.43 shows the timing for status flag clearing by the DTC. TSR write cycle T1 T2 φ TSR address Address Write signal Status flag Interrupt request signal Figure 10.42 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by CPU DTC read cycle T1 T2 DTC write cycle T1 T2 φ Address Source address Destination address Status flag Interrupt request signal Figure 10.43 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by DTC Activation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 242 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9 Usage Notes 10.9.1 Module Stop Mode Setting TPU operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for TPU operation to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 10.9.2 Input Clock Restrictions The input clock pulse width must be at least 1.5 states in the case of single-edge detection, and at least 2.5 states in the case of both-edge detection. The TPU will not operate properly at narrower pulse widths. In phase counting mode, the phase difference and overlap between the two input clocks must be at least 1.5 states, and the pulse width must be at least 2.5 states. Figure 10.44 shows the input clock conditions in phase counting mode. Overlap Phase Phase differdifference Overlap ence Pulse width Pulse width TCLKA (TCLKC) TCLKB (TCLKD) Pulse width Pulse width Notes: Phase difference and overlap : 1.5 states or more Pulse width : 2.5 states or more Figure 10.44 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 243 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.3 Caution on Period Setting When counter clearing on compare match is set, TCNT is cleared in the final state in which it matches the TGR value (the point at which the count value matched by TCNT is updated). Consequently, the actual counter frequency is given by the following formula: φ f= (N + 1) Where 10.9.4 f : Counter frequency φ : Operating frequency N : TGR set value Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear Operations If the counter clear signal is generated in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, TCNT clearing takes precedence and the TCNT write is not performed. Figure 10.45 shows the timing in this case. TCNT write cycle T2 T1 φ TCNT address Address Write signal Counter clear signal TCNT N H'0000 Figure 10.45 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear Operations Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 244 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.5 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Operations If incrementing occurs in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the TCNT write takes precedence and TCNT is not incremented. Figure 10.46 shows the timing in this case. TCNT write cycle T1 T2 φ TCNT address Address Write signal TCNT input clock TCNT N M TCNT write data Figure 10.46 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Operations Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 245 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.6 Conflict between TGR Write and Compare Match If a compare match occurs in the T2 state of a TGR write cycle, the TGR write takes precedence and the compare match signal is inhibited. A compare match does not occur even if the previous value is written. Figure 10.47 shows the timing in this case. TGR write cycle T1 T2 φ TGR address Address Write signal Compare match signal Prohibited TCNT N N+1 TGR N M TGR write data Figure 10.47 Conflict between TGR Write and Compare Match Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 246 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.7 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match If a compare match occurs in the T2 state of a TGR write cycle, the data that is transferred to TGR by the buffer operation will be that in the buffer prior to the write. Figure 10.48 shows the timing in this case. TGR write cycle T2 T1 φ Buffer register address Address Write signal Compare match signal Buffer register write data Buffer register TGR N M N Figure 10.48 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 247 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.8 Conflict between TGR Read and Input Capture If an input capture signal is generated in the T1 state of a TGR read cycle, the data that is read will be that in the buffer after input capture transfer. Figure 10.49 shows the timing in this case. TGR read cycle T2 T1 φ TGR address Address Read signal Input capture signal TGR X Internal data bus M M Figure 10.49 Conflict between TGR Read and Input Capture Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 248 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.9 Conflict between TGR Write and Input Capture If an input capture signal is generated in the T2 state of a TGR write cycle, the input capture operation takes precedence and the write to TGR is not performed. Figure 10.50 shows the timing in this case. TGR write cycle T2 T1 φ TGR address Address Write signal Input capture signal TCNT TGR M M Figure 10.50 Conflict between TGR Write and Input Capture Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 249 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.10 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture If an input capture signal is generated in the T2 state of a buffer register write cycle, the buffer operation takes precedence and the write to the buffer register is not performed. Figure 10.51 shows the timing in this case. Buffer register write cycle T2 T1 φ Buffer register address Address Write signal Input capture signal TCNT TGR Buffer register N M N M Figure 10.51 Conflict between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 250 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.11 Conflict between Overflow/Underflow and Counter Clearing If overflow/underflow and counter clearing occur simultaneously, the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is not set and TCNT clearing takes precedence. Figure 10.52 shows the operation timing when a TGR compare match is specified as the clearing source, and when H'FFFF is set in TGR. φ TCNT input clock TCNT H'FFFF H'0000 Counter clear signal TGF Prohibited TCFV Figure 10.52 Conflict between Overflow and Counter Clearing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 251 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) 10.9.12 Conflict between TCNT Write and Overflow/Underflow If there is an up-count or down-count in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, and overflow/underflow occurs, the TCNT write takes precedence and the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is not set. Figure 10.53 shows the operation timing when there is conflict between TCNT write and overflow. TCNT write cycle T2 T1 φ TCNT address Address Write signal TCNT TCNT write data H'FFFF M Prohibited TCFV flag Figure 10.53 Conflict between TCNT Write and Overflow 10.9.13 Multiplexing of I/O Pins In this LSI, the TCLKA input pin is multiplexed with the TIOCC0 I/O pin, the TCLKB input pin with the TIOCD0 I/O pin, the TCLKC input pin with the TIOCB1 I/O pin, and the TCLKD input pin with the TIOCB2 I/O pin. When an external clock is input, compare match output should not be performed from a multiplexed pin. 10.9.14 Interrupts in Module Stop Mode If module stop mode is entered when an interrupt has been requested, it will not be possible to clear the CPU interrupt source or the DTC activation source. Interrupts should therefore be disabled before entering module stop mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 252 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Section 11 8-Bit Timers This LSI has an on-chip 8-bit timer module with four channels operating on the basis of an 8-bit counter. The 8-bit timer module can be used to count external events and be used as a multifunction timer in a variety of applications, such as generation of counter reset, interrupt requests, and pulse output with an arbitrary duty cycle using a compare-match signal with two registers. 11.1 Features • Selection of clock sources Selected from three internal clocks (φ/8, φ/64, and φ/8192) and an external clock. • Selection of three ways to clear the counters The counters can be cleared on compare-match A or B, or by an external reset signal. • Timer output controlled by two compare-match signals The timer output signal in each channel is controlled by two independent compare-match signals, enabling the timer to be used for various applications, such as the generation of pulse output or PWM output with an arbitrary duty cycle. • Cascading of the two channels Cascading of TMR_1 and TMR_0 The module can operate as a 16-bit timer using TMR_0 as the upper half and TMR_1 as the lower half (16-bit count mode). TMR_1 can be used to count TMR_0 compare-match occurrences (compare-match count mode). Cascading of TMR_3 and TMR_2 The module can operate as a 16-bit timer using TMR_2 as the upper half and TMR_3 as the lower half (16-bit count mode). TMR_3 can be used to count TMR_2 compare-match occurrences (compare-match count mode). • Multiple interrupt sources for each channel Two compare-match interrupts and one overflow interrupt can be requested independently. • Generation of A/D conversion start trigger Channel 0 compare-match A signal can be used as the A/D conversion start trigger. • Module stop mode can be set At initialization, the 8-bit timer operation is halted. Register access is enabled by canceling the module stop mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 253 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Figure 11.1 shows a block diagram of the 8-bit timer module (TMR_1 and TMR_0). External clock sources Internal clock sources φ/8 φ/64 φ/8192 TMCI01 Clock 1 Clock 0 Clock select Compare-match A1 Compare-match A0 Comparator A_0 Overflow 1 Overflow 0 TMO0 TMRI01 TCNT_0 TCORA_1 Comparator A_1 TCNT_1 Clear 0 Clear 1 Compare-match B1 Compare-match B0 Comparator B_0 TMO1 Comparator B_1 Control logic TCORB_0 TCORB_1 TCSR_0 TCSR_1 TCR_0 TCR_1 A/D conversion start request signal CMIA0 CMIB0 OVI0 CMIA1 CMIB1 OVI1 Interrupt signals [Legend] TCORA_0: TCORB_0: TCNT_0: TCSR_0: TCR_0: Time constant register A_0 Time constant register B_0 Timer counter_0 Timer control/status register_0 Timer control register_0 TCORA_1: TCORB_1: TCNT_1: TCSR_1: TCR_1: Time constant register A_1 Time constant register B_1 Timer counter_1 Timer control/status register_1 Timer control register_1 Figure 11.1 Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer Module Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 254 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Internal bus TCORA_0 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.2 Input/Output Pins Table 11.1 summarizes the input and output pins of the 8-bit timer module. Table 11.1 Pin Configuration Channel 0 1 2 Name Symbol I/O Function Timer output0 TMO0 Output Compare-match output Timer clock input01 TMCI01 Input External clock input for the counter Timer reset input01 TMRI01 Input External reset input for the counter Timer output1 Output Compare-match output Timer clock input23 TMCI23 Input External clock input for the counter Timer reset input23 TMRI23 Input External reset input for the counter Timer output2 Output Compare-match output Input External clock input for the counter TMO1 TMO2 Timer clock input23 TMCI23 3 11.3 Timer reset input23 TMRI23 Input External reset input for the counter Timer output3 Output Compare-match output Timer clock input01 TMCI01 Input External clock input for the counter Timer reset input01 TMRI01 Input External reset input for the counter TMO3 Register Descriptions The 8-bit timer has the following registers. For details on the module stop register, refer to section 20.1.2, Module Stop Control Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC). • • • • • • • • • • • Timer counter_0 (TCNT_0) Time constant register A_0 (TCORA_0) Time constant register B_0 (TCORB_0) Timer control register_0 (TCR_0) Timer control/status register_0 (TCSR_0) Timer counter_1 (TCNT_1) Time constant register A_1 (TCORA_1) Time constant register B_1 (TCORB_1) Timer control register_1 (TCR_1) Timer control/status register_1 (TCSR_1) Timer counter_2 (TCNT_2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 255 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers • • • • • • • • • Time constant register A_2 (TCORA_2) Time constant register B_2 (TCORB_2) Timer control register_2 (TCR_2) Timer control/status register_2 (TCSR_2) Timer counter_3 (TCNT_3) Time constant register A_3 (TCORA_3) Time constant register B_3 (TCORB_3) Timer control register_3 (TCR_3) Timer control/status register_3 (TCSR_3) 11.3.1 Timer Counters (TCNT) Each TCNT is an 8-bit up-counter. TCNT_1 and TCNT_0, or TCNT_3 and TCNT_2 comprise a single 16-bit register, so they can be accessed together by word access. This clock source is selected by clock select bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR. TCNT can be cleared by an external reset input signal or compare-match signals A and B. Counter clear bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR select the method of clearing. When TCNT overflows from H'FF to H'00, the overflow flag (OVF) in TCSR is set to 1. The initial value of TCNT is H'00. 11.3.2 Time Constant Registers A (TCORA) TCORA is an 8-bit readable/writable register. TCORA_3, TCORA_2, TCORA_1 and TCORA_0 comprise a single 16-bit register, so they can be accessed together by word access. TCORA is continually compared with the value in TCNT. When a match is detected, the corresponding compare-match flag A (CMFA) in TCSR is set. Note, however, that comparison is disabled during the T2 state of a TCORA write cycle. The timer output from the TMO pin can be freely controlled by the compare-match signal A and the settings of output select bits OS1 and OS0 in TCSR. The initial value of TCORA is H'FF. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 256 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.3.3 Time Constant Registers B (TCORB) TCORB is an 8-bit readable/writable register. TCORB_3, TCORB_2, TCORB_1 and TCORB_0 comprise a single 16-bit register, so they can be accessed together by word access. TCORB is continually compared with the value in TCNT. When a match is detected, the corresponding compare-match flag B (CMFB) in TCSR is set. Note, however, that comparison is disabled during the T2 state of a TCORB write cycle. The timer output from the TMO pin can be freely controlled by the compare-match signal B and the settings of output select bits OS1 and OS0 in TCSR. The initial value of TCORB is H'FF. 11.3.4 Timer Control Registers (TCR) TCR selects the TCNT clock source and the time at which TCNT is cleared, and controls interrupt requests. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 CMIEB 0 R/W Compare-Match Interrupt Enable B Selects whether the CMFB interrupt request (CMIB) is enabled or disabled when the CMFB flag in TCSR is set to 1. 0: CMFB interrupt request (CMIB) is disabled 1: CMFB interrupt request (CMIB) is enabled 6 CMIEA 0 R/W Compare-Match Interrupt Enable A Selects whether the CMFA interrupt request (CMIA) is enabled or disabled when the CMFA flag in TCSR is set to 1. 0: CMFA interrupt request (CMIA) is disabled 1: CMFA interrupt request (CMIA) is enabled 5 OVIE 0 R/W Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable Selects whether the OVF interrupt request (OVI) is enabled or disabled when the OVF flag in TCSR is set to 1. 0: OVF interrupt request (OVI) is disabled 1: OVF interrupt request (OVI) is enabled Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 257 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Bit Bit Name 4 CCLR1 3 CCLR0 Initial Value R/W Description 0 0 R/W R/W Counter Clear 1 and 0 These bits select the method by which TCNT is cleared 00: Clearing is disabled 01: Cleared on compare-match A 10: Cleared on compare-match B 11: Cleared on rising edge of external reset input 2 CKS2 0 R/W Clock Select 2 to 0 1 CKS1 0 R/W 0 CKS0 0 R/W The input clock can be selected from three clocks divided from the system clock (φ). When use of an external clock is selected, three types of count can be selected: at the rising edge, the falling edge, and both rising and falling edges. 000: Clock input disabled 001: φ/8 internal clock source, counted on the falling edge 010: φ/64 internal clock source, counted on the falling edge 011: φ/8192 internal clock source, counted on the falling edge 100: For channel 0: Counted on TCNT1 overflow signal* For channel 1: Counted on TCNT0 overflow signal* For channel 2: Counted on TCNT3 overflow signal* For channel 3: Counted on TCNT2 overflow signal* 101: External clock source, counted at rising edge 110: External clock source, counted at falling edge 111: External clock source, counted at both rising and falling edges Note: * If the count input of channel 0 (channel 2) is the TCNT1 (TCNT3) overflow signal and that of channel 1 (channel 3) is the TCNT1 (TCNT3) compare-match signal, no incrementing clock will be generated. Do not use this setting. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 258 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.3.5 Timer Control/Status Registers (TCSR) TCSR indicates status flags and controls compare-match output. • TCSR_0 Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 CMFB 0 R/(W)* Compare-Match Flag B [Setting condition] • When TCNT = TCORB [Clearing conditions] 6 CMFA 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFB when CMFB = 1, then write 0 in CMFB. • DTC is activated by the CMIB interrupt and the DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of TDC. Compare-match Flag A [Setting condition] • When TCNT = TCORA [Clearing conditions] 5 OVF 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFA when CMFA = 1, then write 0 in CMFA. • DTC is activated by the CMIA interrupt and DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of DTC. Timer Overflow Flag [Setting condition] • When TCNT overflows from H'FF to H'00 [Clearing condition] • 4 ADTE 0 R/W Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF A/D Trigger Enable Enables or disables A/D converter start requests by compare-match A. 0: A/D converter start requests by compare-match A are disabled 1: A/D converter start requests by compare-match A are enabled Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 259 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 3 OS3 0 R/W Output Select 3 and 2 2 OS2 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match B of TCORB and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match B occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match B occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match B occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match B occurs (toggle output) 1 OS1 0 R/W Output Select 1 and 0 0 OS0 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match A of TCORA and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match A occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match A occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match A occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match A occurs (toggle output) Note: * Only a 0 can be written to this bit, to clear the flag Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 260 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers • TCSR_3 and TCSR_1 Bit 7 Bit Name CMFB Initial Value R/W Description 0 R/(W)* Compare-Match Flag B [Setting condition] • When TCNT = TCORB [Clearing conditions] 6 CMFA 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFB when CMFB = 1, then write 0 in CMFB • DTC is activated by the CMIB interrupt and the DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of DTC. Compare-match Flag A [Setting condition] • When TCNT = TCORA [Clearing conditions] 5 OVF 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFA when CMFA = 1, then write 0 in CMFA • DTC is activated by the CMIA interrupt and the DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of DTC. Timer Overflow Flag [Setting condition] • When TCNT overflows from H'FF to H'00 [Clearing condition] • 4 1 Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF Reserved This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 3 OS3 0 R/W Output Select 3 and 2 2 OS2 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match B of TCORB and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match B occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match B occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match B occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match B occurs (toggle output) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 261 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 1 OS1 0 R/W Output Select 1 and 0 0 OS0 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match A of TCORA and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match A occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match A occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match A occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match A occurs (toggle output) Note: * Only a 0 can be written to this bit, to clear the flag. • TCSR_2 Bit 7 Bit Name CMFB Initial Value R/W Description 0 R/(W)* Compare-Match Flag B [Setting condition] • When TCNT = TCORB [Clearing conditions] 6 CMFA 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFB when CMFB = 1, then write 0 in CMFB • DTC is activated by the CMIB interrupt and the DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of DTC. Compare-match Flag A [Setting condition] When TCNT = TCORA [Clearing conditions] 5 OVF 0 R/(W)* • Read CMFA when CMFA = 1, then write 0 in CMFA • DTC is activated by the CMIA interrupt and the DISEL bit = 0 in MRB of DTC. Timer Overflow Flag [Setting condition] • When TCNT overflows from H'FF to H'00 [Clearing condition] • Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 262 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF Section 11 8-Bit Timers Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 4 0 R/W Reserved This bit is a readable/writable bit, but the write value should always be 0. 3 OS3 0 R/W Output Select 3 and 2 2 OS2 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match B of TCORB and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match B occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match B occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match B occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match B occurs (toggle output) 1 OS1 0 R/W Output Select 1 and 0 0 OS0 0 R/W These bits specify how the timer output level is to be changed by a compare-match A of TCORA and TCNT. 00: No change when compare-match A occurs 01: 0 is output when compare-match A occurs 10: 1 is output when compare-match A occurs 11: Output is inverted when compare-match A occurs (toggle output) Note: * Only a 0 can be written to this bit, to clear the flag. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 263 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.4 Operation 11.4.1 Pulse Output Figure 11.2 shows an example of arbitrary duty cycle pulse output. 1. 2. Set TCR in CCR1 to 0 and CCLR0 to 1 to clear TCNT by a TCORA compare-match. Set OS3 to OS0 bits in TCSR to B'0110 to output 1 by a compare-match A and 0 by comparematch B. By the above settings, waveforms with the cycle of TCORA and the pulse width of TCRB can be output without software intervention. TCNT H'FF Counter clear TCORA TCORB H'00 TMO Figure 11.2 Example of Pulse Output Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 264 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.5 Operation Timing 11.5.1 TCNT Incrementation Timing Figure 11.3 shows the TCNT count timing with internal clock source. Figure 11.4 shows the TCNT incrementation timing with external clock source. The pulse width of the external clock for incrementation at signal edge must be at least 1.5 system clock (φ) periods, and at least 2.5 states for incrementation at both edges. The counter will not increment correctly if the pulse width is less than these values. φ Internal clock TCNT input clock TCNT N–1 N N+1 Figure 11.3 Count Timing for Internal Clock Input φ External clock input pin TCNT input clock TCNT N–1 N N+1 Figure 11.4 Count Timing for External Clock Input Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 265 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.5.2 Timing of CMFA and CMFB Setting When a Compare-Match Occurs The CMFA and CMFB flags in TCSR are set to 1 by a compare-match signal generated when the TCOR and TCNT values match. The compare-match signal is generated at the last state in which the match is true, just before the timer counter is updated. Therefore, when TCOR and TCNT match, the compare-match signal is not generated until the next incrementation clock input. Figure 11.5 shows the timing of CMF flag setting. φ TCNT N TCOR N N+1 Compare-match signal CMF Figure 11.5 Timing of CMF Setting 11.5.3 Timing of Timer Output When a Compare-Match Occurs When a compare-match occurs, the timer output changes as specified by the output select bits (OS3 to OS0) in TCSR. Figure 11.6 shows the timing when the output is set to toggle at comparematch A. φ Compare-match A signal Timer output pin Figure 11.6 Timing of Timer Output Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 266 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.5.4 Timing of Compare-Match Clear When a Compare-Match Occurs TCNT is cleared when compare-match A or B occurs, depending on the setting of the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR. Figure 11.7 shows the timing of this operation. φ Compare-match signal N TCNT H'00 Figure 11.7 Timing of Compare-Match Clear 11.5.5 TCNT External Reset Timing TCNT is cleared at the rising edge of an external reset input, depending on the settings of the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR. The width of the clearing pulse must be at least 1.5 states. Figure 11.8 shows the timing of this operation. φ External reset input pin Clear signal TCNT N–1 N H'00 Figure 11.8 Timing of Clearing by External Reset Input Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 267 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.5.6 Timing of Overflow Flag (OVF) Setting OVF in TCSR is set to 1 when the timer count overflows (changes from H'FF to H'00). Figure 11.9 shows the timing of this operation. φ TCNT H'FF H'00 Overflow signal OVF Figure 11.9 Timing of OVF Setting Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 268 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.6 Operation with Cascaded Connection If bits CKS2 to CKS0 in one of TCR_1 and TCR_0, or TCR_3 and TCR_2 are set to B'100, the 8bit timers of the two channels are cascaded. With this configuration, a single 16-bit timer can be used (16-bit timer mode) or compare-matches of 8-bit channel 0 (Channel 2) can be counted by the timer of channel 1 (Channel 3) (compare-match count mode). In the case that channel 0 is connected to channel 1 in cascade, the timer operates as described below. 11.6.1 16-Bit Count Mode When bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR_0 are set to B'100, the timer functions as a single 16-bit timer with channel 0 occupying the upper 8 bits and channel 1 occupying the lower 8 bits. • Setting of compare-match flags The CMF flag in TCSR_0 is set to 1 when a 16-bit compare-match occurs. The CMF flag in TCSR_1 is set to 1 when a lower 8-bit compare-match occurs. • Counter clear specification If the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR_0 have been set for counter clear at compare-match, the 16-bit counter (TCNT_1 and TCNT_0 together) is cleared when a 16-bit comparematch occurs. The 16-bit counter (TCNT_1 and TCNT_0 together) is cleared even if counter clear by the TMRI01 pin has also been set. The settings of the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR_1 are ignored. The lower 8 bits cannot be cleared independently. • Pin output Control of output from the TMO0 pin by bits OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_0 is in accordance with the 16-bit compare-match conditions. Control of output from the TMO1 pin by bits OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_1 is in accordance with the lower 8-bit compare-match conditions. 11.6.2 Compare-Match Count Mode When bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR_1 are B'100, TCNT_1 counts compare-match A for channel 0. Channels 0 and 1 are controlled independently. Conditions such as setting of the CMF flag, generation of interrupts, output from the TMO pin, and counter clearing are in accordance with the settings for each channel. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 269 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.7 Interrupt Sources 11.7.1 Interrupt Sources and DTC Activation The 8-bit timer can generate three types of interrupt: CMIA, CMIB, and OVI. Table 11.2 shows the interrupt sources and priority. Each interrupt source can be enabled or disabled independently by interrupt enable bits in TCR. Independent signals are sent to the interrupt controller for each interrupt. It is also possible to activate the DTC by means of CMIA and CMIB interrupts. Table 11.2 8-Bit Timer Interrupt Sources Interrupt source Description Flag DTC Activation Interrupt Priority CMIA0 TCORA_0 compare-match CMFA Possible High CMIB0 TCORB_0 compare-match CMFB Possible OVI0 TCNT_0 overflow OVF Not possible CMIA1 TCORA_1 compare-match CMFA Possible CMIB1 TCORB_1 compare-match CMFB Possible OVI1 TCNT_1 overflow OVF Not possible CMIA2 TCORA_2 compare-match CMFA Possible CMIB2 TCORB_2 compare-match CMFB Possible OVI2 TCNT_2 overflow OVF Not possible CMIA3 TCORA_3 compare-match CMFA Possible CMIB3 TCORB_3 compare-match CMFB Possible OVI3 TCNT_3 overflow OVF Not possible 11.7.2 Low A/D Converter Activation The A/D converter can be activated only by channel 0 compare match A. If the ADTE bit in TCSR0 is set to 1 when the CMFA flag is set to 1 by the occurrence of channel 0 compare match A, a request to start A/D conversion is sent to the A/D converter. If the 8-bit timer conversion start trigger has been selected on the A/D converter side at this time, A/D conversion is started. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 270 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.8 Usage Notes 11.8.1 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the clear takes priority, so that the counter is cleared and the write is not performed. Figure 11.10 shows this operation. TCNT write cycle by CPU T1 T2 φ Address TCNT address Internal write signal Counter clear signal TCNT N H'00 Figure 11.10 Conflict between TCNT Write and Clear Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 271 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.8.2 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the write takes priority and the counter is not incremented. Figure 11.11 shows this operation. TCNT write cycle by CPU T1 T2 φ Address TCNT address Internal write signal TCNT input clock TCNT N M Counter write data Figure 11.11 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 272 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.8.3 Conflict between TCOR Write and Compare-Match During the T2 state of a TCOR write cycle, the TCOR write has priority even if a compare-match occurs and the compare-match signal is disabled. Figure 11.12 shows this operation. TCOR write cycle by CPU T1 T2 φ Address TCOR address Internal write signal TCNT N N+1 TCOR N M TCOR write data Compare-match signal Prohibited Figure 11.12 Conflict between TCOR Write and Compare-Match 11.8.4 Conflict between Compare-Matches A and B If compare-matches A and B occur at the same time, the 8-bit timer operates in accordance with the priorities for the output states set for compare-match A and compare-match B, as shown in table 11.3. Table 11.3 Timer Output Priorities Output Setting Priority Toggle output High 1 output 0 output No change Low Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 273 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers 11.8.5 Switching of Internal Clocks and TCNT Operation TCNT may increment erroneously when the internal clock is switched over. Table 11.4 shows the relationship between the timing at which the internal clock is switched (by writing to the CKS1 and CKS0 bits) and the TCNT operation. When the TCNT clock is generated from an internal clock, the falling edge of the internal clock pulse is detected. If clock switching causes a change from high to low level, as shown in no. 3 in table 11.4, a TCNT clock pulse is generated on the assumption that the switchover is a falling edge. This increments TCNT. Erroneous incrementation can also happen when switching between internal and external clocks. Table 11.4 Switching of Internal Clock and TCNT Operation No. 1 Timing of Switchover by Means of CKS1 and CKS0 Bits Switching from low 1 to low* TCNT Clock Operation Clock before switchover Clock after switchover TCNT clock TCNT N N+1 CKS bit rewrite 2 Switching from low to high*2 Clock before switchover Clock after switchover TCNT clock TCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bit rewrite Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 274 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers No. 3 Timing of Switchover by Means of CKS1 and CKS0 Bits Switching from high 3 to low* TCNT Clock Operation Clock before switchover Clock after switchover *4 TCNT clock TCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bit rewrite 4 Switching from high to high Clock before switchover Clock after switchover TCNT clock TCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bit rewrite Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 11.8.6 Includes switching from low to stop, and from stop to low. Includes switching from stop to high. Includes switching from high to stop. Generated on the assumption that the switchover is a falling edge; TCNT is incremented. Conflict between Interrupts and Module Stop Mode If module stop mode is entered when an interrupt has been requested, it will not be possible to clear the CPU interrupt source or the DTC activation source. Interrupts should therefore be disabled before entering module stop mode. 11.8.7 Notes on Cascaded Connection If 16-bit count mode and compare-match count mode are set simultaneously, the counter stops and does not operate since input clocks of TCNT_1 and TCNT_0 (TCNT_3 and TCNT_2) are not generated. This setting is prohibited. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 275 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 11 8-Bit Timers Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 276 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) The programmable pulse generator provides pulse outputs using the 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) as a time base. The PPG pulse outputs are divided into 4-bit groups (group 3 and group 2) that can operate both simultaneously and independently. The block diagram of the PPG is shown in figure 12.1. 12.1 • • • • • • • Features 8-bit output data Two output groups Selectable output trigger signals Non-overlap mode Can operate in tandem with the data transfer controller (DTC) Settable inverted output Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 277 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Compare match signals Control logic PO15 PO14 PO13 PO12 PO11 PO10 PO9 PO8 NDERH NDERL PMR PCR Pulse output pins, group 3 PODRH NDRH PODRL NDRL Pulse output pins, group 2 Pulse output pins, group 1 Pulse output pins, group 0 [Legend] PMR: PCR: NDERH: NDERL: NDRH: NDRL: PODRH: PODRL: PPG output mode register PPG output control register Next data enable register H Next data enable register L Next data register H Next data register L Output data register H Output data register L Figure 12.1 Block Diagram of PPG Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 278 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Internal data bus Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.2 Input/Output Pins Table 12.1 summarizes the pin configuration of the PPG. Table 12.1 Pin Configuration Pin Name I/O Function PO15 Output Group 3 pulse output PO14 Output PO13 Output PO12 Output PO11 Output PO10 Output PO9 Output PO8 Output 12.3 Group 2 pulse output Register Descriptions The PPG has the following registers. • • • • • • • • PPG output control register (PCR) PPG output mode register (PMR) Next data enable register H (NDERH) Next data enable register L (NDERL) Output data register H (PODRH) Output data register L (PODRL) Next data register H (NDRH) Next data register L (NDRL) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 279 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.3.1 Next Data Enable Registers H, L (NDERH, NDERL) NDERH and NDERL are 8-bit readable/writable registers that enable or disable pulse output on a bit-by-bit basis. The corresponding DDR also needs to be set to 1 in order to enable pulse output by the PPG. • NDERH Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDER15 0 R/W Next Data Enable 15 to 8 6 NDER14 0 R/W 5 NDER13 0 R/W 4 NDER12 0 R/W 3 NDER11 0 R/W When a bit is set to 1 for pulse output by NDRH, the value in the corresponding NDRH bit is transferred to the PODRH bit by the selected output trigger. Values are not transferred from NDRH to PODRH for cleared bits. 2 NDER10 0 R/W 1 NDER9 0 R/W 0 NDER8 0 R/W • NDERL Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDER7 0 R/W Next Data Enable 7 to 0 6 NDER6 0 R/W 5 NDER5 0 R/W 4 NDER4 0 R/W 3 NDER3 0 R/W When a bit is set to 1 for pulse output by NDRL, the value in the corresponding NDRL bit is transferred to the PODRL bit by the selected output trigger. Values are not transferred from NDRL to PODRL for cleared bits. 2 NDER2 0 R/W 1 NDER1 0 R/W 0 NDER0 0 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 280 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.3.2 Output Data Registers H, L (PODRH, PODRL) PODRH and PODRL are 8-bit readable/writable registers that store output data for use in pulse output. A bit that has been set for pulse output by NDER is read-only and cannot be modified. • PODRH Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 POD15 0 R/W Output Data Register 15 to 8 6 POD14 0 R/W 5 POD13 0 R/W 4 POD12 0 R/W 3 POD11 0 R/W 2 POD10 0 R/W For bits that have been set to pulse output by NDERH, the output trigger transfers NDRH values to this register during PPG operation. While NDERH is set to 1, the CPU cannot write to this register. While NDERH is cleared, the initial output value of the pulse can be set. 1 POD9 0 R/W 0 POD8 0 R/W • PODRL Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 POD7 0 R/W Output Data Register 7 to 0 6 POD6 0 R/W 5 POD5 0 R/W 4 POD4 0 R/W 3 POD3 0 R/W 2 POD2 0 R/W For bits which have been set to pulse output by NDERL, the output trigger transfers NDRL values to this register during PPG operation. While NDERL is set to 1, the CPU cannot write to this register. While NDERL is cleared, the initial output value of the pulse can be set. 1 POD1 0 R/W 0 POD0 0 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 281 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.3.3 Next Data Registers H, L (NDRH, NDRL) NDRH and NDRL are 8-bit readable/writable registers that store the data for the next pulse output. The NDR addresses differ depending on whether pulse output groups have the same output trigger or different output triggers. • NDRH If pulse output groups 3 and 2 have the same output trigger, all eight bits are mapped to the same address and can be accessed at one time, as shown below. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDR15 0 R/W Next Data Register 15 to 8 6 NDR14 0 R/W 5 NDR13 0 R/W 4 NDR12 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRH bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. 3 NDR11 0 R/W 2 NDR10 0 R/W 1 NDR9 0 R/W 0 NDR8 0 R/W If pulse output groups 3 and output pulse groups 2 have different output triggers, the upper 4 bits and the lower 4 bits are mapped to different addresses, as shown below. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDR15 0 R/W Next Data Register 15 to 12 6 NDR14 0 R/W 5 NDR13 0 R/W 4 NDR12 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRH bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. All 1 3 to 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 282 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Bit Bit Name 7 to 4 Initial Value R/W Description All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 3 NDR11 0 R/W Next Data Register 11 to 8 2 NDR10 0 R/W 1 NDR9 0 R/W 0 NDR8 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRH bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. • NDRL If pulse output groups 1 and 0 have the same output trigger, all eight bits are mapped to the same address and can be accessed at one time, as shown below. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDR7 0 R/W Next Data Register 7 to 0 6 NDR6 0 R/W 5 NDR5 0 R/W 4 NDR4 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRL bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. 3 NDR3 0 R/W 2 NDR2 0 R/W 1 NDR1 0 R/W 0 NDR0 0 R/W If pulse output groups 1 and output pulse groups 0 have different output triggers, upper 4 bits and lower 4 bits are mapped to the different addresses as shown below. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 NDR7 0 R/W Next Data Register 7 to 4 6 NDR6 0 R/W 5 NDR5 0 R/W 4 NDR4 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRL bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. All 1 3 to 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 283 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Bit Bit Name 7 to 4 Initial Value R/W Description All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. 3 NDR3 0 R/W Next Data Register 3 to 0 2 NDR2 0 R/W 1 NDR1 0 R/W 0 NDR0 0 R/W The register contents are transferred to the corresponding PODRL bits by the output trigger specified with PCR. 12.3.4 PPG Output Control Register (PCR) PCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects output trigger signals on a group-by-group basis. For details on output trigger selection, refer to section 12.3.5, PPG Output Mode Register (PMR). Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 G3CMS1 1 R/W Group 3 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 6 G3CMS0 1 R/W Select output trigger of pulse output group 3. 00: Compare match in TPU channel 0 01: Compare match in TPU channel 1 10: Compare match in TPU channel 2 11: Compare match in TPU channel 3 5 4 G2CMS1 1 R/W Group 2 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 G2CMS0 1 R/W Select output trigger of pulse output group 2. 00: Compare match in TPC channel 0 01: Compare match in TPC channel 1 10: Compare match in TPC channel 2 11: Compare match in TPC channel 3 3 G1CMS1 1 R/W 2 G1CMS0 1 R/W 1 G0CMS1 1 R/W 0 G0CMS0 1 R/W Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 284 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Reserved Reserved Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.3.5 PPG Output Mode Register (PMR) The PMR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the pulse output mode of the PPG for each group. If inverted output is selected, a low-level pulse is output when PODRH is 1 and a high-level pulse is output when PODRH is 0. If non-overlapping operation is selected, PPG updates its output values on compare match A or B of the TPU that becomes the output trigger. For details, refer to section 12.4.5, Non-Overlapping Pulse Output. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 G3INV 1 R/W Group 3 Inversion Selects direct output or inverted output for pulse output group 3. 0: Inverted output 1: Direct output 6 G2INV 1 R/W Group 2 Inversion Selects direct output or inverted output for pulse output group 2. 0: Inverted output 1: Direct output 5, 4 All 1 R/W Reserved 3 G3NOV 0 R/W Group 3 Non-Overlap Selects normal or non-overlapping operation for pulse output group 3. 0: Normal operation (output values updated at compare match A in the selected TPU channel) 1: Non-overlapping operation (output values at compare match A or B in the selected TPU channel) 2 G2NOV 0 R/W Group 2 Non-Overlap Selects normal or non-overlapping operation for pulse output group 2. 0: Normal operation (output values updated at compare match A in the selected TPU channel) 1: Non-overlapping operation (output values at compare match A or B in the selected TPU channel) 1, 0 All 0 R/W Reserved Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 285 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4 Operation 12.4.1 Overview Figure 12.2 shows a block diagram of the PPG. PPG pulse output is enabled when the corresponding bits in P1DDR and NDER are set to 1. An initial output value is determined by its corresponding PODR initial setting. When the compare match event specified by PCR occurs, the corresponding NDR bit contents are transferred to PODR to update the output values. The sequential output of up to 8 bits of data is possible by writing new output data to NDR before the next compare match. NDER DDR Q Output trigger signal C Q PODR D Q NDR D Pulse output pin Normal output/inverted output Figure 12.2 PPG Output Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 286 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Internal data bus Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.2 Output Timing If pulse output is enabled, the contents of NDR contents are transferred to PODR and output when the specified compare match event occurs. Figure 12.3 shows the timing of these operations for the case of normal output in groups 3 and 2, triggered by compare match A. φ N TCNT TGRA N+1 N Compare match A signal n NDRH PODRH PO15 to PO8 m n m n Figure 12.3 Timing of Transfer and Output of NDR Contents (Example) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 287 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.3 Sample Setup Procedure for Normal Pulse Output Figure 12.4 shows a sample procedure for setting up normal pulse output. Normal PPG output [1] Set TIOR to make TGRA an output compare register (with output disabled). Select TGR functions [1] Set TGRA value [2] Set counting operation [3] Select interrupt request [4] Set initial output data [5] [4] Enable the TGIA interrupt in TIER. The DTC can also be set up to transfer data to NDR. Enable pulse output [6] [5] Set the initial output values in PODR. Select output trigger [7] [6] Set the DDR and NDER bits for the pins to be used for pulse output to 1. Set next pulse output data [8] [7] Select the TPU compare match event to be used as the output trigger in PCR. Start counter [9] [8] Set the next pulse output values in NDR. [2] Set the PPG output trigger period. TPU setup Port and PPG setup TPU setup Compare match? No Yes Set next pulse output data [10] [3] Select the counter clock source with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0. [9] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the TCNT counter. [10] At each TGIA interrupt, set the next output values in NDR. Figure 12.4 Setup Procedure for Normal Pulse Output (Example) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 288 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.4 Example of Normal Pulse Output (Example of Five-Phase Pulse Output) Figure 12.5 shows an example in which pulse output is used for cyclic five-phase pulse output. TCNT value Compare match TCNT TGRA H'0000 Time 80 NDRH PODRH 00 C0 80 40 C0 60 40 20 60 30 20 10 30 18 10 08 18 88 08 80 88 C0 80 40 C0 PO15 PO14 PO13 PO12 PO11 Figure 12.5 Normal Pulse Output Example (Five-Phase Pulse Output) 1. Set up TGRA of the TPU that is used as the output trigger to be an output compare register. Set a frequency in TGRA so the counter will be cleared on compare match A. Set the TGIEA bit of TIER to 1 to enable the compare match/input capture A (TGIA) interrupt. 2. Write H'F8 in P1DDR and NDERH, and set the G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 bits in PCR to select compare match in the TPU channel set up in the previous step to be the output trigger. Write output data H'80 in NDRH. 3. When compare match A occurs, the NDRH contents are transferred to PODRH and output. The TGIA interrupt handling routine writes the next output data (H'C0) in NDRH. 4. Five-phase overlapping pulse output (one or two phases active at a time) can be obtained subsequently by writing H'40, H'60, H'20, H'30. H'10, H'18, H'08, H'88... at successive TGIA interrupts. If the DTC is set for activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be obtained without imposing a load on the CPU. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 289 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.5 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output During non-overlapping operation, transfer from NDR to PODR is performed as follows: • NDR bits are always transferred on PODR bits on compare match A. • On compare match B, NDR bits are transferred only if their value is 0. Bits are not transferred if their value is 1. Figure 12.6 illustrates the non-overlapping pulse output operation. NDER DDR Q Compare match A Compare match B C Q PODR D Pulse output pin Q NDR D Internal data bus Normal output/inverted output Figure 12.6 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output Therefore, 0 data can be transferred ahead of 1 data by making compare match B occur before compare match A. The NDR contents should not be altered during the interval between compare match B and compare match A (the non-overlap margin). This can be accomplished by having the TGIA interrupt handling routine write the next data in NDR, or by having the TGIA interrupt activate the DTC. Note, however, that the next data must be written before the next compare match B occurs. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 290 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Figure 12.7 shows the timing of this operation. Compare match A Compare match B Write to NDR Write to NDR NDR PODR 0 output 0/1 output Write to NDR Do not write here to NDR here 0 output 0/1 output Do not write to NDR here Write to NDR here Figure 12.7 Non-Overlapping Operation and NDR Write Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 291 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.6 Sample Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping Pulse Output Figure 12.8 shows a sample procedure for setting up non-overlapping pulse output. Non-overlapping PPG output [1] Set TIOR to make TGRA and TGRB an output compare registers (with output disabled). Select TGR functions [1] Set TGR values [2] Set counting operation [3] Select interrupt request [4] Set initial output data [5] Enable pulse output [6] Select output trigger [7] Set non-overlapping groups [8] Set next pulse output data [9] [7] Select the TPU compare match event to be used as the pulse output trigger in PCR. Start counter [10] [8] In PMR, select the groups that will operate in non-overlap mode. TPU setup PPG setup TPU setup Compare match A? No Yes Set next pulse output data [2] Set the pulse output trigger period in TGRB and the non-overlap margin in TGRA. [3] Select the counter clock source with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0. [4] Enable the TGIA interrupt in TIER. The DTC can also be set up to transfer data to NDR. [5] Set the initial output values in PODR. [6] Set the DDR and NDER bits for the pins to be used for pulse output to 1. [9] Set the next pulse output values in NDR. [10] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the TCNT counter. [11] [11] At each TGIA interrupt, set the next output values in NDR. Figure 12.8 Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping Pulse Output (Example) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 292 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.7 Example of Non-Overlapping Pulse Output (Example of Four-Phase Complementary Non-Overlapping Output) Figure 12.9 shows an example in which pulse output is used for four-phase complementary nonoverlapping pulse output. TCNT value TGRB TCNT TGRA H'0000 NDRH PODRH Time 95 00 65 95 59 05 65 56 41 59 95 50 56 65 14 95 05 65 Non-overlap margin PO15 PO14 PO13 PO12 PO11 PO10 PO9 PO8 Figure 12.9 Non-Overlapping Pulse Output Example (Four-Phase Complementary) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 293 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 1. Set up the TPU channel to be used as the output trigger channel such that TGRA and TGRB are output compare registers. Set the trigger period in TGRB and the non-overlap margin in TGRA, and set the counter to be cleared on compare match B. Set the TGIEA bit in TIER to 1 to enable the TGIA interrupt. 2. Write H'FF in P1DDR and NDERH, and set the G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 bits in PCR to select compare match in the TPU channel set up in the previous step to be the output trigger. Set the G3NOV and G2NOV bits in PMR to 1 to select non-overlapping output. Write output data H'95 in NDRH. 3. The timer counter in the TPU channel starts. When a compare match with TGRB occurs, outputs change from 1 to 0. When a compare match with TGRA occurs, outputs change from 0 to 1 (the change from 0 to 1 is delayed by the value set in TGRA). The TGIA interrupt handling routine writes the next output data (H'65) in NDRH. 4. Four-phase complementary non-overlapping pulse output can be obtained subsequently by writing H'59, H'56, H'95, ... at successive TGIA interrupts. If the DTC is set for activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be obtained without imposing a load on the CPU. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 294 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.8 Inverted Pulse Output If the G3INV, G2INV, G1INV, and G0INV bits in PMR are cleared to 0, values that are the inverse of the PODR contents can be output. Figure 12.10 shows the outputs when G3INV and G2INV are cleared to 0, in addition to the settings of figure 12.9. TCNT value TGRB TCNT TGRA H'0000 NDRH PODRL Time 95 00 65 95 59 05 65 56 41 59 95 50 56 65 14 95 05 65 PO15 PO14 PO13 PO12 PO11 PO10 PO9 PO8 Figure 12.10 Inverted Pulse Output (Example) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 295 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.4.9 Pulse Output Triggered by Input Capture Pulse output can be triggered by TPU input capture as well as by compare match. If TGRA functions as an input capture register in the TPU channel selected by PCR, pulse output will be triggered by the input capture signal. Figure 12.11 shows the timing of this output. φ TIOC pin Input capture signal NDR N PODR M PO M N N Figure 12.11 Pulse Output Triggered by Input Capture (Example) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 296 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) 12.5 Usage Notes 12.5.1 Module Stop Mode Setting PPG operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for PPG operation to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 12.5.2 Operation of Pulse Output Pins Pins PO15 to PO8 are also used for other peripheral functions such as the TPU. When output by another peripheral function is enabled, the corresponding pins cannot be used for pulse output. Note, however, that data transfer from NDR bits to PODR bits takes place, regardless of the usage of the pins. Pin functions should be changed only under conditions in which the output trigger event will not occur. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 297 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 12 Programmable Pulse Generator (PPG) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 298 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer Section 13 Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer (WDT) is an 8-bit timer that can generate an internal reset signal for this LSI, if a system crash prevents the CPU from writing to the timer counter, thus allowing it to overflow. When this watchdog function is not needed, the WDT can be used as an interval timer. In interval timer operation, an interval timer interrupt is generated each time the counter overflows. The block diagram of the WDT is shown in figure 13.1. 13.1 Features • Selectable from eight counter input clocks. • Switchable between watchdog timer mode and interval timer mode In watchdog timer mode: • If the counter overflows, it is possible to select whether this LSI is internally reset or not. In interval timer mode: • If the counter overflows, the WDT generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 299 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer Internal reset signal* Interrupt control Clock Clock select Reset control RSTCSR TCNT φ/2 φ/64 φ/128 φ/512 φ/2048 φ/8192 φ/32768 φ/131072 Internal clock sources TSCR Module bus Bus interface Internal bus Overflow WOVI (interrupt request signal) WDT [Legend] TCSR: Timer control/status register TCNT: Timer counter RSTCSR: Reset control/status register Note: * The type of internal reset signal depends on a register setting. Figure 13.1 Block Diagram of WDT 13.2 Register Descriptions The WDT has the following three registers. To prevent accidental overwriting, TCSR, TCNT, and RSTCSR have to be written to by a different method to normal registers. For details, refer to section 13.5.1, Notes on Register Access. • Timer control/status register (TCSR) • Timer counter (TCNT) • Reset control/status register (RSTCSR) 13.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT) TCNT is an 8-bit readable/writable up-counter. TCNT is initialized to H'00 by a reset, when the TME bit in TCSR is cleared to 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 300 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer 13.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) TCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register. Its functions include selecting the clock source to be input to TCNT, and selecting the timer mode. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 OVF 0 R/(W)* Overflow Flag Indicates that TCNT has overflowed. Only a write of 0 is permitted, to clear the flag. [Setting condition] • When TCNT overflows (changes from H'FF to H'00) When internal reset request generation is selected in watchdog timer mode, OVF is cleared automatically by the internal reset. [Clearing condition] • 6 WT/IT 0 R/W Cleared by reading TCSR when OVF = 1, then writing 0 to OVF Timer Mode Select Selects whether the WDT is used as a watchdog timer or an interval timer. 0: Interval timer mode 1: Watchdog timer mode 5 TME 0 R/W Timer Enable When this bit is set to 1, TCNT starts counting. When this bit is cleared, TCNT stops counting and is initialized to H'00. 4, 3 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 301 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 CKS2 0 R/W Clock Select 2 to 0 1 CKS1 0 R/W 0 CKS0 0 R/W Selects the clock source to be input to TCNT. The overflow frequency for φ = 20 MHz is enclosed in parentheses. 000: Clock φ/2 (frequency: 25.6 µs) 001: Clock φ/64 (frequency: 819.2 µs) 010: Clock φ/128 (frequency: 1.6 ms) 011: Clock φ/512 (frequency: 6.6 ms) 100: Clock φ/2048 (frequency: 26.2 ms) 101: Clock φ/8192 (frequency: 104.9 ms) 110: Clock φ/32768 (frequency: 419.4 ms) 111: Clock φ/131072 (frequency: 1.68 s) Note: * Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 302 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer 13.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) RSTCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the generation of the internal reset signal when TCNT overflows, and selects the type of internal reset signal. RSTCSR is initialized to H'1F by a reset signal from the RES pin, and not by the WDT internal reset signal caused by overflows. Bit 7 Bit Name WOVF Initial Value R/W 0 R/(W)* Description Watchdog Overflow Flag This bit is set when TCNT overflows in watchdog timer mode. This bit cannot be set in interval timer mode, and only 0 can be written. [Setting condition] • Set when TCNT overflows (changed from H'FF to H'00) in watchdog timer mode [Clearing condition] • 6 RSTE 0 R/W Cleared by reading RSTCSR when WOVF = 1, and then writing 0 to WOVF Reset Enable Specifies whether or not a reset signal is generated in the chip if TCNT overflows during watchdog timer operation. 0: Reset signal is not generated even if TCNT overflows (Though this LSI is not reset, TCNT and TCSR in WDT are reset) 1: Reset signal is generated if TCNT overflows 5 RSTS 0 R/W Reset Select Selects the type of internal reset generated if TCNT overflows during watchdog timer operation. 0: Power-on reset 1: Setting prohibited 4 to 0 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified. Note: * Only 0 can be written, for flag clearing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 303 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer 13.3 Operation 13.3.1 Watchdog Timer Mode Operation To use the WDT as a watchdog timer, set the WT/IT bit in TCSR and the TME bit to 1. Software must prevent TCNT overflows by rewriting the TCNT value (normally by writing H'00) before overflow occurs. This ensures that TCNT does not overflow while the system is operating normally. If TCNT overflows without being rewritten because of a system malfunction or other error, the WOVF bit in RSTCSR is set to 1. If the RSTE bit in RSTCSR is set to 1, an internal reset is issued. This is shown in figure 13.2. At this time, select the power-on reset by clearing the RSTS bit in RSTCSR to 0. The internal reset signal is output for 518 states. If a reset caused by a signal input to the RES pin occurs at the same time as a reset caused by a WDT overflow, the reset by the RES pin has priority and the WOVF bit in RSTCSR is cleared to 0. TCNT value Overflow H'FF Time H'00 WT/IT=1 TME=1 Write H'00 to TCNT WOVF=1 WT/IT=1 TME=1 Write H'00 to TCNT internal reset is generated Internal reset signal* 518 states [Legend] WT/IT: Timer mode select bit TME: Timer enable bit Note: * The internal reset signal is generated only if the RSTE bit is set to 1. Figure 13.2 Example of WDT0 Watchdog Timer Operation 13.3.2 Interval Timer Mode When the WDT is used as an interval timer, an interval timer interrupt (WOVI) is generated each time the TCNT overflows. Therefore, an interrupt can be generated at intervals. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 304 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer When the TCNT overflows in interval timer mode, an interval timer interrupt (WOVI) is requested at the time the OVF bit of the TCSR is set to 1. 13.4 Interrupts During interval timer mode operation, an overflow generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI). The interval timer interrupt is requested whenever the OVF flag is set to 1 in TCSR. OVF must be cleared to 0 in the interrupt handling routine. Table 13.1 WDT Interrupt Source Name Interrupt Source Interrupt Flag DTC Activation WOVI TCNT overflow WOVF Impossible 13.5 Usage Notes 13.5.1 Notes on Register Access The watchdog timer’s TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR registers differ from other registers in being more difficult to write to. The procedures for writing to and reading these registers are given below. Writing to TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR: To write to TCNT and TCSR, execute a word transfer instruction. They cannot be written to by a byte transfer instruction. TCNT and TCSR both have the same write address. Therefore, the relative condition shown in figure 13.3 needs to be satisfied in order to write to TCNT or TCSR. The transfer instruction writes the lower byte data to TCNT or TCSR according to the satisfied condition. To write to RSTCSR, execute a word transfer instruction for address H'FF76. A byte transfer instruction cannot write to RSTCSR. The method of writing 0 to the WOVF bit differs from that of writing to the RSTE and RSTS bits. To write 0 to the WOVF bit, satisfy the condition shown in figure 13.3. If satisfied, the transfer instruction clears the WOVF bit to 0, but has no effect on the RSTE and RSTS bits. To write to the RSTE and RSTS bits, satisfy the condition shown in figure 13.3. If satisfied, the transfer instruction writes the values in bits 6 and 5 of the lower byte into the RSTE and RSTS bits, respectively, but has no effect on the WOVF bit. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 305 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer TCNT write Writing to RSTE and RSTS bits Address: H'FF74 H'FF76 15 8 H'A5 7 0 Write data TCSR write Writing 0 to WOVF bit Address: H'FF74 H'FF76 15 8 H'A5 7 0 Write data or H'00 Figure 13.3 Writing to TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR (Example for WDT0) Reading TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR (WDT0): These registers are read in the same way as other registers. The read addresses are H'FF74 for TCSR, H'FF75 for TCNT, and H'FF77 for RSTCSR. 13.5.2 Conflict between Timer Counter (TCNT) Write and Increment If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the write takes priority and the timer counter is not incremented. Figure 13.4 shows this operation. TCNT write cycle T1 T2 φ Address Internal write signal TCNT input clock TCNT N M Counter write data Figure 13.4 Conflict between TCNT Write and Increment Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 306 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer 13.5.3 Changing Value of CKS2 to CKS0 If bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCSR are written to while the WDT is operating, errors could occur in the incrementation. Software must be used to stop the watchdog timer (by clearing the TME bit to 0) before changing the value of bits CKS2 to CKS0. 13.5.4 Switching between Watchdog Timer Mode and Interval Timer Mode If the mode is switched from watchdog timer to interval timer while the WDT is operating, errors could occur in the incrementation. Software must be used to stop the watchdog timer (by clearing the TME bit to 0) before switching the mode. 13.5.5 Internal Reset in Watchdog Timer Mode This LSI is not reset internally if TCNT overflows while the RSTE bit is cleared to 0 during watchdog timer operation, however TCNT and TCSR of the WDT are reset. TCNT, TCSR, or RSTCR cannot be written to for 132 states following an overflow. During this period, any attempt to read the WOVF flag is not acknowledged. Accordingly, wait 132 states after overflow to write 0 to the WOVF flag for clearing. 13.5.6 OVF Flag Clearing in Interval Timer Mode When the OVF flag setting conflicts with the OVF flag reading in interval timer mode, writing 0 to the OVF bit may not clear the flag even though the OVF bit has been read while it is 1. If there is a possibility that the OVF flag setting and reading will conflict, such as when the OVF flag is polled with the interval timer interrupt disabled, read the OVF bit while it is 1 at least twice before writing 0 to the OVF bit to clear the flag. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 307 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 13 Watchdog Timer Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 308 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) This LSI has three independent serial communication interface (SCI) channels. The SCI can handle both asynchronous and clocked synchronous serial communication. Serial data communication can be carried out using standard asynchronous communication chips such as a Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) or an Asynchronous Communication Interface Adapter (ACIA). A function is also provided for serial communication between processors (multiprocessor communication function). The SCI also supports an IC card (Smart Card) interface conforming to ISO/IEC 7816-3 (Identification Card) as a serial communication interface extension function. Figure 14.1 shows a block diagram of the SCI. 14.1 Features • Choice of asynchronous or clocked synchronous serial communication mode • Full-duplex communication capability The transmitter and receiver are mutually independent, enabling transmission and reception to be executed simultaneously. Double-buffering is used in both the transmitter and the receiver, enabling continuous transmission and continuous reception of serial data. • On-chip baud rate generator allows any bit rate to be selected External clock can be selected as a transfer clock source (except for in Smart Card interface mode). • Choice of LSB-first or MSB-first transfer (except in the case of asynchronous mode 7-bit data) • Four interrupt sources Transmit-end, transmit-data-empty, receive-data-full, and receive error that can issue requests. The transmit-data-empty interrupt and receive-data-full interrupt can be used to activate the data transfer controller (DTC). • Module stop mode can be set Asynchronous mode: • • • • Data length: 8 or 7 bits Stop bit length: 2 or 1 bits Parity: Even, odd, or none Receive error detection: Parity, overrun, and framing errors Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 309 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) • Break detection: Break can be detected by reading the RxD pin level directly in the case of a framing error Clocked synchronous mode: • Data length: 8 bits • Receive error detection: Overrun errors detected Smart Card interface: Bus interface • Automatic transmission of error signal (parity error) in receive mode • Error signal detection and automatic data retransmission in transmit mode • Direct convention and inverse convention both supported Module data bus RDR TDR BRR SCMR SSR RxD TxD SCR RSR TSR SMR Baud rate generator Transmission/ reception control Parity generation φ φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 Clock Parity check External clock SCK [Legend] RSR: Receive shift register RDR: Receive data register TSR: Transmit shift register TDR: Transmit data register SMR: Serial mode register SCR: Serial control register SSR: Serial status register SCMR: Smart Card mode register BRR: Bit rate register Figure 14.1 Block Diagram of SCI Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 310 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TEI TXI RXI ERI Internal data bus Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.2 Input/Output Pins Table 14.1 shows the serial pins for each SCI channel. Table 14.1 Pin Configuration Channel Pin Name* I/O Function 0 SCK0 I/O SCI0 clock input/output RxD0 Input SCI0 receive data input TxD0 Output SCI0 transmit data output SCK1 I/O SCI1 clock input/output 1 2 Note: 14.3 * RxD1 Input SCI1 receive data input TxD1 Output SCI1 transmit data output SCK2 I/O SCI2 clock input/output RxD2 Input SCI2 receive data input TxD2 Output SCI2 transmit data output Pin names SCK, RxD, and TxD are used in the text for all channels, omitting the channel designation. Register Descriptions The SCI has the following registers for each channel. The serial mode register (SMR), serial status register (SSR), and serial control register (SCR) are described separately for normal serial communication interface mode and Smart Card interface mode because their bit functions differ in part. • • • • • • • • • Receive shift register (RSR) Receive data register (RDR) Transmit data register (TDR) Transmit shift register (TSR) Serial mode register (SMR) Serial control register (SCR) Serial status register (SSR) Smart card mode register (SCMR) Bit rate register (BRR) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 311 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR) RSR is a shift register that is used to receive serial data input to the RxD pin and convert it into parallel data. When one byte of data has been received, it is transferred to RDR automatically. RSR cannot be directly accessed by the CPU. 14.3.2 Receive Data Register (RDR) RDR is an 8-bit register that stores received data. When the SCI has received one byte of serial data, it transfers the received serial data from RSR to RDR, where it is stored. After this, RSR is receive-enabled. As RSR and RDR function as a double buffer in this way, continuous receive operations are possible. After confirming that the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, read RDR only once. RDR cannot be written to by the CPU. 14.3.3 Transmit Data Register (TDR) TDR is an 8-bit register that stores data for transmission. When the SCI detects that TSR is empty, it transfers the transmit data written in TDR to TSR and starts transmission. The double-buffered structure of TDR and TSR enables continuous serial transmission. If the next transmit data has already been written to TDR during serial transmission, the SCI transfers the written data to TSR to continue transmission. Although TDR can be read or written to by the CPU at all times, to achieve reliable serial transmission, write transmit data to TDR only once after confirming that the TDRE bit in SSR is set to 1. 14.3.4 Transmit Shift Register (TSR) TSR is a shift register that transmits serial data. To perform serial data transmission, the SCI first transfers transmit data from TDR to TSR, then sends the data to the TxD pin. TSR cannot be directly accessed by the CPU. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 312 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR) SMR is used to set the SCI’s serial transfer format and select the baud rate generator clock source. Some bit functions of SMR differ between normal serial communication interface mode and Smart Card interface mode. • Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 C/A 0 R/W Communication Mode 0: Asynchronous mode 1: Clocked synchronous mode 6 CHR 0 R/W Character Length (enabled only in asynchronous mode) 0: Selects 8 bits as the data length 1: Selects 7 bits as the data length. LSB-first is fixed and the MSB of TDR is not transmitted in transmission In clocked synchronous mode, a fixed data length of 8 bits is used. 5 PE 0 R/W Parity Enable (enabled only in asynchronous mode) When this bit is set to 1, the parity bit is added to transmit data before transmission, and the parity bit is checked in reception. For a multiprocessor format, parity bit addition and checking are not performed regardless of the PE bit setting. 4 O/E 0 R/W Parity Mode (enabled only when the PE bit is 1 in asynchronous mode) 0: Selects even parity 1: Selects odd parity Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 313 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 3 STOP 0 R/W Stop Bit Length (enabled only in asynchronous mode) Selects the stop bit length in transmission. 0: 1 stop bit 1: 2 stop bits In reception, only the first stop bit is checked. If the second stop bit is 0, it is treated as the start bit of the next transmit character. 2 MP 0 R/W Multiprocessor Mode (enabled only in asynchronous mode) When this bit is set to 1, the multiprocessor communication function is enabled. The PE bit and O/E bit settings are invalid in multiprocessor mode. 1 CKS1 0 R/W Clock Select 1 and 0 0 CKS0 0 R/W These bits select the clock source for the baud rate generator. 00: φ clock (n = 0) 01: φ/4 clock (n = 1) 10: φ/16 clock (n = 2) 11: φ/64 clock (n = 3) For the relationship between the bit rate register setting and the baud rate, see section 14.3.9, Bit Rate Register (BRR). n is the decimal representation of the value of n in BRR (see section 14.3.9, Bit Rate Register (BRR)). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 314 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) • Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 GM 0 R/W GSM Mode When this bit is set to 1, the SCI operates in GSM mode. In GSM mode, the timing of the TEND setting is advanced by 11.0 etu (Elementary Time Unit: the time for transfer of one bit), and clock output control mode addition is performed. For details, refer to section 14.7.8, Clock Output Control. 6 BLK 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, the SCI operates in block transfer mode. For details on block transfer mode, refer to section 14.7.3, Block Transfer Mode. 5 PE 0 R/W Parity Enable (enabled only in asynchronous mode) When this bit is set to 1, the parity bit is added to transmit data in transmission, and the parity bit is checked in reception. In Smart Card interface mode, this bit must be set to 1. 4 O/E 0 R/W Parity Mode (enabled only when the PE bit is 1 in asynchronous mode) 0: Selects even parity 1: Selects odd parity For details on setting this bit in Smart Card interface mode, refer to section 14.7.2, Data Format (Except for Block Transfer Mode). 3 BCP1 0 R/W Basic Clock Pulse 2 and 1 2 BCP0 0 R/W These bits specify the number of basic clock periods in a 1-bit transfer interval on the Smart Card interface. 00: 32 clock (S = 32) 01: 64 clock (S = 64) 10: 372 clock (S = 372) 11: 256 clock (S = 256) For details, refer to section 14.7.4, Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Smart Card Interface Mode. S stands for the value of S in BRR (see section 14.3.9, Bit Rate Register (BRR)). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 315 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 1 CKS1 0 R/W Clock Select 1 and 0 0 CKS0 0 R/W These bits select the clock source for the baud rate generator. 00: φ clock (n = 0) 01: φ/4 clock (n = 1) 10: φ/16 clock (n = 2) 11: φ/64 clock (n = 3) For the relationship between the bit rate register setting and the baud rate, see section 14.3.9, Bit Rate Register (BRR). n is the decimal representation of the value of n in BRR (see section 14.3.9, Bit Rate Register (BRR)). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 316 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.6 Serial Control Register (SCR) SCR is a register that enables or disables SCI transfer operations and interrupt requests, and is also used to selection of the transfer clock source. For details on interrupt requests, refer to section 14.8, Interrupt Sources. Some bit functions of SCR differ between normal serial communication interface mode and Smart Card interface mode. • Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TIE 0 R/W Transmit Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, the TXI interrupt request is enabled. 6 RIE 0 R/W Receive Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, RXI and ERI interrupt requests are enabled. 5 TE 0 R/W Transmit Enable When this bit s set to 1, transmission is enabled. 4 RE 0 R/W Receive Enable When this bit is set to 1, reception is enabled. 3 MPIE 0 R/W Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (enabled only when the MP bit in SMR is 1 in asynchronous mode) When this bit is set to 1, receive data in which the multiprocessor bit is 0 is skipped, and setting of the RDRF, FER, and ORER status flags in SSR is prohibited. On receiving data in which the multiprocessor bit is 1, this bit is automatically cleared and normal reception is resumed. For details, refer to section 14.5, Multiprocessor Communication Function. 2 TEIE 0 R/W Transmit End Interrupt Enable This bit is set to 1, TEI interrupt request is enabled. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 317 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 1 CKE1 0 R/W Clock Enable 0 and 1 0 CKE0 0 R/W Selects the clock source and SCK pin function. Asynchronous mode: 00: Internal baud rate generator SCK pin functions as I/O port 01: Internal baud rate generator Outputs a clock of the same frequency as the bit rate from the SCK pin. 1×: External clock Inputs a clock with a frequency 16 times the bit rate from the SCK pin. Clocked synchronous mode: 0×: Internal clock (SCK pin functions as clock output) 1×: External clock (SCK pin functions as clock input) [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 318 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) • Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TIE 0 R/W Transmit Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, TXI interrupt request is enabled. 6 RIE 0 R/W Receive Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, RXI and ERI interrupt requests are enabled. 5 TE 0 R/W Transmit Enable 4 RE 0 R/W Receive Enable When this bit is set to 1, transmission is enabled. When this bit is set to 1, reception is enabled. 3 MPIE 0 R/W Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (enabled only when the MP bit in SMR is 1 in asynchronous mode) Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode. 2 TEIE 0 R/W Transmit End Interrupt Enable Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode. 1 CKE1 0 R/W Clock Enable 1 and 0 0 CKE0 0 R/W Enables or disables clock output from the SCK pin. The clock output can be dynamically switched in GSM mode. For details, refer to section 14.7.8, Clock Output Control. When the GM bit in SMR is 0 00: Output disabled (SCK pin can be used as an I/O port pin) 01: Clock output 1×: Reserved When the GM bit in SMR is 1 00: Output fixed low 01: Clock output 10: Output fixed high 11: Clock output [Legend] ×: Don’t care Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 319 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.7 Serial Status Register (SSR) SSR is a register containing status flags of the SCI and multiprocessor bits for transfer. 1 cannot be written to flags TDRE, RDRF, ORER, PER, and FER; they can only be cleared. Some bit functions of SSR differ between normal serial communication interface mode and Smart Card interface mode. • Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TDRE 1 R/W Transmit Data Register Empty Displays whether TDR contains transmit data. [Setting conditions] • When the TE bit in SCR is 0 • When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data can be written to TDR [Clearing conditions] 6 RDRF 0 R/W • When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1 • When the DTC is activated by a TXI interrupt request and writes data to TDR Receive Data Register Full Indicates that the received data is stored in RDR. [Setting condition] • When serial reception ends normally and receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR [Clearing conditions] • When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1 • When the DTC is activated by an RXI interrupt and transferred data from RDR The RDRF flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 320 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 5 ORER 0 R/W Overrun Error [Setting condition] • When the next serial reception is completed while RDRF = 1 [Clearing condition] • 4 FER 0 R/W When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1 Framing Error [Setting condition] • When the stop bit is 0 [Clearing condition] • When 0 is written to FER after reading FER = 1 In 2-stop-bit mode, only the first stop bit is checked. 3 PER 0 R/W Parity Error [Setting condition] • When a parity error is detected during reception [Clearing condition] • When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 321 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 TEND 1 R Transmit End [Setting conditions] • When the TE bit in SCR is 0 • When TDRE = 1 at transmission of the last bit of a 1-byte serial transmit character [Clearing conditions] 1 MPB 0 R • When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1 • When the DTC is activated by a TXI interrupt and writes data to TDR Multiprocessor Bit MPB stores the multiprocessor bit in the receive data. When the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0 its previous state is retained. 0 MPBT 0 R/W Multiprocessor Bit Transfer MPBT stores the multiprocessor bit to be added to the transmit data. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 322 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) • Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TDRE 1 R/W Transmit Data Register Empty Displays whether TDR contains transmit data. [Setting conditions] • When the TE bit in SCR is 0 • When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data can be written to TDR [Clearing conditions] 6 RDRF 0 R/W • When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1 • When the DTC is activated by a TXI interrupt request and writes data to TDR Receive Data Register Full Indicates that the received data is stored in RDR. [Setting condition] • When serial reception ends normally and receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR [Clearing conditions] • When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1 • When the DTC is activated by an RXI interrupt and transferred data from RDR The RDRF flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 323 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 5 ORER 0 R/W Overrun Error [Setting condition] • When the next serial reception is completed while RDRF = 1 [Clearing condition] • 4 ERS 0 R/W When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1 Error Signal Status [Setting condition] • When the low level of the error signal is sampled [Clearing condition] • 3 PER 0 R/W When 0 is written to ERS after reading ERS =1 Parity Error [Setting condition] • When a parity error is detected during reception [Clearing condition] • Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 324 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 TEND 1 R Transmit End This bit is set to 1 when no error signal has been sent back from the receiving end and the next transmit data is ready to be transferred to TDR. [Setting conditions] • When the TE bit in SCR is 0 and the ERS bit is also 0 • When the ERS bit is 0 and the TDRE bit is 1 after the specified interval following transmission of 1-byte data. The timing of bit setting differs according to the register setting as follows: When GM = 0 and BLK = 0, 2.5 etu after transmission starts When GM = 0 and BLK = 1, 1.5 etu after transmission starts When GM = 1 and BLK = 0, 1.0 etu after transmission starts When GM = 1 and BLK = 1, 1.0 etu after transmission starts [Clearing conditions] 1 MPB 0 R • When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1 • When the DTC is activated by a TXI interrupt and writes data to TDR Multiprocessor Bit This bit is not used in Smart Card interface mode. 0 MPBT 0 R/W Multiprocessor Bit Transfer Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 325 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.8 Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR) SCMR is a register that selects Smart Card interface mode and its format. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 4 All 1 Reserved 3 0 R/W These bits are always read as 1. SDIR Smart Card Data Transfer Direction Selects the serial/parallel conversion format. 0: LSB-first in transfer 1: MSB-first in transfer The bit setting is valid only when the transfer data format is 8 bits. For 7-bit data, LSB-first is fixed. 2 SINV 0 R/W Smart Card Data Invert Specifies inversion of the data logic level. The SINV bit does not affect the logic level of the parity bit. To invert the parity bit, invert the O/E bit in SMR. 0: TDR contents are transmitted as they are. Receive data is stored as it is in RDR 1: TDR contents are inverted before being transmitted. Receive data is stored in inverted form in RDR 1 1 Reserved This bit is always read as 1. 0 SMIF 0 R/W Smart Card Interface Mode Select This bit is set to 1 to make the SCI operate in Smart Card interface mode. 0: Normal asynchronous mode or clocked synchronous mode 1: Smart card interface mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 326 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.3.9 Bit Rate Register (BRR) BRR is an 8-bit register that adjusts the bit rate. As the SCI performs baud rate generator control independently for each channel, different bit rates can be set for each channel. Table 14.2 shows the relationships between the N setting in BRR and bit rate B for normal asynchronous mode, clocked synchronous mode, and Smart Card interface mode. The initial value of BRR is H'FF, and it can be read or written to by the CPU at all times. Table 14.2 The Relationships between The N Setting in BRR and Bit Rate B Mode BRR Setting N Asynchronous Mode N= Clocked Synchronous Mode N= Smart Card Interface Mode N= [Legend] B: N: φ: n and S: φ × 106 64 × 2 2n−1 × B φ × 106 8 × 2 2n−1 × B φ × 106 S × 2 2n+1 × B Error −1 Error (%) = { φ × 106 B × 64 × 2 2n−1 × (N + 1) − 1 } × 100 −1 − 1 Error (%) = { φ × 106 B × S × 2 2n+1 × (N + 1) − 1 } × 100 Bit rate (bit/s) BRR setting for baud rate generator (0 ≤ N ≤ 255) Operating frequency (MHz) Determined by the SMR settings shown in the following tables. SMR Setting SMR Setting CKS1 CKS0 n BCP1 BCP0 S 0 0 0 0 0 32 0 1 1 0 1 64 1 0 2 1 0 372 1 1 3 1 1 256 Table 14.3 shows sample N settings in BRR in normal asynchronous mode. Table 14.4 shows the maximum bit rate for each frequency in normal asynchronous mode. Table 14.6 shows sample N settings in BRR in clocked synchronous mode. Table 14.8 shows sample N settings in BRR in Smart Card interface mode. In Smart Card interface mode, S (the number of basic clock periods in a 1-bit transfer interval) can be selected. For details, refer to section 14.7.4, Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Smart Card Interface Mode. Tables 14.5 and 14.7 show the maximum bit rates with external clock input. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 327 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (1) Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 4 4.9152 5 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 70 0.03 2 86 0.31 2 88 –0.25 150 1 207 0.16 1 255 0.00 2 64 0.16 300 1 103 0.16 1 127 0.00 1 129 0.16 600 0 207 0.16 0 255 0.00 1 64 0.16 1200 0 103 0.16 0 127 0.00 0 129 0.16 2400 0 51 0.16 0 63 0.00 0 64 0.16 4800 0 25 0.16 0 31 0.00 0 32 –1.36 9600 0 12 0.16 0 15 0.00 0 15 1.73 19200 0 7 0.00 0 7 1.73 31250 0 3 0.00 0 4 –1.70 0 4 0.00 38400 0 3 0.00 0 3 1.73 Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 6 6.144 7.3728 8 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 106 –0.44 2 108 0.08 2 130 –0.07 2 141 0.03 150 2 77 0.16 2 79 0.00 2 95 0.00 2 103 0.16 300 1 155 0.16 1 159 0.00 1 191 0.00 1 207 0.16 600 1 77 0.16 1 79 0.00 1 95 0.00 1 103 0.16 1200 0 155 0.16 0 159 0.00 0 191 0.00 0 207 0.16 2400 0 77 0.16 0 79 0.00 0 95 0.00 0 103 0.16 4800 0 38 0.16 0 39 0.00 0 47 0.00 0 51 0.16 9600 0 19 –2.34 0 19 0.00 0 23 0.00 0 25 0.16 19200 0 9 –2.34 0 9 0.00 0 11 0.00 0 12 0.16 31250 0 5 0.00 0 5 2.40 0 7 0.00 38400 0 4 –2.34 0 4 0.00 0 5 0.00 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 328 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (2) Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 9.8304 10 12 12.288 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 174 –0.26 2 177 –0.25 2 212 0.03 2 217 0.08 150 2 127 0.00 2 129 0.16 2 155 0.16 2 159 0.00 300 1 255 0.00 2 64 0.16 2 77 0.16 2 79 0.00 600 1 127 0.00 1 129 0.16 1 155 0.16 1 159 0.00 1200 0 255 0.00 1 64 0.16 1 77 0.16 1 79 0.00 2400 0 127 0.00 0 129 0.16 0 155 0.16 0 159 0.00 4800 0 63 0.00 0 64 0.16 0 77 0.16 0 79 0.00 9600 0 31 0.00 0 32 –1.36 0 38 0.16 0 39 0.00 19200 0 15 0.00 0 15 1.73 0 19 –2.34 0 19 0.00 31250 0 9 –1.70 0 9 0.00 0 11 0.00 0 11 2.40 38400 0 7 0.00 0 7 1.73 0 9 –2.34 0 9 0.00 Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 14 Bit Rate (bit/s) 14.7456 16 17.2032 n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 248 –0.17 3 64 0.70 3 70 0.03 3 75 0.48 150 2 181 0.13 2 191 0.00 2 207 0.16 2 223 0.00 300 2 90 0.13 2 95 0.00 2 103 0.16 2 111 0.00 600 1 181 0.13 1 191 0.00 1 207 0.16 1 223 0.00 1200 1 90 0.13 1 95 0.00 1 103 0.16 1 111 0.00 2400 0 181 0.13 0 191 0.00 0 207 0.16 0 223 0.00 4800 0 90 0.13 0 95 0.00 0 103 0.16 0 111 0.00 9600 0 45 –0.93 0 47 0.00 0 51 0.16 0 55 0.00 19200 0 22 –0.93 0 23 0.00 0 25 0.16 0 27 0.00 31250 0 13 0.00 0 14 –1.70 0 15 0.00 0 13 1.20 38400 0 11 0.00 0 12 0.16 0 13 0.00 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 329 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) (3) Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 18 19.6608 20 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 3 79 –0.12 3 86 0.31 3 88 –0.25 150 2 233 0.16 2 255 0.00 3 64 0.16 300 2 116 0.16 2 127 0.00 2 129 0.16 600 1 233 0.16 1 255 0.00 2 64 0.16 1200 1 116 0.16 1 127 0.00 1 129 0.16 2400 0 233 0.16 0 255 0.00 1 64 0.16 4800 0 116 0.16 0 127 0.00 0 129 0.16 9600 0 58 –0.69 0 63 0.00 0 64 0.16 19200 0 28 1.02 0 31 0.00 0 32 –1.36 31250 0 17 0.00 0 19 –1.70 0 19 0.00 38400 0 14 –2.34 0 15 0.00 0 15 1.73 Table 14.4 Maximum Bit Rate for Each Frequency (Asynchronous Mode) φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) n N φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) n N 4 125000 0 0 12 375000 0 0 4.9152 153600 0 0 12.288 384000 0 0 5 156250 0 0 14 437500 0 0 6 187500 0 0 14.7456 460800 0 0 6.144 192000 0 0 16 500000 0 0 7.3728 230400 0 0 17.2032 537600 0 0 8 250000 0 0 18 562500 0 0 9.8304 307200 0 0 19.6608 614400 0 0 10 312500 0 0 20 625000 0 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 330 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.5 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) 4 1.0000 62500 12 3.0000 187500 4.9152 1.2288 76800 12.288 3.0720 192000 5 1.2500 78125 14 3.5000 218750 6 1.5000 93750 14.7456 3.6864 230400 6.144 1.5360 96000 16 4.0000 250000 7.3728 1.8432 115200 17.2032 4.3008 268800 8 2.0000 125000 18 4.5000 281250 9.8304 2.4576 153600 19.6608 4.9152 307200 10 2.5000 156250 20 5.0000 312500 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 331 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.6 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Clocked Synchronous Mode) Operating Frequency φ (MHz) Bit Rate (bit/s) 4 n N 8 10 16 n N n N n N 20 n N 110 250 2 249 3 124 3 249 500 2 124 2 249 3 124 1k 1 249 2 124 2 249 2.5 k 1 99 1 199 1 249 2 99 2 124 5k 0 199 1 99 1 124 1 199 1 249 10 k 0 99 0 199 0 249 1 99 1 124 25 k 0 39 0 79 0 99 0 159 0 199 50 k 0 19 0 39 0 49 0 79 0 99 100 k 0 9 0 19 0 24 0 39 0 49 250 k 0 3 0 7 0 9 0 15 0 19 500 k 0 1 0 3 0 4 0 7 0 9 1M 0 0* 0 1 0 3 0 4 0 0* 0 1 0* 2.5 M 5M 0 [Legend] Blank: Setting prohibited. : Can be set, but there will be a degree of error. *: Continuous transfer is not possible. Table 14.7 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Clocked Synchronous Mode) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) 4 0.6667 666666.7 14 2.3333 2333333.3 6 1.0000 1.000000.0 16 2.6667 2666666.7 8 1.3333 1333333.3 18 3.0000 3000000.0 10 1.6667 1666666.7 20 3.3333 3333333.3 12 2.0000 2000000.0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 332 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.8 Examples of Bit Rate for Various BRR Settings (Smart Card Interface Mode) (When n = 0 and S = 372) Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 7.1424 10.00 10.7136 13.00 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 9600 0 0 0.00 0 1 30 0 1 25 0 1 8.99 Operating Frequency φ (MHz) 14.2848 16.00 18.00 20.00 Bit Rate (bit/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 9600 0 1 0.00 0 1 12.01 0 2 15.99 0 2 6.60 Table 14.9 Maximum Bit Rate at Various Frequencies (Smart Card Interface Mode) (When S = 372) φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) n N φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bit/s) n N 7.1424 9600 0 0 14.2848 19200 0 0 10.00 13441 0 0 16.00 21505 0 0 10.7136 14400 0 0 18.00 24194 0 0 13.00 17473 0 0 20.00 26882 0 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 333 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4 Operation in Asynchronous Mode Figure 14.2 shows the general format for asynchronous serial communication. One frame consists of a start bit (low level), followed by transfer/receive data (in LSB-first order), a parity bit (high or low level), and finally stop bits (high level). In asynchronous serial communication, the transmission line is usually held in the mark state (high level). The SCI monitors the transmission line. When the transmission line goes to the space state (low level), the SCI recognizes a start bit and starts serial communication. Inside the SCI, the transmitter and receiver are independent units, enabling full-duplex. Both the transmitter and the receiver also have a double-buffered structure, so data can be read or written during transmission or reception, enabling continuous data transfer. 1 Serial data LSB D0 0 Idle state (mark state) 1 MSB D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 Start bit Transmit/receive data 1 bit 8 or 7 bits D6 D7 0/1 Parity bit 1 bit, or none 1 1 Stop bit 2 or 1 bits One unit of transfer data (character or frame) Figure 14.2 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, Two Stop Bits) 14.4.1 Data Transfer Format Table 14.10 shows the data transfer formats that can be used in asynchronous mode. Any of 12 transfer formats can be selected according to the SMR setting. For details on the multiprocessor bit, refer to section 14.5, Multiprocessor Communication Function. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 334 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.10 Serial Transfer Formats (Asynchronous Mode) SMR Settings Serial Transfer Format and Frame Length CHR PE MP STOP 1 0 0 0 0 S 8-bit data STOP 0 0 0 1 S 8-bit data STOP STOP 0 1 0 0 S 8-bit data P STOP 0 1 0 1 S 8-bit data P STOP STOP 1 0 0 0 S 7-bit data STOP 1 0 0 1 S 7-bit data STOP STOP 1 1 0 0 S 7-bit data P STOP 1 1 0 1 S 7-bit data P STOP STOP 0 — 1 0 S 8-bit data MPB STOP 0 — 1 1 S 8-bit data MPB STOP STOP 1 — 1 0 S 7-bit data MPB STOP 1 — 1 1 S 7-bit data MPB STOP STOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 [Legend] S: Start bit STOP: Stop bit P: Parity bit MPB: Multiprocessor bit Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 335 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4.2 Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Asynchronous Mode In asynchronous mode, the SCI operates on a basic clock with a frequency of 16 times the transfer rate. In reception, the SCI samples the falling edge of the start bit using the basic clock, and performs internal synchronization. Receive data is latched internally at the rising edge of the 8th pulse of the basic clock as shown in figure 14.3. Thus, the reception margin in asynchronous mode is given by formula (1) below. M = { (0.5 – D – 0.5 1 )– N 2N – (L – 0.5) F} × 100 [%] ... Formula (1) Where N: D: L: F: Ratio of bit rate to clock (N = 16) Clock duty cycle (D = 0.5 to 1.0) Frame length (L = 9 to 12) Absolute value of clock rate deviation Assuming values of F (absolute value of clock rate deviation) = 0 and D (clock duty cycle) = 0.5 in formula (1), the reception margin can be given by the formula. M = {0.5 – 1/(2 × 16)} × 100 [%] = 46.875% However, this is only the computed value, and a margin of 30% to 20% should be allowed for in system design. 16 clocks 8 clocks 0 7 15 0 7 15 0 Internal basic clock Receive data (RxD) Start bit D0 Synchronization sampling timing Data sampling timing Figure 14.3 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 336 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 D1 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4.3 Clock Either an internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input at the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI’s serial clock, according to the setting of the C/A bit in SMR and the CKE0 and CKE1 bits in SCR. When an external clock is input at the SCK pin, the clock frequency should be 16 times the bit rate used. When the SCI is operated on an internal clock, the clock can be output from the SCK pin. The frequency of the clock output in this case is equal to the bit rate, and the phase is such that the rising edge of the clock is in the middle of the transmit data, as shown in figure 14.4. SCK TxD 0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 0/1 1 1 1 frame Figure 14.4 Relationship between Output Clock and Transfer Data Phase (Asynchronous Mode) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 337 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4.4 SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode) Before transmitting and receiving data, first clear the TE and RE bits in SCR to 0, then initialize the SCI as described below. When the operating mode, or transfer format, is changed for example, the TE and RE bits must be cleared to 0 before making the change using the following procedure. When the TE bit is cleared to 0, the TDRE flag is set to 1. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not initialize the contents of the RDRF, PER, FER, and ORER flags, or the contents of RDR. When the external clock is used in asynchronous mode, the clock must be supplied even during initialization. [1] Set the clock selection in SCR. Be sure to clear bits RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE, and bits TE and RE, to 0. Start initialization Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0 Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR (TE and RE bits are cleared to 0.) [1] Set data transfer format in SMR and SCMR [2] Set value in BRR [3] When the clock is selected in asynchronous mode, it is output immediately after SCR settings are made. [2] Set the data transfer format in SMR and SCMR. [3] Write a value corresponding to the bit rate to BRR. Not necessary if an external clock is used. Wait No 1-bit interval elapsed? Yes Set TE and RE bits in SCR to 1, and set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits [4] Wait at least one bit interval, then set the TE bit or RE bit in SCR to 1. Also set the RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits. Setting the TE and RE bits enables the TxD and RxD pins to be used. [4] <Initialization completion> Figure 14.5 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 338 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4.5 Data Transmission (Asynchronous Mode) Figure 14.6 shows an example of operation for transmission in asynchronous mode. In transmission, the SCI operates as described below. 1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. If the flag is cleared to 0, the SCI recognizes that data has been written to TDR, and transfers the data from TDR to TSR. 2. After transferring data from TDR to TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts transmission. If the TIE bit is set to 1 at this time, a transmit data empty interrupt request (TXI) is generated. Continuous transmission is possible because the TXI interrupt routine writes next transmit data to TDR before transmission of the current transmit data has been completed. 3. Data is sent from the TxD pin in the following order: start bit, transmit data, parity bit or multiprocessor bit (may be omitted depending on the format), and stop bit. 4. The SCI checks the TDRE flag at the timing for sending the stop bit. 5. If the TDRE flag is 0, the data is transferred from TDR to TSR, the stop bit is sent, and then serial transmission of the next frame is started. 6. If the TDRE flag is 1, the TEND flag in SSR is set to 1, the stop bit is sent, and then the “mark state” is entered, in which 1 is output. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a TEI interrupt request is generated. Figure 14.7 shows a sample flowchart for transmission in asynchronous mode. 1 Start bit 0 Data D0 D1 Parity Stop Start bit bit bit D7 0/1 1 0 Data D0 D1 Parity Stop bit bit D7 0/1 1 1 Idle state (mark state) TDRE TEND TXI interrupt Data written to TDR and TXI interrupt request generated TDRE flag cleared to 0 in request generated TXI interrupt service routine TEI interrupt request generated 1 frame Figure 14.6 Example of Operation in Transmission in Asynchronous Mode (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 339 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) [1] Initialization Start transmission Read TDRE flag in SSR [2] [2] SCI status check and transmit data write: Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag is set to 1, then write transmit data to TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. No TDRE = 1 Yes Write transmit data to TDR and clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0 No All data transmitted? Yes [3] Read TEND flag in SSR No TEND = 1 Yes No Break output? Yes [1] SCI initialization: The TxD pin is automatically designated as the transmit data output pin. After the TE bit is set to 1, a frame of 1s is output, and transmission is enabled. [4] [3] Serial transmission continuation procedure: To continue serial transmission, read 1 from the TDRE flag to confirm that writing is possible, then write data to TDR, and then clear the TDRE flag to 0. Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag is automatic when the DTC is activated by a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI) request, and data is written to TDR. [4] Break output at the end of serial transmission: To output a break in serial transmission, set DDR for the port corresponding to the TxD pin to 1, clear DR to 0, then clear the TE bit in SCR to 0. Clear DR to 0 and set DDR to 1 Clear TE bit in SCR to 0 <End> Figure 14.7 Sample Serial Transmission Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 340 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.4.6 Serial Data Reception (Asynchronous Mode) Figure 14.8 shows an example of operation for reception in asynchronous mode. In serial reception, the SCI operates as described below. 1. The SCI monitors the communication line. If a start bit is detected, the SCI performs internal synchronization, receives receive data in RSR, and checks the parity bit and stop bit. 2. If an overrun error occurs (when reception of the next data is completed while the RDRF flag is still set to 1), the ORER bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated. Receive data is not transferred to RDR. The RDRF flag remains to be set to 1. 3. If a parity error is detected, the PER bit in SSR is set to 1 and receive data is transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated. 4. If a framing error is detected (when the stop bit is 0), the FER bit in SSR is set to 1 and receive data is transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated. 5. If reception is completed successfully, the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, and receive data is transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an RXI interrupt request is generated. Continuous reception is possible because the RXI interrupt routine reads the receive data transferred to RDR before reception of the next receive data has been completed. 1 Start bit 0 Data D0 D1 Parity Stop Start bit bit bit D7 0/1 1 0 Data D0 D1 Parity Stop bit bit D7 0/1 0 1 Idle state (mark state) RDRF FER RXI interrupt request generated RDR data read and RDRF flag cleared to 0 in RXI interrupt service routine ERI interrupt request generated by framing error 1 frame Figure 14.8 Example of SCI Operation in Reception (Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 341 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.11 shows the states of the SSR status flags and receive data handling when a receive error is detected. If a receive error is detected, the RDRF flag retains its state before receiving data. Reception cannot be resumed while a receive error flag is set to 1. Accordingly, clear the ORER, FER, PER, and RDRF bits to 0 before resuming reception. Figure 14.9 shows a sample flowchart for serial data reception. Table 14.11 SSR Status Flags and Receive Data Handling SSR Status Flag RDRF* ORER FER PER Receive Data Receive Error Type 1 1 0 0 Lost Overrun error 0 0 1 0 Transferred to RDR Framing error 0 0 0 1 Transferred to RDR Parity error 1 1 1 0 Lost Overrun error + framing error 1 1 0 1 Lost Overrun error + parity error 0 0 1 1 Transferred to RDR Framing error + parity error 1 1 1 1 Lost Overrun error + framing error + parity error Note: * The RDRF flag retains the state it had before data reception. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 342 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Initialization [1] Start reception [1] SCI initialization: The RxD pin is automatically designated as the receive data input pin. [2] [3] Receive error processing and break detection: [2] If a receive error occurs, read the ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR to identify the error. After performing the Yes appropriate error processing, ensure PER∨FER∨ORER = 1 that the ORER, PER, and FER flags are [3] all cleared to 0. Reception cannot be No Error processing resumed if any of these flags are set to 1. In the case of a framing error, a (Continued on next page) break can be detected by reading the value of the input port corresponding to [4] Read RDRF flag in SSR the RxD pin. Read ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR [4] SCI status check and receive data read: Read SSR and check that RDRF = 1, then read the receive data in RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0. Transition of the RDRF flag from 0 to 1 can also be identified by an RXI interrupt. No RDRF = 1 Yes Read receive data in RDR, and clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0 No All data received? Yes Clear RE bit in SCR to 0 [5] [5] Serial reception continuation procedure: To continue serial reception, before the stop bit for the current frame is received, read the RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF flag to 0. The RDRF flag is cleared automatically when DTC is activated by an RXI interrupt and the RDR value is read. <End> Figure 14.9 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 343 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) [3] Error processing No ORER = 1 Yes Overrun error processing No FER = 1 Yes Yes Break? No Framing error processing Clear RE bit in SCR to 0 No PER = 1 Yes Parity error processing Clear ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR to 0 <End> Figure 14.9 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 344 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.5 Multiprocessor Communication Function Use of the multiprocessor communication function enables data transfer between a number of processors sharing communication lines by asynchronous serial communication using the multiprocessor format, in which a multiprocessor bit is added to the transfer data. When multiprocessor communication is performed, each receiving station is addressed by a unique ID code. The serial communication cycle consists of two component cycles; an ID transmission cycle that specifies the receiving station, and a data transmission cycle. The multiprocessor bit is used to differentiate between the ID transmission cycle and the data transmission cycle. If the multiprocessor bit is 1, the cycle is an ID transmission cycle; if the multiprocessor bit is 0, the cycle is a data transmission cycle. Figure 14.10 shows an example of inter-processor communication using the multiprocessor format. The transmitting station first sends the ID code of the receiving station with which it wants to perform serial communication as data with a 1 multiprocessor bit added. It then sends transmit data as data with a 0 multiprocessor bit added. When data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is received, the receiving station compares that data with its own ID. The station whose ID matches then receives the data sent next. Stations whose IDs do not match continue to skip data until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is again received. The SCI uses the MPIE bit in SCR to implement this function. When the MPIE bit is set to 1, transfer of receive data from RSR to RDR, error flag detection, and setting the SSR status flags, RDRF, FER, and ORER to 1, are inhibited until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is received. On reception of a receive character with a 1 multiprocessor bit, the MPB bit in SSR is set to 1 and the MPIE bit is automatically cleared, thus normal reception is resumed. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an RXI interrupt is generated. When the multiprocessor format is selected, the parity bit setting is rendered invalid. All other bit settings are the same as those in normal asynchronous mode. The clock used for multiprocessor communication is the same as that in normal asynchronous mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 345 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Transmitting station Serial transmission line Receiving station A Receiving station B Receiving station C Receiving station D (ID = 01) (ID = 02) (ID = 03) (ID = 04) Serial data H'01 H'AA (MPB = 1) (MPB = 0) ID transmission cycle = Data transmission cycle = receiving station Data transmission to specification receiving station specified by ID Legend: MPB: Multiprocessor bit Figure 14.10 Example of Communication Using Multiprocessor Format (Transmission of Data H'AA to Receiving Station A) 14.5.1 Multiprocessor Serial Data Transmission Figure 14.11 shows a sample flowchart for multiprocessor serial data transmission. For an ID transmission cycle, set the MPBT bit in SSR to 1 before transmission. For a data transmission cycle, clear the MPBT bit in SSR to 0 before transmission. All other SCI operations are the same as those in asynchronous mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 346 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) [1] Initialization Start transmission Read TDRE flag in SSR [2] No [2] SCI status check and transmit data write: Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag is set to 1, then write transmit data to TDR. Set the MPBT bit in SSR to 0 or 1. Finally, clear the TDRE flag to 0. TDRE = 1 Yes Write transmit data to TDR and set MPBT bit in SSR Clear TDRE flag to 0 No All data transmitted? [3] Yes Read TEND flag in SSR No TEND = 1 Yes No Break output? [1] SCI initialization: The TxD pin is automatically designated as the transmit data output pin. After the TE bit is set to 1, a frame of 1s is output, and transmission is enabled. [4] Yes [3] Serial transmission continuation procedure: To continue serial transmission, be sure to read 1 from the TDRE flag to confirm that writing is possible, then write data to TDR, and then clear the TDRE flag to 0. Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag is automatic when the DTC is activated by a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI) request, and data is written to TDR. [4] Break output at the end of serial transmission: To output a break in serial transmission, set the port DDR to 1, clear DR to 0, then clear the TE bit in SCR to 0. Clear DR to 0 and set DDR to 1 Clear TE bit in SCR to 0 <End> Figure 14.11 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Transmission Flowchart 14.5.2 Multiprocessor Serial Data Reception Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 347 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Figure 14.13 shows a sample flowchart for multiprocessor serial data reception. If the MPIE bit in SCR is set to 1, data is skipped until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is received. On receiving data with a 1 multiprocessor bit, the receive data is transferred to RDR. An RXI interrupt request is generated at this time. All other SCI operations are the same as in asynchronous mode. Figure 14.12 shows an example of SCI operation for multiprocessor format reception. 1 Start bit 0 Data (ID1) MPB D0 D1 D7 1 Stop bit Start bit 1 0 Data (Data1) D0 D1 Stop MPB bit D7 0 1 1 Idle state (mark state) MPIE RDRF RDR value ID1 MPIE = 0 RXI interrupt request (multiprocessor interrupt) generated If not this station’s ID, MPIE bit is set to 1 again RDR data read and RDRF flag cleared to 0 in RXI interrupt service routine RXI interrupt request is not generated, and RDR retains its state (a) Data does not match station’s ID 1 Start bit 0 Data (ID2) D0 D1 Stop MPB bit D7 1 1 Start bit 0 Data (Data2) D0 D1 D7 Stop MPB bit 0 1 1 Idle state (mark state) MPIE RDRF RDR value ID1 MPIE = 0 Data2 ID2 RXI interrupt request (multiprocessor interrupt) generated RDR data read and RDRF flag cleared to 0 in RXI interrupt service routine Matches this station’s ID, so reception continues, and data is received in RXI interrupt service routine MPIE bit set to 1 again (b) Data matches station’s ID Figure 14.12 Example of SCI Operation in Reception (Example with 8-Bit Data, Multiprocessor Bit, One Stop Bit) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 348 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Initialization [1] SCI initialization: The RxD pin is automatically designated as the receive data input pin. [1] Start reception Read MPIE bit in SCR [2] ID reception cycle: Set the MPIE bit in SCR to 1. [2] [3] SCI status check, ID reception and comparison: Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read the receive data in RDR and compare it with this station’s ID. If the data is not this station’s ID, set the MPIE bit to 1 again, and clear the RDRF flag to 0. If the data is this station’s ID, clear the RDRF flag to 0. Read ORER and FER flags in SSR FER ∨ ORER = 1 Yes No Read RDRF flag in SSR [3] No RDRF = 1 [4] SCI status check and data reception: Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read the data in RDR. Yes Read receive data in RDR No This station’s ID? Yes Read ORER and FER flags in SSR FER ∨ ORER = 1 Yes No Read RDRF flag in SSR [5] Receive error processing and break detection: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER and FER flags in SSR to identify the error. After performing the appropriate error processing, ensure that the ORER and FER flags are all cleared to 0. Reception cannot be resumed if either of these flags is set to 1. In the case of a framing error, a break can be detected by reading the RxD pin [4] value. No RDRF = 1 Yes Read receive data in RDR No All data received? [5] Error processing Yes Clear RE bit in SCR to 0 (Continued on next page) <End> Figure 14.13 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 349 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) [5] Error processing No ORER = 1 Yes Overrun error processing No FER = 1 Yes Yes Break? No Framing error processing Clear RE bit in SCR to 0 Clear ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR to 0 <End> Figure 14.13 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (2) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 350 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.6 Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode Figure 14.14 shows the general format for clocked synchronous communication. In clocked synchronous mode, data is transmitted or received synchronous with clock pulses. Each character of data transferred consists of 8 bits. In clocked synchronous serial communication, data on the transmission line is output from one falling edge of the serial clock to the next. In clocked synchronous mode, the SCI receives data in synchronous with the rising edge of the serial clock. After 8-bit data is output, the transmission line holds the MSB state. In clocked synchronous mode, no parity or multiprocessor bit is added. Inside the SCI, the transmitter and receiver are independent units, enabling full-duplex communication through the use of a common clock. Both the transmitter and the receiver also have a double-buffered structure, so data can be read or written during transmission or reception, enabling continuous data transfer. One unit of transfer data (character or frame) * * Synchronization clock MSB LSB Bit 0 Serial data Bit 1 Don’t care Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Don’t care Note: * High except in continuous transfer Figure 14.14 Data Format in Synchronous Communication (For LSB-First) 14.6.1 Clock Either an internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external synchronization clock input at the SCK pin can be selected, according to the setting of CKE0 and CKE1 bits in SCR. When the SCI is operated on an internal clock, the serial clock is output from the SCK pin. Eight serial clock pulses are output in the transfer of one character, and when no transfer is performed the clock is fixed high. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 351 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.6.2 SCI Initialization (Clocked Synchronous Mode) Before transmitting and receiving data, the TE and RE bits in SCR should be cleared to 0, then the SCI should be initialized as described in a sample flowchart in figure 14.15. When the operating mode, or transfer format, is changed for example, the TE and RE bits must be cleared to 0 before making the change using the following procedure. When the TE bit is cleared to 0, the TDRE flag is set to 1. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not change the contents of the RDRF, PER, FER, and ORER flags, or the contents of RDR. [1] Set the clock selection in SCR. Be sure to clear bits RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE, and RE, to 0. Start initialization Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0 [2] Set the data transfer format in SMR and SCMR. Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR (TE, RE bits 0) [1] Set data transfer format in SMR and SCMR [2] Set value in BRR [3] Wait [3] Write a value corresponding to the bit rate to BRR. Not necessary if an external clock is used. [4] Wait at least one bit interval, then set the TE bit or RE bit in SCR to 1. Also set the RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits. Setting the TE and RE bits enables the TxD and RxD pins to be used. No 1-bit interval elapsed? Yes Set TE and RE bits in SCR to 1, and set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits [4] <Transfer start> Note: * In simultaneous transmit and receive operations, the TE and RE bits should both be cleared to 0 or set to 1 simultaneously. Figure 14.15 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 352 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.6.3 Serial Data Transmission (Clocked Synchronous Mode) Figure 14.16 shows an example of SCI operation for transmission in clocked synchronous mode. In serial transmission, the SCI operates as described below. 1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR, and if the flag is 0, the SCI recognizes that data has been written to TDR, and transfers the data from TDR to TSR. 2. After transferring data from TDR to TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts transmission. If the TIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI) is generated. Continuous transmission is possible because the TXI interrupt routine writes the next transmit data to TDR before transmission of the current transmit data has been completed. 3. 8-bit data is sent from the TxD pin synchronized with the output clock when output clock mode has been specified, and synchronized with the input clock when use of an external clock has been specified. 4. The SCI checks the TDRE flag at the timing for sending the MSB (bit 7). 5. If the TDRE flag is cleared to 0, data is transferred from TDR to TSR, and serial transmission of the next frame is started. 6. If the TDRE flag is set to 1, the TEND flag in SSR is set to 1, and the TDRE flag maintains the output state of the last bit. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a TEI interrupt request is generated. The SCK pin is fixed high. Figure 14.17 shows a sample flow chart for serial data transmission. Even if the TDRE flag is cleared to 0, transmission will not start while a receive error flag (ORER, FER, or PER) is set to 1. Make sure that the receive error flags are cleared to 0 before starting transmission. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not clear the receive error flags. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 353 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Transfer direction Synchronization clock Serial data Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 6 Bit 7 TDRE TEND TXI interrupt request generated Data written to TDR and TDRE flag cleared to 0 in TXI interrupt service routine TXI interrupt request generated TEI interrupt request generated 1 frame Figure 14.16 Sample SCI Transmission Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 354 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Initialization [1] Start transmission Read TDRE flag in SSR [2] No TDRE = 1 Yes Write transmit data to TDR and clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0 No All data transmitted? [3] Yes [1] SCI initialization: The TxD pin is automatically designated as the transmit data output pin. [2] SCI status check and transmit data write: Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag is set to 1, then write transmit data to TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. [3] Serial transmission continuation procedure: To continue serial transmission, be sure to read 1 from the TDRE flag to confirm that writing is possible, then write data to TDR, and then clear the TDRE flag to 0. Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag is automatic when the DTC is activated by a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI) request and data is written to TDR. Read TEND flag in SSR No TEND = 1 Yes Clear TE bit in SCR to 0 <End> Figure 14.17 Sample Serial Transmission Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 355 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.6.4 Serial Data Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode) Figure 14.18 shows an example of SCI operation for reception in clocked synchronous mode. In serial reception, the SCI operates as described below. 1. The SCI performs internal initialization synchronous with a synchronous clock input or output, starts receiving data, and stores the received data in RSR. 2. If an overrun error occurs (when reception of the next data is completed while the RDRF flag in SSR is still set to 1), the ORER bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated, receive data is not transferred to RDR, and the RDRF flag remains to be set to 1. 3. If reception is completed successfully, the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, and receive data is transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an RXI interrupt request is generated. Continuous reception is possible because the RXI interrupt routine reads the receive data transferred to RDR before reception of the next receive data has finished. Synchronization clock Serial data Bit 7 Bit 0 Bit 7 Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 6 Bit 7 RDRF ORER RXI interrupt request generated RDR data read and RDRF flag cleared to 0 in RXI interrupt service routine RXI interrupt request generated ERI interrupt request generated by overrun error 1 frame Figure 14.18 Example of SCI Operation in Reception Reception cannot be resumed while a receive error flag is set to 1. Accordingly, clear the ORER, FER, PER, and RDRF bits to 0 before resuming reception. Figure 14.19 shows a sample flow chart for serial data reception. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 356 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) [1] Initialization Start reception [2] Read ORER flag in SSR Yes [3] ORER = 1 No Error processing (Continued below) Read RDRF flag in SSR [4] No RDRF = 1 Yes Read receive data in RDR, and clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0 No All data received? Yes Clear RE bit in SCR to 0 [5] [1] SCI initialization: The RxD pin is automatically designated as the receive data input pin. [2] [3] Receive error processing: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER flag in SSR, and after performing the appropriate error processing, clear the ORER flag to 0. Transfer cannot be resumed if the ORER flag is set to 1. [4] SCI status check and receive data read: Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read the receive data in RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0. Transition of the RDRF flag from 0 to 1 can also be identified by an RXI interrupt. [5] Serial reception continuation procedure: To continue serial reception, before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received, reading the RDRF flag, reading RDR, and clearing the RDRF flag to 0 should be finished. The RDRF flag is cleared automatically when the DTC is activated by a receive data full interrupt (RXI) request and the RDR value is read. <End> [3] Error processing Overrun error processing Clear ORER flag in SSR to 0 <End> Figure 14.19 Sample Serial Reception Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 357 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.6.5 Simultaneous Serial Data Transmission and Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode) Figure 14.20 shows a sample flowchart for simultaneous serial transmit and receive operations. The following procedure should be used for simultaneous serial data transmit and receive operations after initializing the SCI. To switch from transmit mode to simultaneous transmit and receive mode, after checking that the SCI has finished transmission and the TDRE and TEND flags are set to 1, clear TE to 0. Then simultaneously set TE and RE to 1 with a single instruction. To switch from receive mode to simultaneous transmit and receive mode, after checking that the SCI has finished reception, clear RE to 0. Then after checking that the RDRF and receive error flags (ORER, FER, and PER) are cleared to 0, simultaneously set TE and RE to 1 with a single instruction. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 358 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Initialization [1] [1] SCI initialization: The TxD pin is designated as the transmit data output pin, and the RxD pin is designated as the receive data input pin, enabling simultaneous transmit and receive operations. [2] SCI status check and transmit data write: Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag is set to 1, then write transmit data to TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. Transition of the TDRE flag from 0 to 1 can also be identified by a TXI interrupt. Receive error processing: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER flag in SSR, and after performing the appropriate error processing, clear the ORER flag to 0. Transmission/reception cannot be resumed if the ORER flag is set to 1. Start transmission/reception Read TDRE flag in SSR [2] No TDRE = 1 Yes Write transmit data to TDR and clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0 [3] Read ORER flag in SSR ORER = 1 No Read RDRF flag in SSR Yes [3] Error processing [4] SCI status check and receive data read: Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read the receive data in RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0. Transition of the RDRF flag from 0 to 1 can also be identified by an RXI interrupt. [5] Serial transmission/reception continuation procedure: To continue serial transmission/ reception, before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received, finish reading the RDRF flag, reading RDR, and clearing the RDRF flag to 0. Also, before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is transmitted, read 1 from the TDRE flag to confirm that writing is possible. Then write data to TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag is automatic when the DTC is activated by a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI) request and data is written to TDR. Also, the RDRF flag is cleared automatically when the DTC is activated by a receive data full interrupt (RXI) request and the RDR value is read. [4] No RDRF = 1 Yes Read receive data in RDR, and clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0 No All data received? [5] Yes Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0 <End> Note: * When switching from transmit or receive operation to simultaneous transmit and receive operations, first clear the TE bit and RE bit to 0, then set both these bits to 1 simultaneously. Figure 14.20 Sample Flowchart of Simultaneous Serial Transmit and Receive Operations Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 359 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.7 Operation in Smart Card Interface The SCI supports an IC card (Smart Card) interface that conforms to ISO/IEC 7816-3 (Identification Card) as a serial communication interface extension function. Switching between the normal serial communication interface and the Smart Card interface mode is carried out by means of a register setting. 14.7.1 Pin Connection Example Figure 14.21 shows an example of connection with the Smart Card. In communication with an IC card, as both transmission and reception are carried out on a single data transmission line, the TxD pin and RxD pin should be connected to the LSI pin. The data transmission line should be pulled up to the VCC power supply with a resistor. If an IC card is not connected, and the TE and RE bits are both set to 1, closed transmission/reception is possible, enabling self-diagnosis to be carried out. When the clock generated on the Smart Card interface is used by an IC card, the SCK pin output is input to the CLK pin of the IC card. This LSI port output is used as the reset signal. VCC TxD RxD SCK Rx (port) This LSI Data line Clock line Reset line I/O CLK RST IC card Connected equipment Figure 14.21 Schematic Diagram of Smart Card Interface Pin Connections Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 360 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.7.2 Data Format (Except for Block Transfer Mode) Figure 14.22 shows the transfer data format in Smart Card interface mode. • One frame consists of 8-bit data plus a parity bit in asynchronous mode. • In transmission, a guard time of at least 2 etu (Elementary Time Unit: the time for transfer of one bit) is left between the end of the parity bit and the start of the next frame. • If a parity error is detected during reception, a low error signal level is output for one etu period, 10.5 etu after the start bit. • If an error signal is sampled during transmission, the same data is retransmitted automatically after a delay of 2 etu or longer. When there is no parity error Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp D6 D7 Dp Transmitting station output When a parity error occurs Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 DE Transmitting station output [Legend] DS: D0 to D7: Dp: DE: Receiving station output Start bit Data bits Parity bit Error signal Figure 14.22 Normal Smart Card Interface Data Format Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 361 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Data transfer with other types of IC cards (direct convention and inverse convention) are performed as described in the following. (Z) A Z Z A Z Z Z A A Z Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp (Z) State Figure 14.23 Direct Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 0) With the direction convention type IC and the above sample start character, the logic 1 level corresponds to state Z and the logic 0 level to state A, and transfer is performed in LSB-first order. The start character data above is H'3B. For the direct convention type, clear the SDIR and SINV bits in SCMR to 0. According to Smart Card regulations, clear the O/E bit in SMR to 0 to select even parity mode. (Z) A Z Z A A A A A A Z Ds D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Dp (Z) State Figure 14.24 Inverse Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 1) With the inverse convention type, the logic 1 level corresponds to state A and the logic 0 level to state Z, and transfer is performed in MSB-first order. The start character data for the above is H'3F. For the inverse convention type, set the SDIR and SINV bits in SCMR to 1. According to Smart Card regulations, even parity mode is the logic 0 level of the parity bit, and corresponds to state Z. In this LSI, the SINV bit inverts only data bits D7 to D0. Therefore, set the O/E bit in SMR to 1 to invert the parity bit for both transmission and reception. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 362 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.7.3 Block Transfer Mode Operation in block transfer mode is the same as that in SCI asynchronous mode, except for the following points. • In reception, though the parity check is performed, no error signal is output even if an error is detected. However, the PER bit in SSR is set to 1 and must be cleared before receiving the parity bit of the next frame. • In transmission, a guard time of at least 1 etu is left between the end of the parity bit and the start of the next frame. • In transmission, because retransmission is not performed, the TEND flag is set to 1, 11.5 etu after transmission start. • As with the normal Smart Card interface, the ERS flag indicates the error signal status, but since error signal transfer is not performed, this flag is always cleared to 0. 14.7.4 Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Smart Card Interface Mode In Smart Card interface mode, the SCI operates on a basic clock with a frequency of 32, 64, 372, or 256 times the transfer rate (fixed at 16 times in normal asynchronous mode) as determined by bits BCP1 and BCP0. In reception, the SCI samples the falling edge of the start bit using the basic clock, and performs internal synchronization. As shown in figure 14.25, by sampling receive data at the rising-edge of the 16th, 32nd, 186th, or 128th pulse of the basic clock, data can be latched at the middle of the bit. The reception margin is given by the following formula. M = | (0.5 – | D – 0.5 | 1 ) – (L – 0.5) F – (1 + F) | × 100% N 2N Where M: Reception margin (%) N: Ratio of bit rate to clock (N = 32, 64, 372, and 256) D: Clock duty cycle (D = 0 to 1.0) L: Frame length (L = 10) F: Absolute value of clock frequency deviation Assuming values of F = 0, D = 0.5 and N = 372 in the above formula, the reception margin formula is as follows. M = (0.5 – 1/2 × 372) × 100% = 49.866% Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 363 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 372 clocks 186 clocks 0 185 185 371 0 371 0 Internal basic clock Receive data (RxD) Start bit D0 D1 Synchronization sampling timing Data sampling timing Figure 14.25 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode (Using Clock of 372 Times the Transfer Rate) 14.7.5 Initialization Before transmitting and receiving data, initialize the SCI as described below. Initialization is also necessary when switching from transmit mode to receive mode, or vice versa. 1. 2. 3. 4. Clear the TE and RE bits in SCR to 0. Clear the error flags ERS, PER, and ORER in SSR to 0. Set the GM, BLK, O/E, BCP0, BCP1, CKS0, CKS1 bits in SMR. Set the PE bit to 1. Set the SMIF, SDIR, and SINV bits in SCMR. When the SMIF bit is set to 1, the TxD and RxD pins are both switched from ports to SCI pins, and are placed in the high-impedance state. 5. Set the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR. 6. Set the CKE0 and CKE1 bits in SCR. Clear the TIE, RIE, TE, RE, MPIE, and TEIE bits to 0. If the CKE0 bit is set to 1, the clock is output from the SCK pin. 7. Wait at least one bit interval, then set the TIE, RIE, TE, and RE bits in SCR. Do not set the TE bit and RE bit at the same time, except for self-diagnosis. To switch from receive mode to transmit mode, after checking that the SCI has finished reception, initialize the SCI, and set RE to 0 and TE to 1. Whether SCI has finished reception or not can be checked with the RDRF, PER, or ORER flags. To switch from transmit mode to receive mode, Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 364 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) after checking that the SCI has finished transmission, initialize the SCI, and set TE to 0 and RE to 1. Whether SCI has finished transmission or not can be checked with the TEND flag. 14.7.6 Data Transmission (Except for Block Transfer Mode) As data transmission in Smart Card interface mode involves error signal sampling and retransmission processing, the operations are different from those in normal serial communication interface mode (except for block transfer mode). Figure 14.26 illustrates the retransfer operation when the SCI is in transmit mode. 1. If an error signal is sent back from the receiving end after transmission of one frame is complete, the ERS bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated. The ERS bit in SSR should be kept cleared to 0 until the next parity bit is sampled. 2. The TEND bit in SSR is not set for a frame in which an error signal indicating an abnormality is received. Data is retransferred from TDR to TSR, and retransmitted automatically. 3. If an error signal is not sent back from the receiving end, the ERS bit in SSR is not set. Transmission of one frame, including a retransfer, is judged to have been completed, and the TEND bit in SSR is set to 1. If the TIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, a TXI interrupt request is generated. Writing transmit data to TDR transfers the next transmit data. Figure 14.28 shows a flowchart for transmission. The sequence of transmit operations can be performed automatically by specifying the DTC to be activated with a TXI interrupt source. In a transmit operation, the TDRE flag is set to 1 at the same time as the TEND flag in SSR is set, and a TXI interrupt will be generated if the TIE bit in SCR has been set to 1. If the TXI request is designated beforehand as a DTC activation source, the DTC will be activated by the TXI request, and transfer of the transmit data will be carried out. The TDRE and TEND flags are automatically cleared to 0 when data is transferred by the DTC. In the event of an error, the SCI retransmits the same data automatically. During this period, the TEND flag remains cleared to 0 and the DTC is not activated. Therefore, the SCI and DTC will automatically transmit the specified number of bytes in the event of an error, including retransmission. However, the ERS flag is not cleared automatically when an error occurs, and so the RIE bit should be set to 1 beforehand so that an ERI request will be generated in the event of an error, and the ERS flag will be cleared. When performing transfer using the DTC, it is essential to set and enable the DTC before carrying out SCI setting. For details of the DTC setting procedures, refer to section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 365 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Transfer frame n+1 Retransferred frame nth transfer frame Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp (DE) Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 TDRE Transfer to TSR from TDR Transfer to TSR from TDR Transfer to TSR from TDR TEND [7] [9] FER/ERS [6] [8] Figure 14.26 Retransfer Operation in SCI Transmit Mode The timing for setting the TEND flag depends on the value of the GM bit in SMR. The TEND flag set timing is shown in figure 14.27. I/O data Ds D0 D1 TXI (TEND interrupt) D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE Guard time 12.5 etu When GM = 0 11.0 etu When GM = 1 [Legend] Ds: D0 to D7: Dp: DE: Start bit Data bits Parity bit Error signal Figure 14.27 TEND Flag Generation Timing in Transmission Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 366 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Start Initialization Start transmission ERS = 0? No Yes Error processing No TEND = 1? Yes Write data to TDR, and clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0 No All data transmitted ? Yes No ERS = 0? Yes Error processing No TEND = 1? Yes Clear TE bit to 0 End Figure 14.28 Example of Transmission Processing Flow Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 367 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.7.7 Serial Data Reception (Except for Block Transfer Mode) Data reception in Smart Card interface mode uses the same operation procedure as for normal serial communication interface mode. Figure 14.29 illustrates the retransfer operation when the SCI is in receive mode. 1. If an error is found when the received parity bit is checked, the PER bit in SSR is automatically set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated. The PER bit in SSR should be kept cleared to 0 until the next parity bit is sampled. 2. The RDRF bit in SSR is not set for a frame in which an error has occurred. 3. If no error is found when the received parity bit is checked, the PER bit in SSR is not set to 1, the receive operation is judged to have been completed normally, and the RDRF flag in SSR is automatically set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, an RXI interrupt request is generated. Figure 14.30 shows a flowchart for reception. A sequence of receive operations can be performed automatically by specifying the DTC to be activated using an RXI interrupt source. In a receive operation, an RXI interrupt request is generated when the RDRF flag is set to 1 if the RIE bit is set to 1. If the RXI request is designated beforehand as a DTC activation source, the DTC will be activated by the RXI request, and the receive data will be transferred. The RDRF flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is transferred by the DTC. If an error occurs in receive mode and the ORER or PER flag is set to 1, a transfer error interrupt (ERI) request will be generated. Hence, so the error flag must be cleared to 0. In the event of an error, the DTC is not activated and receive data is skipped. Therefore, receive data is transferred for only the specified number of bytes in the event of an error. Even when a parity error occurs in receive mode and the PER flag is set to 1, the data that has been received is transferred to RDR and can be read from there. Note: For details on receive operations in block transfer mode, refer to section 14.4, Operation in Asynchronous Mode. Transfer frame n+1 Retransferred frame nth transfer frame Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp (DE) Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 RDRF [2] [4] [1] [3] PER Figure 14.29 Retransfer Operation in SCI Receive Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 368 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Start Initialization Start reception ORER = 0 and PER = 0 No Yes Error processing No RDRF = 1? Yes Read RDR and clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0 No All data received? Yes Clear RE bit to 0 Figure 14.30 Example of Reception Processing Flow Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 369 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.7.8 Clock Output Control When the GM bit in SMR is set to 1, the clock output level can be fixed with bits CKE0 and CKE1 in SCR. At this time, the minimum clock pulse width can be made the specified width. Figure 14.31 shows the timing for fixing the clock output level. In this example, GM is set to 1, CKE1 is cleared to 0, and the CKE0 bit is controlled. CKE0 SCK Specified pulse width Specified pulse width Figure 14.31 Timing for Fixing Clock Output Level When turning on the power or switching between Smart Card interface mode and software standby mode, the following procedures should be followed in order to maintain the clock duty cycle. Powering On: To secure clock duty cycle from power-on, the following switching procedure should be followed. 1. The initial state is port input and high impedance. Use a pull-up resistor or pull-down resistor to fix the potential. 2. Fix the SCK pin to the specified output level with the CKE1 bit in SCR. 3. Set SMR and SCMR, and switch to smart card mode operation. 4. Set the CKE0 bit in SCR to 1 to start clock output. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 370 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) When Changing from Smart Card Interface Mode to Software Standby Mode: 1. Set the data register (DR) and data direction register (DDR) corresponding to the SCK pin to the value for the fixed output state in software standby mode. 2. Write 0 to the TE bit and RE bit in the serial control register (SCR) to halt transmit/receive operation. At the same time, set the CKE1 bit to the value for the fixed output state in software standby mode. 3. Write 0 to the CKE0 bit in SCR to halt the clock. 4. Wait for one serial clock period. During this interval, clock output is fixed at the specified level, with the duty cycle preserved. 5. Make the transition to the software standby state. When Returning to Smart Card Interface Mode from Software Standby Mode: 1. Exit the software standby state. 2. Write 1 to the CKE0 bit in SCR and output the clock. Signal generation is started with the normal duty cycle. Software standby Normal operation [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] Normal operation [6] [7] Figure 14.32 Clock Halt and Restart Procedure Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 371 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.8 Interrupt Sources 14.8.1 Interrupts in Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode Table 14.12 shows the interrupt sources in normal serial communication interface mode. A different interrupt vector is assigned to each interrupt source, and individual interrupt sources can be enabled or disabled using the enable bits in SCR. When the TDRE flag in SSR is set to 1, a TXI interrupt request is generated. When the TEND flag in SSR is set to 1, a TEI interrupt request is generated. A TXI interrupt can activate the DTC to perform data transfer. The TDRE flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is transferred by the DTC. When the RDRF flag in SSR is set to 1, an RXI interrupt request is generated. When the ORER, PER, or FER flag in SSR is set to 1, an ERI interrupt request is generated. An RXI interrupt request can activate the DTC to transfer data. The RDRF flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is transferred by the DTC. A TEI interrupt is requested when the TEND flag is set to 1 and the TEIE bit is set to 1. If a TEI interrupt and a TXI interrupt are requested simultaneously, the TXI interrupt has priority for acceptance. However, if the TDRE and TEND flags are cleared simultaneously by the TXI interrupt routine, the SCI cannot branch to the TEI interrupt routine later. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 372 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.12 SCI Interrupt Sources Channel Name 0 ERI_0 Receive Error ORER, FER, PER Not possible RXI_0 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_0 Transmit Data Empty TDRE Possible TEI_0 Transmission End TEND Not possible ERI_1 Receive Error ORER, FER, PER Not possible RXI_1 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_1 Transmit Data Empty TDRE Possible TEI_1 Transmission End TEND Not possible ERI_2 Receive Error ORER, FER, PER Not possible RXI_2 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_2 Transmit Data Empty TDRE Possible TEI_2 Transmission End TEND Not possible 1 2 14.8.2 Interrupt Source Interrupt Flag DTC Activation Interrupts in Smart Card Interface Mode Table 14.13 shows the interrupt sources in Smart Card interface mode. The transmit end interrupt (TEI) request cannot be used in this mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 373 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Table 14.13 SCI Interrupt Sources Channel Name Interrupt Source Interrupt Flag DTC Activation 0 ERI_0 Receive Error, error signal detection ORER, PER, ERS Not possible RXI_0 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_0 Transmit Data Empty TEND Possible ERI_1 Receive Error, error signal detection ORER, PER, ERS Not possible RXI_1 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_1 Transmit Data Empty TEND Possible ERI_2 Receive Error, error signal detection ORER, PER, ERS Not possible RXI_2 Receive Data Full RDRF Possible TXI_2 Transmit Data Empty TEND Possible 1 2 In Smart Card interface mode, as in normal serial communication interface mode, transfer can be carried out using the DTC. In transmit operations, the TDRE flag is also set to 1 at the same time as the TEND flag in SSR is set, and a TXI interrupt is generated. If the TXI request is designated beforehand as a DTC activation source, the DTC will be activated by the TXI request, and transmit data will be transferred. The TDRE and TEND flags are automatically cleared to 0 when data is transferred by the DTC. In the event of an error, the SCI retransmits the same data automatically. During this period, the TEND flag remains cleared to 0 and the DTC is not activated. Therefore, the SCI and DTC will automatically transmit the specified number of bytes in the event of an error, including retransmission. However, the ERS flag is not cleared automatically when an error occurs. Hence, the RIE bit should be set to 1 beforehand so that an ERI request will be generated in the event of an error, and the ERS flag will be cleared. When transferring using the DTC, it is essential to set and enable the DTC before carrying out SCI setting. For details of the DTC setting procedures, refer to section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). In receive operations, an RXI interrupt request is generated when the RDRF flag in SSR is set to 1. If the RXI request is designated beforehand as a DTC activation source, the DTC will be activated by the RXI request, and the receive data will be transferred. The RDRF flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is transferred by the DTC. If an error occurs, an error flag is set but the RDRF flag is not. Consequently, the DTC is not activated, instead, an ERI interrupt request is sent to the CPU. Therefore, the error flag should be cleared. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 374 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.9 Usage Notes 14.9.1 Module Stop Mode Setting SCI operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for SCI operation to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 14.9.2 Break Detection and Processing When framing error detection is performed, a break can be detected by reading the RxD pin value directly. In a break, the input from the RxD pin becomes all 0s, setting the FER flag, and possibly the PER flag. Note that as the SCI continues the receive operation after receiving a break, even if the FER flag is cleared to 0, it will be set to 1 again. 14.9.3 Mark State and Break Detection When TE is 0, the TxD pin is used as an I/O port whose direction (input or output) and level are determined by DR and DDR. This can be used to set the TxD pin to mark state (high level) or send a break during serial data transmission. To maintain the communication line at mark state until TE is set to 1, set both DDR and DR to 1. As TE is cleared to 0 at this point, the TxD pin becomes an I/O port, and 1 is output from the TxD pin. To send a break during serial transmission, first set DDR to 1 and DR to 0, and then clear TE to 0. When TE is cleared to 0, the transmitter is initialized regardless of the current transmission state, the TxD pin becomes an I/O port, and 0 is output from the TxD pin. 14.9.4 Receive Error Flags and Transmit Operations (Clocked Synchronous Mode Only) Transmission cannot be started when a receive error flag (ORER, PER, or FER) is set to 1, even if the TDRE flag is cleared to 0. Be sure to clear the receive error flags to 0 before starting transmission. Note also that receive error flags cannot be cleared to 0 even if the RE bit is cleared to 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 375 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.9.5 Restrictions on Using DTC When the external clock source is used as a synchronization clock, update TDR by the DTC and wait for at least five φ clock cycles before allowing the transmit clock to be input. If the transmit clock is input within four clock cycles after TDR modification, the SCI may malfunction (figure 14.33). When using the DTC to read RDR, be sure to set the receive end interrupt source (RXI) as a DTC activation source. SCK t TDRE LSB Serial data D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Note: When external clock is supplied, t must be more than four clock cycles. Figure 14.33 Sample Transmission using DTC in Clocked Synchronous Mode 14.9.6 SCI Operations during Mode Transitions Transmission: Before making the transition to module stop, software standby, watch, sub-active, or sub-sleep mode, stop all transmit operations (TE = TIE = TEIE = 0). TSR, TDR, and SSR are reset. The states of the output pins during each mode depend on the port settings, and the pins output a high-level signal after mode is cancelled and then the TE is set to 1 again. If the transition is made during data transmission, the data being transmitted will be undefined. To transmit data in the same transmission mode after mode cancellation, set TE to 1, read SSR, write to TDR, clear TDRE in this order, and then start transmission. To transmit data in a different transmission mode, initialize the SCI first. Figure 14.34 shows a sample flowchart for mode transition during transmission. Figures 14.35 and 14.36 show the pin states during transmission. Before making the transition from the transmission mode using DTC transfer to module stop, software standby, watch, sub-active, or sub-sleep mode, stop all transmit operations (TE = TIE = TEIE = 0). Setting TE and TIE to 1 after mode cancellation generates a TXI interrupt request to start transmission using the DTC. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 376 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Transmission No All data transmitted? [1] [1] Data being transmitted is lost halfway. Data can be normally transmitted from the CPU by setting TE to 1, reading SSR, writing to TDR, and clearing TDRE to 0 after mode cancellation; however, if the DTC has been initiated, the data remaining in DTC RAM will be transmitted when TE and TIE are set to 1. Yes Read TEND flag in SSR No TEND = 1 Yes TE = 0 [2] [2] Also clear TIE and TEIE to 0 when they are 1. [3] Make transition to software standby mode etc. [3] Module stop, watch, sub-active, and sub-sleep modes are included. Cancel software standby mode etc. No Change operating mode? Yes Initialization TE = 1 Start transmission Figure 14.34 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Transmission Transmission start Transmission end Transition to Software standby software standby mode cancelled mode TE bit SCK output pin TxD output pin Port input/output Port input/output Port High output Start SCI TxD output Stop Port input/output Port High output SCI TxD output Figure 14.35 Pin States during Transmission in Asynchronous Mode (Internal Clock) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 377 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Transmission start Transmission end Transition to Software standby software standby mode cancelled mode TE bit SCK output pin TxD output pin Port input/output Port input/output Marking output Port Last TxD bit retained SCI TxD output Port input/output Port High output* SCI TxD output Note: * Initialized in software standby mode Figure 14.36 Pin States during Transmission in Clocked Synchronous Mode (Internal Clock) Reception: Before making the transition to module stop, software standby, watch, sub-active, or sub-sleep mode, stop reception (RE = 0). RSR, RDR, and SSR are reset. If transition is made during data reception, the data being received will be invalid. To receive data in the same reception mode after mode cancellation, set RE to 1, and then start reception. To receive data in a different reception mode, initialize the SCI first. Figure 14.37 shows a sample flowchart for mode transition during reception. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 378 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Reception Read RDRF flag in SSR RDRF = 1 No [1] [1] Data being received will be invalid. Yes Read receive data in RDR [2] Module stop, watch, sub-active, and subsleep modes are included. RE = 0 [2] Make transition to software standby mode etc. Cancel software standby mode etc. Change operating mode? No Yes Initialization RE = 1 Start reception Figure 14.37 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Reception Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 379 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) 14.9.7 Notes when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin • Problem in Operation: When DDR and DR are set to 1, SCI clock output is used in clocked synchronous mode, and the SCK pin is changed to the port pin while transmission is ended, port output is enabled after low-level output occurs for one half-cycle. When switching the SCK pin to the port pin by making the following settings while DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1, low-level output occurs for one halfcycle. 1. End of serial data transmission 2. TE bit = 0 3. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output 4. Occurrence of low-level output (see figure 14.38) Half-cycle low-level output SCK/port 1. End of transmission Bit 6 Data 4. Low-level output Bit 7 2. TE = 0 TE 3. C/A = 0 C/A CKE1 CKE0 Figure 14.38 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 380 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) • Usage Note: To prevent low-level output occurred when switching the SCK pin to port pin, follow the procedure described below. As this sample procedure temporarily places the SCK pin in the input state, the SCK/port pin should be pulled up beforehand with an external circuit. With DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1, make the following settings in the order shown. 1. End of serial data transmission 2. TE bit = 0 3. CKE1 bit = 1 4. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output 5. CKE1 bit = 0 High-level output SCK/port 1. End of transmission Data TE Bit 6 Bit 7 2. TE = 0 4. C/A = 0 C/A 3. CKE1 = 1 CKE1 5. CKE1 = 0 CKE0 Figure 14.39 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin to Port Pin (Example of Preventing Low-Level Output) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 381 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 14 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 382 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) This LSI has two independent synchronous serial communication unit (SSU) channels. The SSU has master mode in which this LSI outputs clocks as a master device for synchronous serial communication and slave mode in which clocks are input from an external device for synchronous serial communication. Synchronous serial communication can be performed with devices having different clock polarity and clock phase. Figure 15.1 is a block diagram of the SSU. 15.1 • • • • • • • • • • Features Choice of master mode or slave mode Choice of standard mode or bidirectional mode Synchronous serial communication with devices with different clock polarity and clock phase Choice of 8/16/32-bit width of transmit/receive data Full-duplex communication capability The shift register is incorporated, enabling transmission and reception to be executed simultaneously. Continuous serial communication Choice of LSB-first or MSB-first transfer Choice of a clock source φ/2, φ/4, φ/8, φ/16, φ/32, φ/64, φ/128, φ/256, or external clock Five interrupt sources Transmit-end, transmit-data-register-empty, receive-data-register-full, overrun-error, and conflict error Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 383 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Bus interface Figure 15.1 shows a block diagram of the SSU. Module data bus Internal data bus SSCRH SSTDR 0 SSRDR 0 SSCRL OEI SSTDR 1 SSRDR 1 SSMR CEI SSTDR 2 SSRDR 2 SSER RXI SSTDR 3 SSRDR 3 SSSR TXI Control circuit TEI Clock Clock selector Shift-in Shift-out SSTRSR φ φ/2 φ/4 φ/8 φ/16 φ/32 φ/64 φ/128 φ/256 Selector SSI [Legend] SSCRH: SSCRL: SSMR: SSER: SSSR: SSTDR3 to SSTDR0: SSRDR3 to SSRDR0: SSTRSR: SSO SCS SSCK (External clock) SS control register H SS control register L SS mode register SS enable register SS status register SS transmit data register SS receive data register SS transmit/recive shift register Figure 15.1 Block Diagram of SSU Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 384 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.2 Input/Output Pins Table 15.1 shows the SSU pin configuration. Table 15.1 Pin Configuration Name Symbol I/O Function SSU clock SSCK I/O SSU clock input/output SSU receive data input SSI I/O SSU receive data input/output SSU transmit data output SSO I/O SSU transmit data input/output SSU chip select input/output SCS I/O SSU chip select input/output 15.3 Register Descriptions The SSU has the following registers. • • • • • • • SS control register H (SSCRH) SS control register L (SSCRL) SS mode register (SSMR) SS enable register (SSER) SS status register (SSSR) SS transmit data register 3 to 0 (SSTDR3 to SSTDR0) SS receive data register 3 to 0 (SSRDR3 to SSRDR0) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 385 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.1 SS Control Register H (SSCRH) SSCRH specifies master/slave device selection, bidirectional mode enable, SSO pin output value selection, SSCK pin selection, and SCS pin selection. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 MSS 0 R/W Master/Slave Device Selection Selects that this module is used in master mode or slave mode. When master mode is selected, transfer clocks are output from the SSCK pin. When the CE bit in SSSR is set, this bit is automatically cleared. 0: Slave mode is selected 1: Master mode is selected 6 BIDE 0 R/W Bidirectional Mode Enable Selects that both serial data input pin and output pin are used or one of them is used. However, transmission and reception are not performed simultaneously when bidirectional mode is selected. For details, section 15.4.3, Relationship between Data I/O Pins and Shift Register. 0: Standard mode (two pins are used as data input and output) 1: Bidirectional mode (one pin is used for data input and output) 5 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 4 SOL 0 R/W Serial Data Output Value Selection The output level of serial data, which retains that of the last bit, can be modified by operating this bit before or after transmission. When modifying the output level, use the MOV instruction after clearing the SOLP bit to 0. Since writing to this bit during data transmission causes malfunctions, this bit should not be modified. 0: Serial data output is modified to low level 1: Serial data output is modified to high level Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 386 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 3 SOLP 1 R/W SOL Bit Write Protect When modifying the output level of serial data, use the MOV instruction after setting SOL to 1 and clearing SOLP to 0, or by clearing SOL and SOLP to 0. 0: Output level can be modified by the SOL value 1: Output level cannot be modified by the SOL value. This bit is always read as 1 2 SCKS 0 R/W SSCK Pin Selection Selects that the SSCK pin functions as a port or a serial clock pin. When MSS = 1, the SSCK pin functions as a serial clock output pin regardless of the setting of this bit. 0: Functions as an I/O port 1: Functions as a serial clock 1 CSS1 0 R/W SCS Pin Selection 0 CSS0 0 R/W Select that the SCS pin functions as a port or SCS input or output. However, when MSS = 0, the SCS pin functions as an input pin regardless of the CSS1 and CSS0 settings. 00: I/O port 01: Functions as SCS input 10: Functions as SCS automatic input/output (however, functions as SCS input before and after transfer and outputs a low level during transfer) 11: Functions as SCS automatic output (however, outputs a high level before and after transfer and outputs a low level during transfer) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 387 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.2 SS Control Register L (SSCRL) SSCRL selects software reset and transmit/receive data width. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7, 6 All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 5 SRES 0 R/W Software Reset Setting this bit to 1 forcibly resets the SSU internal sequencer. After that, this bit is automatically cleared. The ORER, TEND, TDRE, RDRF, and CE bits in SSSR and the TE and RE bits in SSER are also initialized. Values of other bits for SSU registers are held. To stop transfer, set this bit to 1 to reset the SSU internal sequencer. 4 to 2 All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 1 DATS1 0 R/W Transmit/Receive Data Length Selection 0 DATS0 0 R/W Select serial data length from 8, 16, and 32 bits. 00: 8 bits 01: 16 bits 10: 32 bits 11: Setting invalid Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 388 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.3 SS Mode Register (SSMR) SSMR selects the MSB first/LSB first, clock phase, clock polarity, and clock rate of synchronous serial communication. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 MLS 0 R/W MSB First/LSB First Selects the serial data is transmitted in MSB first or LSB first. 0: LSB first 1: MSB first 6 CPOS 0 R/W Clock Polarity Selection Selects SSCK clock polarity. 0: High output in idle mode, and low output in active mode 1: Low output in idle mode, and high output in active mode 5 CPHS 0 R/W Clock Phase Selection Selects SSCK clock phase. 0: Data changes at the first edge 1: Data is latched at the first edge 4, 3 All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 2 CKS2 0 R/W Transfer Clock Rate Selection 1 CKS1 0 R/W 0 CKS0 0 R/W Select the transfer clock rate (prescaler division rate) when a master mode is selected. 000: φ/2 001: φ/4 010: φ/8 011: φ/16 100: φ/32 101: φ/64 110: φ/128 111: φ/256 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 389 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.4 SS Enable Register (SSER) SSER performs transfer/receive control of synchronous serial communication and setting of interrupt enable. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TE 0 R/W Transmit Enable 6 RE 0 R/W Receive Enable When this bit is set to 1, transmission is enabled. When this bit is set to 1, reception is enabled. 5, 4 All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 3 TEIE 0 R/W Transmit End Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, TEI interrupt request is enabled. 2 TIE 0 R/W Transmit Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, TXI interrupt request is enabled. 1 RIE 0 R/W Receive Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, RXI interrupt request is enabled. 0 CEIE 0 R/W Conflict Error Interrupt Enable When this bit is set to 1, CEI interrupt request is enabled. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 390 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.5 SS Status Register (SSSR) SSSR is a status flag register for interrupts. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 6 ORER 0 R/W Overrun Error If the next data is received while RDRF = 1, an overrun error occurs, indicating abnormal termination. SSRDR stores 1-frame receive data before an overrun error occurs and loses data received later. While ORER = 1, continuous serial reception cannot be continued. Serial transmission cannot be continued, either. [Setting condition] • When the next reception data is transferred to SSRDR while RDRF = 1 [Clearing condition] • 5, 4 All 0 When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 3 TEND 1 R Transmit End [Setting condition] • When the last bit of transmit data is transmitted with TDRE = 1 [Clearing conditions] • When 0 is written to the TEND bit after reading TEND = 1 • When data is written to SSTDR Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 391 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 TDRE 1 R/W Transmit Data Register Empty Indicates whether or not SSTDR contains transmit data. [Setting conditions] • When the TE bit in SSER is 0 • When data is transferred from SSTDR to SSTRSR and SSTDR is ready to be written to. [Clearing conditions] 1 RDRF 0 R/W • When 0 is written to the TDRE bit after reading TDRE = 1 • When data is written to SSTDR with TE = 1 Receive Data Register Full Indicates whether or not SSRDR contains received data. [Setting condition] • When receive data is transferred from SSTRSR to SSRDR after successful data reception [Clearing conditions] Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 392 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 • When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1 • When received data is read from SSRDR Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 0 CE 0 R/W Conflict/Incomplete Error Indicates that a conflict error has occurred when 0 is externally input via the SCS pin with MSS = 1. If the SCS pin level changes to 1 during slave operation, an incomplete error occurs because it is determined that a master device has terminated the transfer. Data reception does not continue while the CE bit is set to 1. Reset the SSU internal sequencer by setting the SRES bit in SSCRL to 1 before resuming transfer after incomplete error. [Setting conditions] • When a low level is input to the SCS pin in master device mode (MSS in SSCRH = 1) • When a 1 is input to the SCS pin during slave device mode (MSS in SSCRH = 0) transfer [Clearing condition] • 15.3.6 When 0 is written to the CE bit after reading CE = 1 SS Transmit Data Register 3 to 0 (SSTDR3 to SSTDR0) SSTDR is an 8-bit register that stores transmit data. When 8-bit data length is selected by bits DATS1 and DATS0 in SSCRL, SSTDR0 is valid. When 16-bit data length is selected, SSTDR0 and SSTDR1 are valid. When 32-bit data length is selected, SSTDR3 to SSTDR0 are valid. Do not attempt to access invalid SS transmit data registers. When the SSU detects that SSTRSR is empty, it transfers the transmit data written in SSTDR to SSTRSR and starts transmission. If the next transmit data has already been written to SSTDR during serial transmission, the SSU transfers the written data to SSTRSR to continue transmission. Although SSTDR can be read or written to by the CPU and DTC at all times, to achieve reliable serial transmission, write transmit data to SSTDR after confirming that the TDRE bit in SSSR is set to 1. The initial value of this register is H'00. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 393 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.3.7 SS Receive Data Register 3 to 0 (SSRDR3 to SSRDR0) SSRDR is an 8-bit register that stores receive data. When 8-bit data length is selected by bits DATS1 and DATS0 in SSCRL, SSRDR0 is valid. When 16-bit data length is selected, SSRDR0 and SSRDR1 are valid. When 32-bit data length is selected, SSRDR3 to SSRDR0 are valid. Do not attempt to access invalid SS receive data registers. When the SSU has received 1-byte data, it transfers the received serial data from SSTRSR to SSRDR where it is stored. After this, SSTRSR is receive-enabled. Since SSTRSR and SSRDR function as a double buffer in this way, continuous receive operations can be performed. Read SSRDR after confirming that the RDRF bit in SSSR is set to 1. SSRDR cannot be written to by the CPU. The initial value of this register is H'00. 15.3.8 SS Shift Register (SSTRSR) SSTRSR is a shift register that transmits and receives serial data. When data from SSTDR to SSTRSR is transferred with MLS = 0, bit 0 of transmit data is bit 0 in the SSTDR contents (LSB first communication). When data from SSTDR to SSTRSR is transferred with MLS = 1, bit 0 of transmit data is bit 7 in the SSTDR contents (MSB first communication). To perform serial data transmission, the SSU transfers data starting from LSB (bit 0) in SSTRSR to the SSO pin. In reception, the SSU sets serial data that has been input from the SSI pin to SSTRSR starting from LSB (bit 0) and converts it into parallel data. When 1-byte data has been received, the SSTRSR contents are automatically transferred to SSRDR. SSTRSR cannot be directly accessed by the CPU. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 394 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.4 Operation 15.4.1 Transfer Clock A transfer clock can be selected from eight internal clocks and an external clock. When using this module, set SCKS in SSCRH to 1 to select the SSCK pin as a serial clock. When MSS in SSCRH is 1, an internal clock is selected and the SSCK pin is used as an output pin. When transfer is started, the clock with the transfer rate set by bits CKS2 to CKS0 in SSMR is output from the SSCK pin. When MSS = 0, an external clock is selected and the SSCK pin is used as an input pin. 15.4.2 Relationship of Clock Phase, Polarity, and Data The relationship of clock phase, polarity, and transfer data depends on the combination of CPOS and CPHS in SSMR. Figure 15.2 shows the relationship. Setting the MLS bit specifies that MSB or LSB first communication. When MLS = 0, data is transferred from the LSB to MSB. When MLS = 1, data is transferred from the MSB to LSB. (1) When CPHS = 0 SCS SSCK (CPOS = 0) SSCK (CPOS = 1) SSI, SSO Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 (2) When CPHS = 1 SCS SSCK (CPOS = 0) SSCK (CPOS = 1) SSI, SSO Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Figure 15.2 Relationship of Clock Phase, Polarity, and Data Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 395 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.4.3 Relationship between Data I/O Pins and the Shift Register The connection between data I/O pins and the shift register (SSTRSR) depends on the combination of the MSS and BIDE bits in SSCRH. Figure 15.3 shows the connection. The SSU transmits serial data from the SSO pin and receives serial data from the SSI pin when operating with BIDE = 0 and MSS = 1 (standard, master mode) (see figure 15.3 (1)). The SSU transmits serial data from the SSI pin and receives serial data from the SSO pin when operating with BIDE = 0 and MSS = 0 (standard, slave mode) (see figure 15.3 (2)). The SSU transmits and receives serial data from the SSO pin regardless of master or slave mode when operating with BIDE = 1 (bidirectional mode) (see figure 15.3 (3) and (4)). However, even if both the TE and RE bits are set to 1, transmission and reception are not performed simultaneously. Either the TE or RE bit must be selected. (1) When BIDE = 0 (standard mode), MSS = 1, TE = 1, and RE = 1 (2) When BIDE = 0 (standard mode), MSS = 0, TE = 1, and RE = 1 SSCK Shift register (SSTRSR) SSO SSCK Shift register (SSTRSR) SSI SSO SSI (3) When BIDE = 1 (bidirectional mode), MSS = 1, and TE or RE = 1 (4) When BIDE=1 (bidirectional mode), MSS = 0, and TE or RE = 1 SSCK Shift register (SSTRSR) SSO SSCK Shift register (SSTRSR) SSI Figure 15.3 Relationship between Data I/O Pins and the Shift Register Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 396 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 SSO SSI Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.4.4 Data Transmission and Data Reception The SSU performs data communications using the bus with four lines: the clock line (SSCK), data input (SSI or SSO), data output (SSI or SSO), and chip select (SCS). The SSU also supports bidirectional mode in which the data is output and input using one pin. SSU Initialization: Figure 15.4 shows an example of the SSU initialization. Before transmitting and receiving data, first clear the TE and RE bits in SSER to 0, then initialize the SSU. Note: When the operating mode or transfer format is changed for example, the TE and RE bits must be cleared to 0. When the TE bit is cleared to 0, the TDRE bit is set to 1. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not initialize the values of the RDRF and ORER bits or the contents of SSRDR. Start initialization Clear TE and RE bits in SSER to 0 [1] Specify master/slave device selection, bidirectional mode enable, SSO pin output value selection, SSCK pin selection, and SCS pin selection. [2] Specify transmit/receive data length. [1] Specify CSS1, CSS0, MSS, BIDE, SOL, and SCKS bits [2] Specify bits DATS1 and DATS0 [3] Specify CKS2 to CKS0, MLS, CPOS, and CPHS bits [4] Specify TE, RE, TEIE, TIE, RIE, and CEIE bits simultaneously [3] Specify MSB first/LSB first selection, clock polarity selection, clock phase selection, and transfer clock rate selection. [4] Specify enable/disable of interrupt request to the CPU. End Figure 15.4 Example of SSU Initialization Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 397 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Data Transmission: Figure 15.5 shows an example of transmission operation, and figure 15.6 shows an example of data transmission flowchart. When transmitting data, the SSU operates as shown below. In master device mode, the SSU outputs a transfer clock and data. In slave device mode, when a low level signal is input to the SCS pin and a transfer clock is input to the SSCK pin, the SSU outputs data in synchronization with the transfer clock. Writing transmit data to SSTDR after initialization of the SSU automatically clears the TDRE bit in SSSR to 0, and the contents of SSTDR is transferred to SSTRSR. After that, the SSU sets the TDRE bit to 1 and starts transmission. At this time, if the TIE bit in SSER is set to 1, a TXI interrupt is generated. When 1-frame data has been transferred with the TDRE bit cleared to 0, the SSTDR contents are transferred to SSTRSR to start the next transmission. When the 8th bit of transmit data has been transferred with the TDRE bit set to 1, the TEND bit in SSSR is set to 1 and the state is retained. At this time, if the TEIE bit is set to 1, a TEI interrupt is generated. After transmission, the output level of the SSCK pin is fixed at a high level when CPOS = 0 and at a low level when CPOS = 1. While the ORER bit in SSSR is set to 1, transmission is not performed. Check that the ORER bit is cleared to 0. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 398 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) (1) When 8-bit data length is selected (SSTDR0 is valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 1 frame 1 frame SCS SSCK SSO Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSTDR0 (LSB first transmission) SSTDR0 (MSB first transmission) TDRE TEND LSI operation User operation TXI interrupt generated TEI interrupt generated TXI interrupt generated TEI interrupt generated Data written to Data written to SSTDR0 SSTDR0 (2) When 16-bit data length is selected (SSTDR0 and SSTDR1 are valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 1 frame SCS SSCK SSO (LSB first) Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SSO (MSB first) Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SSTDR1 SSTDR0 Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSTDR0 SSTDR1 TDRE TEND LSI operation TEI interrupt generated TXI interrupt generated User operation Data written to SSTDR1 to SSTDR0 (3) When 32-bit data length is selected (SSTDR0, SSTDR1, SSTDR2, and SSTDR3 are valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 1 frame SCS SSCK SSO (LSB first) Bit 0 to Bit Bit 0 7 SSTDR3 SSO (MSB first) Bit 7 to Bit Bit 7 0 SSTDR0 to Bit Bit 7 0 SSTDR2 to Bit 0 SSTDR1 to Bit 7 SSTDR1 Bit 7 to Bit 0 to Bit Bit 0 7 SSTDR2 Bit 7 SSTDR0 to Bit 0 SSTDR3 TDRE TEND LSI operation User operation Data written to SSTDR3 to SSTDR0 TXI interrupt generated TEI interrupt generated Figure 15.5 Example of Transmission Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 399 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) [1] Initialization: Specify the settings such as transmit data format. Start [1] Initialization [2] Read TDRE in SSR TDRE = 1? [2] Check the SSU state and write transmit data: Write transmit data to SSTDR after reading and confirming that the TDRE bit is 1. The TDRE bit is automatically cleared to 0 and transmission is started by writing data to SSTDR. No Yes Write transmit data to SSTDR TDRE automatically cleared Yes [3] Procedure for continuous data transmission: To continue data transmission, confirm that the TDRE bit is 1 meaning that SSTDR is ready to be written to. After that, data can be written to SSTDR. The TDRE bit is automatically cleared to 0 by writing data to SSTDR. No [4] Transmission end procedure: To end transmission, confirm TEND = 1 and wait until the last bit is surely transmitted, then set TE to 0. Data transferd from SSTDR to SSTRSR Set TDRE to 1 to start transmission [3] Continuous data transmission? No Read TEND in SSSR TEND = 1? Yes Clear TEND to 0 Wait Confirm TEND = 0 [4] 1-bit interval elapsed ? No Yes Clear TE in SSER to 0 End transmission Note: Hatching boxes represent SSU internal operations. Figure 15.6 Example of Data Transmission Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 400 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Data Reception: Figure 15.7 shows an example of reception operation, and figure 15.8 shows an example of data reception flowchart. When receiving data, the SSU operates as shown below. After initialization, the SSU dummy-reads SSRDR and data reception is started. In master device mode, the SSU outputs a transfer clock and receives data. In slave device mode, when a low level signal is input to the SCS pin and a transfer clock is input to the SSCK pin, the SSU receives data in synchronization with the transfer clock. When 1-frame data has been received, the received data is stored in SSRDR. At this time, if the RIE bit is set to 1, an RXI interrupt is generated. The RDRF bit is automatically cleared to 0 by reading SSRDR. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 401 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) (1) When 8-bit data length is selected (SSRDR0 is valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 1 frame SCS 1 frame SSCK Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SSI Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSTDR0 (LSB first transmission) SSTDR0 (MSB first transmission) RDRF LSI operation RXI interrupt generated User operation RXI interrupt generated Read SSRDR0 Dummy-read SSRDR0 (2) When 16-bit data length is selected (SSRDR0 and SSRDR1 are valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 1 frame SCS SSCK SSI (LSB first) Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SSI (MSB first) Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 SSRDR1 SSRDR0 Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 SSRDR0 SSRDR1 RDRF LSI operation User operation RXI interrupt generated Dummy-read SSRDR0 (3) When 32-bit data length is selected (SSRDR0, SSRDR1, SSRDR2, and SSRDR3 are valid) with CPOS = 0 and CPHS = 0 SCS SSCK SSI (LSB first) Bit 0 SSI (MSB first) Bit 7 to Bit Bit 7 0 SSRDR3 to Bit Bit 7 0 SSRDR2 Bit Bit 0 7 SSRDR0 to to Bit 0 SSRDR1 to Bit 7 SSRDR1 Bit 7 to Bit 0 Bit 7 SSRDR0 Bit Bit 0 7 SSRDR2 to to Bit 0 SSRDR3 RDRF LSI operation User operation Dummy-read SSRDR0 RXI interrupt generated Figure 15.7 Example of Reception Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 402 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Start [1] Initialization [2] Dummy-read SSRDR RDRF = 1? Yes ORER = 1? Initialization: Specify the settings such as receive data format. [2] Start reception: When SSRDR is dummy-read with RE = 1, reception is started. [3], [6] Receive error processing: When a receive error occurs execute the designated error processing after reading the ORER bit in SSSR. After that, clear the ORER bit to 0. While the ORER bit is set to 1, reception is not resumed. Read SSRDR No [1] Yes [3] [4] To continue single reception: When continuing single reception, the next single reception starts after reading received data in SSRDR. [5] To complete reception: To complete reception, read received data after clearing the RE bit to 0. When reading SSRDR without clearing the RE bit, reception is resumed. No [4] Continuous data reception? No Yes Read received data in SSRDR RDRF automatically cleared [5] RE = 0 Read received data in SSRDR End reception [6] Overrun error processing Clear ORER in SSSR End reception Note: Hatching boxes represent SSU internal operations. Figure 15.8 Example of Data Reception Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 403 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Data Transmission/Reception: Figure 15.9 shows an example of simultaneous transmission/reception operation. The data transmission/reception is performed combining the data transmission and data reception as mentioned above. The data transmission/reception is started by writing transmit data to SSTDR with TE = RE = 1. When the RDRF has been set to 1 at the 8th rising edge of the transfer clock (in a case of 8-bit data length), the ORER bit in SSSR is set to 1. This indicates that an overrun error (OEI) has occurred. At this time, data transmission/reception is stopped. While the ORER bit in SSSR is set to 1, transmission/reception is not performed. To resume the transmission/reception, clear the ORER bit to 0. Before switching transmission mode (TE = 1) or reception mode (RE = 1) to transmission/reception mode (TE = RE = 1), clear the TE and RE bits to 0. When starting the transfer, confirm that the TEND, RDRF, and ORER bits are cleared to 0 before setting the TE and RE bits to 1. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 404 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) [1] Initialization: Specify the settings such as transmit/receive data format. Start [1] Initialization [2] Read TDRE in SSSR No TDRE = 1? Yes Write transmit data to SSTDR [3] Check the SSU state: Read SSSR and confirm that the RDRF bit is 1. A change of the RDRF bit (from 0 to 1) can be notified by RXI interrupt. TDRE automatically cleared Data transferred from SSTDR to SSTRSR [4] Receive error processing: When a receive error occurs, execute the designated error processing after reading the ORER bit in SSSR. After that, clear the ORER bit to 0. While the ORER bit is set to 1, transmission or reception is not resumed. TDRE set to 1 to start transmission Read SSSR [3] No RDRF = 1? Yes ORER = 1? [2] Check the SSU state and write transmit data: Write transmit data to SSTDR after reading and confirming that the TDRE bit is 1. The TDRE bit is automatically cleared to 0 and transmission is started by writing data to SSTDR. Yes [4] No Read received data in SSRDR RDRF automatically cleared [5] Continuous data transmission/reception Yes [5] Procedure for continuous data transmission/ reception: To continue serial data transmission/reception, confirm that the TDRE bit 1meaning that SSTDR is ready to be written to. After that, data can be written to SSTDR. The TDRE bit is automatically cleared to 0 by writing data to SSTDR. No Read TEND in SSSR TEND = 1? No Yes Clear TEND in SSSR to 0 1-bit internal elapsed? Yes No Error processing Clear TE and RE in SSER to 0 End transmission/reception Note: Hatching boxes represent SSU internal operations. Figure 15.9 Example of Simultaneous Transmission/Reception Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 405 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) 15.4.5 SCS Pin Control and Conflict Error When bits CSS1 and CSS0 in SSCRH are specified to B'10, the SCS pin functions as an input (Hi-Z) to detect conflict error. The conflict detection period starts when setting the MSS bit in SSCRH to 1 and ends when starting serial transfer. When a low level signal is input to the SCS pin within the period, a conflict error occurs. At this time, the CE bit in SSSR is set to 1 and the MSS bit is cleared to 0. Note: While the CE bit is set to 1, transmission or reception is not resumed. Clear the CE bit to 0 before resuming the transmission or reception. External input to SCS Internal-clocked SCS MSS Transfer enabled internal signal Data written to SSTDR CE SCS output (Hi-Z) Conflict error detection period Worst time for internally clocking SCS Figure 15.10 Conflict Error Detection Timing (Before Transfer Start) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 406 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) φ SCS (Hi-Z) MSS Transfer enabled internal signal CE Transfer end Conflict error detection period Figure 15.11 Conflict Error Detection Timing (After Transfer End) 15.5 Interrupt Requests The SSU interrupt requests consist of transmit data register empty, transmit end, receive data register full, overrun error, and conflict error. Of these interrupt sources, transmit data register empty, transmit end, receive data register full can activate the DTC for data transfer. The TDRE, TEND, and RDRF bits are automatically cleared to 0 by the DTC data transfer. Since these interrupt requests are allocated to four vector addresses: SSEr_i0, SSRx_i0, SSTx_i0 and SSERT_i1, the interrupt sources must be distinguished by flags. Table 15.2 lists interrupt sources. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 407 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 15 Synchronous Serial Communication Unit (SSU) Table 15.2 Interrupt Souses Channel Abbreviation 0 SSEr_i0 1 Interrupt Request Symbol Interrupt Condition Overrun error OEI RIE = 1, ORER = 1 Conflict error CEI CEIE = 1, CE = 1 SSRx_i0 Receive data register full RXI RIE = 1, RDRF = 1 SSTx_i0 Transmit data register empty TXI TIE = 1, TDRE = 1 Transmit end TEI TEIE = 1, TEND = 1 Overrun error OEI RIE = 1, ORER = 1 Conflict error CEI CEIE = 1, CE = 1 Receive data register full RXI RIE = 1, RDRF = 1 SSERT_i1 Transmit data register empty TXI TIE = 1, TDRE = 1 Transmit end TEI TEIE = 1, TEND = 1 When interrupt conditions shown in table 15.2 are satisfied and the I bit in CCR is 0, the CPU executes interrupt exception processing. Clear each interrupt source in the exception processing. 15.6 Usage Note 15.6.1 Setting of Module Stop Mode The SSU can be enabled/disabled by the module stop control register setting and is disabled by the initial value. Canceling module stop mode enables to access the SSU registers. For details, see section 20, Power-Down Modes. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 408 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Section 16 A/D Converter This LSI includes a successive approximation type 10-bit A/D converter that allows up to sixteen analog input channels to be selected. The block diagram of the A/D converter is shown in figure 16.1. 16.1 • • • • • • • • • Features 10-bit resolution Sixteen input channels Conversion time: 13.3 µs per channel (at 20 MHz operation) Two operating modes Single mode: Single-channel A/D conversion Scan mode: Continuous A/D conversion on 1 to 4 channels Four data registers Conversion results are held in a 16-bit data register for each channel Sample and hold function Three conversion start methods Software 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) or 8-bit timer conversion start trigger External trigger signal Interrupt request An A/D conversion end interrupt request (ADI) can be generated Module stop mode can be set Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 409 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Module data bus Vref 10-bit D/A AVSS Bus interface A D D R A A D D R B A D D R C A D D R D A D C S R A D C R φ/2 + φ/4 Comparator Multiplexer AN0 AN1 AN2 AN3 AN4 AN5 AN6 AN7 AN8 AN9 AN10 AN11 AN12 AN13 AN14 AN15 Successive approximations register AVCC Internal data bus Control circuit φ/8 Sample-andhold circuit φ/16 ADI interrupt Conversion start trigger from TPU or 8-bit timer ADTRG [Legend] ADCR: A/D control register ADCSR: A/D control/status register ADDRA: A/D data register A ADDRB: A/D data register B ADDRC: A/D data register C ADDRD: A/D data register D Figure 16.1 Block Diagram of A/D Converter Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 410 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.2 Input/Output Pins Table 16.1 summarizes the input pins used by the A/D converter. 12 analog input pins are divided into three groups, each of which includes four channels; analog input pins 3 to 0 (AN3 to AN0) comprising group 0, analog input pins 7 to 4 (AN7 to AN4) comprising group 1, analog input pins 11 to 8 (AN11 to AN8) comprising group 2, and analog input pins 15 to 12 (AN15 to AN12) comprising group 3. The AVcc and AVss pins are the power supply pins for the A/D converter analog section. The Vref pin is the A/D conversion reference voltage pin. Table 16.1 Pin Configuration Pin Name Symbol I/O Function Analog power supply pin AVCC Input Analog section power supply and reference voltage Analog ground pin AVSS Input Analog section ground and reference voltage Reference voltage pin Vref Input Reference voltage of A/D conversion Analog input pin 0 AN0 Input Group 0 analog input pins Analog input pin 1 AN1 Input Analog input pin 2 AN2 Input Analog input pin 3 AN3 Input Analog input pin 4 AN4 Input Analog input pin 5 AN5 Input Analog input pin 6 AN6 Input Analog input pin 7 AN7 Input Analog input pin 8 AN8 Input Analog input pin 9 AN9 Input Analog input pin 10 AN10 Input Analog input pin 11 AN11 Input Analog input pin 12 AN12 Input Analog input pin 13 AN13 Input Analog input pin 14 AN14 Input Analog input pin 15 AN15 A/D external trigger input pin ADTRG Group 1 analog input pins Group 2 analog input pins Group 3 analog input pins Input Input External trigger input pin for starting A/D conversion Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 411 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.3 Register Description The A/D converter has the following registers. • • • • • • A/D data register A (ADDRA) A/D data register B (ADDRB) A/D data register C (ADDRC) A/D data register D (ADDRD) A/D control/status register (ADCSR) A/D control register (ADCR) 16.3.1 A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) There are four 16-bit read-only ADDR registers ADDRA to ADDRD, used to store the results of A/D conversion. The ADDR registers to store conversion results for each channel are shown in table 16.2. The converted 10-bit data is stored in bits 6 to 15 in ADDR. The lower 6 bits are always read as 0. The data bus between the CPU and the A/D converter is 8 bits wide. The upper byte can be read directly from the CPU, however the lower byte should be read via a temporary register. The temporary register contents are transferred from the ADDR when the upper byte data is read. When reading the ADDR, always read the upper byte first, and then read the lower byte, or read in word unit. Otherwise, the read contents are not guaranteed. Table 16.2 Analog Input Channels and Corresponding ADDR Registers Analog Input Channel CH3 = 0 CH3 = 1 Group 0 (CH2 = 0) Group 1 (CH2 = 1) Group 2 (CH2 = 0) Group 3 (CH2 = 1) A/D Data Register to Store the A/D Conversion Results AN0 AN4 AN8 AN12 ADDRA AN1 AN5 AN9 AN13 ADDRB AN2 AN6 AN10 AN14 ADDRC AN3 AN7 AN11 AN15 ADDRD Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 412 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.3.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ADCSR controls A/D conversion operations. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 ADF 0 R/(W) A/D End Flag A status flag that indicates the end of A/D conversion. [Setting conditions] • When A/D conversion ends in single mode • When A/D conversion ends on all specified channels selected in scan mode [Clearing conditions] 6 ADIE 0 R/W • When 0 is written after reading ADF = 1 • When the DTC is activated by an ADI interrupt and ADDR is read A/D Interrupt Enable A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) is enabled when this bit is set to 1. 5 ADST 0 R/W A/D Start Clearing this bit to 0 stops A/D conversion, and the A/D converter enters the wait state. Setting this bit to 1 starts A/D conversion. In single mode, this bits is automatically cleared to 0 when conversion on the specified channel is complete. In scan mode, conversion continues sequentially on the specified channels until this bit is cleared to 0 by software, a reset, or a transition to software standby mode, hardware standby mode or module stop mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 413 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 4 SCAN 0 R/W Scan Mode Selects the A/D conversion operating mode. 0: Single mode 1: Scan mode 3 CH3 0 R/W Channel Select 0 to 3 2 CH2 0 R/W Select analog input channels. 1 CH1 0 R/W When SCAN = 0 When SCAN = 1 0 CH0 0 R/W 0000: AN0 0000: AN0 0001: AN1 0001: AN1, AN0 0010: AN2 0010: AN2 to AN0 0011: AN3 0011: AN3 to AN0 0100: AN4 0100: AN4 0101: AN5 0101: AN5, AN4 0110: AN6 0110: AN6 to AN4 0111: AN7 0111: AN7 to AN4 1000: AN8 1000: AN8 1001: AN9 1001: AN9, AN8 1010: AN10 1010: AN10 to AN8 1011: AN11 1011: AN11 to AN8 1100: AN12 1100: AN12 1101: AN13 1101: AN13, AN12 1110: AN14 1110: AN14 to AN12 1111: AN15 1111: AN15 to AN12 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 414 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.3.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) The ADCR enables A/D conversion started by an external trigger signal. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 TRGS1 0 R/W Timer Trigger Select 1 and 0 6 TRGS0 0 R/W Enable the start of A/D conversion by a trigger signal. Bits TRGS0 and TRGS1 should be set while A/D conversion is stopped (ADST = 0). 00: A/D conversion is started by software 01: A/D conversion is started by TPU conversion start trigger 10: Start of A/D conversion by 8-bit timer conversion start trigger is allowed 11: A/D conversion is started by the ADTRG pin 5, 4 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1. 3 CKS1 0 R/W Clock Select 1 and 0 2 CKS0 0 R/W Specify the A/D conversion time. The conversion time should be changed only when ADST = 0. Specify a value within the range shown in table 22.7. 00: Conversion time = 530 states (max.) 01: Conversion time = 266 states (max.) 10: Conversion time = 134 states (max.) 11: Conversion time = 68 states (max.) 1, 0 All 1 Reserved These bits are always read as 1. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 415 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.4 Operation The A/D converter operates by successive approximation with 10-bit resolution. It has two operating modes; single mode and scan mode. When changing the operating mode or analog input channel, clear the ADST bit in ADCSR to 0 first in order to prevent incorrect operation. The ADST bit can be set at the same time as the operating mode or analog input channel is changed. 16.4.1 Single Mode In single mode, A/D conversion is performed only once on the specified single channel as follows. 1. A/D conversion is started when the ADST bit is set to 1 by software or external trigger input. 2. When A/D conversion is completed, the result is transferred to the A/D data register corresponding to the channel. 3. On completion of conversion, the ADF bit in ADCSR is set to 1. If the ADIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an ADI interrupt request is generated. 4. The ADST bit retains 1 during A/D conversion. When A/D conversion ends, the ADST bit is automatically cleared to 0 and the A/D converter enters the wait state. If the ADST bit is cleared to 0 during A/D conversion, the conversion is stopped and the A/D converter enters the wait state. 16.4.2 Scan Mode In scan mode, A/D conversion is to be performed sequentially on the specified channels up to four channels as follows. 1. When the ADST bit is set to 1 by software, TPU or external trigger input, A/D conversion starts on the first channel in the group (for example, AN0 when CH3 and CH2 = 00, AN4 when CH3 and CH2 = 01, AN8 when CH3 and CH2 = 10, or AN12 when CH3 and CH2 = 11). 2. When the A/D conversion is completed on one channel, the result is sequentially transferred to the A/D data register corresponding to the channel. 3. When the conversion is completed on all the selected channels, the ADF bit in ADCSR is set to 1. If the ADIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an ADI interrupt is requested after A/D conversion ends. Then, the A/D converter restarts the conversion from the first channel in the group. 4. Steps 2 to 3 are repeated as long as the ADST bit is set to 1. When the ADST bit is cleared to 0, the A/D conversion stops and the A/D converter enters the wait state. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 416 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time The A/D converter includes the sample-and-hold circuit. The A/D converter samples the analog input when the A/D conversion start delay time (tD) has passed after the ADST bit is set to 1, and then conversion is started. Figure 16.2 shows the A/D conversion timing. Table 16.3 shows the A/D conversion time. As shown in figure 16.2, the A/D conversion time (tCONV) includes tD and input sampling time (tSPL). The length of tD varies depending on the timing of the write access to ADCSR. Therefore, the total conversion time varies within the range shown in table 16.3. In scan mode, the values given in table 16.3 indicate the first conversion time. The second and subsequent conversion time is shown in table 16.4. In both cases, set bits CKS1 and CKS0 in ADCR within the range shown in table 22.8 in section 22, Electrical Characteristics. (1) φ Address (2) Write signal Input sampling timing ADF tD tSPL tCONV [Legend] (1): ADCSR write cycle (2): ADCSR address A/D conversion start delay tD: tSPL: Input sampling time tCONV: A/D conversion time Figure 16.2 A/D Conversion Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 417 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Table 16.3 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode) CKS1 = 0 CKS0 = 0 Item Symbol Min Typ Max CKS1 = 1 CKS0 = 1 CKS0 = 0 CKS0 = 1 Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A/D conversion tD start delay 18 33 10 17 6 9 4 5 Input sampling time 127 63 31 15 266 131 134 67 68 tSPL 515 A/D conversion tCONV time 530 259 Note: All values represent the number of states. Table 16.4 A/D Conversion Time (Scan Mode) CKS1 CKS0 Conversion Time (State) 0 0 512 (Fixed) 1 256 (Fixed) 1 0 128 (Fixed) 1 64 (Fixed) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 418 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.4.4 External Trigger Input Timing A/D conversion can be externally triggered. When bits TRGS0 and TRGS1 in ADCR are set to 11, an external trigger is input on the ADTRG pin. At the falling edge of the ADTRG pin, the ADST bit in ADCSR is set to 1, and the A/D conversion starts. Other operations are the same as when the ADST bit has been set to 1 by software in both single and scan modes. Figure 16.3 shows the timing. φ ADTRG Internal trigger signal ADST A/D conversion Figure 16.3 External Trigger Input Timing 16.5 Interrupt Source When A/D conversion is completed, the A/D converter generates an A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI). The ADI interrupt request is enabled when the ADIE bit is set to 1 while the ADF bit in ADCSR is set to 1 after A/D conversion is completed. The DTC can be activated by an ADI interrupt. Having the converted data read by the DTC in response to an ADI interrupt enables continuous conversion without imposing a load on software. Table 16.5 A/D Converter Interrupt Source Name Interrupt Source Interrupt Source Flag DTC Activation ADI A/D conversion completed ADF Possible Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 419 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.6 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions This LSI’s A/D conversion accuracy definitions are given below. • Resolution The number of A/D converter digital output codes • Quantization error The deviation inherent in the A/D converter, given by 1/2 LSB (see figure 16.4). • Offset error The deviation of the analog input voltage value from the ideal A/D conversion characteristic when the digital output changes from the minimum voltage value B'0000000000 (H'000) to B'0000000001 (H'001) (see figure 16.5). • Full-scale error The deviation of the analog input voltage value from the ideal A/D conversion characteristic when the digital output changes from B'1111111110 (H'3FE) to B'1111111111 (H'3FF) (see figure 16.5). • Nonlinearity error The error with respect to the ideal A/D conversion characteristic between zero voltage and fullscale voltage. Does not include offset error, full-scale error, or quantization error (see figure 16.5). • Absolute accuracy The deviation between the digital value and the analog input value. Includes offset error, fullscale error, quantization error, and nonlinearity error. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 420 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Digital output Ideal A/D conversion characteristic 111 110 101 100 011 010 Quantization error 001 000 1 2 1024 1024 1022 1023 FS 1024 1024 Analog input voltage Figure 16.4 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions Full-scale error Digital output Ideal A/D conversion characteristic Nonlinearity error Actual A/D conversion characteristic Offset error FS Analog input voltage Figure 16.5 A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 421 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.7 Usage Notes 16.7.1 Module Stop Mode Setting Operation of the A/D converter can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial setting is for operation of the A/D converter to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 20, Power-Down Modes. 16.7.2 Permissible Signal Source Impedance This LSI’s analog input is designed such that conversion accuracy is guaranteed for an input signal for which the signal source impedance is 5 kΩ or less. This specification is provided to enable the A/D converter’s sample-and-hold circuit input capacitance to be charged within the sampling time; if the sensor output impedance exceeds 5 kΩ, charging may be insufficient and it may not be possible to guarantee A/D conversion accuracy. However, for A/D conversion in single mode with a large capacitance provided externally, the input load will essentially comprise only the internal input resistance of 10 kΩ, and the signal source impedance is ignored. However, as a low-pass filter effect is obtained in this case, it may not be possible to follow an analog signal with a large differential coefficient (e.g., 5 mV/µs or greater) (see figure 16.6). When converting a high-speed analog signal or converting in scan mode, a low-impedance buffer should be inserted. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 422 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.7.3 Influences on Absolute Accuracy Adding capacitance results in coupling with GND, and therefore noise in GND may adversely affect absolute accuracy. Be sure to make the connection to an electrically stable GND such as AVss. Care is also required to insure that filter circuits do not communicate with digital signals on the mounting board (i.e., acting as antennas). This LSI Sensor output impedance to 5 kΩ A/D converter equivalent circuit 10 kΩ Sensor input Low-pass filter C to 0.1 µF Cin = 15 pF 20 pF Figure 16.6 Example of Analog Input Circuit 16.7.4 Range of Analog Power Supply and Other Pin Settings If the conditions below are not met, the reliability of the device may be adversely affected. • Analog input voltage range The voltage applied to analog input pin ANn during A/D conversion should be in the range AVss ≤ VNn ≤ AVcc. • Relationship between AVcc, AVss and Vcc, Vss Set AVss = Vss as the relationship between AVcc, AVss and Vcc, Vss. If the A/D converter is not used, the AVcc and AVss pins must not be left open. • Setting range of the Vref pin The reference voltage set by the Vref pin should be in the range Vref ≤ AVcc. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 423 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter 16.7.5 Notes on Board Design In board design, digital circuitry and analog circuitry should be as mutually isolated as possible, and layout in which digital circuit signal lines and analog circuit signal lines cross or are in close proximity should be avoided as far as possible. Failure to do so may result in incorrect operation of the analog circuitry due to inductance, adversely affecting A/D conversion values. Also, digital circuitry must be isolated from the analog input signals (AN15 to AN0) and analog power supply (AVcc) by the analog ground (AVss). Also, the analog ground (AVss) should be connected at one point to a stable digital ground (Vss) on the board. 16.7.6 Notes on Noise Countermeasures A protection circuit should be connected in order to prevent damage due to abnormal voltage, such as an excessive surge at the analog input pins (AN15 to AN0), between AVcc and AVss, as shown in figure 16.7. Also, the bypass capacitors connected to AVcc and the filter capacitor connected to AN15 to AN0 must be connected to AVss. If a filter capacitor is connected, the input currents at the analog input pins (AN15 to AN0) are averaged, and so an error may arise. Also, when A/D conversion is performed frequently, as in scan mode, if the current charged and discharged by the capacitance of the sample-and-hold circuit in the A/D converter exceeds the current input via the input impedance (Rin), an error will arise in the analog input pin voltage. Careful consideration is therefore required when deciding circuit constants. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 424 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter AVCC Rin*2 100 Ω AN0 to AN15 *1 0.1 µF AVSS Notes: Values are reference values. 1. 10 µF 0.01 µF 2. Rin: Input impedance Figure 16.7 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit Table 16.6 Analog Pin Specifications Item Min Max Unit Analog input capacitance 20 pF Permissible signal source impedance 5 kΩ 10 kΩ AN15 to AN0 To A/D converter 20 pF Note: Values are reference values. Figure 16.8 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 425 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 16 A/D Converter Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 426 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 17 RAM Section 17 RAM This LSI has 8 kbytes of on-chip high-speed static RAM. The RAM is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus, enabling one-state access by the CPU to both byte data and word data. The on-chip RAM can be enabled or disabled by means of the RAME bit in the system control register (SYSCR). For details on SYSCR, refer to section 3.2.2, System Control Register (SYSCR). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 427 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 17 RAM Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 428 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Section 18 ROM The features of the flash memory are summarized below. The block diagram of the flash memory is shown in figure 18.1. 18.1 Features • Size: 128 kbytes • Programming/erase methods The flash memory is programmed 128 bytes at a time. Erase is performed in single-block units. The flash memory is configured as follows: 32 kbytes × 2 blocks, 28 kbytes × 1 block, 16 kbytes × 1 block, 8 kbytes × 2 blocks, and 1 kbyte × 4 blocks. To erase the entire flash memory, each block must be erased in turn. • Reprogramming capability The flash memory can be reprogrammed up to 100 times. • Three programming modes Boot mode User mode Programmer mode On-board programming/erasing can be done in boot mode, in which the boot program built into the chip is started to erase or program of the entire flash memory. In normal user program mode, individual blocks can be erased or programmed. • Programmer mode Flash memory can be programmed/erased in programmer mode using a PROM programmer, as well as in on-board programming mode. • Automatic bit rate adjustment For data transfer in boot mode, this LSI’s bit rate can be automatically adjusted to match the transfer bit rate of the host. • Programming/erasing protection Sets software protection against flash memory programming/erasing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 429 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Internal address bus Module bus Internal data bus (16 bits) FLMCR1 FLMCR2 EBR1 Bus interface/controller Operating mode FWE pin Mode pins EBR2 RAMER Flash memory (128 kbytes) [Legend] FLMCR1: FLMCR2: EBR1: EBR2: RAMER: Flash memory control register 1 Flash memory control register 2 Erase block register 1 Erase block register 2 RAM emulation register Figure 18.1 Block Diagram of Flash Memory 18.2 Mode Transitions When the mode pins and the FWE pin are set in the reset state and a reset-start is executed, this LSI enters an operating mode as shown in figure 18.2. In user mode, flash memory can be read but not programmed or erased. The boot, user program and programmer modes are provided as modes to write and erase the flash memory. The differences between boot mode and user program mode are shown in table 18.1. Figure 18.3 shows the operation flow for boot mode and figure 18.4 shows that for user program mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 430 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM MD1 = 1, MD2 = 1, FWE = 0 *1 User mode (on-chip ROM enabled) FWE = 1 Reset state RES = 0 RES = 0 MD1 = 1, MD2 = 1, FWE = 1 RES = 0 MD2 = 0, MD1 = 1, FWE = 1 FWE = 0 User program mode *2 RES = 0 Programmer mode *1 Boot mode On-board programming mode Notes: Only make a transition between user mode and user program mode when the CPU is not accessing the flash memory. 1. RAM emulation possible 2. This LSI transits to programmer mode by using the dedicated PROM programmer. Figure 18.2 Flash Memory State Transitions Table 18.1 Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode Boot Mode User Program Mode Yes Yes Block erase No Yes Programming control program* (2) (1) (2) (3) Total erase (1) Erase/erase-verify (2) Program/program-verify (3) Emulation Note: * To be provided by the user, in accordance with the recommended algorithm. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 431 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 1. Initial state The old program version or data remains written in the flash memory. The user should prepare the programming control program and new application program beforehand in the host. 2. Programming control program transfer When boot mode is entered, the boot program in this LSI (originally incorporated in the chip) is started and the programming control program in the host is transferred to RAM via SCI communication. The boot program required for flash memory erasing is automatically transferred to the RAM boot program area. Host Host Programming control program New application program New application program This LSI This LSI SCI Boot program Flash memory RAM SCI Boot program RAM Flash memory Boot program area Application program (old version) Application program (old version) 3. Flash memory initialization The erase program in the boot program area (in RAM) is executed, and the flash memory is initialized (to H'FF). In boot mode, total flash memory erasure is performed, without regard to blocks. Programming control program 4. Writing new application program The programming control program transferred from the host to RAM is executed, and the new application program in the host is written into the flash memory. Host Host New application program This LSI This LSI SCI Boot program Flash memory RAM Flash memory Boot program area Flash memory preprogramming erase Programming control program SCI Boot program RAM Boot program area New application program Programming control program Program execution state Figure 18.3 Boot Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 432 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 1. Initial state The FWE assessment program that confirms that user program mode has been entered, and the program that will transfer the programming/erase control program from flash memory to on-chip RAM should be written into the flash memory by the user beforehand. The programming/erase control program should be prepared in the host or in the flash memory. 2. Programming/erase control program transfer When user program mode is entered, user software confirms this fact, executes transfer program in the flash memory, and transfers the programming/erase control program to RAM. Host Host Programming/ erase control program New application program New application program This LSI This LSI SCI Boot program Flash memory RAM SCI Boot program Flash memory RAM FWE assessment program FWE assessment program Transfer program Transfer program Programming/ erase control program Application program (old version) Application program (old version) 3. Flash memory initialization The programming/erase program in RAM is executed, and the flash memory is initialized (to H'FF). Erasing can be performed in block units, but not in byte units. 4. Writing new application program Next, the new application program in the host is written into the erased flash memory blocks. Do not write to unerased blocks. Host Host New application program This LSI This LSI SCI Boot program Flash memory RAM FWE assessment program Flash memory RAM FWE assessment program Transfer program Transfer program Programming/ erase control program Flash memory erase SCI Boot program Programming/ erase control program New application program Program execution state Figure 18.4 User Program Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 433 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.3 Block Configuration Figure 18.5 shows the block configuration of 128-kbyte flash memory. The thick lines indicate erasing units, the narrow lines indicate programming units, and the values are addresses. The flash memory is divided into 32 kbytes (2 blocks), 28 kbytes (1 block), 16 kbytes (1 block), 8 kbytes (2 blocks), and 1 kbyte (4 blocks). Erasing is performed in these units. Programming is performed in 128-byte units starting from an address with lower eight bits H'00 or H'80. EB0 Erase unit 1 kbyte H'000000 H'000001 H'000002 H'000380 H'000381 H'000382 EB1 Erase unit 1 kbyte H'000400 H'000401 H'000402 H'000780 H'000781 H'000782 EB2 Erase unit 1 kbyte H'000800 H'000801 H'000B80 H'000B81 H'000B82 EB3 Erase unit 1 kbyte H'000C00 H'000C01 H'000C02 H'000F80 H'000F81 H'000F82 EB4 Erase unit 28 kbytes EB5 Erase unit 16 kbytes EB6 Erase unit 8 kbytes EB7 Erase unit 8 kbytes EB8 Erase unit 32 kbytes EB9 Erase unit 32 kbytes H'000802 H'001000 H'001001 H'001002 H'007F80 H'007F81 H'007F82 H'008000 H'008001 H'008002 H'00BF80 H'00BF81 H'00BF82 H'00C000 H'00C001 H'00C002 H'00DF80 H'00DF81 H'00DF82 H'00E000 H'00E001 H'00E002 H'00FF80 H'00FF81 H'00FF82 H'010000 H'010001 H'010002 H'017F80 H'017F81 H'017F82 H'018000 H'018001 H'018002 H'01FF80 H'01FF81 H'01FF82 Programming unit: 128 bytes H'0003FF Programming unit: 128 bytes REJ09B0426-0100 H'00047F H'0007FF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'00087F H'000BFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'000C7F H'000FFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'00107F H'007FFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'00807F H'00BFFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'00C07F H'00DFFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'00E07F H'00FFFF Programming unit: 128 bytes H'01007F H'017FFF Programming unit: 128 bytes Figure 18.5 Flash Memory Block Configuration Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 434 of 534 H'00007F H'01807F H'01FFFF Section 18 ROM 18.4 Input/Output Pins The flash memory is controlled by means of the pins shown in table 18.2. Table 18.2 Pin Configuration Pin Name I/O Function RES Input Reset FWE Input Flash program/erase protection by hardware MD2 Input Sets this LSI’s operating mode MD1 Input Sets this LSI’s operating mode MD0 Input Sets this LSI’s operating mode TxD2 Output Serial transmit data output RxD2 Input Serial receive data input 18.5 Register Descriptions The flash memory has the following registers. Flash memory control register 1 (FLMCR1) Flash memory control register 2 (FLMCR2) Erase block register 1 (EBR1) Erase block register 2 (EBR2) RAM emulation register (RAMER) 18.5.1 Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1) FLMCR1 makes the flash memory enter program mode, program-verify mode, erase mode, or erase-verify mode. For details on the register setting, refer to section 18.8, Flash Memory Programming/Erasing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 435 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 FWE — R Reflects the input level at the FWE pin. It is set to 1 when a low level is input to the FWE pin, and cleared to 0 when a high level is input. 6 SWE 0 R/W Software Write Enable When this bit is set to 1, flash memory programming/erasing is enabled. When this bit is cleared to 0, other FLMCR1 register bits and all EBR1 and EBR2 bits cannot be set. 5 ESU1 0 R/W Erase Setup When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory changes to the erase setup state. When it is cleared to 0, the erase setup state is cancelled. 4 PSU1 0 R/W Program Setup When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory changes to the program setup state. When it is cleared to 0, the program setup state is cancelled. Set this bit to 1 before setting the P1 bit in FLMCR1. 3 EV1 0 R/W Erase-Verify When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory changes to erase-verify mode. When it is cleared to 0, erase-verify mode is cancelled. 2 PV1 0 R/W Program-Verify When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory changes to program-verify mode. When it is cleared to 0, program-verify mode is cancelled. 1 E1 0 R/W Erase When this bit is set to 1 while the SWE1 and ESU1 bits are 1, the flash memory changes to erase mode. When it is cleared to 0, erase mode is cancelled. 0 P1 0 R/W Program When this bit is set to 1 while the SWE1 and PSU1 bits are 1, the flash memory changes to program mode. When it is cleared to 0, program mode is cancelled. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 436 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.5.2 Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2) FLMCR2 indicates the state of flash memory programming/erasing. FLMCR2 is a read-only register, and should not be written to. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 FLER 0 R Indicates that an error has occurred during flash memory programming or erasing. When the flash memory enters the error-protection state, this bit is set to 1. All 0 — See section 18.9.3, Error Protection, for details. 6 to 0 — Reserved These bits are always read as 0. 18.5.3 Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1) EBR1 specifies the flash memory erase area block. EBR1 is initialized to H'00 when the SWE bit in FLMCR1 is 0. Do not set more than one bit at a time, otherwise, all the bits in EBR1 are automatically cleared to 0. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 EB7 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 8 kbytes of EB7 (H'00E000 to H'00FFFF) will be erased. 6 EB6 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 8 kbytes of EB6 (H'00C000 to H'00DFFF) will be erased. 5 EB5 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 16 kbytes of EB5 (H'008000 to H'00BFFF) will be erased. 4 EB4 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 28 kbytes of EB4 (H'001000 to H'007FFF) will be erased. 3 EB3 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 1 kbyte of EB3 (H'000C00 to H'000FFF) will be erased. 2 EB2 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 1 kbyte of EB2 (H'000800 to H'000BFF) will be erased. 1 EB1 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 1 kbyte of EB1 (H'000400 to H'0007FF) will be erased. 0 EB0 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 1 kbyte of EB0 (H'000000 to H'0003FF) will be erased. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 437 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.5.4 Erase Block Register 2 (EBR2) EBR2 specifies the flash memory erase area block. EBR1 is initialized to H'00 when the SWE bit in FLMCR1 is 0. Do not set more than one bit at a time, otherwise, all the bits in EBR1 are be automatically cleared to 0. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 to 2 — All 0 — Reserved 1 EB9 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 32 kbytes of EB9 (H'018000 to H'01FFFF) will be erased. 0 EB8 0 R/W When this bit is set to 1, 32 kbytes of EB8 (H'010000 to H'017FFF) will be erased. These bits are always read as 0. 18.5.5 RAM Emulation Register (RAMER) RAMER specifies the area of flash memory to be overlapped with part of RAM when emulating real-time flash memory programming. RAMER settings should be made in user mode or user program mode. To ensure correct operation of the emulation function, the ROM for which RAM emulation is performed should not be accessed immediately after this register has been modified. If accessed, normal access execution is not guaranteed. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 — 0 — Reserved 6 — 0 — These bits are always read as 0. 5 — 0 R/W Reserved 4 — 0 3 RAMS 0 Only 0 should be written to these bits. R/W RAM Select Specifies selection or non-selection of flash memory emulation in RAM. When RAMS = 1, the flash memory is overlapped with part of RAM, and all flash memory blocks are program/eraseprotected. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 438 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 1 0 RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W Flash Memory Area Selection Specifies one of the following flash memory areas to overlap the RAM area of H'FFE000 to H'FFE3FF when the RAMS bit is set to 1. The areas correspond with 1-kbyte erase blocks. 00×: H'000000 to H'0003FF (EB0) 01×: H'000400 to H'0007FF (EB1) 10×: H'000800 to H'000BFF (EB2) 11×: H'000C00 to H'000FFF (EB3) [Legend] ×: Don’t care 18.6 On-Board Programming Modes There are two modes for programming/erasing of the flash memory; boot mode enabling on-board programming/erasing and programmer mode enabling programming/erasing with a PROM programmer. On-board programming/erasing can also be performed in user program mode. At reset-start in reset mode, this LSI changes to a mode depending on the MD pin settings and FWE pin setting, as shown in table 18.3. The input level of each pin must be defined four states before the reset ends. When boot mode is entered, the boot program built into this LSI is initiated. The boot program transfers the programming control program from the externally-connected host to on-chip RAM via SCI_2. After erasing the entire flash memory, the programming control program is executed. This can be used for programming initial values in the on-board state or for a forcible return in case that programming/erasing cannot be performed in user program mode. In user program mode, individual blocks can be erased and programmed by branching to the user program/erase control program prepared by the user. Table 18.3 Setting On-Board Programming Modes MD2 MD1 MD0 FWE LSI State after Reset End 1 1 1 1 User Mode 0 1 1 1 Boot Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 439 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.6.1 Boot Mode Table 18.4 shows the boot mode operations from a reset end to a branch to the programming control program. 1. In boot mode, the flash memory programming control program must be prepared in the host beforehand. Prepare a programming control program in accordance with the description in section 18.8, Flash Memory Programming/Erasing. 2. SCI_2 should be set to asynchronous mode with the transfer format of 8-bit data, 1 stop bit, and no parity. 3. When the boot program is initiated, the chip measures the low-level period of asynchronous SCI communication data (H'00) transmitted continuously from the host. The chip then calculates the bit rate of transmission from the host, and adjusts the SCI_2 bit rate to match that of the host. The reset should end with the RxD pin high. The RxD and TxD pins should be pulled up on the board if necessary. After the reset is complete, it takes approximately 100 states before the chip is ready to measure the low-level period. 4. When the bit rate matching is completed, the chip transmits 1-byte data H'00 to the host to indicate the end of bit rate adjustment. The host should confirm that this adjustment end indication (H'00) has been received normally, and transmit 1-byte data H'55 to the chip. If reception could not be performed normally, initiate boot mode again by a reset. Depending on the host’s transfer bit rate and system clock frequency of this LSI, there will be a discrepancy between the bit rates of the host and the chip. To operate the SCI properly, set the host’s transfer bit rate and system clock frequency of this LSI within the ranges listed in table 18.5. 5. In boot mode, a part of the on-chip RAM area is used by the boot program. The area H'FFE800 to H'FFEFBF is used to store the programming control program to be transferred from the host. The boot program area cannot be used until the execution is shifted to the programming control program. 6. Before branching to the programming control program, the chip terminates transfer operations by SCI_2 (by clearing the RE and TE bits in SCR to 0), however the adjusted bit rate value is retained in BRR. Therefore, the programming control program can still use it for transfer of write data or verify data with the host. At this time, the TxD pin is in the high level output state. The contents of the CPU general registers are undefined immediately after branching to the programming control program. These registers must be initialized at the beginning of the programming control program, since the stack pointer (SP), in particular, is used implicitly in subroutine calls, etc. 7. Boot mode can be cleared by a reset. End the reset by driving the reset pin low, waiting at least 20 states, and then setting the mode (MD) pins. Boot mode is also cleared when a WDT overflow occurs. 8. Do not change the MD pin input level in boot mode. 9. All interrupts are disabled during programming or erasing of the flash memory. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 440 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Table 18.4 Boot Mode Operation Item Boot mode start Host Operation Processing Contents Communications Contents LSI Operation Processing Contents Branches to boot program at reset-start Boot program initiation Bit rate adjustment Continuously transmits data H'00 at specified bit rate Transmits data H'55 when data H'00 is received error-free H'00, H'00 ...... H'00 H'00 · Measures low-level period of receive data H'00 · Calculates bit rate and sets it in BRR of SCI_2 · Transmits data H'00 to host as adjustment end indication H'55 H'AA Transmits data H'AA to host when data H'55 is received Receives data H'AA Transfer of programming control program Transmits number of bytes (N) of programming control program to be transferred as 2-byte data (low-order byte following high-order byte) Transmits 1-byte of programming control program (repeated for N times) High-order byte and low-order byte Echobacks the 2-byte data received Echoback H'XX Echoback Flash memory erase Boot program erase error H'FF H'AA Receives data H'AA Echobacks received data to host and also transfers it to RAM (repeated for N times) Checks flash memory data, erases all flash memory blocks in case of written data existing, and transmits data H'AA to host (If erase could not be done, transmits data H'FF to host and aborts operation) Branches to programming control program transferred to on-chip RAM and starts execution Table 18.5 System Clock Frequencies for which Automatic Adjustment of LSI Bit Rate is Possible Host Bit Rate System Clock Frequency Range of LSI 19,200 bps 20 MHz 9,600 bps 8 to 20 MHz 4,800 bps 4 to 20 MHz Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 441 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.6.2 Programming/Erasing in User Program Mode On-board programming/erasing of an individual flash memory block can also be performed in user program mode by branching to a user program/erase control program. The user must set branching conditions and provide on-board means of supplying programming data. The flash memory must contain the user program/erase control program or a program that provides the user program/erase control program from external memory. Since the flash memory itself cannot be read during programming/erasing, transfer the user program/erase control program to on-chip RAM, as in boot mode. Figure 18.6 shows a sample procedure for programming/erasing in user program mode. Prepare a user program/erase control program in accordance with the description in section 18.8, Flash Memory Programming/Erasing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 442 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Reset-start No Program/erase? Yes Transfer user program/erase control program to RAM Branch to flash memory application program Branch to user program/erase control program in RAM FWE = high* Execute user program/erase control program (flash memory rewrite) Clear FWE Branch to flash memory application program Note: * Do not constantly apply a high level to the FWE pin. Only apply a high level to the FWE pin when programming or erasing the flash memory. To prevent excessive programming or erasing, while a high level is being applied to the FWE pin, activate the watchdog timer in case of handling CPU runaways. Figure 18.6 Programming/Erasing Flowchart Example in User Program Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 443 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.7 Flash Memory Emulation in RAM A setting in the RAM emulation register (RAMER) enables part of RAM to be overlapped onto the flash memory area so that data to be written to flash memory can be emulated in RAM in real time. Emulation can be performed in user mode or user program mode. Figure 18.7 shows an example of emulation of real-time flash memory programming. 1. Set RAMER to overlap part of RAM onto the area for which real-time programming is required. 2. Emulation is performed using the overlapping RAM. 3. After the program data has been confirmed, the RAMS bit is cleared, thus releasing the RAM overlap. 4. The data written in the overlapping RAM is written into the flash memory space (EB0). Start of emulation program Set RAMER Write tuning data to overlap RAM Execute application program No Tuning OK? Yes Clear RAMER Write to flash memory emulation block End of emulation program Figure 18.7 Flowchart for Flash Memory Emulation in RAM Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 444 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM An example in which flash memory block area EB0 is overlapped is shown in figure 18.8. 1. The RAM area to be overlapped is fixed at a 1-kbyte area in the range H'FFE000 to H'FFE3FF. 2. The flash memory area to overlap is selected by RAMER from a 1-kbyte area of the EB0 to EB3 blocks. 3. The overlapped RAM area can be accessed from both the flash memory addresses and RAM addresses. 4. When the RAMS bit in RAMER is set to 1, program/erase protection is enabled for all flash memory blocks (emulation protection). In this state, setting the P1 or E1 bit in FLMCR1 to 1 does not make a transition to program mode or erase mode. 5. A RAM area cannot be erased by execution of software in accordance with the erase algorithm. 6. Block area EB0 contains the vector table. When performing RAM emulation, the vector table is needed in the overlap RAM. H'000000 Flash memory (EB0) Flash memory (EB0) (EB1) On-chip RAM (Shadow of H'FFE000 to H'FFE3FF) (EB2) Flash memory (EB2) (EB3) (EB3) H'0003FF H'000400 H'0007FF H'000800 H'000BFF H'000C00 H'000FFF H'FFE000 On-chip RAM (1 kbyte) On-chip RAM (1 kbyte) H'FFE3FF Normal memory map Memory map with overlapped RAM Figure 18.8 Example of RAM Overlap Operation Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 445 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.8 Flash Memory Programming/Erasing The flash memory is programmed or erased in on-board programming mode by a software method using the CPU. Depending on the FLMCR1 setting, the flash memory operates in one of the following four modes: Program mode, program-verify mode, erase mode, and erase-verify mode. The programming control program in boot mode and the user program/erase control program in user program mode perform programming/erasing in combination with these modes. Flash memory programming and erasing should be performed in accordance with the descriptions in section 18.8.1, Program/Program-Verify, and section 18.8.2, Erase/Erase-Verify, respectively. 18.8.1 Program/Program-Verify When writing data or programs to the flash memory, the program/program-verify flowchart shown in figure 18.9 should be followed. Performing programming operations according to this flowchart will enable data or programs to be written to the flash memory without subjecting the chip to voltage stress or sacrificing program data reliability. 1. Programming must be done on erased addresses. Do not perform additional programming or previously programmed addresses. 2. Programming should be performed in units of 128 bytes. A 128-byte data must be transferred even if data to be written is fewer than 128 bytes. In this case, H'FF data must be written to the extra addresses. 3. Prepare the following data storage areas in RAM: A 128-byte programming data area, a 128byte reprogramming data area, and a 128-byte additional-programming data area. Perform reprogramming data computation and additional programming data computation according to figure 18.9. 4. Consecutively transfer 128 bytes of data in byte units from the reprogramming data area or additional-programming data area to the flash memory. The program address and 128-byte data are latched in the flash memory. The lower 8 bits of the start address in the flash memory destination area must be H'00 or H'80. 5. The time during which the P1 bit is set to 1 is the programming time. Figure 18.9 shows the allowable programming times. 6. The watchdog timer (WDT) is set to prevent overprogramming due to program runaway, etc. Set the overflow cycle to approximately 6.6 ms. 7. For a dummy write to a verify address, write 1-byte data H'FF to an address whose lower 2 bits are B'00. Verify data can be read in longwords from the address to which a dummy write was performed. 8. The number of repetitions of the program/program-verify sequence for the same bit should be less than 1,000. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 446 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Start of programming Write pulse application subroutine Perform programming in the erased state. Do not perform additional programming on previously programmed addresses. START Apply Write Pulse Set SWE bit in FLMCR1 WDT enable Wait (tsswe) µs Set PSU bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tspsu) µs *7 Set P bit in FLMCR1 *7 Store 128-byte program data in program data area and reprogram data area *4 n=1 Start of programming m=0 Wait (tsp) µs *5*7 Clear P bit in FLMCR1 Write 128-byte data in RAM reprogram data area consecutively to flash memory End of programming *1 Sub-Routine-Call Wait (tcp) µs *7 Apply Write pulse Wait (tcpsu) µs See Note 6 for pulse width Set PV bit in FLMCR1 Clear PSU bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tspv) µs *7 *7 H'FF dummy write to verify address Disable WDT End Sub *7 Read verify data *2 Write data = verify data? No n←n+1 Increment address Note 6: Write Pulse Width Number of Writes n Wait (tspvr) µs Write Time (tsp) µs 30 * 30 * 30 * 30 * 30 * 30 * 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 No 6≥n? Yes Additional-programming data computation 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 998 999 1000 m=1 Yes Transfer additional-programming data to additional-programming data area *4 *3 Reprogram data computation Transfer reprogram data to reprogram data area No 200 200 200 *4 128-byte data verification completed? Yes Clear PV bit in FLMCR1 Reprogram Note: * Use a 10 µs write pulse for additional programming. Wait (tcpv) µs RAM 6 ≥ n? *7 No Yes Successively write 128-byte data from additional*1 programming data area in RAM to flash memory Program data storage area (128 bytes) Sub-Routine-Call Reprogram data storage area (128 bytes) Apply Write Pulse (Additional programming) Additional-programming data storage area (128 bytes) m=0? *7 No Yes Clear SWE bit in FLMCR1 n ≥ (N) ? No Yes Clear SWE bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tcswe) µs Wait (tcswe) µs *7 Notes: 1. Data transfer is performed by byte transfer. The lower 8 bits of the first address written to must be H'00 or H'80. A 128-byte data transfer must be performed even if writing fewer than 128 bytes; in this case, End of programming Programming failure H'FF data must be written to the extra addresses. 2. Verify data is read in 16-bit (word) units. 3. Reprogram data is determined by the operation shown in the table below (comparison between the data stored in the program data area and the verify data). Bits for which the reprogram data is 0 are programmed in the next reprogramming loop. Therefore, even bits for which programming has been completed will be subjected to programming once again if the result of the subsequent verify operation is NG. 4. A 128-byte area for storing program data, a 128-byte area for storing reprogram data, and a 128-byte area for storing additional data must be provided in RAM. The contents of the reprogram data area and additional data area are modified as programming proceeds. 5. A write pulse of 30 µs or 200 µs is applied according to the progress of the programming operation. See Note 6 for details of the pulse widths. When writing of additional-programming data is executed, a 10 µs write pulse should be applied. Reprogram data X' means reprogram data when the write pulse is applied. 7. The wait times and value of N are shown in section 22.5, Flash Memory Characteristics. Additional-Programming Data Computation Table Reprogram Data Computation Table Original Data Verify Data Reprogram Data (D) 0 (V) 0 (X) 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 Comments Reprogram Data (X') Verify Data Additional(V) Programming Data (Y) Comments Programming completed 0 0 0 Additional programming to be executed Programming incomplete; reprogram 0 1 1 Additional programming not to be executed 1 0 1 Additional programming not to be executed 1 1 1 Additional programming not to be executed Still in erased state; no action Figure 18.9 Program/Program-Verify Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 447 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.8.2 Erase/Erase-Verify When erasing flash memory, the erase/erase-verify flowchart shown in figure 18.10 should be followed. 1. Prewriting (setting erase block data to all 0s) is not necessary. 2. Erasing is performed in block units. Specify a single block o be erased with the erase block registers (EBR2 and EBR1). To erase multiple blocks, each block must be erased in turn. 3. The time during which the E bit is set to 1 is the flash memory erase time. 4. The watchdog timer (WDT) is set to prevent overerasing due to program runaway, etc. Set the overflow cycle to approximately 19.8 ms. 5. For a dummy write to a verify address, write 1-byte data H'FF to an address whose lower two bits are B'00. Verify data can be read in longwords from the address to which a dummy write was performed. 6. If the read data is not erased successfully, set erase mode again, and repeat the erase/eraseverify sequence as before. Note that the number of repetitions of the erase/erase-verify sequence should be less than 100. 18.8.3 Interrupt Handling when Programming/Erasing Flash Memory All interrupts, including the NMI interrupt, should be disabled while flash memory is being programmed, erased, or the boot program is being executed, for the following three reasons: 1. Interrupt during programming/erasing may cause a violation of the programming or erasing algorithm, with the result that normal operation cannot be assured. 2. If interrupt exception handling starts before the vector address is written or during programming/erasing, a correct vector cannot be fetched and the CPU malfunctions. 3. If an interrupt occurs during boot program execution, normal boot mode sequence cannot be carried out. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 448 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM Start *1 Perform erasing in block units. Set SWE bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tsswe) µs *5 n=1 *3 *4 Set EBR1 or EBR2 Enable WDT Set ESU bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tsesu) µs *5 Start of erase Set E bit in FLMCR1 *5 Wait (tse) ms Clear E bit in FLMCR1 Erase halted Wait (tce) µs *5 Clear ESU bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tcesu) µs *5 Disable WDT Set EV bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tsev) µs n←n+1 *5 Set block start address as verify address H'FF dummy write to verify address Wait (tsevr) µs *5 *2 Read verify data Increment address Verify data = all 1s? No Yes No Last address of block? Yes Clear EV bit in FLMCR1 *5 Wait (tcev) µs Wait (tcev) µs *5 n ≥ (N)? Clear SWE bit in FLMCR1 Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. *5 Clear EV bit in FLMCR1 *5 Yes Clear SWE bit in FLMCR1 Wait (tcswe) µs Wait (tcswe) µs End of erasing Erase failure No *5 Prewriting (setting erase block data to all 0s) is not necessary. Verify data is read in 16-bit (word) units. Make only a single-bit specification in the erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2). Two or more bits must not be set simultaneously. Erasing is performed in block units. To erase multiple blocks, each block must be erased in turn. The wait times and the value of N are shown in section 22.5, Flash Memory Characteristics. Figure 18.10 Erase/Erase-Verify Flowchart Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 449 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.9 Program/Erase Protection There are three kinds of flash memory program/erase protection; hardware protection, software protection, and error protection. 18.9.1 Hardware Protection Hardware protection refers to a state in which programming/erasing of flash memory is forcibly disabled or aborted because of a transition to reset or standby mode. Flash memory control register 1 (FLMCR1), flash memory control register 2 (FLMCR2), and erase block register 1 (EBR1) are initialized. In a reset via the RES pin, the reset state is not entered unless the RES pin is held low until oscillation settles after powering on. In the case of a reset during operation, hold the RES pin low for the RES pulse width specified in the AC characteristics section. 18.9.2 Software Protection Software protection can be implemented against programming/erasing of all flash memory blocks by clearing the SWE bit in FLMCR1. When software protection is in effect, setting the P1 or E1 bit in FLMCR1 does not cause a transition to program mode or erase mode. By setting the erase block register 1 (EBR1), erase protection can be set for individual blocks. When EBR1 is set to H'00, erase protection is set for all blocks. 18.9.3 Error Protection In error protection, an error is detected when CPU runaway occurs during flash memory programming/erasing, or operation is not performed in accordance with the program/erase algorithm, and the program/erase operation is aborted. Aborting the program/erase operation prevents damage to the flash memory due to overprogramming or overerasing. When the following errors are detected during programming/erasing of flash memory, the FLER bit in FLMCR2 is set to 1, and the error protection state is entered. • When the flash memory of the relevant address area is read during programming/erasing (including vector read and instruction fetch) • Immediately after exception handling (excluding a reset) during programming/erasing • When a SLEEP instruction is executed during programming/erasing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 450 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM The FLMCR2, FLMCR1, and EBR1 settings are retained, however program mode or erase mode is aborted at the point at which the error occurred. Program mode or erase mode cannot be reentered by re-setting the P1 or E1 bit. However, PV1 and EV1 bit setting is enabled, and a transition can be made to verify mode. Error protection can be cleared only by a power-on reset. 18.10 Programmer Mode In programmer mode, a PROM programmer can be used to perform programming/erasing via a socket adapter, just as for a discrete flash memory. Use a PROM programmer that supports the Renesas 128-kbyte flash memory on-chip MCU device type (FZTAT128V5A). 18.11 Power-Down States for Flash Memory In user mode, the flash memory will operate in either of the following states: • Normal operating mode The flash memory can be read and written to. • Standby mode All flash memory circuits are halted. Table 18.6 shows the correspondence between the operating modes of this LSI and the flash memory. When the flash memory returns to its normal operating state from standby mode, a period to settle the power supply circuits that were stopped is needed. When the flash memory returns to its normal operating state, bits STS2 to STS0 in SBYCR must be set to provide a wait time of at least 20 µs, even when the external clock is being used. Table 18.6 Flash Memory Operating States LSI Operating State Flash Memory Operating State Active mode Normal operating mode Standby mode Standby mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 451 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 18 ROM 18.12 Note on Switching from F-ZTAT Version to Masked ROM Version The masked ROM version does not have the internal registers for flash memory control that are provided in the F-ZTAT version. Table 18.7 lists the registers that are present in the F-ZTAT version but not in the masked ROM version. If a register listed in table 18.7 is read in the masked ROM version, an undefined value will be returned. Therefore, if application software developed on the F-ZTAT version is switched to a masked ROM version product, it must be modified to ensure that the registers in table 18.7 have no effect. Table 18.7 Registers Present in F-ZTAT Version but Absent in Masked ROM Version Register Abbreviation Address Flash memory control register 1 FLMCR1 H'FFA8 Flash memory control register 2 FLMCR2 H'FFA9 Erase block register 1 EBR1 H'FFAA Erase block register 2 EBR2 H'FFAB RAM emulation register RAMER H'FEDB Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 452 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator This LSI has an on-chip clock pulse generator that generates the system clock (φ), the bus master clock, and internal clocks. The clock pulse generator consists of an oscillator, PLL circuit, clock selection circuit, medium-speed clock divider, and bus master clock selection circuit. A block diagram of the clock pulse generator is shown in figure19.1. SCKCR LPWRCR SCK2 to SCK0 STC1, STC0 EXTAL Clock oscillator PLL circuit (×1, ×2, ×4) XTAL Clock selection circuit Mediumspeed clock divider φ/32 to φ/2 φ System clock to φ pin Bus master clock selection circuit Internal clock to peripheral modules Bus master clock to CPU and DTC [Legend] LPWRCR: Low-power control register SCKCR: System clock control register Figure 19.1 Block Diagram of Clock Pulse Generator The frequency can be changed by means of the PLL circuit. Frequency changes are performed by software by settings in the low-power control register (LPWRCR) and system clock control register (SCKCR). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 453 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator 19.1 Register Descriptions The on-chip clock pulse generator has the following registers. • System clock control register (SCKCR) • Low-power control register (LPWRCR) 19.1.1 System Clock Control Register (SCKCR) SCKCR performs φ clock output control, selection of operation when the PLL circuit frequency multiplication factor is changed, and medium-speed mode control. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 PSTOP 0 R/W φ Clock Output Disable Controls φ output. High-speed Mode, Medium-Speed Mode 0: φ output 1: Fixed high Sleep Mode 0: φ output 1: Fixed high Software Standby Mode 0: Fixed high 1: Fixed high Hardware Standby Mode 0: High impedance 1: High impedance 6 to 4 All 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 0. 3 STCS 0 R/W Frequency Multiplication Factor Switching Mode Select Selects the operation when the PLL circuit frequency multiplication factor is changed. 0: Specified multiplication factor is valid after transition to software standby mode 1: Specified multiplication factor is valid immediately after STC1 bit and STC0 bit are rewritten Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 454 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 2 SCK2 0 R/W System Clock Select 2 to 0 1 SCK1 0 R/W These bits select the bus master clock. 0 SCK0 0 R/W 000: High-speed mode 001: Medium-speed clock is φ/2 010: Medium-speed clock is φ/4 011: Medium-speed clock is φ/8 100: Medium-speed clock is φ/16 101: Medium-speed clock is φ/32 11×: Setting prohibited [Legend] ×: Don’t care 19.1.2 Bit Low-Power Control Register (LPWRCR) Bit Name 7 to 4 Initial Value R/W Description All 0 Reserved The write value should always be 0. 3, 2 All 0 R/W Reserved These bits can be read from and write to, but should not be set to 1. 1 STC1 0 R/W Frequency Multiplication Factor 0 STC0 0 R/W The STC bits specify the frequency multiplication factor of the PLL circuit. 00: ×1 01: ×2 10: ×4 11: Setting prohibited Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 455 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator 19.2 Oscillator Clock pulses can be supplied by connecting a crystal resonator, or by input of an external clock. In either case, the input clock should not exceed 20 MHz. 19.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Resonator Circuit Configuration: A crystal resonator can be connected as shown in the example in figure 19.2. Select the damping resistance Rd according to table19.1. An AT-cut parallel-resonance crystal should be used. CL1 EXTAL XTAL CL1 = CL2 = 22 to 10 pF CL2 Rd Figure 19.2 Connection of Crystal Resonator (Example) Table19.1 Damping Resistance Value Frequency (MHz) 4 8 10 12 16 20 Rd (Ω) 500 200 0 0 0 0 Figure19.3 shows the equivalent circuit of the crystal resonator. Use a crystal resonator that has the characteristics shown in table 19.2. CL XTAL L Rs C0 EXTAL AT-cut parallel-resonance type Figure 19.3 Crystal Resonator Equivalent Circuit Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 456 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Table19.2 Crystal Resonator Characteristics Frequency (MHz) 4 8 10 12 16 20 RS max (Ω) 120 80 70 60 50 40 C0 max (pF) 7 7 7 7 7 7 19.2.2 External Clock Input Circuit Configuration: An external clock signal can be input as shown in the examples in figure 19.4. If the XTAL pin is left open, ensure that stray capacitance does not exceed 10 pF. When complementary clock is input to the XTAL pin, the external clock input should be fixed high in standby mode. External clock input EXTAL XTAL Open (a) XTAL pin left open EXTAL External clock input XTAL (b) Complementary clock input at XTAL pin Figure 19.4 External Clock Input (Examples) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 457 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Table19.3 shows the input conditions for the external clock. Table19.3 External Clock Input Conditions VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions External clock input low pulse width tEXL 15 ns Figure 19.5 External clock input high pulse width tEXH 15 ns External clock rise time tEXr 5 ns External clock fall time tEXf 5 ns tEXH tEXL VCC × 0.5 EXTAL tEXr tEXf Figure 19.5 External Clock Input Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 458 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator 19.3 PLL Circuit The PLL circuit multiplies the frequency of the clock from the oscillator by a factor of 1, 2, or 4. The multiplication factor is set by the STC0 bit and the STC1 bit in LPWRCR. The phase of the rising edge of the internal clock is controlled so as to match that at the EXTAL pin. When the multiplication factor of the PLL circuit is changed, the operation varies according to the setting of the STCS bit in SCKCR. When STCS = 0, the setting becomes valid after a transition to software standby mode. The transition time count is performed in accordance with the setting of bits STS2 to STS0 in SBYCR. For details on SBYCR, refer to section 20.1.1, Standby Control Register (SBYCR). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. The initial PLL circuit multiplication factor is 1. STS2 to STS0 are set to give the specified transition time. The target value is set in STC1 and STC0, and a transition is made to software standby mode. The clock pulse generator stops and the value set in STC1 and STC0 becomes valid. Software standby mode is cleared, and a transition time is secured in accordance with the setting in STS2 to STS0. 6. After the set transition time has elapsed, this LSI resumes operation using the target multiplication factor. If a PC break is set for the SLEEP instruction, software standby mode is entered and break exception handling is executed after the oscillation settling time. In this case, the instruction following the SLEEP instruction is executed after execution of the RTE instruction. When STCS = 1, this LSI operates on the changed multiplication factor immediately after bits STC1 and STC0 are rewritten. 19.4 Medium-Speed Clock Divider The medium-speed clock divider divides the system clock to generate φ/2, φ/4, φ/8, φ/16, and φ/32. 19.5 Bus Master Clock Selection Circuit The bus master clock selection circuit selects the clock supplied to the bus master by setting the bits SCK2 to SCK0 in SCKCR. The bus master clock can be selected from high-speed mode, or medium-speed clocks (φ/2, φ/4, φ/8, φ/16, φ/32). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 459 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator 19.6 Usage Notes 19.6.1 Note on Crystal Resonator As various characteristics related to the crystal resonator are closely linked to the user’s board design, thorough evaluation is necessary on the user’s part, using the resonator connection examples shown in this section as a guide. As the resonator circuit ratings will depend on the floating capacitance of the resonator and the mounting circuit, the ratings should be determined in consultation with the resonator manufacturer. The design must ensure that a voltage exceeding the maximum rating is not applied to the oscillator pin. 19.6.2 Note on Board Design When designing the board, place the crystal resonator and its load capacitors as close as possible to the XTAL and EXTAL pins. Other signal lines should be routed away from the oscillator circuit, as shown in figure 19.6. This is to prevent induction from interfering with correct oscillation. Signal A Signal B Avoid CL2 This LSI XTAL EXTAL CL1 Figure 19.6 Note on Board Design of Oscillator Circuit Figure 19.7 shows external circuitry recommended to be provided around the PLL circuit. Place oscillation settling capacitor C1 and resistor R1 close to the PLLCAP pin, and ensure that no other signal lines cross this line. Separate PLLVss from the other Vcc and Vss lines at the board power supply source, and be sure to insert bypass capacitors CB close to the pins. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 460 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator R1 = 3 kΩ C1 = 470 pF PLLCAP PLLVSS VCL VCC CB = 0.1 µF* CB = 0.1 µF VSS (Values are preliminary recommended values.) Note: * CB is laminated ceramic. Figure 19.7 External Circuitry Recommended for PLL Circuit Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 461 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 19 Clock Pulse Generator Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 462 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Section 20 Power-Down Modes In addition to the normal program execution state, this LSI has five power-down modes in which operation of the CPU and oscillator is halted and power consumption is reduced. Low-power operation can be achieved by individually controlling the CPU, on-chip peripheral modules, and so on. This LSI’s operating modes are as follows: • • • • • • High-speed mode Medium-speed mode Sleep mode Module stop mode Software standby mode Hardware standby mode The above modes except the high-speed mode are power-down modes. Sleep mode is a CPU state, medium-speed mode is a CPU and bus master state, and module stop mode is an internal peripheral function (including bus masters other than the CPU) state. Some of these states can be combined. After a reset, the LSI is in high-speed mode. Figure 21.1 shows possible transitions between modes. Table 21.1 shows the conditions of transition made by the SLEEP instruction and recovery from power-down mode by an interrupt. Table 21.2 shows the internal states in each mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 463 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Program-halted state STBY pin = Low Reset state Hardware standby mode STBY pin = High, RES pin = Low RES pin = High Program execution state SSBY = 0 Sleep mode (main clock) SLEEP command High-speed mode (main clock) Any interrupt SCK2 to SCK0 = 0 SLEEP command SCK2 to SCK0 ≠ 0 Software standby mode External interrupt* Medium-speed mode (main clock) : Transition after exception processing Notes: SSBY = 1 : Low power dissipation mode * NMI and IRQ5 to IRQ0 • When a transition is made between modes by means of an interrupt, the transition cannot be made on interrupt source generation alone. Ensure that interrupt handling is performed after accepting the interrupt request. • From any state except hardware standby mode, a transition to the reset state occurs when RES is driven low. • From any state, a transition to hardware standby mode occurs when STBY is driven low. Figure 20.1 Mode Transition Diagram Table 20.1 Low Power Consumption Mode Transition Conditions Pre-Transition State High-speed/ Medium-speed Status of Control Bit at Transition SSBY State after Transition Invoked by SLEEP Command State after Transition Back from Low Power Mode Invoked by Interrupt 0 Sleep High-speed/Medium-speed 1 Software standby High-speed/Medium-speed Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 464 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Table 20.2 LSI Internal States in Each Mode MediumHigh-Speed Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby System clock pulse generator Operate Operate Operate Operate Halted Halted CPU Instructions Registers Operate Mediumspeed operation Halted (retained) High/ mediumspeed operation Halted (retained) Halted (undefined) External interrupts NMI Operate Operate Operate Operate Operate Halted Peripheral functions PBC Operate Mediumspeed operation Operate Halted (retained) Halted (retained) Halted (reset) I/O Operate Operate Operate Operate Retained High impedance TPU Operate Operate Operate Halted (retained) Halted (retained) Halted (reset) WDT Operate Operate Operate Operate Halted (retained) Halted (reset) SCI Operate Operate Operate Halted* (reset/ retained) Halted (reset) Halted (reset) RAM Operate Mediumspeed operation Operate (DTC) Operate Retained Retained SSU Operate Operate Operate Halted (reset) Halted (reset) Halted (reset) Function IRQ5 to IRQ0 DTC TMR PPG A/D Notes: Halted (retained) means that internal register values are retained. The internal state is in the operation suspended state. Halted (reset) means that internal register values and internal states are initialized. In module stop mode, only modules for which a stop setting has been made are halted (reset or retained). * The SCI’s TDR, RDR, and SSR are halted (reset), and the other registers are halted (retained). Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 465 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.1 Register Descriptions Registers related to the power down mode are shown below. For details on the system clock control register (SCKCR), refer to section 19.1.1, System Clock Control Register (SCKCR). • • • • • System clock control register (SCKCR) Standby control register (SBYCR) Module stop control register A (MSTPCRA) Module stop control register B (MSTPCRB) Module stop control register C (MSTPCRC) 20.1.1 Standby Control Register (SBYCR) SBYCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that performs software standby mode control. Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 7 SSBY 0 R/W Software Standby This bit specifies the transition mode after executing the SLEEP instruction 0: Shifts to sleep mode when the SLEEP instruction is executed 1: Shifts to software standby mode when the SLEEP instruction is executed This bit does not change when clearing the software standby mode by using external interrupts and shifting to normal operation. This bit should be written with 0 when clearing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 466 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description 6 STS2 0 R/W Standby Timer Select 2 to 0 5 STS1 0 R/W 4 STS0 0 R/W These bits select the MCU wait time for clock settling when software standby mode is cancelled by an external interrupt. With a crystal oscillator (table 21.3), select a wait time of 8 ms (oscillation settling time) or more, depending on the operating frequency. With an external clock, select a wait time of 2 ms or more. 000: Standby time = 8,192 states 001: Standby time = 16,384 states 010: Standby time = 32,768 states 011: Standby time = 65,536 states 100: Standby time = 131,072 states 101: Standby time = 262,144 states 110: Reserved 111: Standby time = 16 states 3 1 R/W Reserved The write value should always be 0. 2 to 0 All 0 Reserved These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be modified. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 467 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.1.2 Module Stop Control Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC) MSTPCR is comprised of three 8-bit readable/writable registers, and performs module stop mode control. Setting a bit to 1 causes the corresponding module to enter module stop mode. Clearing the bit to 0 clears the module stop mode. • MSTPCRA Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Module 7 MSTPA7* 0 R/W 6 MSTPA6 0 R/W Data transfer controller (DTC) 5 MSTPA5 1 R/W 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) 4 MSTPA4 1 R/W 8-bit timer (TMR_1, TMR_0) 3 MSTPA3 1 R/W Programmable pulse generator (PPG) 2 MSTPA2* 1 R/W 1 MSTPA1 1 R/W A/D converter 0 MSTPA0 1 R/W 8-bit timer (TMR_3, TMR_2) • MSTPCRB Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W Module 7 MSTPB7 1 R/W Serial communication interface 0 (SCI0) 6 MSTPB6 1 R/W Serial communication interface 1 (SCI1) 5 MSTPB5 1 R/W Serial communication interface 2 (SCI2) 4 MSTPB4* MSTPB3* 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 MSTPB2* MSTPB1* 1 R/W 0 MSTPB0* 1 R/W 3 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 468 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes • MSTPCRC Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W 7 1 R/W 6 MSTPC7* MSTPC6* 1 R/W 5 MSTPC5* 1 R/W 4 MSTPC4 1 R/W 3 MSTPC3* 1 R/W 2 MSTPC2 1 R/W 1 MSTPC1* MSTPC0* 1 R/W 1 R/W 0 Note: 20.2 * Module PC break controller (PBC) Synchronous serial communication unit (SSU) MSTPA7 is a readable/writable bit with an initial value of 0. The write value should always be 0. MSTPA2, MSTPB4 to MSTPB0, MSTPC7 to MSTPC5, MSTPC3, MSTPC1, and MSTPC0 are readable/writable bits with an initial value of 1. The write value should always be 1. Medium-Speed Mode When the SCK2 to SCK0 bits in SCKCR are set to 1, the operating mode changes to mediumspeed mode as soon as the current bus cycle ends. In medium-speed mode, the CPU operates on the operating clock (φ/2, φ/4, φ/8, φ/16, or φ/32) specified by the SCK2 to SCK0 bits. Bus masters (DTC) other than the CPU also operate in medium-speed mode. On-chip peripheral modules other than bus masters always operate on the high-speed clock (φ). In medium-speed mode, a bus access is executed in the specified number of states with respect to the bus master operating clock. For example, if φ/4 is selected as the operating clock, on-chip memory is accessed in 4 states, and internal I/O registers in 8 states. Medium-speed mode is cleared by clearing all of bits SCK2 to SCK0 to 0. A transition is made to high-speed mode and medium-speed mode is cleared at the end of the current bus cycle. If a SLEEP instruction is executed when the SSBY bit in SBYCR is cleared to 0, a transition is made to sleep mode. When sleep mode is cleared by an interrupt, medium-speed mode is restored. When the SLEEP instruction is executed with the SSBY bit = 1, operation shifts to the software standby mode. When software standby mode is cleared by an external interrupt, medium-speed mode is restored. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 469 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes When the RES pin is set low and medium-speed mode is cancelled, operation shifts to the reset state. The same applies in the case of a reset caused by overflow of the watchdog timer. When the STBY pin is driven low, a transition is made to hardware standby mode. Figure 21.2 shows the timing for transition to and clearance of medium-speed mode. Medium-speed mode φ, peripheral module clock Bus master clock Internal address bus SCKCR SCKCR Internal write signal Figure 20.2 Medium-Speed Mode Transition and Clearance Timing 20.3 Sleep Mode 20.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode If SLEEP instruction is executed when the SBYCR SSBY bit = 0, the CPU enters the sleep mode. In sleep mode, CPU operation stops, however the contents of the CPU’s internal registers are retained. Other peripheral modules do not stop. 20.3.2 Clearing Sleep Mode Sleep mode is cleared by any interrupt, or signals at the RES, or STBY pins. • Exiting Sleep Mode by Interrupts: When an interrupt occurs, sleep mode is exited and interrupt exception processing starts. Sleep mode is not exited if the interrupt is disabled, or if interrupts other than NMI are masked by the CPU. • Exiting Sleep Mode by RES pin: Setting the RES pin low level selects the reset state. After the stipulated reset input duration, driving the RES pin high level restart the CPU performing reset exception processing. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 470 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes • Exiting Sleep Mode by STBY Pin: When the STBY pin level is driven low, a transition is made to hardware standby mode. 20.4 Software Standby Mode 20.4.1 Transition to Software Standby Mode A transition is made to software standby mode if the SLEEP instruction is executed when the SBYCR SSBY bit is set to 1. In this mode, the CPU, on-chip peripheral modules, and oscillator, all stop. However, the contents of the CPU’s internal registers, on-chip RAM data, and the states of on-chip peripheral modules other than the SCI, SSU, A/D converter, and the states of I/O ports, are retained. In this mode, the oscillator stops, and therefore power consumption is significantly reduced. 20.4.2 Clearing Software Standby Mode Software standby mode is cleared by an external interrupt (NMI pin, or pins IRQ5 to IRQ0), or by means of the RES pin or STBY pin. • Clearing with an interrupt When an NMI or IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupt request signal is input, clock oscillation starts, and after the time set in bits STS2 to STS0 in SBYCR has elapsed, stable clocks are supplied to the entire chip, software standby mode is cleared, and interrupt exception handling is started. When clearing software standby mode with an IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupt, set the corresponding enable bit to 1 and ensure that no interrupt with a higher priority than interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 is generated. Software standby mode cannot be cleared if the interrupt has been masked on the CPU side or has been designated as a DTC activation source. • Clearing with the RES pin When the RES pin is driven low, clock oscillation is started. At the same time as clock oscillation starts, clocks are supplied to the entire chip. Note that the RES pin must be held low until clock oscillation settles. When the RES pin goes high, the CPU begins reset exception handling. • Clearing with the STBY pin When the STBY pin is driven low, a transition is made to hardware standby mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 471 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.4.3 Setting Oscillation Stabilization Time after Clearing Software Standby Mode Bits STS2 to STS0 in SBYCR should be set as described below. • Using a Crystal Oscillator: Set bits STS2 to STS0 so that the standby time is at least 8 ms (the oscillation settling time). Table 21.3 shows the standby times for different operating frequencies and settings of bits STS2 to STS0. • Using an External Clock The PLL circuit requires a time for settling. Set bits STS2 to STS0 so that the standby time is at least 2 ms(the oscillation settling time). Table 20.3 Oscillation Stabilization Time Settings STS2 STS1 STS0 Standby Time 20 16 12 10 8 6 4 MHz MHz MHz MHz MHz MHz MHz Unit 0 0 1 1 0 1 Note: 0 8,192 states 0.41 0.51 0.68 0.8 1.0 1.3 2.0 1 16,384 states 0.82 1.0 1.3 1.6 2.0 2.7 4.1 0 32,768 states 1.6 2.0 2.7 3.3 4.1 5.5 8.2 1 65,536 states 3.3 4.1 5.5 6.6 8.2 10.9 16.4 8.2 10.9 13.1 16.4 21.8 32.8 ms 0 131,072 states 6.6 1 262,144 states 13.1 16.4 21.8 26.2 32.8 43.6 65.6 0 Reserved 1 16 states* 0.8 1.0 1.3 1.6 2.0 1.7 4.0 µs : Recommended time setting * Cannot be used in this LSI. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 472 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.4.4 Software Standby Mode Application Example Figure 21.3 shows an example in which a transition is made to software standby mode at the falling edge on the NMI pin, and software standby mode is cleared at the rising edge on the NMI pin. In this example, an NMI interrupt is accepted with the NMIEG bit in SYSCR cleared to 0 (falling edge specification), then the NMIEG bit is set to 1 (rising edge specification), the SSBY bit is set to 1, and a SLEEP instruction is executed, causing a transition to software standby mode. Software standby mode is then cleared at the rising edge on the NMI pin. Oscillator φ NMI NMIEG SSBY Software standby mode NMI exception (power-down mode) handling NMIEG = 1 SSBY = 1 SLEEP instruction NMI exception handling Oscillation stabilization time tOSC2 Figure 20.3 Software Standby Mode Application Example Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 473 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.5 Hardware Standby Mode 20.5.1 Transition to Hardware Standby Mode When the STBY pin is driven low, a transition is made to hardware standby mode from any mode. In hardware standby mode, all functions enter the reset state and stop operation, resulting in a significant reduction in power consumption. As long as the prescribed voltage is supplied, on-chip RAM data is retained. I/O ports are set to the high-impedance state. In order to retain on-chip RAM data, the RAME bit in SYSCR should be cleared to 0 before driving the STBY pin low. Do not change the state of the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) while this LSI is in hardware standby mode. 20.5.2 Clearing Hardware Standby Mode Hardware standby mode is cleared by means of the STBY pin and the RES pin. When the STBY pin is driven high while the RES pin is low, the reset state is set and clock oscillation is started. Ensure that the RES pin is held low until the clock oscillator settles (at least 8 msthe oscillation settling timewhen using a crystal oscillator). When the RES pin is subsequently driven high, a transition is made to the program execution state via the reset exception handling state. 20.5.3 Hardware Standby Mode Timings Timing of Transition to Hardware Standby Mode 1. To retain RAM contents with the RAME bit set to 1 in SYSCR Drive the RES signal low at least 10 states before the STBY signal goes low, as shown in figure 21.4. After STBY has gone low, RES has to wait for at least 0 ns before becoming high. STBY t1 ≥ 10 tcyc t2 ≥ 0 ns RES Figure 20.4 Timing of Transition to Hardware Standby Mode Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 474 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 2. To retain RAM contents with the RAME bit cleared to 0 in SYSCR, or when RAM contents do not need to be retained RES does not have to be driven low as in the above case. Timing of Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode Drive the RES signal low approximately 100 ns or more before STBY goes high to execute a power-on reset. STBY t ≥ 100 ns tOSC1 RES Figure 20.5 Timing of Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode 20.6 Module Stop Mode Module stop mode can be set for individual on-chip peripheral modules. When the corresponding MSTP bit in MSTPCR is set to 1, module operation stops at the end of the bus cycle and a transition is made to module stop mode. The CPU continues operating independently. When the corresponding MSTP bit is cleared to 0, module stop mode is cleared and the module starts operating at the end of the bus cycle. In module stop mode, the internal states of modules other than the SCI* and A/D converter are retained. After reset clearance, all modules other than DTC are in module stop mode. When an on-chip peripheral module is in module stop mode, read/write access to its registers is disabled. Note: * The internal states of some SCI registers are retained. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 475 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.7 φ Clock Output Disabling Function The output of the φ clock can be controlled by means of the PSTOP bit in SCKCR, and DDR for the corresponding port. When the PSTOP bit is set to 1, the φ clock stops at the end of the bus cycle, and φ output goes high. φ clock output is enabled when the PSTOP bit is cleared to 0. When DDR for the corresponding port is cleared to 0, φ clock output is disabled and input port mode is set. Table 21.4 shows the state of the φ pin in each processing state. Table 20.4 φ Pin State in Each Processing State Register Settings DDR PSTOP Normal Mode Sleep Mode Software Standby Mode Hardware Standby Mode 0 × High impedance High impedance High impedance High impedance 1 0 φ output φ output Fixed high High impedance 1 1 Fixed high Fixed high Fixed high High impedance Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 476 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes 20.8 Usage Notes 20.8.1 I/O Port Status In software standby mode, I/O port states are retained. Therefore, there is no reduction in current consumption for the output current when a high-level signal is output. 20.8.2 Current Consumption during Oscillation Stabilization Wait Period Current consumption increases during the oscillation settling wait period. 20.8.3 DTC Module Stop Depending on the operating status of the DTC, MSTPA6 bit may not be set to 1. Setting of the DTC module stop mode should be carried out only when the respective module is not activated. For details, refer to section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). 20.8.4 On-Chip Peripheral Module Interrupt Relevant interrupt operations cannot be performed in module stop mode. Consequently, if module stop mode is entered when an interrupt has been requested, it will not be possible to clear the CPU interrupt source or the DTC activation source. Interrupts should therefore be disabled before entering module stop mode. 20.8.5 Writing to MSTPCR MSTPCR should only be written to by the CPU. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 477 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 20 Power-Down Modes Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 478 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Section 21 List of Registers The register list gives information on the on-chip I/O register addresses, how the register bits are configured, and the register states in each operating mode. The information is given as shown below. 1. • • • • 2. • • • • 3. • • Register addresses (address order) Registers are listed in the order of ascending addresses. For 16-bit registers, the addresses of MSB are shown. Registers are classified according to functional modules. The access size is indicated. Register bits Bit configurations of the registers are listed in the same order as the register addresses. Reserved bits are indicated by “” in the bit name columns. Registers for which bit numbers are shown are those operate as counters or hold data. For 16-bit registers, bits in MSB are shown in the upper line and bits in LSB in the lower line. Register states in each operating mode Register states are listed in the same order as the register addresses. The register states shown here are for the basic operating modes. If an on-chip module has its own reset state, refer to the section on that on-chip module. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 479 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers 21.1 Register Addresses (Address Order) The data-bus width column indicates the number of bits. The access-state column shows the number of states of the selected basic clock that is required for access to the register. Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State SS control register H_0 SSCRH_0 8 H'FB00 SSU_0 16 3 SS control register L_0 SSCRL_0 8 H'FB01 SSU_0 16 3 SS mode register_0 SSMR_0 8 H'FB02 SSU_0 16 3 SS enable register_0 SSER_0 8 H'FB03 SSU_0 16 3 SS status register_0 SSSR_0 8 H'FB04 SSU_0 16 3 SS transmit data register 0_0 SSTDR0_0 8 H'FB06 SSU_0 16 3 SS transmit data register 1_0 SSTDR1_0 8 H'FB07 SSU_0 16 3 SS transmit data register 2_0 SSTDR2_0 8 H'FB08 SSU_0 16 3 SS transmit data register 3_0 SSTDR3_0 8 H'FB09 SSU_0 16 3 SS receive data register 0_0 SSRDR0_0 8 H'FB0A SSU_0 16 3 SS receive data register 1_0 SSRDR1_0 8 H'FB0B SSU_0 16 3 SS receive data register 2_0 SSRDR2_0 8 H'FB0C SSU_0 16 3 SS receive data register 3_0 SSRDR3_0 8 H'FB0D SSU_0 16 3 SS control register H_1 SSCRH_1 8 H'FB10 SSU_1 16 3 SS control register L_1 SSCRL_1 8 H'FB11 SSU_1 16 3 SS mode register_1 SSMR_1 8 H'FB12 SSU_1 16 3 SS enable register_1 SSER_1 8 H'FB13 SSU_1 16 3 SS status register_1 SSSR_1 8 H'FB14 SSU_1 16 3 SS transmit data register 0_1 SSTDR0_1 8 H'FB16 SSU_1 16 3 SS transmit data register 1_1 SSTDR1_1 8 H'FB17 SSU_1 16 3 SS transmit data register 2_1 SSTDR2_1 8 H'FB18 SSU_1 16 3 SS transmit data register 3_1 SSTDR3_1 8 H'FB19 SSU_1 16 3 SS receive data register 0_1 SSRDR0_1 8 H'FB1A SSU_1 16 3 SS receive data register 1_1 SSRDR1_1 8 H'FB1B SSU_1 16 3 SS receive data register 2_1 SSRDR2_1 8 H'FB1C SSU_1 16 3 SS receive data register 3_1 SSRDR3_1 8 H'FB1D SSU_1 16 3 8 H'FB40 PORT 16 3 Port D realtime input data register PDRTIDR Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 480 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State Timer control register_2 TCR_2 8 H'FDC0 TMR_2 8 2 Timer control register_3 TCR_3 8 H'FDC1 TMR_3 8 2 Timer control/status register_2 TCSR_2 8 H'FDC2 TMR_2 8 2 Timer control/status register_3 TCSR_3 8 H'FDC3 TMR_3 8 2 Timer constant register A_2 TCORA_2 8 H'FDC4 TMR_2 8 2 Timer constant register A_3 TCORA_3 8 H'FDC5 TMR_3 8 2 Timer constant register B_2 TCORB_2 8 H'FDC6 TMR_2 8 2 Timer constant register B_3 TCORB_3 8 H'FDC7 TMR_3 8 2 Timer counter_2 TCNT_2 8 H'FDC8 TMR_2 8 2 Timer counter_3 TCNT_3 8 H'FDC9 TMR_3 8 2 Standby control register SBYCR 8 H'FDE4 SYSTEM 8 2 System control register SYSCR 8 H'FDE5 SYSTEM 8 2 System clock control register SCKCR 8 H'FDE6 SYSTEM 8 2 Mode control register MDCR 8 H'FDE7 SYSTEM 8 2 Module stop control register A MSTPCRA 8 H'FDE8 SYSTEM 8 2 Module stop control register B MSTPCRB 8 H'FDE9 SYSTEM 8 2 Module stop control register C MSTPCRC 8 H'FDEA SYSTEM 8 2 Low-power control register LPWRCR 8 H'FDEC SYSTEM 8 2 Break address register A BARA 32 H'FE00 PBC 32 2 Break address register B BARB 32 H'FE04 PBC 32 2 Break control register A BCRA 8 H'FE08 PBC 8 2 Break control register B BCRB 8 H'FE09 PBC 8 2 IRQ sense control register H ISCRH 8 H'FE12 INT 8 2 IRQ sense control register L ISCRL 8 H'FE13 INT 8 2 IRQ enable register IER 8 H'FE14 INT 8 2 IRQ status register ISR 8 H'FE15 INT 8 2 DTC enable register A DTCERA 8 H'FE16 DTC 8 2 DTC enable register B DTCERB 8 H'FE17 DTC 8 2 DTC enable register C DTCERC 8 H'FE18 DTC 8 2 DTC enable register D DTCERD 8 H'FE19 DTC 8 2 DTC enable register E DTCERE 8 H'FE1A DTC 8 2 DTC enable register F DTCERF 8 H'FE1B DTC 8 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 481 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State DTC enable register G DTCERG 8 H'FE1C DTC 8 2 DTC vector register DTVECR 8 H'FE1F DTC 8 2 PPG output control register PCR 8 H'FE26 PPG 8 2 PPG output mode register PMR 8 H'FE27 PPG 8 2 Next data enable register H NDERH 8 H'FE28 PPG 8 2 Next data enable register L NDERL 8 H'FE29 PPG 8 2 Output data register H PODRH 8 H'FE2A PPG 8 2 Output data register L PODRL 8 H'FE2B PPG 8 2 Next data register H NDRH 8 H'FE2C PPG 8 2 Next data register L NDRL 8 H'FE2D PPG 8 2 Next data register H NDRH 8 H'FE2E PPG 8 2 Next data register L NDRL 8 H'FE2F PPG 8 2 Port 1 data direction register P1DDR 8 H'FE30 PORT 8 2 Port 3 data direction register P3DDR 8 H'FE32 PORT 8 2 Port 7 data direction register P7DDR 8 H'FE36 PORT 8 2 Port A data direction register PADDR 8 H'FE39 PORT 8 2 Port B data direction register PBDDR 8 H'FE3A PORT 8 2 Port C data direction register PCDDR 8 H'FE3B PORT 8 2 Port D data direction register PDDDR 8 H'FE3C PORT 8 2 Port F data direction register PFDDR 8 H'FE3E PORT 8 2 Port A pull-up MOS control register PAPCR 8 H'FE40 PORT 8 2 Port B pull-up MOS control register PBPCR 8 H'FE41 PORT 8 2 Port C pull-up MOS control register PCPCR 8 H'FE42 PORT 8 2 Port D pull-up MOS control register PDPCR 8 H'FE43 PORT 8 2 Port 3 open drain control register P3ODR 8 H'FE46 PORT 8 2 Port A open drain control register PAODR 8 H'FE47 PORT 8 2 Port B open drain control register PBODR 8 H'FE48 PORT 8 2 Port C open drain control register PCODR 8 H'FE49 PORT 8 2 Timer control register_3 TCR_3 8 H'FE80 TPU_3 16 2 Timer mode register_3 TMDR_3 8 H'FE81 TPU_3 16 2 Timer I/O control register H_3 TIORH_3 8 H'FE82 TPU_3 16 2 Timer I/O control register L_3 TIORL_3 8 H'FE83 TPU_3 16 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 482 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State Timer interrupt enable register_3 TIER_3 8 H'FE84 TPU_3 16 2 Timer status register_3 TSR_3 8 H'FE85 TPU_3 16 2 Timer counter H_3 TCNTH_3 8 H'FE86 TPU_3 16 2 Timer counter L_3 TCNTL_3 8 H'FE87 TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register AH_3 TGRAH_3 8 H'FE88 TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register AL_3 TGRAL_3 8 H'FE89 TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register BH_3 TGRBH_3 8 H'FE8A TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register BL_3 TGRBL_3 8 H'FE8B TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register CH_3 TGRCH_3 8 H'FE8C TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register CL_3 TGRCL_3 8 H'FE8D TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register DH_3 TGRDH_3 8 H'FE8E TPU_3 16 2 Timer general register DL_3 TGRDL_3 8 H'FE8F TPU_3 16 2 Timer control register_4 TCR_4 8 H'FE90 TPU_4 16 2 Timer mode register_4 TMDR_4 8 H'FE91 TPU_4 16 2 Timer I/O control register_4 TIOR_4 8 H'FE92 TPU_4 16 2 Timer interrupt enable register_4 TIER_4 8 H'FE94 TPU_4 16 2 Timer status register_4 TSR_4 8 H'FE95 TPU_4 16 2 Timer counter H_4 TCNTH_4 8 H'FE96 TPU_4 16 2 Timer counter L_4 TCNTL_4 8 H'FE97 TPU_4 16 2 Timer general register AH_4 TGRAH_4 8 H'FE98 TPU_4 16 2 Timer general register AL_4 TGRAL_4 8 H'FE99 TPU_4 16 2 Timer general register BH_4 TGRBH_4 8 H'FE9A TPU_4 16 2 Timer general register BL_4 TGRBL_4 8 H'FE9B TPU_4 16 2 Timer control register_5 TCR_5 8 H'FEA0 TPU_5 16 2 Timer mode register_5 TMDR_5 8 H'FEA1 TPU_5 16 2 Timer I/O control register_5 TIOR_5 8 H'FEA2 TPU_5 16 2 Timer interrupt enable register_5 TIER_5 8 H'FEA4 TPU_5 16 2 Timer status register_5 TSR_5 8 H'FEA5 TPU_5 16 2 Timer counter H_5 TCNTH_5 8 H'FEA6 TPU_5 16 2 Timer counter L_5 TCNTL_5 8 H'FEA7 TPU_5 16 2 Timer general register AH_5 TGRAH_5 8 H'FEA8 TPU_5 16 2 Timer general register AL_5 TGRAL_5 8 H'FEA9 TPU_5 16 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 483 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State Timer general register BH_5 TGRBH_5 8 H'FEAA TPU_5 16 2 Timer general register BL_5 TGRBL_5 8 H'FEAB TPU_5 16 2 Timer start register TSTR 8 H'FEB0 TPU 16 common 2 Timer synchro register TSYR 8 H'FEB1 TPU 16 common 2 Interrupt priority register A IPRA 8 H'FEC0 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register B IPRB 8 H'FEC1 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register C IPRC 8 H'FEC2 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register D IPRD 8 H'FEC3 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register E IPRE 8 H'FEC4 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register F IPRF 8 H'FEC5 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register G IPRG 8 H'FEC6 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register H IPRH 8 H'FEC7 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register J IPRJ 8 H'FEC9 INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register K IPRK 8 H'FECA INT 8 2 Interrupt priority register M IPRM 8 H'FECC INT 8 2 RAM emulation register RAMER 8 H'FEDB ROM 8 2 Port 1 data register P1DR 8 H'FF00 PORT 8 2 Port 3 data register P3DR 8 H'FF02 PORT 8 2 Port 7 data register P7DR 8 H'FF06 PORT 8 2 Port A data register PADR 8 H'FF09 PORT 8 2 Port B data register PBDR 8 H'FF0A PORT 8 2 Port C data register PCDR 8 H'FF0B PORT 8 2 Port D data register PDDR 8 H'FF0C PORT 8 2 Port F data register PFDR 8 H'FF0E PORT 8 2 Timer control register_0 TCR_0 8 H'FF10 TPU_0 16 2 Timer mode register_0 TMDR_0 8 H'FF11 TPU_0 16 2 Timer I/O control register H_0 TIORH_0 8 H'FF12 TPU_0 16 2 Timer I/O control register L_0 TIORL_0 8 H'FF13 TPU_0 16 2 Timer interrupt enable register_0 TIER_0 8 H'FF14 TPU_0 16 2 Timer status register_0 TSR_0 8 H'FF15 TPU_0 16 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 484 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State Timer counter H_0 TCNTH_0 8 H'FF16 TPU_0 16 2 Timer counter L_0 TCNTL_0 8 H'FF17 TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register AH_0 TGRAH_0 8 H'FF18 TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register AL_0 TGRAL_0 8 H'FF19 TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register BH_0 TGRBH_0 8 H'FF1A TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register BL_0 TGRBL_0 8 H'FF1B TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register CH_0 TGRCH_0 8 H'FF1C TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register CL_0 TGRCL_0 8 H'FF1D TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register DH_0 TGRDH_0 8 H'FF1E TPU_0 16 2 Timer general register DL_0 TGRDL_0 8 H'FF1F TPU_0 16 2 Timer control register_1 TCR_1 8 H'FF20 TPU_1 16 2 Timer mode register_1 TMDR_1 8 H'FF21 TPU_1 16 2 Timer I/O control register_1 TIOR_1 8 H'FF22 TPU_1 16 2 Timer interrupt enable register_1 TIER_1 8 H'FF24 TPU_1 16 2 Timer status register_1 TSR_1 8 H'FF25 TPU_1 16 2 Timer counter H_1 TCNTH_1 8 H'FF26 TPU_1 16 2 Timer counter L_1 TCNTL_1 8 H'FF27 TPU_1 16 2 Timer general register AH_1 TGRAH_1 8 H'FF28 TPU_1 16 2 Timer general register AL_1 TGRAL_1 8 H'FF29 TPU_1 16 2 Timer general register BH_1 TGRBH_1 8 H'FF2A TPU_1 16 2 Timer general register BL_1 TGRBL_1 8 H'FF2B TPU_1 16 2 Timer control register_2 TCR_2 8 H'FF30 TPU_2 16 2 Timer mode register_2 TMDR_2 8 H'FF31 TPU_2 16 2 Timer I/O control register_2 TIOR_2 8 H'FF32 TPU_2 16 2 Timer interrupt enable register_2 TIER_2 8 H'FF34 TPU_2 16 2 Timer status register_2 TSR_2 8 H'FF35 TPU_2 16 2 Timer counterH_2 TCNTH_2 8 H'FF36 TPU_2 16 2 Timer counter L_2 TCNTL_2 8 H'FF37 TPU_2 16 2 Timer general register AH_2 TGRAH_2 8 H'FF38 TPU_2 16 2 Timer general register AL_2 TGRAL_2 8 H'FF39 TPU_2 16 2 Timer general register BH_2 TGRBH_2 8 H'FF3A TPU_2 16 2 Timer general register BL_2 TGRBL_2 8 H'FF3B TPU_2 16 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 485 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State Timer control register_0 TCR_0 8 H'FF68 TMR_0 8 2 Timer control register_1 TCR_1 8 H'FF69 TMR_1 8 2 Timer control/status register_0 TCSR_0 8 H'FF6A TMR_0 8 2 Timer control/status register_1 TCSR_1 8 H'FF6B TMR_1 8 2 Time constant register A_0 TCORA_0 8 H'FF6C TMR_0 8 2 Time constant register A_1 TCORA_1 8 H'FF6D TMR_1 8 2 Time constant register B_0 TCORB_0 8 H'FF6E TMR_0 8 2 Time constant register B_1 TCORB_1 8 H'FF6F TMR_1 8 2 Timer counter_0 TCNT_0 8 H'FF70 TMR_0 8 2 Timer counter_1 TCNT_1 8 H'FF71 TMR_1 8 2 Timer control/status register_0 TCSR_0 8 H'FF74 WDT_0 16 2 Timer counter_0 TCNT_0 8 H'FF75 WDT_0 16 2 Reset control/status register RSTCSR 8 H'FF77 WDT 16 2 Serial mode register_0 SMR_0 8 H'FF78 SCI_0 8 2 Bit rate register_0 BRR_0 8 H'FF79 SCI_0 8 2 Serial control register_0 SCR_0 8 H'FF7A SCI_0 8 2 Transmit data register_0 TDR_0 8 H'FF7B SCI_0 8 2 Serial status register_0 SSR_0 8 H'FF7C SCI_0 8 2 Receive data register_0 RDR_0 8 H'FF7D SCI_0 8 2 Smart card mode register_0 SCMR_0 8 H'FF7E SCI_0 8 2 Serial mode register_2 SMR_2 8 H'FF88 SCI_2 8 2 Bit rate register_2 BRR_2 8 H'FF89 SCI_2 8 2 Serial control register_2 SCR_2 8 H'FF8A SCI_2 8 2 Transmit data register_2 TDR_2 8 H'FF8B SCI_2 8 2 Serial status register_2 SSR_2 8 H'FF8C SCI_2 8 2 Receive data register_2 RDR_2 8 H'FF8D SCI_2 8 2 Smart card mode register_2 SCMR_2 8 H'FF8E SCI_2 8 2 A/D data register AH ADDRAH 8 H'FF90 A/D 8 2 A/D data register AL ADDRAL 8 H'FF91 A/D 8 2 A/D data register BH ADDRBH 8 H'FF92 A/D 8 2 A/D data register BL ADDRBL 8 H'FF93 A/D 8 2 A/D data register CH ADDRCH 8 H'FF94 A/D 8 2 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 486 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Name Number Abbreviation of Bits Address* Module Data Access Width State A/D data register CL ADDRCL 8 H'FF95 A/D 8 2 A/D data register DH ADDRDH 8 H'FF96 A/D 8 2 A/D data register DL ADDRDL 8 H'FF97 A/D 8 2 A/D control/status register ADCSR 8 H'FF98 A/D 8 2 A/D control register ADCR 8 H'FF99 A/D 8 2 Flash memory control register 1 FLMCR1 8 H'FFA8 ROM 8 2 Flash memory control register 2 FLMCR2 8 H'FFA9 ROM 8 2 Erase block register 1 EBR1 8 H'FFAA ROM 8 2 Erase block register 2 EBR2 8 H'FFAB ROM 8 2 Port 1 register PORT1 8 H'FFB0 PORT 8 2 Port 3 register PORT3 8 H'FFB2 PORT 8 2 Port 4 register PORT4 8 H'FFB3 PORT 8 2 Port 7 register PORT7 8 H'FFB6 PORT 8 2 Port 9 register PORT9 8 H'FFB8 PORT 8 2 Port A register PORTA 8 H'FFB9 PORT 8 2 Port B register PORTB 8 H'FFBA PORT 8 2 Port C register PORTC 8 H'FFBB PORT 8 2 Port D register PORTD 8 H'FFBC PORT 8 2 Port F register PORTF 8 H'FFBE PORT 8 2 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 487 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers 21.2 Register Bits The bit names of the registers in the on-chip peripheral modules are listed below. The 16-bit register is indicated in two rows, 8 bits for each row. Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module SSU_0 SSCRH _0 MSS BIDE SOL SOLP SCKS CSS1 CSS0 SSCRL _0 SRES DATS1 DATS0 SSMR _0 MLS CPOS CPHS CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 SSER _0 TE RE TEIE TIE RIE CEIE SSSR _0 ORER TEND TDRE RDRF CE SSTDR0 _0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR1 _0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR2 _0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR3 _0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR0 Bit 7 _0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR1 Bit 7 _0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR2 Bit 7 _0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR3 Bit 7 _0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 488 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module SSU_1 SSCRH _1 MSS BIDE SOL SOLP SCKS CSS1 CSS0 SSCRL _1 SRES DATS1 DATS0 SSMR_1 MLS CPOS CPHS CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 SSER_1 TE RE TEIE TIE RIE CEIE SSSR_1 ORER TEND TDRE RDRF CE SSTDR0 _1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR1 _1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR2 _1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSTDR3 _1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR0 Bit 7 _1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR1 Bit 7 _1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR2 Bit 7 _1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSRDR3 Bit 7 _1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 PDRTIDR Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 PORT TCR_2 CMIEB CMIEA OVIE CCLR1 CCLR0 CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 TCR_3 CMIEB CMIEA OVIE CCLR1 CCLR0 CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 TMR_2, TMR_3 TCSR_2 CMFB CMFA OVF ADTE OS3 OS2 OS1 OS0 TCSR_3 CMFB CMFA OVF OS3 OS2 OS1 OS0 TCORA _2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCORA _3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 489 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module TMR_2, TMR_3 TCORB _2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCORB _3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCNT_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCNT_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SBYCR SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 SYSCR MACS INTM1 INTM0 NMIEG RAME SCKCR PSTOP STCS SCK2 SCK1 SCK0 MDCR MDS2 MDS1 MDS0 MSTP CRA MSTPA7 MSTPA6 MSTPA5 MSTPA4 MSTPA3 MSTPA2 MSTPA1 MSTPA0 MSTP CRB MSTPB7 MSTPB6 MSTPB5 MSTPB4 MSTPB3 MSTPB2 MSTPB1 MSTPB0 MSTP CRC MSTPC7 MSTPC6 MSTPC5 MSTPC4 MSTPC3 MSTPC2 MSTPC1 MSTPC0 LPWR CR STC1 STC0 BARA BAA23 BAA22 BAA21 BAA20 BAA19 BAA18 BAA17 BAA16 BAA15 BAA14 BAA13 BAA12 BAA11 BAA10 BAA9 BAA8 BAA7 BAA6 BAA5 BAA4 BAA3 BAA2 BAA1 BAA0 BAB23 BAB22 BAB21 BAB20 BAB19 BAB18 BAB17 BAB16 BAB15 BAB14 BAB13 BAB12 BAB11 BAB10 BAB9 BAB8 BAB7 BAB6 BAB5 BAB4 BAB3 BAB2 BAB1 BAB0 BCRA CMFA CDA BAMRA2 BAMRA1 BAMRA0 CSELA1 CSELA0 BIEA BCRB CMFB CDB BAMRB2 BAMRB1 BAMRB0 CSELB1 CSELB0 BIEB ISCRH IRQ5SCB IRQ5SCA IRQ4SCB IRQ4SCA ISCRL IRQ3SCB IRQ3SCA IRQ2SCB IRQ2SCA IRQ1SCB IRQ1SCA IRQ0SCB IRQ0SCA IER IRQ5E IRQ4E IRQ3E IRQ2E IRQ1E IRQ0E ISR IRQ5F IRQ4F IRQ3F IRQ2F IRQ1F IRQ0F BARB Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 490 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 SYSTEM PBC INT Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module DTCERA DTCEA7 DTCEA6 DTCEA5 DTCEA4 DTCEA3 DTCEA2 DTCEA1 DTCEA0 DTC DTCERB DTCEB7 DTCEB6 DTCEB5 DTCEB4 DTCEB3 DTCEB2 DTCEB1 DTCEB0 DTCERC DTCEC7 DTCEC6 DTCEC5 DTCEC4 DTCEC3 DTCEC2 DTCEC1 DTCEC0 DTCERD DTCED7 DTCED6 DTCED5 DTCED4 DTCED3 DTCED2 DTCED1 DTCED0 DTCERE DTCEE7 DTCEE6 DTCEE5 DTCEE4 DTCEE3 DTCEE2 DTCEE1 DTCEE0 DTCERF DTCEF7 DTCEF6 DTCEF5 DTCEF4 DTCEF3 DTCEF2 DTCEF1 DTCEF0 DTCERG DTCEG7 DTCEG6 DTCEG5 DTCEG4 DTCEG3 DTCEG2 DTCEG1 DTCEG0 DTVECR SWDTE DTVEC6 DTVEC5 DTVEC4 DTVEC3 DTVEC2 DTVEC1 DTVEC0 PCR G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0 PPG PMR G3INV G2INV G3NOV G2NOV NDERH NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9 NDER8 NDERL NDER7 NDER6 NDER5 NDER4 NDER3 NDER2 NDER1 NDER0 PODRH POD15 POD14 POD13 POD12 POD11 POD10 POD9 POD8 PODRL POD7 POD6 POD5 POD4 POD3 POD2 POD1 POD0 NDRH NDR15 NDR14 NDR13 NDR12 NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 NDRL NDR7 NDR6 NDR5 NDR4 NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 NDRH NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 NDRL NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 P1DDR P17DDR P16DDR P15DDR P14DDR P13DDR P12DDR P11DDR P10DDR P3DDR P37DDR P36DDR P35DDR P34DDR P33DDR P32DDR P31DDR P30DDR P7DDR P77DDR P76DDR P75DDR P74DDR P73DDR P72DDR P71DDR P70DDR PADDR PA3DDR PA2DDR PA1DDR PA0DDR PBDDR PB7DDR PB6DDR PB5DDR PB4DDR PB3DDR PB2DDR PB1DDR PB0DDR PCDDR PC7DDR PC6DDR PC5DDR PC4DDR PC3DDR PC2DDR PC1DDR PC0DDR PDDDR PD7DDR PD6DDR PD5DDR PD4DDR PD3DDR PD2DDR PD1DDR PD0DDR PFDDR PF7DDR PF6DDR PF5DDR PF4DDR PF3DDR PF2DDR PF1DDR PF0DDR PAPCR PBPCR PB7PCR PB6PCR PB5PCR PB4PCR PB3PCR PB2PCR PB1PCR PB0PCR PCPCR PC7PCR PC6PCR PC5PCR PC4PCR PC3PCR PC2PCR PC1PCR PC0PCR PDPCR PD7PCR PD6PCR PD5PCR PD4PCR PD3PCR PD2PCR PD1PCR PD0PCR PORT PA3PCR PA2PCR PA1PCR PA0PCR Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 491 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module P3ODR P37ODR P36ODR P35ODR P34ODR P33ODR P32ODR P31ODR P30ODR PORT PAODR PBODR PB7ODR PB6ODR PB5ODR PB4ODR PB3ODR PB2ODR PB1ODR PB0ODR PCODR PC7ODR PC6ODR PC5ODR PC4ODR PC3ODR PC2ODR PC1ODR PC0ODR TCR_3 CCLR2 PA3ODR PA2ODR PA1ODR PA0ODR CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TMDR_3 BFB BFA MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIORH_3 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIORL_3 IOD3 IOD2 IOD1 IOD0 IOC3 IOC2 IOC1 IOC0 TIER_3 TTGE TCIEV TGIED TGIEC TGIEB TGIEA TSR_3 TCFV TGFD TGFC TGFB TGFA TCNTH_3 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_3 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_3 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRCH_3 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRCL_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRDH_3 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRDL_3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCR_4 CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TMDR_4 MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIOR_4 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIER_4 TTGE TCIEU TCIEV TGIEB TGIEA TSR_4 TCFD TCFU TCFV TGFB TGFA TCNTH_4 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_4 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_4 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_4 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_4 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_4 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 492 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TPU_3 TPU_4 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TPU_5 TMDR_5 MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIOR_5 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIER_5 TTGE TCIEU TCIEV TGIEB TGIEA TSR_5 TCFD TCR_5 TCFU TCFV TGFB TGFA TCNTH_5 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_5 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_5 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_5 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_5 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_5 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 CST5 CST4 CST3 CST2 CST1 CST0 TSTR TSYR SYNC5 SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0 IPRA IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRB IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRC IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRD IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRE IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRF IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRG IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRH IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRJ IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRK IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 IPRM IPR6 IPR5 IPR4 IPR2 IPR1 IPR0 RAMER RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 FLASH (F-ZTAT Version) P1DR P17DR P16DR P15DR P14DR P13DR P12DR P11DR P10DR PORT P3DR P37DR P36DR P35DR P34DR P33DR P32DR P31DR P30DR P7DR P77DR P76DR P75DR P74DR P73DR P72DR P71DR P70DR PADR PA3DR PA2DR PA1DR PA0DR TPU common INT Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 493 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module PBDR PB7DR PB6DR PB5DR PB4DR PB3DR PB2DR PB1DR PB0DR PORT PCDR PC7DR PC6DR PC5DR PC4DR PC3DR PC2DR PC1DR PC0DR PDDR PD7DR PD6DR PD5DR PD4DR PD3DR PD2DR PD1DR PD0DR PFDR PF7DR PF6DR PF5DR PF4DR PF3DR PF2DR PF1DR PF0DR TCR_0 CCLR2 CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TMDR_0 BFB BFA MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIORH_0 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIORL_0 IOD3 IOD2 IOD1 IOD0 IOC3 IOC2 IOC1 IOC0 TIER_0 TTGE TCIEV TGIED TGIEC TGIEB TGIEA TSR_0 TCFV TGFD TGFC TGFB TGFA TCNTH_0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRCH_0 Bit 15 TGRCL_0 Bit 7 TGRDH_0 Bit 15 TGRDL_0 Bit 7 TCR_1 CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TMDR_1 MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIOR_1 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIER_1 TTGE TCIEU TCIEV TGIEB TGIEA TSR_1 TCFD TCFU TCFV TGFB TGFA TCNTH_1 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_1 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_1 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 494 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TPU_0 TPU_1 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 TPU_2 TMDR_2 MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 TIOR_2 IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 TIER_2 TTGE TCIEU TCIEV TGIEB TGIEA TSR_2 TCFD TCR_2 TCFU TCFV TGFB TGFA TCNTH_2 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TCNTL_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRAH_2 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRAL_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TGRBH_2 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 TGRBL_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCR_0 CMIEA OVIE CCLR1 CCLR0 CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 CMIEB TCR_1 CMIEB CMIEA OVIE CCLR1 CCLR0 CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 TCSR_0 CMFB CMFA OVF ADTE OS3 OS2 OS1 OS0 TCSR_1 CMFB CMFA OVF OS3 OS2 OS1 OS0 TCORA_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCORA_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCORB_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCORB_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCNT_0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 TCNT_1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TCSR_0 OVF WT/IT TME CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 TCNT_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RSTCSR WOVF RSTE RSTS SMR_0* 1 CHR PE O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 (SMR_0*2) (GM) (BLK) (PE) (O/E) (BCP1) (BCP0) (CKS1) (CKS0) BRR_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SCR_0 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TDRE RDRF ORER FER PER TEND MPB MPBT TDR_0 SSR_0* 1 C/A TMR_0, TMR_1 WDT_0 SCI_0 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 495 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module (SSR_0* ) (TDRE) (RDRF) (ORER) (ERS) (PER) (TEND) (MPB) (MPBT) SCI_0 RDR_0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SCMR_0 SDIR SINV SMIF 1 SMR_2* C/A CHR PE O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 2 (SMR_2*2) (GM) (BLK) (PE) (O/E) (BCP1) (BCP0) (CKS1) (CKS0) BRR_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SCR_2 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SSR_2* TDRE RDRF ORER FER PER TEND MPB MPBT (SSR_2*2) (TDRE) (RDRF) (ORER) (ERS) (PER) (TEND) (MPB) (MPBT) RDR_2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 SDIR SINV SMIF ADDRAH AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 ADDRAL AD1 AD0 ADDRBH AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 ADDRBL AD1 AD0 ADDRCH AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 ADDRCL AD1 AD0 ADDRDH AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 ADDRDL AD1 AD0 TDR_2 1 SCMR_2 ADCSR ADF ADIE ADST SCAN CH3 CH2 CH1 CH0 ADCR TRGS1 TRGS0 CKS1 CKS0 FLMCR1 FWE SWE ESU1 PSU1 EV1 PV1 E1 P1 FLMCR2 FLER EBR1 EB7 EB6 EB5 EB4 EB3 EB2 EB1 EB0 EBR2 EB9 EB8 PORT1 P17 P16 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 PORT3 P37 P36 P35 P34 P33 P32 P31 P30 PORT4 P47 P46 P45 P44 P43 P42 P41 P40 PORT7 P77 P76 P75 P74 P73 P72 P71 P70 PORT9 P97 P96 P95 P94 P93 P92 P91 P90 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 496 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 SCI_2 A/D FLASH (F-ZTAT Version) PORT Section 21 List of Registers Abbreviation Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module PORT PORTA PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0 PORTB PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PB2 PB1 PB0 PORTC PC7 PC6 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 PORTD PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 PORTF PF7 PF6 PF5 PF4 PF3 PF2 PF1 PF0 Notes: 1. Normal serial communication interface mode. 2. Smart Card interface mode. Some bit functions of SMR differ in normal serial communication interface mode and Smart Card interface mode. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 497 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers 21.3 Register States in Each Operating Mode Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module SSCRH_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSCRL_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSMR_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSER_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSSR_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR0_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR1_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR2_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR3_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR0_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR1_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR2_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR3_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSCRH_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSCRL_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSMR_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSER_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSSR_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR0_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR1_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR2_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSTDR3_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR0_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR1_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR2_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSRDR3_1 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized PDRTIDR Initialized Initialized Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 498 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 SSU_0 SSU_1 SSU_1 PORT Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module TCR_2 Initialized Initialized TCR_3 Initialized Initialized TCSR_2 Initialized Initialized TCSR_3 Initialized Initialized TCORA_2 Initialized Initialized TCORA_3 Initialized Initialized TCORB_2 Initialized Initialized TCORB_3 Initialized Initialized TCNT_2 Initialized Initialized TCNT_3 Initialized Initialized SBYCR Initialized SYSCR Initialized SCKCR Initialized MDCR Initialized MSTPCRA Initialized MSTPCRB Initialized MSTPCRC Initialized LPWRCR Initialized BARA Initialized Initialized BARB Initialized Initialized BCRA Initialized Initialized BCRB Initialized Initialized ISCRH Initialized Initialized ISCRL Initialized Initialized IER Initialized Initialized ISR Initialized Initialized TMR_2, TMR_3 SYSTEM PBC INT Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 499 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module DTCERA Initialized Initialized DTCERB Initialized Initialized DTCERC Initialized Initialized DTCERD Initialized Initialized DTCERE Initialized Initialized DTCERF Initialized Initialized DTCERG Initialized Initialized DTVECR Initialized Initialized PCR Initialized Initialized PMR Initialized Initialized NDERH Initialized Initialized NDERL Initialized Initialized PODRH Initialized Initialized PODRL Initialized Initialized NDRH Initialized Initialized NDRL Initialized Initialized NDRH Initialized Initialized NDRL Initialized Initialized P1DDR Initialized P3DDR Initialized P7DDR Initialized PADDR Initialized PBDDR Initialized PCDDR Initialized PDDDR Initialized PFDDR Initialized PAPCR Initialized PBPCR Initialized PCPCR Initialized PDPCR Initialized Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 500 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 DTC PPG PORT Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module P3ODR Initialized PAODR Initialized PBODR Initialized PCODR Initialized TCR_3 Initialized Initialized TMDR_3 Initialized Initialized TIORH_3 Initialized Initialized TIORL_3 Initialized Initialized TIER_3 Initialized Initialized TSR_3 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_3 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_3 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_3 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_3 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_3 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_3 Initialized Initialized TGRCH_3 Initialized Initialized TGRCL_3 Initialized Initialized TGRDH_3 Initialized Initialized TGRDL_3 Initialized Initialized TCR_4 Initialized Initialized TMDR_4 Initialized Initialized TIOR_4 Initialized Initialized TIER_4 Initialized Initialized TSR_4 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_4 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_4 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_4 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_4 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_3 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_4 Initialized Initialized PORT TPU_3 TPU_4 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 501 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module TCR_5 Initialized Initialized TMDR_5 Initialized Initialized TIOR_5 Initialized Initialized TIER_5 Initialized Initialized TSR_5 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_5 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_5 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_5 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_5 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_5 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_5 Initialized Initialized TSTR Initialized Initialized TSYR Initialized Initialized IPRA Initialized Initialized IPRB Initialized Initialized IPRC Initialized Initialized IPRD Initialized Initialized IPRE Initialized Initialized IPRF Initialized Initialized IPRG Initialized Initialized IPRH Initialized Initialized IPRJ Initialized Initialized IPRK Initialized Initialized IPRM Initialized Initialized RAMER Initialized Initialized ROM P1DR Initialized PORT P3DR Initialized P7DR Initialized PADR Initialized PBDR Initialized Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 502 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TPU_5 TPU common INT Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module PCDR Initialized PDDR Initialized PFDR Initialized TCR_0 Initialized Initialized TMDR_0 Initialized Initialized TIORH_0 Initialized Initialized TIORL_0 Initialized Initialized TIER_0 Initialized Initialized TSR_0 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_0 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_0 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_0 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_0 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_0 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_0 Initialized Initialized TGRCH_0 Initialized Initialized TGRCL_0 Initialized Initialized TGRDH_0 Initialized Initialized TGRDL_0 Initialized Initialized TCR_1 Initialized Initialized TMDR_1 Initialized Initialized TIOR_1 Initialized Initialized TIER_1 Initialized Initialized TSR_1 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_1 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_1 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_1 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_1 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_1 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_1 Initialized Initialized PORT TPU_0 TPU_1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 503 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module TCR_2 Initialized Initialized TMDR_2 Initialized Initialized TIOR_2 Initialized Initialized TIER_2 Initialized Initialized TSR_2 Initialized Initialized TCNTH_2 Initialized Initialized TCNTL_2 Initialized Initialized TGRAH_2 Initialized Initialized TGRAL_2 Initialized Initialized TGRBH_2 Initialized Initialized TGRBL_2 Initialized Initialized TCR_0 Initialized Initialized TCR_1 Initialized Initialized TCSR_0 Initialized Initialized TCSR_1 Initialized Initialized TCORA_0 Initialized Initialized TCORA_1 Initialized Initialized TCORB_0 Initialized Initialized TCORB_1 Initialized Initialized TCNT_0 Initialized Initialized TCNT_1 Initialized Initialized TCSR_0 Initialized Initialized TCNT_0 Initialized Initialized RSTCSR Initialized Initialized SMR_0 Initialized Initialized BRR_0 Initialized Initialized SCR_0 Initialized Initialized TDR_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSR_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized RDR_0 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SCMR_0 Initialized Initialized Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 504 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TPU_2 TMR_0, TMR_1 WDT_0 SCI_0 Section 21 List of Registers Register Abbreviation Reset High Speed Medium Speed Sleep Module Stop Software Standby Hardware Standby Module SMR_2 Initialized Initialized BRR_2 Initialized Initialized SCR_2 Initialized Initialized TDR_2 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SSR_2 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized RDR_2 Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized SCMR_2 Initialized Initialized ADDRAH Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRAL Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRBH Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRBL Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRCH Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRCL Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRDH Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADDRDL Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADCSR Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized ADCR Initialized Initialized Initialized Initialized FLMCR1 Initialized Initialized FLMCR2 Initialized Initialized EBR1 Initialized Initialized EBR2 Initialized Initialized PORT1 Initialized PORT3 Initialized PORT4 Initialized PORT7 Initialized PORT9 Initialized PORTA Initialized PORTB Initialized PORTC Initialized PORTD Initialized PORTF Initialized SCI_2 A/D ROM PORT Note: is not initialized. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 505 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 21 List of Registers Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 506 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 22.1 lists the absolute maximum ratings. Table 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Item Symbol Value Power supply voltage VCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Input voltage (XTAL, EXTAL) Vin –0.3 to VCC +0.3 V Input voltage (ports 4 and 9) Vin –0.3 to AVCC +0.3 V Input voltage (except XTAL, EXTAL, ports 4 and 9) Vin –0.3 to VCC +0.3 V Analog power supply voltage AVCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Analog input voltage VAN –0.3 to AVCC +0.3 V Operating temperature Topr Storage temperature Tstg Unit Regular specifications: –20 to +75 °C Wide-range specifications: –40 to +85 °C –55 to +125 °C Caution: Permanent damage to the chip may result if absolute maximum rating are exceeded. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 507 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2 DC Characteristics Table 22.2 lists the DC characteristics. Table 22.3 lists the permissible output currents. Table 22.2 DC Characteristics Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)*1 Item Test Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VCC × 0.2 V VCC × 0.7 V VCC × 0.05 V RES, STBY, VIH NMI, MD2 to MD0, FWE VCC × 0.9 VCC + 0.3 V EXTAL VCC × 0.7 VCC + 0.3 V Ports 7, 3, 1, A to D, F VCC × 0.7 VCC + 0.3 V Ports 9, 4 AVCC × 0.7 RES, STBY, VIL NMI, MD2 to MD0, FWE –0.3 VCC × 0.1 V EXTAL –0.3 VCC × 0.2 V Ports 7, 3, 1, A to D, F –0.3 VCC × 0.2 V Ports 9, 4 –0.3 AVCC × 0.2 V Output high voltage All output pins VOH VCC – 0.5 V VCC – 1.0 V IOH = –1 mA Output low voltage All output pins VOL 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA Schmitt trigger input voltage Symbol IRQ5 to IRQ0 VT – VT + + VT – VT Input high voltage Input low voltage Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 508 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 – AVCC + 0.3 V IOH = –200 µA Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Symbol Typ Max Unit 1.0 µA 1.0 µA 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V –IP 30 300 µA Vin = 0 V Cin Input leakage RES | Iin | current STBY, NMI, MD2 to MD0, FWE Ports 9, 4 Input pull-up Ports A to D MOS current Input capacitance Supply current*2 RES Test Conditions Min Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V 30 pF Vin = 0 V NMI 30 pF f = 1 MHz All input pins except RES and NMI 15 pF Ta = 25°C 80 90 mA VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.5 V f = 20MHz Sleep mode 60 70 mA VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.5 V f = 20MHz All modules stopped 55 mA f = 20 MHz, VCC = 5.0 V (reference values) Mediumspeed mode (φ/32) 65 mA f = 20 MHz, VCC = 5.0 V (reference values) Standby mode 2.0 5.0 µA Ta ≤ 50°C 200 µA 50°C < Ta 1.0 2.0 mA AVCC = 5.0 V Normal operation ICC*3 Analog During A/D power supply conversion current Idle AlCC 5.0 µA Reference During A/D power supply conversion current Idle AlCC 1.0 2.0 mA 5.0 µA RAM standby voltage VRAM 2.0 V Vref = 5.0 V Notes: 1. If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, Vref, and AVSS pins open. Apply a voltage between 4.5 V and 5.5 V to the AVCC pin by connecting them to VCC, for instance. Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 509 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 2. Supply current values are for VIH = VCC (EXTAL), AVCC (ports 4 and 9), or VCC (other), and VIL = 0 V, with all output pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up MOS transistors in the off state. 3. ICC depends on VCC and f as follows: ICC (max) = 27 + 0.435 × VCC × f (normal operation) ICC (max) = 27 + 0.3 × VCC × f (sleep mode) Table 22.3 Permissible Output Currents Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)* Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Permissible output low current (per pin) All output pins VCC = 4.5 to 5.5 V IOL 10 mA Permissible output low current (total) Total of all output pins VCC = 4.5 to 5.5 V ∑ IOL 100 mA Permissible output All output high current (per pin) pins VCC = 4.5 to 5.5 V –IOH 2.0 mA Permissible output high current (total) VCC = 4.5 to 5.5 V ∑ –IOH 30 mA Total of all output pins Note: * To protect chip reliability, do not exceed the output current values in table 22.3. 22.3 AC Characteristics Figure 22.1 shows the test conditions for the AC characteristics. 5V RL LSI output pin C RH C=30 pF RL= 2.4 kΩ RH=12 kΩ Input/output timing measurement levels • Low level : 0.8 V • High level : 2.0 V Figure 22.1 Output Load Circuit Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 510 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.1 Clock Timing Table 22.4 lists the clock timing Table 22.4 Clock Timing Conditions : VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 4 MHz to 20 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions Clock cycle time tcyc 50 250 ns Figure 22.2 Clock high pulse width tCH 12 ns Clock low pulse width tCL 12 ns Clock rise time tCr 13 ns Clock fall time tCf 13 ns Oscillation settling time at reset (crystal) tOSC1 20 ms Figure 22.3 Oscillation settling time in software standby (crystal) tOSC2 8 ms Figure 20.3 External clock output settling delay time tDEXT 2 ms Figure 22.3 tcyc tCH tCf φ tCL tCr Figure 22.2 System Clock Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 511 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics EXTAL tDEXT tDEXT VCC STBY tOSC1 tOSC1 RES φ Figure 22.3 Oscillation Settling Timing 22.3.2 Control Signal Timing Table 22.5 lists the control signal timing. Table 22.5 Control Signal Timing Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 4 MHz to 20 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions RES setup time tRESS 200 ns Figure 22.4 RES pulse width tRESW 20 tcyc NMI setup time tNMIS 150 ns NMI hold time tNMIH 10 ns NMI pulse width (exiting software standby mode) tNMIW 200 ns IRQ setup time tIRQS 150 ns IRQ hold time tIRQH 10 ns IRQ pulse width (exiting software standby mode) tIRQW 200 ns Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 512 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Figure 22.5 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics φ tRESS tRESS RES tRESW Figure 22.4 Reset Input Timing φ tNMIS tNMIH NMI tNMIW IRQi (i = 5 to 0) tIRQW tIRQS tIRQH IRQ Edge input tIRQS IRQ Level input Figure 22.5 Interrupt Input Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 513 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.3 Timing of On-Chip Peripheral Modules Table 22.6 lists the timing of on-chip peripheral modules. Table 22.6 Timing of On-Chip Peripheral Modules Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0, φ = 4 MHz to 20 Hz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions Output data delay time tPWD 50 ns Figure 22.6 Input data setup time tPRS 30 Input data hold time tPRH 30 Realtime input port data hold time tRTIPH 4 tcyc Figure 22.7 Timer output delay time tTOCD 50 ns Figure 22.8 Timer input setup time tTICS 30 Timer clock input setup time tTCKS 30 ns Figure 22.9 Timer clock pulse width Single edge tTCKWH 1.5 tcyc Both edges tTCKWL 2.5 Input clock cycle Asynchronous tScyc 4 6 Item I/O port TPU SCI Synchronous tcyc Input clock pulse width tSCKW 0.4 0.6 tScyc Input clock rise time tSCKr 1.5 tcyc Input clock fall time tSCKf 1.5 Transmit data delay time tTXD 40 Receive data setup time (synchronous) tRXS 50 Receive data hold time (synchronous) tRXH 50 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 514 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 ns Figure 22.10 Figure 22.11 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions A/D Trigger input setup time converter tTRGS 30 ns Figure 22.12 PPG Pulse output delay time tPOD 50 ns Figure 22.13 TMR Timer output delay time tTMOD 50 ns Figure 22.14 Timer reset input setup time tTMRS 30 ns Figure 22.16 Timer clock input setup time tTMCS 30 ns Figure 22.15 Timer clock pulse width Single edge tTMCWH 1.5 tCYC Both edges tTMCWL 2.5 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 515 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.7 Timing of SSU Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 , φ = 4 MHz to 20 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item SSU Clock cycle Master Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions tSUCYC 2 256 tCYC 4 256 30 Figure 22.17 Figure 22.18 Figure 22.19 Figure 22.20 80 30 80 Slave Clock high level pulse width Master Clock low level pulse width Master tHI Slave tLO Slave ns ns Clock rise time tRISE 20 ns Clock fall time tFALL 20 ns tSU 30 ns 30 10 10 1.5 1.5 Data input setup time Master Data input hold time Master SCS setup time Master Slave tH Slave tLEAD Slave SCS hold time Master tLAG Slave Data output delay time Master Data output hold time Master tOD Slave tOH Slave 1.5 1.5 40 40 30 30 1.5 1.5 ns tCYC tCYC ns ns Continuous Master transmit delay Slave time tTD Slave access time tSA 1 tCYC Slave out release time tREL 1 tCYC Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 516 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 tCYC Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T2 T1 φ tPRS tPRH Ports 9, 7, 4, 3, 1, A to D, F (read) tPWD Ports 7, 3, 1, A to D, F (write) Figure 22.6 I/O Port Input/Output Timing φ IRQ3 tRTIPH Port D input Figure 22.7 Realtime Input Port Data Input Timing φ tTOCD Output compare output* tTICS Input capture input* Note: * TIOCA5 to TIOCA0, TIOCB5 to TIOCB0, TIOCC3, TIOCC0, TIOCD3, TIOCD0 Figure 22.8 TPU Input/Output Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 517 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics φ tTCKS tTCKS TCLKA to TCLKD tTCKWL tTCKWH Figure 22.9 TPU Clock Input Timing tSCKW tSCKr tSCKf SCK2, SCK0 tScyc Figure 22.10 SCK Clock Input Timing SCK2, SCK0 tTXD TxD2, TxD0 (transmit data) tRXS tRXH RxD2, RxD0 (receive data) Figure 22.11 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clocked Synchronous Mode) φ tTRGS ADTRG Figure 22.12 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 518 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics φ tPOD PO15 to 8 Figure 22.13 PPG Output Timing φ tTMOD TMO3, TMO2 TMO1, TMO0 Figure 22.14 8-Bit Timer Output Timing φ tTMCS tTMCS TMCI23, TMCI01 tTMCWL tTMCWH Figure 22.15 8-Bit Timer Clock Input Timing Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 519 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics φ tTMRS TMRI23, TMRI01 Figure 22.16 8-Bit Timer Reset Input Timing SCS (output) tTD tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE SSCK (output) CPOS = 1 tLO tHI SSCK (output) CPOS = 0 tSUCYC tLO SSO (output) tOH tOD SSI (input) tSU tH Figure 22.17 SSU Timing (Master, CPHS = 1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 520 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 tLAG Section 22 Electrical Characteristics SCS (output) tTD tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE tLAG SSCK (output) CPOS = 1 tLO tHI SSCK (output) CPOS = 0 tSUCYC tLO SSO (output) tOD tOH SSI (input) tH tSU Figure 22.18 SSU Timing (Master, CPHS = 0) SCS (input) tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE tLAG tTD SSCK (input) CPOS = 1 tLO tHI SSCK (input) CPOS = 0 tSUCYC tLO SSO (input) tSU tH tREL SSI (output) tSA tOH tOD Figure 22.19 SSU Timing (Slave, CPHS = 1) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 521 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics SCS (input) tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE tLAG tTD SSCK (input) CPOS = 1 tLO tHI SSCK (input) CPOS = 0 tSUCYC tLO SSO (input) tSU tH tREL SSI (output) tSA tOH tOD Figure 22.20 SSU Timing (Slave, CPHS = 0) Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 522 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics Table 22.8 lists the A/D conversion characteristics. Table 22.8 A/D Conversion Characteristics Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0V, φ = 4 MHz to 20 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Min Typ Max Unit Resolution 10 10 10 bits Conversion time 10 200 µs Analog input capacitance 20 pF Permissible signal-source impedance 5 kΩ Nonlinearity error ±3.5 LSB Offset error ±3.5 LSB Full-scale error ±3.5 LSB Quantization ±0.5 LSB Absolute accuracy ±4.0 LSB Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 523 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.5 Flash Memory Characteristics Table 22.9 lists the flash memory characteristics. Table 22.9 Flash Memory Characteristics Conditions: VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, VSS = PLLVSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = 0 to +75°C (Programming/erasing operating temperature range) Item Symbol Min 1 2 4 Programming time* * * tP Erase time* * * tE 100 1200 ms/block Reprogramming count NWEC 100 Times 1 µs 1 3 5 Programming Max Unit 10 200 ms/ 128 bytes Test Condition Wait time after SWE bit setting* 1 Wait time after PSU1 bit setting* tsswe 1 tspsu 50 50 µs Wait time after P1 bit setting* * tsp30 28 30 32 µs Programming time wait tsp200 198 200 202 µs Programming time wait tsp10 8 10 12 µs Additionalprogramming time wait 1 1 4 tcp 5 5 µs 1 Wait time after PSU1 bit clear* tcpsu 5 5 µs Wait time after PV1 bit setting* tspv 4 4 µs tspvr 2 2 µs Wait time after P1 bit clear* 1 1 Wait time after H'FF dummy write* 1 Wait time after PV1 bit clear* 1 tcpv 2 2 µs Wait time after SWE bit clear* 1 4 Maximum programming count* * tcswe 100 100 µs N 1000 Times Wait time after SWE bit setting* 1 Wait time after ESU1 bit setting* tsswe 1 1 µs tsesu 100 100 µs Wait time after E1 bit setting* * 1 Wait time after E1 bit clear* tse 10 10 100 ms tce 10 10 µs Wait time after ESU1 bit clear* 1 Wait time after EV1 bit setting* tcesu 10 10 µs 1 Erase Typ 1 1 5 1 Wait time after H'FF dummy write* 1 Wait time after EV1 bit clear* Wait time after SWE bit clear* 1 5 Maximum erase count* * 1 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 524 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 1 tsev 20 20 µs tsevr 2 2 µs tcev 4 4 µs tcswe 100 100 µs N 12 120 Times Erase time wait Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Notes: 1. Make each time setting in accordance with the program/program-verify flowchart or erase/erase-verify flowchart. 2. Programming time per 128 bytes (shows the total period for which the P1 bit in the flash memory control register (FLMCR1) is set. It does not include the programming verification time.) 3. Block erase time (shows the total period for which the E1-bit FLMCR1 is set. It does not include the erase verification time.) 4. To specify the maximum programming time value (tp (max)) in the 128-bytes programming algorithm, set the max. value (1000) for the maximum programming count (n). The wait time after P1 bit setting should be changed as follows according to the value of the programming counter (n). Programming counter (n) = 1 to 6: tsp30 = 30 µs Programming counter (n) = 7 to 1000: tsp200 = 200 µs [In additional programming] Programming counter (n) = 1 to 6: tsp10 = 10 µs 5. For the maximum erase time (tE (max)), the following relationship applies between the wait time after E1 bit setting (tse) and the maximum erase count (N): tE (max) = Wait time after E1 bit setting (tse) × maximum erase count (N) To set the maximum erase time, the values of (tse) and (N) should be set so as to satisfy the above formula. Examples: When tse = 100 ms, N = 12 times When tse = 10 ms, N = 120 times Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 525 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 526 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Appendix Appendix A. I/O Port States in Each Pin State Port Name MCU Operating Mode Reset Hardware Standby Mode Software Standby Mode Program Execution State Sleep Mode Port 1 7 T T Keep I/O port Port 3 7 T T Keep I/O port Port 4 7 T T T Input port Port 7 7 T T Keep I/O port Port 9 7 T T T Input port Port A 7 T T Keep I/O port Port B 7 T T Keep I/O port Port C 7 T T Keep I/O port Port D 7 T T Keep I/O port PF7 7 T T [DDR = 0] [DDR = 0] T T [DDR = 1] [DDR = 1] H Clock output Keep I/O port PF6 7 T T PF5 PF4 PF3 PF2 PF1 PF0 [Legend] H: High level T: High impedance Keep: Input port becomes high-impedance, output port retains state Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 527 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Appendix B. Product Code Lineup Product Type H8S/2604 group Product Code F-ZTAT version HD64F2604 Mark Code HD64F2604FA20 (Normal spec) HD64F2604FA20W (Wide Temperature Range spec) HD64F2604FA20V (Normal spec) HD64F2604FA20WV (Wide Temperature Range spec) Masked ROM version HD6432604 HD6432604(***)FA (Normal spec) HD6432604(***)FAW (Wide Temperature Range spec) HD6432604(***)FAV (Normal spec) HD6432604(***)FAWV (Wide Temperature Range spec) HD6432603 HD6432603(***)FA (Normal spec) HD6432603(***)FAW (Wide Temperature Range spec) HD6432603(***)FAV (Normal spec) HD6432603(***)FAWV (Wide Temperature Range spec) [Legend] (***): ROM code Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 528 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Package (Renesas Package Code) 100-pin QFP PRQP0100KB-A (FP-100M/FP-100MV) Appendix C. Package Dimensions JEITA Package Code P-QFP100-14x14-0.50 RENESAS Code PRQP0100KB-A Previous Code FP-100M/FP-100MV MASS[Typ.] 1.2g NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS"*1"AND"*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH 2. DIMENSION"*3"DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. HD *1 D 75 51 76 50 bp Reference Symbol Nom Max 14 D c c1 HE Dimension in Millimeters Min E 14 A2 2.70 *2 E b1 ZE Terminal cross section 1 25 16.0 15.8 16.0 A1 0.00 bp 0.17 A1 θ L L1 Detail F *3 y bp x M θ 0.12 0.12 0.25 0.22 0.27 0.17 0° 8° 0.5 0.08 x 0.10 y ZD 1.0 ZE 1.0 L 0.22 0.15 e L1 16.2 0.20 c1 c A A2 c F 16.2 3.05 b1 ZD e 15.8 HE A 26 100 HD 0.4 0.5 0.6 1.0 Figure C.1 Dimensions Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 529 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Appendix Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 530 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Index Numerics C 16-bit count mode................................... 269 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) ................. 167 8-bit timers.............................................. 253 Cascaded connection............................... 269 Cascaded operation ................................. 217 Chain transfer.................................. 115, 121 Clock pulse generator ............................. 453 CMIA ...................................................... 270 CMIB ...................................................... 270 Compare-match count mode ................... 269 Condition field .......................................... 37 Condition-code register (CCR) ................. 22 Conversion time ...................................... 417 CPU operating modes ............................... 14 A A/D converter ......................................... 409 A/D converter activation......................... 235 A/D trigger input .................................... 164 Absolute address....................................... 40 Activation by software............................ 119 Address map ............................................. 51 Address space ........................................... 18 Addressing modes..................................... 38 ADI ......................................................... 419 Advanced mode ........................................ 15 Arithmetic operations instructions............ 30 Asynchronous mode ............................... 334 B Bcc...................................................... 27, 35 Bit manipulation instructions.................... 33 Bit rate .................................................... 327 Block data transfer instructions ................ 37 Block transfer mode................................ 113 Boot mode .............................................. 440 Branch instructions ................................... 35 Break....................................................... 375 Break address...................................... 87, 90 Break conditions ....................................... 90 Buffer operation...................................... 212 Bus arbitration .......................................... 98 Bus cycle .................................................. 95 Bus masters............................................... 98 D Data direction register............................. 125 Data register............................................ 125 Data transfer controller ............................. 99 Data transfer instructions .......................... 29 DTC vector table..................................... 107 E Effective address................................. 38, 42 Effective address extension....................... 37 Emulation................................................ 444 Erase/erase-verify ................................... 448 Erasing units ........................................... 434 Exception handling ................................... 53 Extended control register (EXR)............... 21 External trigger ....................................... 419 F Flash memory ......................................... 429 Framing error .......................................... 341 Free-running count operation.................. 206 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 531 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 G O General registers ....................................... 20 On-board programming .......................... 439 Open-drain control register ..................... 125 Operating mode selection ......................... 47 Operation field .......................................... 37 Output trigger.......................................... 284 Overrun error .......................................... 341 OVI ......................................................... 270 I Immediate ................................................. 41 Input capture........................................... 209 Input pull-up MOS ................................. 125 Instruction set ........................................... 27 Interrupt control modes ............................ 76 Interrupt controller.................................... 63 Interrupt exception handling vector table ............................................... 72 Interrupt mask bit ..................................... 22 Interrupt mask level .................................. 21 Interrupt priority register (IPR) ................ 63 Interrupts .................................................. 59 Interval timer mode ................................ 304 L Logic operations instructions.................... 32 M MAC instruction....................................... 49 Mark state ............................................... 375 Memory cycle........................................... 95 Memory indirect ....................................... 41 Multiply-accumulate register (MAC) ....... 23 P Parity error .............................................. 341 PC break controller ................................... 87 Periodic count operation ......................... 206 Phase counting mode .............................. 225 Pin assignment ............................................ 3 PLL circuit .............................................. 459 Port register............................................. 125 Program counter (PC) ............................... 21 Program/erase protection ........................ 450 Program/program-verify ......................... 446 Program-counter relative .......................... 41 Programmable pulse generator ............... 277 Programmer mode................................... 451 Programming units.................................. 434 Programming/erasing in user program mode ......................................... 442 Pulse output ............................................ 264 PWM modes ........................................... 219 R N NMI .......................................................... 71 Non-overlapping pulse output ................ 290 Normal mode ............................ 14, 111, 120 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 532 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 Register direct ........................................... 39 Register field............................................. 37 Register indirect........................................ 39 Register indirect with displacement.......... 39 Register indirect with post-increment ....... 40 Register indirect with pre-decrement........ 40 Register information ............................... 107 Registers ADCR ......................... 415, 487, 496, 505 ADCSR....................... 413, 487, 496, 505 ADDR......................... 412, 486, 496, 505 BARA ........................... 88, 481, 490, 499 BARB ........................... 89, 481, 490, 499 BCRA ........................... 89, 481, 490, 499 BCRB ........................... 90, 481, 490, 499 BRR ............................ 327, 486, 495, 504 CRA.................................................... 103 CRB .................................................... 104 DAR.................................................... 103 DTCER ....................... 104, 481, 491, 500 DTVECR .................... 105, 482, 491, 500 EBR1 .......................... 437, 487, 496, 505 EBR2 .......................... 438, 487, 496, 505 FLMCR1..................... 435, 487, 496, 505 FLMCR2..................... 437, 487, 496, 505 IER................................ 67, 481, 490, 499 IPR................................ 66, 484, 493, 502 ISCR ............................. 68, 481, 490, 499 ISR................................ 70, 481, 490, 499 LPWRCR.................... 455, 481, 490, 499 MDCR .......................... 48, 481, 490, 499 MRA ................................................... 102 MRB ................................................... 103 MSTPCR .................... 468, 481, 490, 499 NDER ......................... 280, 482, 491, 500 NDR............................ 282, 482, 491, 500 P1DDR ....................... 129, 482, 491, 500 P1DR .......................... 130, 484, 493, 502 PADDR....................... 144, 482, 491, 500 PADR ......................... 145, 484, 493, 502 PAODR....................... 146, 482, 492, 501 PAPCR ....................... 146, 482, 491, 500 PBDDR....................... 148, 482, 491, 500 PBDR.......................... 149, 484, 494, 502 PBODR....................... 150, 482, 492, 501 PBPCR........................ 150, 482, 491, 500 PCDDR....................... 153, 482, 491, 500 PCDR .......................... 154, 484, 494, 503 PCODR ....................... 155, 482, 492, 501 PCPCR ........................ 155, 482, 491, 500 PCR............................. 284, 482, 491, 500 PDDDR....................... 159, 482, 491, 500 PDDR.......................... 160, 484, 494, 503 PDPCR........................ 161, 482, 491, 500 PFDDR........................ 162, 482, 491, 500 PFDR .......................... 163, 484, 494, 503 PMR ............................ 285, 482, 491, 500 PODR.......................... 281, 482, 491, 500 PORT1 ........................ 130, 487, 496, 505 PORT4 ........................ 138, 487, 496, 505 PORT9 ........................ 143, 487, 496, 505 PORTA ....................... 145, 487, 497, 505 PORTB........................ 149, 487, 497, 505 PORTC........................ 154, 487, 497, 505 PORTD ....................... 160, 487, 497, 505 PORTF ........................ 163, 487, 497, 505 RAMER ...................... 438, 484, 493, 502 RDR ............................ 312, 486, 496, 504 RSR..................................................... 312 RSTCSR...................... 303, 486, 495, 504 SAR..................................................... 103 SBYCR ....................... 466, 481, 490, 499 SCKCR ....................... 454, 481, 490, 499 SCMR ......................... 326, 486, 496, 504 SCR............................. 317, 486, 495, 504 SMR ............................ 313, 486, 495, 504 SSR ............................. 320, 486, 495, 504 SYSCR.......................... 49, 481, 490, 499 TCNT ......................... 203, 256, 300, 485, .................................... 486, 492, 495, 504 TCNTH ............................................... 494 TCOR.......................... 256, 481, 489, 499 TCR............................. 257, 481, 489, 499 TCSR .......................... 259, 481, 489, 499 TDR ............................ 312, 486, 495, 504 TGR ............................ 213, 483, 492, 501 TIER............................ 198, 483, 492, 501 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 533 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TIOR............................181, 482, 492, 501 TMDR .........................179, 482, 492, 501 TSR..............................312, 483, 492, 501 TSTR ...........................203, 484, 493, 502 TSYR...........................204, 484, 493, 502 Repeat mode ........................................... 112 Reset ......................................................... 55 Reset exception handling.......................... 55 S Scan mode .............................................. 416 Serial communication interface .............. 309 Shift instructions....................................... 32 Single mode ............................................ 416 Software activation ......................... 116, 122 Stack pointer (SP)..................................... 20 Stack status ............................................... 61 SWDTEND............................................. 116 Synchronous operation ........................... 210 System control instructions ...................... 36 T TCIU_1................................................... 234 TCIU_2................................................... 234 TCIU_4................................................... 234 TCIU_5................................................... 234 TCIV_0................................................... 234 TCIV_1................................................... 234 TCIV_2................................................... 234 TCIV_3................................................... 234 TCIV_4................................................... 234 TCIV_5................................................... 234 Rev. 1.00 Jan. 24, 2008 Page 534 of 534 REJ09B0426-0100 TCNT incrementation timing.................. 265 TGIA_0................................................... 234 TGIA_1................................................... 234 TGIA_2................................................... 234 TGIA_3................................................... 234 TGIA_4................................................... 234 TGIA_5................................................... 234 TGIB_0 ................................................... 234 TGIB_1 ................................................... 234 TGIB_2 ................................................... 234 TGIB_3 ................................................... 234 TGIB_4 ................................................... 234 TGIB_5 ................................................... 234 TGIC_0 ................................................... 234 TGIC_3 ................................................... 234 TGID_0................................................... 234 TGID_3................................................... 234 Toggle output.................................. 207, 273 Trace bit .................................................... 21 Traces........................................................ 58 Trap instruction......................................... 60 TRAPA instruction ............................. 41, 60 V Vector number for the software activation interrupt................................................... 105 W Watchdog timer....................................... 299 Waveform output by compare match...... 207 WOVI ..................................................... 305 Renesas 16-Bit Single-Chip Microcomputer Hardware Manual H8S/2604 Group Publication Date: Rev.1.00, Jan. 24, 2008 Published by: Sales Strategic Planning Div. Renesas Technology Corp. Edited by: Customer Support Department Global Strategic Communication Div. Renesas Solutions Corp. 2008. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan. Sales Strategic Planning Div. Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan RENESAS SALES OFFICES http://www.renesas.com Refer to "http://www.renesas.com/en/network" for the latest and detailed information. Renesas Technology America, Inc. 450 Holger Way, San Jose, CA 95134-1368, U.S.A Tel: <1> (408) 382-7500, Fax: <1> (408) 382-7501 Renesas Technology Europe Limited Dukes Meadow, Millboard Road, Bourne End, Buckinghamshire, SL8 5FH, U.K. Tel: <44> (1628) 585-100, Fax: <44> (1628) 585-900 Renesas Technology (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. Unit 204, 205, AZIACenter, No.1233 Lujiazui Ring Rd, Pudong District, Shanghai, China 200120 Tel: <86> (21) 5877-1818, Fax: <86> (21) 6887-7858/7898 Renesas Technology Hong Kong Ltd. 7th Floor, North Tower, World Finance Centre, Harbour City, Canton Road, Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong Tel: <852> 2265-6688, Fax: <852> 2377-3473 Renesas Technology Taiwan Co., Ltd. 10th Floor, No.99, Fushing North Road, Taipei, Taiwan Tel: <886> (2) 2715-2888, Fax: <886> (2) 3518-3399 Renesas Technology Singapore Pte. Ltd. 1 Harbour Front Avenue, #06-10, Keppel Bay Tower, Singapore 098632 Tel: <65> 6213-0200, Fax: <65> 6278-8001 Renesas Technology Korea Co., Ltd. Kukje Center Bldg. 18th Fl., 191, 2-ka, Hangang-ro, Yongsan-ku, Seoul 140-702, Korea Tel: <82> (2) 796-3115, Fax: <82> (2) 796-2145 Renesas Technology Malaysia Sdn. Bhd Unit 906, Block B, Menara Amcorp, Amcorp Trade Centre, No.18, Jln Persiaran Barat, 46050 Petaling Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan, Malaysia Tel: <603> 7955-9390, Fax: <603> 7955-9510 Colophon 6.2 H8S/2604 Group Hardware Manual